Download 2015 Nissan Murano | Owner`s Manual | Nissan USA

Transcript
®
2015
M U RAN O
OWNER’S MANUAL
For your safety, read carefully and keep in this vehicle.
Owner’s Manual Supplement
The information contained within this supplement revises the “Operating the power
liftgate (if so equipped)” information in the “Liftgate” section of the 2015 Murano
Owner’s Manual.
Read carefully and keep in vehicle.
Printing: October 2015 (01)
Publication No. SU15EA 4Z52U0
NOTE:
To open, close or reverse the power liftgate,
the shift lever must be in P (Park). Also, the
power liftgate will not operate if battery
voltage is low.
LPD2212
Instrument panel switch
OPERATING THE POWER LIFTGATE
(if so equipped)
WARNING
● Make sure that all passengers have
their hands, etc., inside the vehicle before closing the liftgate.
● Do not leave children unattended inside
the vehicle. They could unknowingly activate switches or controls. Unattended
children could become involved in serious accidents.
Power Open:
The power liftgate automatically moves from the
fully closed position to the fully open position in
approximately 5 – 8 seconds. The power open
feature can be activated by the switch on the
Intelligent Key, the instrument panel switch, the
glove box switch and the liftgate request switch.
A chime sounds to indicate the power open
sequence has been started.
LPD2295
Liftgate opener switch
● The liftgate can be opened by the instrument
panel switch, liftgate request switch and the
Intelligent Key even if the vehicle is locked.
The liftgate will individually unlock and open.
Once the liftgate is closed, the vehicle will
remain in the unlock status.
● The Intelligent Key button must be held for
1 second before the liftgate opens.
● The liftgate must be unlocked to open it with
A.
the liftgate opener switch 䊊
A warning chime will sound if the shift lever is
moved out of P (Park) during a power open
operation.
Power Close:
The power liftgate automatically moves from the
fully open position to the secondary position.
When the liftgate reaches the secondary position, the cinching motor engages and pulls the
liftgate to its primary latch position. Power close
takes approximately 7 – 10 seconds. The power
close feature can be activated by the switch on
the Intelligent Key, the instrument panel and the
A . A chime sounds to
liftgate opener switch 䊊
indicate the power close sequence has been
started.
A is activated
● If the liftgate opener switch 䊊
while the cinching motor is engaged, the
cinching motor will disengage and release
the latch.
● The Intelligent Key button must be held for
1 second before the liftgate closes.
Reverse:
The power liftgate will stop immediately during
power open or power close if the Intelligent Key,
instrument panel or liftgate switch is pushed or if
A is pushed. The
the liftgate opener switch 䊊
power liftgate will reverse direction if the Intelligent Key, instrument panel, liftgate switch or the
A is pushed a second
liftgate opener switch 䊊
time. A chime will sound to announce the reversal.
Auto Reverse:
If an obstacle is detected during power open or
power close, a warning chime will sound and the
liftgate will reverse direction and return to the full
open or full close position. If a second obstacle is
detected, the liftgate motion will stop and the
liftgate will enter manual mode.
A pinch strip is mounted on each side of the
liftgate. If an obstacle is detected by a pinch strip
during power close, the liftgate will reverse direction and return to the full open position.
NOTE:
If the pinch strip is damaged or removed,
the power close function will not operate.
WARNING
There are some small distances immediately before the closed position which
cannot be detected. Make sure that all
passengers have their hands, etc., inside
the vehicle before closing the liftgate.
LPD2297
Manual Mode:
If power operation is not available, the liftgate
may be operated manually. Power operation may
not be available if the power liftgate main switch
is in the ON position, if multiple obstacles have
been detected in a single power cycle, or if
battery voltage is low.
If the power liftgate opener switch is pushed
during power open or close, the power operation
will be canceled and the liftgate can be operated
manually.
To open the liftgate manually, press the liftgate
opener switch and lift the liftgate.
To close, lower and push the liftgate down securely.
Auto Power Back Door System Battery
Power Saving Mode:
The vehicle goes into power saving mode when
the liftgate is open for a long time (approximately
12 hours). This is to prevent deterioration of the
battery. The power saving mode automatically
cuts the power supply of the power liftgate door.
When the power to the liftgate is cut off, the
manual mode must be performed. After the
manual mode is performed, the power liftgate
function is restored.
NOTE:
When a battery voltage is lower than approximately 11V, the power back door may
not operate after automatic return.
FOREWORD
Welcome to the growing family of new NISSAN
owners. This vehicle is delivered to you with
confidence. It was produced using the latest
techniques and strict quality control.
This manual was prepared to help you understand the operation and maintenance of your
vehicle so that you may enjoy many miles (kilometers) of driving pleasure. Please read through this
manual before operating your vehicle.
A separate Warranty Information Booklet
explains details about the warranties covering your vehicle. The “NISSAN Service
and Maintenance Guide” explains details
about maintaining and servicing your vehicle. Additionally, a separate Customer
Care/Lemon Law Booklet (U.S. only) will
explain how to resolve any concerns you
may have with your vehicle, and clarify your
rights under your state’s lemon law.
A NISSAN dealership knows your vehicle best.
When you require any service or have any questions, they will be glad to assist you with the
extensive resources available to them.
In addition to factory-installed options, your vehicle may also be equipped with additional accessories installed by NISSAN or by a NISSAN
dealer prior to delivery. It is important that you
familiarize yourself with all disclosures, warnings,
cautions and instructions concerning proper use
READ FIRST—THEN DRIVE SAFELY
of such accessories prior to operating the vehicle
and/or accessory. See a NISSAN dealer for details concerning the particular accessories with
which your vehicle is equipped.
Before driving your vehicle, please read this
Owner’s Manual carefully. This will ensure familiarity with controls and maintenance requirements, assisting you in the safe operation of your
vehicle.
WARNING
IMPORTANT SAFETY INFORMATION REMINDERS FOR SAFETY!
Follow these important driving rules to
help ensure a safe and comfortable trip
for you and your passengers!
● NEVER drive under the influence of alcohol or drugs.
● ALWAYS observe posted speed limits
and never drive too fast for conditions.
● ALWAYS give your full attention to driving
and avoid using vehicle features or taking
other actions that could distract you.
● ALWAYS use your seat belts and appropriate child restraint systems. Pre-teen
children should be seated in the rear seat.
● ALWAYS provide information about the
proper use of vehicle safety features to
all occupants of the vehicle.
● ALWAYS review this Owner’s Manual
for important safety information.
WHEN READING THE MANUAL
For descriptions specified for all-wheel drive
models, an AWD mark is placed at the beginning
of the applicable sections/items.
As with other vehicles with features for
off-road use, failure to operate all-wheel
drive models correctly may result in loss of
control or an accident. Be sure to read
“Driving safety precautions” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual.
ON-PAVEMENT AND OFF-ROAD DRIVING
This vehicle will handle and maneuver
differently from an ordinary passenger
car because it has a higher center of
gravity for off-road use. As with other
vehicles with features of this type, failure to operate this vehicle correctly may
result in loss of control or an accident.
For additional information, refer to “Onpavement and off-road driving
precautions,” “Avoiding collision and
rollover” and “Driving safety precautions” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual.
MODIFICATION OF YOUR VEHICLE
This vehicle should not be modified.
Modification
could
affect
its
performance, safety or durability and may
even violate governmental regulations. In
addition, damage or performance problems resulting from modifications may
not be covered under NISSAN warranties.
This manual includes information for all features
and equipment available on this model. Features
and equipment in your vehicle may vary depending on model, trim level, options selected, order,
date of production, region or availability. Therefore, you may find information about features or
equipment that are not included or installed on
your vehicle.
All information, specifications and illustrations in
this manual are those in effect at the time of printing. NISSAN reserves the right to change specifications, performance, design or component suppliers without notice and without obligation. From
time to time, NISSAN may update or revise this
manual to provide Owners with the most accurate
information currently available. Please carefully
read and retain with this manual all revision updates sent to you by NISSAN to ensure you have
access to accurate and up-to-date information regarding your vehicle. Current versions of vehicle
Owner’s Manuals and any updates can also be
found in the Owner section of the NISSAN website
at https://owners.nissanusa.com/nowners/
navigation/manualsGuide. If you have questions concerning any information in your Owner’s
Manual, contact NISSAN Consumer Affairs. See
the NISSAN CUSTOMER CARE PROGRAM
page in this Owner’s Manual for contact information.
IMPORTANT INFORMATION ABOUT
THIS MANUAL
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65
WARNING
You will see various symbols in this manual. They
are used in the following ways:
WARNING
WARNING
This is used to indicate the presence of a
hazard that could cause death or serious
personal injury. To avoid or reduce the
risk, the procedures must be followed
precisely.
CAUTION
This is used to indicate the presence of a
hazard that could cause minor or moderate personal injury or damage to your vehicle. To avoid or reduce the risk, the procedures must be followed carefully.
APD1005
If you see this symbol, it means “Do not do this”
or “Do not let this happen.”
If you see a symbol similar to these in an illustration, it means the arrow points to the front of the
vehicle.
Arrows in an illustration that are similar to these
indicate movement or action.
Arrows in an illustration that are similar to these
call attention to an item in the illustration.
Engine exhaust, some of its constituents,
and certain vehicle components contain or
emit chemicals known to the State of
California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles
and certain products of component wear
contain or emit chemicals known to the
State of California to cause cancer and
birth defects or other reproductive harm.
CALIFORNIA PERCHLORATE
ADVISORY
Some vehicle parts, such as lithium batteries, may contain perchlorate material. The
following advisory is provided: “Perchlorate
Material – special handling may apply, See
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate/”.
BLUETOOTH® is a
trademark owned by
Bluetooth SIG, Inc.
and licensed to
Visteon.
SiriusXM® services
require a subscription
after trial period and
are sold separately or
as a package. The
satellite service is
available only in the
48 contiguous USA
and DC. SiriusXM
satellite service is
also available in
Canada; see
www.siriusxm.ca.
© 2015 NISSAN NORTH AMERICA, INC.
All rights reserved. No part of this Owner’s
Manual may be reproduced or stored in a retrieval
system, or transmitted in any form, or by any
means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying,
recording or otherwise, without the prior written
permission of Nissan North America, Inc.
NISSAN CUSTOMER CARE PROGRAM
NISSAN CARES . . .
Both NISSAN and your NISSAN dealer are dedicated to serving all your automotive needs. Your satisfaction with your vehicle and your NISSAN dealer are
our primary concerns. Your NISSAN dealer is always available to assist you with all your automobile sales and service needs.
However, if there is something that your NISSAN
dealer cannot assist you with or you would like to
provide NISSAN directly with comments or
questions, please contact the NISSAN Consumer Affairs Department using our toll-free
number:
For U.S. customers
1-800-NISSAN-1
(1-800-647-7261)
For Canadian customers
1-800-387-0122
The Consumer Affairs Department will ask for the
following information:
– Your name, address, and telephone number
– Vehicle identification number (attached to the
top of the instrument panel on the driver’s
side)
– Date of purchase
– Current odometer reading
– Your NISSAN dealer’s name
– Your comments or questions
OR
You can write to NISSAN with the information at:
For U.S. customers
Nissan North America, Inc.
Consumer Affairs Department
P.O. Box 685003
Franklin, TN 37068-5003
or via e-mail at:
[email protected]
For Canadian customers
Nissan Canada Inc.
5290 Orbitor Drive
Mississauga, Ontario L4W 4Z5
or via e-mail at:
[email protected]
If you prefer, visit us at:
www.nissanusa.com (for U.S. customers) or
www.nissan.ca (for Canadian customers)
We appreciate your interest in NISSAN and thank you for buying a quality NISSAN vehicle.
Table of
Contents
Illustrated table of contents
0
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1
Instruments and controls
2
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
4
Starting and driving
5
In case of emergency
6
Appearance and care
7
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8
Technical and consumer information
9
Index
10
0 Illustrated table of contents
Air bags, seat belts and child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-2
Exterior front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-3
Exterior rear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-4
Passenger compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-5
Instrument panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-6
Engine compartment check locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-8
Warning/indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-9
AIR BAGS, SEAT BELTS AND CHILD
RESTRAINTS
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
Supplemental front-impact air bags
(P. 1-46)
Occupant classification sensor
(weight sensor) (P. 1-46)
Seat belts (P. 1-13)
Head restraints/headrests (P. 1-10)
Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and
rollover supplemental air bag (P. 1-46)
Rear seat center seat belt (located on
ceiling) (P. 1-13)
Rear seat outboard seat top tether
strap anchor (located on bottom of
seatback) (P. 1-25)
LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for
CHildren) system (P. 1-25)
Folding rear bench seat (P. 1-2)
Front seat-mounted side-impact
supplemental air bag (P. 1-46)
Seat belt with pretensioner (P. 1-46)
Seats (P. 1-2)
Driver supplemental knee air bag
(P. 1-46)
Refer to the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details.
LII2269
0-2 Illustrated table of contents
EXTERIOR FRONT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
Front view camera (if so equipped)
(P. 4-12)
Engine hood (P. 3-22)
Windshield wiper and washer switch,
wiper blades (P. 2-27, 8-19)
Windshield (P. 8-19)
Rearview mirror (P. 3-32)
Power windows (P. 2-45)
Door locks, NISSAN Intelligent Key®,
keys (P. 3-4, 3-2)
Mirrors (P. 3-32)
Side view camera (if so equipped)
(P. 4-12)
Tire pressure (P. 8-29)
Flat tire (P. 6-3)
Tire chains (P. 8-36)
Fog light switch (if so equipped)
(P. 2-30)
Replacing bulbs (P. 8-27)
Headlight and turn signal switch
(P. 2-30)
Refer to the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details.
LII2225
Illustrated table of contents 0-3
EXTERIOR REAR
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Antenna (P. 4-29)
Rear window wiper and washer switch
(P. 2-29)
Liftgate release (P. 3-22)
Rearview camera (P. 4-2)
Replacing bulbs (P. 8-27)
Fuel-filler door (P. 3-27)
Fuel-filler cap, fuel recommendation
(P. 3-27, P. 9-2 )
Child safety rear door lock (P. 3-4)
Refer to the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details.
LII2222
0-4 Illustrated table of contents
PASSENGER COMPARTMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Glove box (P. 2-40)
Console box (P. 2-40)
Map lights (P. 2-51)
Power moonroof (if so equipped)
(P. 2-48)
Luggage hooks (P. 2-40)
Center armrest (rear seats) (P. 1-2)
Sun visors (P. 3-31)
Seats (P. 1-2)
Cup holders (P. 2-40)
Refer to the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details.
LII2223
Illustrated table of contents 0-5
INSTRUMENT PANEL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
LIC2999
0-6 Illustrated table of contents
Vent (P. 4-25)
Headlight/fog light (if so equipped)/turn
signal switch (P. 2-30)
Supplemental front-impact air bag
(P. 1-46)
Meters, gauges, warning/indicator
lights and Vehicle Information Display
(P. 2-3, P. 2-7, P. 2-14)
Windshield wiper/washer switch and
rear window wiper/washer switch
(P. 2-27)
Vent (P. 4-25)
Hazard warning flasher switch (P. 6-2)
Radio (P. 4-38)
Front passenger supplemental air bag
(P. 2-25)
Vent (P. 4-25)
Glove box (P. 2-43)
Front passenger air bag warning status
light (P. 1-46)
Power outlet (P. 2-39)
Heater and air conditioning controls
(P. 4-26)
Shift lever (P. 5-16)
Push-button ignition switch (P. 5-10)
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
Cruise control main/Intelligent Cruise
Control (ICC) (if so equipped) set
switches (P. 5-33)
Driver supplemental knee air bag
(P. 1-46)
Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System/
Audio control switches (P. 4-29)
Hood release (P. 3-22)/Fuel door
release (P. 3-27)
Fuse box (P. 8-22)
Power liftgate main switch
(if so equipped) (P. 3-23)
Heated steering wheel switch
(if so equipped) (P. 2-34)
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF
switch (P. 2-38)
Instrument brightness control
(P. 2-30)/Twin trip odometer reset
switch (P. 2-3)
*: Refer to the separate Navigation System Owner’s Manual (if so equipped).
Refer to the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details.
Illustrated table of contents 0-7
ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECK
LOCATIONS
VQ35DE engine
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
Engine coolant reservoir (P. 8-7)
Drive belt location (P. 8-17)
Engine oil dipstick (P. 8-9)
Engine oil filler cap (P. 8-9)
Brake fluid reservoir (P. 8-14)
Air cleaner (P. 8-18)
Fuse box (P. 8-22)
Fuse box/Fusible links (P. 8-22)
Battery (P. 8-15)
Radiator cap (P. 8-7)
Power steering fluid reservoir (P. 8-13)
Windshield-washer fluid reservoir
(P. 8-14)
Engine cover removed for clarity.
Refer to the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details.
LDI2633
0-8 Illustrated table of contents
WARNING/INDICATOR LIGHTS
Warning
light
or
Name
Page
Anti-lock Braking
System (ABS) warning light
2-8
Brake warning light
Warning
light
Name
Page
Low windshieldwasher fluid warning
light
2-11
Master warning light
Name
Page
High beam indicator
light (blue)
2-12
Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)
2-12
2-11
2-11
Security indicator
light
2-13
Power steering
warning light
2-11
Side light and headlight indicator light
(green)
2-13
Seat belt warning
light and chime
Supplemental air
bag warning light
2-12
Slip indicator light
2-13
Page
Turn signal/hazard
indicator lights
2-13
Front fog light indicator light (if so
equipped)
2-12
Vehicle Dynamic
Control (VDC) off
indicator light
2-14
Front passenger air
bag status light
2-12
2-8
or
Charge warning
light
2-8
Engine oil pressure
warning light
2-8
Forward Emergency
Braking system
warning light (if so
equipped)
2-9
Low tire pressure
warning light
2-9
Indicator
light
Name
Indicator
light
Illustrated table of contents 0-9
MEMO
0-10 Illustrated table of contents
1 Safety—Seats, seat belts and
supplemental restraint system
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
Front manual seat adjustment
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
Front power seat adjustment
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
Rear bench seat adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
Armrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7
Flexible seating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7
Head restraints/headrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
Adjustable head restraint/headrest
components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
Remove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
Install . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
Adjust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
Precautions on seat belt usage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
Seat belt warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16
Pregnant women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16
Injured persons. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16
Three-point type seat belt with retractor . . . . . . . . . . 1-16
Seat belt extenders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22
Seat belt maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23
Child safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23
Infants. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24
Small children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24
Larger children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24
Child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25
Precautions on child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25
LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for
CHildren) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-27
Rear-facing child restraint installation using
LATCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
Rear-facing child restraint installation using
the seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-32
Forward-facing child restraint installation
using LATCH. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-35
Forward-facing child restraint installation
using the seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-39
Booster seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-43
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-46
Precautions on SRS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-46
Supplemental air bag warning labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-65
Supplemental air bag warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-66
SEATS
● Do not leave children or adults who
would normally require assistance of
others alone in your vehicle. Pets
should also not be left alone. They
could accidentally injure themselves or
others through inadvertent operation of
the vehicle. Also, on hot, sunny days,
temperatures in a closed vehicle could
quickly become high enough to cause
severe or possibly fatal injuries to
people or animals.
ARS1152
WARNING
● Do not ride in a moving vehicle when
the seatback is reclined. This can be
dangerous. The shoulder belt will not
be against your body. In an accident,
you could be thrown into it and receive
neck or other serious injuries. You
could also slide under the lap belt and
receive serious internal injuries.
● For the most effective protection when
the vehicle is in motion, the seat should
be upright. Always sit well back in the
seat with both feet on the floor and
adjust the seat properly. For additional
information, refer to “Precautions on
seat belt usage” in this section.
● After adjustment, gently rock in the seat
to make sure it is securely locked.
● Do not adjust the driver’s seat while
driving so full attention may be given to
vehicle operation. The seat may move
suddenly and could cause loss of control of the vehicle.
● The seatback should not be reclined
any more than needed for comfort. Seat
belts are most effective when the passenger sits well back and straight up in
the seat. If the seatback is reclined, the
risk of sliding under the lap belt and
being injured is increased.
CAUTION
When adjusting the seat positions, be
sure not to contact any moving parts to
avoid possible injuries and/or damage.
1-2 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
FRONT MANUAL SEAT
ADJUSTMENT (if so equipped)
Your vehicle seats can be adjusted manually. For
additional information about adjusting the seats,
refer to the steps outlined in this section.
LRS2160
LRS2161
Forward and backward
Reclining
Pull the center of the bar up and hold it while you
slide the seat forward or backward to the desired
position. Release the bar to lock the seat in
position.
To recline the seatback, pull the lever up and lean
back. To bring the seatback forward, pull the lever
up and lean your body forward. Release the lever
to lock the seatback in position.
The reclining feature allows adjustment of the
seatback for occupants of different sizes for
added comfort and to help obtain proper seat
belt fit. For additional information, refer to “Precautions on seat belt usage” in this section. Also,
the seatback can be reclined to allow occupants
to rest when the vehicle is stopped and the shift
lever is in the P (Park) position.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-3
LRS2202
Seat lifter (driver’s seat)
Pull up or push down the adjusting lever to adjust
the seat height until the desired position is
achieved.
LRS2130
FRONT POWER SEAT ADJUSTMENT
(if so equipped)
Operating tips
● The power seat motor has an auto-reset
overload protection circuit. If the motor
stops during operation, wait 30 seconds
then reactivate the switch.
● Do not operate the power seat switch for a
long period of time when the engine is off.
This will discharge the battery.
Forward and backward
Moving the switch forward or backward will slide
the seat forward or backward to the desired
position.
Reclining
Move the recline switch backward until the desired angle is obtained. To bring the seatback
forward again, move the switch forward and
move your body forward. The seatback will move
forward.
1-4 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
The reclining feature allows adjustment of the
seatback for occupants of different sizes for
added comfort and to help obtain proper seat
belt fit. For additional information, refer to “Precautions on seat belt usage” in this section. Also,
the seatback can be reclined to allow occupants
to rest when the vehicle is stopped and the shift
lever is in P (Park).
LRS2636
LRS2270
Seat lifter (driver’s seat)
Lumbar support (driver’s seat)
Push the front or rear end of the switch up or
down to adjust the angle and height of the seat
cushion.
The lumbar support feature provides adjustable
lower back support to the driver. Push the front or
back end of the switch to adjust the seat lumbar
area.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-5
WARNING
● After adjustment, check to be sure the
seat is securely locked.
● Do not ride in a moving vehicle when
the seatback is reclined. This can be
dangerous. The shoulder belt will not
be against your body. In an accident,
you could be thrown into it and receive
neck or other serious injuries. You
could also slide under the lap belt and
receive serious internal injuries.
LRS2570
Outboard seats
REAR BENCH SEAT ADJUSTMENT
LRS2635
Reclining
A and position the seatPull the reclining strap 䊊
back at the desired angle. Release the reclining
strap after positioning the seat at the desired
angle.
The reclining feature allows adjustment of the
seatback for occupants of different sizes to help
obtain proper seat belt fit. For additional information, refer to “Precautions on the seat belt usage”
in this section. The seatback may also be reclined
to allow occupants to rest when the vehicle is
parked.
1-6 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
● For the most effective protection when
the vehicle is in motion, the seat should
be upright. Always sit well back in the
seat with both feet on the floor and
adjust the seat belt properly. For additional information, refer to “Precautions on seat belt usage” in this section.
FLEXIBLE SEATING
WARNING
● Never allow anyone to ride in the cargo
area or on the rear seats when they are
in the fold-down position. In a collision,
people riding in these areas without
proper restraints are more likely to be
seriously injured or killed.
LRS2588
ARMRESTS
The rear bench center armrest is locked in the up
position. To lower the armrest, pull the armrest
down.
To return the armrest to the up position, push up
on the armrest until it is in the full up position.
● Do not allow people to ride in any area
of your vehicle that is not equipped with
seats and seat belts. Be sure everyone
in your vehicle is in a seat and using a
seat belt properly.
● Do not allow more than one person to
use the same seat belt.
● Do not fold down the rear seats when
occupants are in the rear seat area or
any luggage is on the rear seats.
– Make sure that the seat path is clear
before moving the seat.
– Be careful not to allow hands or feet
to get caught or pinched in the seat.
● Head restraints/headrests should be
adjusted properly as they may provide
significant protection against injury in
an accident. Always replace and adjust
them properly if they have been removed for any reason.
● If the head restraints/headrests are removed for any reason, they should be
securely stored to prevent them from
causing injury to passengers or damage
to the vehicle in case of sudden braking
or an accident.
● When returning rear row seatbacks to
the upright position, either by manual
operation or power operation (if so
equipped), the operator should always
verify that the back is locked in the
upright position by gently rocking the
seatback before allowing passengers
to occupy the rear seats. If they are not
completely secured, passengers may be
injured in an accident or sudden stop.
● Properly secure all cargo to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not
place cargo higher than the seatbacks.
In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured
cargo could cause personal injury.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-7
LRS2589
Folding the rear bench seat
Before folding the rear seats:
● Disconnect and secure the center seat belt
and tongue into the retractor base. For additional information, refer to “Stowing the
rear center seat belt” in this section.
LRS2590
To fold down the seatbacks:
1. Pull the strap on the rear seat.
or
2. Pull the lever beside the cargo area and fold
the seatback.
● Secure the seat belts on the seat belt hooks
on the side wall. For additional information,
refer to “Seat belt hooks” in this section.
● Remove drink containers from the rear cup
holder.
1-8 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2591
To return the seatbacks:
Manual operation:
1. Lift up each seatback and push it to the
upright position until it is latched.
2. Always reconnect the center seat belt when
the seat is returned to the upright position.
If the control unit detects any obstacle or malfunctions while in the power operation, a beep
sounds for 4 seconds and the seatback will return to the folded position automatically. Check if
there are any obstacles caught that prevent seats
from returning to the folded position. See a
NISSAN dealer if the beep still sounds.
● If the rear center seat belt connector
and the seatbacks are not secured in
the correct position, serious personal
injury may result in an accident or sudden stop.
CAUTION
When operating the rear power seatback
return, make sure that the vehicle is
stopped and the transmission is in the P
(Park) position.
LRS2659
䊊
B
䊊
A
Instrument panel switch
Cargo area switch
Power operation (if so equipped):
1. Push and hold the corresponding switch
located on the lower side of the instrument
panel or the right or left side in the cargo
area.
A beep sounds once and the seatback will be
returned automatically.
A beep sounds twice when the seatback is fully
returned to the seating position.
WARNING
● When returning the seatbacks, be sure
to attach the rear center seat belt
connector.
● Do not unfasten the rear center seat
belt connector except when folding
down the rear seat.
● When attaching the rear center seat belt
connector, be certain that the seatbacks are completely secured in the
latched position and the rear center
seat belt connector is completely
secured.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-9
HEAD RESTRAINTS/HEADRESTS
● Adjustable head restraints/headrests have
multiple notches along the stalk(s) to lock
them in a desired adjustment position.
WARNING
Head restraints/headrests supplement
the other vehicle safety systems. They may
provide additional protection against injury in certain rear end collisions. Adjustable head restraints/headrests must be
adjusted properly, as specified in this section. Check the adjustment after someone
else uses the seat. Do not attach anything
to the head restraint/headrest stalks or
remove the head restraint/headrest. Do
not use the seat if the head
restraint/headrest has been removed. If
the head restraint/headrest was removed,
reinstall and properly adjust the head
restraint/headrest before an occupant
uses the seating position. Failure to follow these instructions can reduce the effectiveness
of
the
head
restraints/headrests. This may increase
the risk of serious injury or death in a
collision.
● Proper Adjustment:
– For the adjustable type, align the head
restraint/headrest so the center of your
ear is approximately level with the center
of the head restraint/headrest.
– If your ear position is still higher than the
recommended alignment, place the head
restraint/headrest at the highest position.
LRS2403
The illustration shows the seating positions
equipped with head restraints/headrests.
䉱 Indicates the seating position is equipped with
a head restraint.
䡲 Indicates the seating position is equipped with
a headrest.
+ Indicates the seating position is not equipped
with a head restraint or headrest (if applicable).
● Your vehicle is equipped with a head
restraint/headrest that may be integrated,
adjustable or non-adjustable.
1-10 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
● If the head restraint/headrest has been removed, ensure that it is reinstalled and
locked in place before riding in that designated seating position.
5. Reinstall and properly adjust the head
restraint/headrest before an occupant uses
the seating position.
LRS2300
ADJUSTABLE HEAD RESTRAINT/
HEADREST COMPONENTS
1. Removable head restraint/headrest
2. Multiple notches
3. Lock knob
4. Stalks
LRS2302
REMOVE
Use the following procedure to remove the head
restraint/headrest:
1. Pull the head restraint/headrest up to the
highest position.
2. Push and hold the lock knob.
3. Remove the head restraint/headrest from
the seat.
4. Store the head restraint/headrest properly in
a secure place so it is not loose in the
vehicle.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-11
LRS2303
INSTALL
1. Align the head restraint/headrest stalks with
the holes in the seat. Make sure that the
head restraint/headrest is facing the correct
direction. The stalk with the notch (notches)
1 must be installed in the hole with the lock
䊊
2 .
knob 䊊
WRS0134
LRS2305
ADJUST
Raise
For adjustable head restraint/headrest
To raise the head restraint/headrest, pull it up.
Adjust the head restraint/headrest so the center
is level with the center of your ears. If your ear
position is still higher than the recommended
alignment, place the head restraint/headrest at
the highest position.
Make sure the head restraint/headrest is positioned so the lock knob is engaged in the notch
before riding in that designated seating position.
2. Push and hold the lock knob and push the
head restraint/headrest down.
3. Properly adjust the head restraint/headrest
before an occupant uses the seating position.
1-12 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
SEAT BELTS
LRS2306
Lower
To lower, push and hold the lock knob and push
the head restraint/headrest down.
Make sure the head restraint/headrest is positioned so the lock knob is engaged in the notch
before riding in that designated seating position.
SSS0136
PRECAUTIONS ON SEAT BELT
USAGE
If you are wearing your seat belt properly adjusted and you are sitting upright and well back in
your seat with both feet on the floor, your chances
of being injured or killed in a collision and/or the
severity of injury may be greatly reduced.
NISSAN strongly encourages you and all of your
passengers to buckle up every time you drive,
even if your seating position includes a supplemental air bag.
Most U.S. states and Canadian provinces or
territories specify that seat belts be worn at
all times when a vehicle is being driven.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-13
SSS0134
WARNING
● Every person who drives or rides in this
vehicle should use a seat belt at all
times. Children should be in the rear
seats and in an appropriate restraint.
1-14 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
SSS0016
WARNING
● The seat belt should be properly adjusted to a snug fit. Failure to do so may
reduce the effectiveness of the entire
restraint system and increase the
chance or severity of injury in an accident. Serious injury or death can occur if
the seat belt is not worn properly.
● Be sure the seat belt tongue is securely
fastened to the proper buckle.
● Do not wear the seat belt inside out or
twisted. Doing so may reduce its
effectiveness.
● Do not allow more than one person to
use the same seat belt.
● Never carry more people in the vehicle
than there are seat belts.
SSS0014
WARNING
● Always route the shoulder belt over
your shoulder and across your chest.
Never put the belt behind your back,
under your arm or across your neck. The
belt should be away from your face and
neck, but not falling off your shoulder.
● Position the lap belt as low and snug as
possible AROUND THE HIPS, NOT THE
WAIST. A lap belt worn too high could
increase the risk of internal injuries in
an accident.
● If the seat belt warning light glows continuously while the ignition is turned
ON with all doors closed and all seat
belts fastened, it may indicate a malfunction in the system. Have the system
checked by a NISSAN dealer.
● No changes should be made to the seat
belt system. For example, do not modify
the seat belt, add material, or install
devices that may change the seat belt
routing or tension. Doing so may affect
the operation of the seat belt system.
Modifying or tampering with the seat
belt system may result in serious personal injury.
● Once a seat belt pretensioner has activated, it cannot be reused and must be
replaced together with the retractor.
See a NISSAN dealer.
● Removal and installation of pretensioner system components should be
done by a NISSAN dealer.
● All seat belt assemblies, including retractors and attaching hardware, should
be inspected after any collision by a
NISSAN dealer. NISSAN recommends
that all seat belt assemblies in use during a collision be replaced unless the
collision was minor and the belts show
no damage and continue to operate
properly. Seat belt assemblies not in
use during a collision should also be
inspected and replaced if either damage or improper operation is noted.
● All child restraints and attaching hardware should be inspected after any collision. Always follow the restraint
manufacturer’s inspection instructions
and replacement recommendations.
The child restraints should be replaced
if they are damaged.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-15
PREGNANT WOMEN
NISSAN recommends that pregnant women use
seat belts. The seat belt should be worn snug and
always position the lap belt as low as possible
around the hips, not the waist. Place the shoulder
belt over your shoulder and across your chest.
Never run the lap/shoulder belt over your abdominal area. Contact your doctor for specific
recommendations.
INJURED PERSONS
LRS0786
SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT
Both the driver’s and passenger’s front seats are
equipped with a seat belt warning light. The
warning light, located on the instrument panel,
will show the status of the driver and passenger
seat belt.
NOTE:
NISSAN recommends that injured persons use
seat belts. Check with your doctor for specific
recommendations.
THREE-POINT TYPE SEAT BELT
WITH RETRACTOR
WARNING
● Every person who drives or rides in this
vehicle should use a seat belt at all
times.
The front passenger seat belt warning light
will not light up if the seat is not occupied.
For
additional
information,
refer
to
“Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders”
in the “Instruments and controls” section of this
manual.
1-16 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
● Do not ride in a moving vehicle when
the seatback is reclined. This can be
dangerous. The shoulder belt will not
be against your body. In an accident,
you could be thrown into it and receive
neck or other serious injuries. You
could also slide under the lap belt and
receive serious internal injuries.
● For the most effective protection when
the vehicle is in motion, the seat should
be upright. Always sit well back and
upright in the seat with both feet on the
floor and adjust the seat belt properly.
● Do not allow children to play with the
seat belts. Most seating positions are
equipped with Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode seat belts. If the seat
belt becomes wrapped around a child’s
neck with the ALR mode activated, the
child can be seriously injured or killed if
the seat belt retracts and becomes
tight. This can occur even if the vehicle
is parked. Unbuckle the seat belt to
release the child. If the seat belt cannot
be unbuckled or is already unbuckled,
release the child by cutting the seat belt
with a suitable tool (such as a knife or
scissors) to release the seat belt.
LRS2160
Manual front seat shown
Fastening the seat belts
1. Adjust the seat. For additional information,
refer to “Seats” in this section.
LRS2593
Power front seat shown
LRS2674
2. Slowly pull the seat belt out of the retractor
A until
and insert the tongue into the buckle 䊊
you hear and feel the latch engage.
● The retractor is designed to lock during a sudden stop or on impact. A
slow pulling motion permits the seat
belt to move and allows you some
freedom of movement in the seat.
● If the seat belt cannot be pulled from
its fully retracted position, firmly pull
the belt and release it. Then
smoothly pull the belt out of the retractor.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-17
The ELR mode allows the seat belt to extend and
retract to allow the driver and passengers some
freedom of movement in the seat. The ELR locks
the seat belt when the vehicle slows down rapidly
or during certain impacts.
The ALR mode (child restraint mode) locks the
seat belt for child restraint installation.
LRS2675
3. Position the lap belt portion low and snug
B as shown.
on the hips䊊
4. Pull the shoulder belt portion toward the
C . Be sure
retractor to take up extra slack 䊊
the shoulder belt is routed over your shoulder and across your chest.
The front passenger seat and the rear seating
positions three-point seat belts have two modes
of operation:
● Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)
● Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)
When the ALR mode is activated, the seat belt
cannot be extended again until the seat belt
tongue is detached from the buckle and fully
retracted. The seat belt returns to the ELR mode
after the seat belt fully retracts. For additional
information, refer to “Child restraints” in this section.
The ALR mode should be used only for
child restraint installation. During normal
seat belt use by an occupant, the ALR mode
should not be activated. If it is activated, it
may cause uncomfortable seat belt tension.
WARNING
When fastening the seat belts, be certain
that the seatbacks are completely secured
in the latched position. If they are not
completely secured, passengers may be
injured in an accident or sudden stop.
1-18 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
WRS0139
Unfastening the seat belts
To unfasten the seat belt, press the button on the
1 . The seat belt automatically retracts.
buckle 䊊
Checking seat belt operation
Seat belt retractors are designed to lock seat belt
movement by two separate methods:
● When the seat belt is pulled quickly from the
retractor
● When the vehicle slows down rapidly
To increase your confidence in the seat belts,
check the operation as follows:
● Grasp the shoulder belt and pull forward
quickly. The retractor should lock and restrict further belt movement.
If the retractor does not lock during this check or
if you have any questions about seat belt operation, see a NISSAN dealer.
LRS2529
SSS0241
The rear center seat belt has a connector tongue
1 and a seat belt tongue 䊊
2 . Both the connector
䊊
tongue and the seat belt tongue must be securely
latched for proper seat belt operation.
● Always fasten the connector tongue
and the seat belt in the order shown.
Rear center seat belt
WARNING
● Always make sure both the connector
tongue and the seat belt tongue are
secured when using the seat belt or
installing a child restraint. Do not use
the seat belt or child restraint with only
the seat belt tongue attached. This
could result in serious personal injury in
case of an accident or a sudden stop.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-19
Stowing the rear center seat belt
When folding down the rear seat, the rear center
seat belt can be retracted into a stowed position
as follows:
1 so that the
1. Hold the connector tongue 䊊
seat belt does not retract suddenly when the
tongue is released from the connector
buckle. Release the connector tongue by
A into
inserting a suitable tool such as a key 䊊
the connector buckle.
2. Insert the seat belt tongue into the retractor
2 .
base first 䊊
3. Then secure the connector tongue into the
3 .
retractor base 䊊
WARNING
● Do not unfasten the rear center seat
belt connector except when folding
down the rear seat.
● When attaching the rear center seat belt
connector, be certain that the seatbacks are completely secured in the
latched position and the rear center
seat belt connector is completely
secured.
LRS2660
1-20 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
● If the rear center seat belt connector
and the seatbacks are not secured in
the correct position, serious personal
injury may result in an accident or sudden stop.
Attaching the center seat belt
WARNING
Always be sure the center seat belt connector
tongue and connector buckle are attached. Disconnect only when folding down the rear seat.
● Do not unfasten the rear center seat
belt connector except when folding
down the rear seat.
To connect the buckle:
● When attaching the rear center seat belt
connector, be certain that the seatbacks are completely secured in the
latched position and the rear center
seat belt connector is completely
secured.
1. Pull out the connector tongue from the re1 .
tractor base 䊊
2. Pull out the seat belt tongue from the retrac2 .
tor base 䊊
3. Pull the seat belt and secure the connector
3 .
buckle until it clicks 䊊
The center seat belt connector tongue can be
attached only into the rear center seat belt connector buckle.
● If the rear center seat belt connector
and the seatbacks are not secured in
the correct position, serious personal
injury may result in an accident or sudden stop.
To fasten the seat belt, refer to ⬙Fastening the
seat belts⬙ in this section.
LRS2661
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-21
WARNING
● After adjustment, release the adjustment button and try to move the shoulder belt anchor up and down to make
sure it is securely fixed in position.
● The shoulder belt anchor height should
be adjusted to the position best for you.
Failure to do so may reduce the effectiveness of the entire restraint system
and increase the chance or severity of
injury in an accident.
LRS0242
Shoulder belt height adjustment (front
seats)
The shoulder belt anchor height should be adjusted to the position best for you. For additional
information, refer to “Precautions on seat belt
usage” in this section. To adjust, pull out the
1 and move the shoulder belt
adjustment button 䊊
2 , so the belt
anchor to the desired position 䊊
passes over the center of the shoulder. The belt
should be away from your face and neck, but not
falling off your shoulder. Release the adjustment
button to lock the shoulder belt anchor into position.
1-22 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2616
Seat belt hooks
When the seat belt is not in use and when folding
down the rear seats, hook the rear seat belts on
the seat belt hooks.
SEAT BELT EXTENDERS
If, because of body size or driving position, it is
not possible to properly fit the lap/shoulder belt
and fasten it, an extender that is compatible with
the installed seat belts is available for purchase.
The extender adds approximately 8 in (200 mm)
of length and is available for the:
● Driver and front passenger seating positions
CHILD SAFETY
See a NISSAN dealer for assistance with purchasing an extender if an extender is required.
WARNING
● Only NISSAN seat belt extenders, made
by the same company which made the
original equipment seat belts, should
be used with NISSAN seat belts.
● Adults and children who can use the
standard seat belt should not use an
extender. Such unnecessary use could
result in serious personal injury in the
event of an accident.
● Never use seat belt extenders to install
child restraints. If the child restraint is
not secured properly, the child could be
seriously injured in a collision or a sudden stop.
SEAT BELT MAINTENANCE
● To clean the seat belt webbing, apply a
mild soap solution or any solution recommended for cleaning upholstery or carpet.
Then wipe with a cloth and allow the seat
belts to dry in the shade. Do not allow the
seat belts to retract until they are completely
dry.
● If dirt builds up in the shoulder belt
guide of the seat belt anchors, the seat
belts may retract slowly. Wipe the shoulder
belt guide with a clean, dry cloth.
● Periodically check to see that the seat
belt and the metal components, such as
buckles, tongues, retractors, flexible wires
and anchors, work properly. If loose parts,
deterioration, cuts or other damage on the
webbing is found, the entire seat belt assembly should be replaced.
WARNING
Do not allow children to play with the seat
belts. Most seating positions are
equipped with Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode seat belts. If the seat belt
becomes wrapped around a child’s neck
with the ALR mode activated, the child can
be seriously injured or killed if the seat
belt retracts and becomes tight. This can
occur even if the vehicle is parked. Unbuckle the seat belt to release the child. If
the seat belt cannot be unbuckled or is
already unbuckled, release the child by
cutting the seat belt with a suitable tool
(such as a knife or scissors) to release the
seat belt.
Children need adults to help protect them.
They need to be properly restrained.
In addition to the general information in this
manual, child safety information is available from
many other sources, including doctors, teachers,
government traffic safety offices, and community
organizations. Every child is different, so be sure
to learn the best way to transport your child.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-23
There are three basic types of child restraint
systems:
● Rear-facing child restraints
● Forward-facing child restraints
● Booster seats
The proper restraint depends on the child’s size.
Generally, infants up to about 1 year and less
than 20 lbs (9 kg) should be placed in rear-facing
child restraints. Forward-facing child restraints
are available for children who outgrow rearfacing child restraints and are at least 1 year old.
Booster seats are used to help position a vehicle
lap/shoulder belt on a child who can no longer
use a forward-facing child restraint.
WARNING
Infants and children need special protection. The vehicle’s seat belts may not fit
them properly. The shoulder belt may
come too close to the face or neck. The lap
belt may not fit over their small hip bones.
In an accident, an improperly fitting seat
belt could cause serious or fatal injury.
Always use appropriate child restraints.
All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or territories require the use of approved child restraints
for infants and small children. For additional information, refer to “Child restraints” in this section.
that fits your vehicle and always follow the manufacturer’s instructions for installation and use.
A child restraint may be secured in the vehicle by
using either the LATCH (Lower Anchors and
Tethers for CHildren) system or with the vehicle
seat belt. For additional information, refer to
“Child restraints” in this section.
Children that are over 1 year old and weigh at
least 20 lbs (9 kg) should remain in a rear-facing
child restraint as long as possible up to the height
or weight limit of the child restraint. Children who
outgrow the height or weight limit of the rearfacing child restraint and are at least 1 year old
should be secured in a forward-facing child restraint with a harness. Refer to the manufacturer’s instructions for minimum and maximum
weight and height recommendations. NISSAN
recommends that small children be placed in
child restraints that comply with Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. You should choose a
child restraint that fits your vehicle and always
follow the manufacturer’s instructions for installation and use.
NISSAN recommends that all pre-teens
and children be restrained in the rear seat.
Studies show that children are safer when
properly restrained in the rear seat than in
the front seat.
This is especially important because your
vehicle has a supplemental restraint system (air bag system) for the front passenger. For additional information, refer to
“Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)” in
this section.
INFANTS
Infants up to at least 1 year old should be placed
in a rear-facing child restraint. NISSAN recommends that infants be placed in child restraints
that comply with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety
Standards or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety
Standards. You should choose a child restraint
1-24 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
SMALL CHILDREN
LARGER CHILDREN
Children should remain in a forward-facing child
restraint with a harness until they reach the maximum height or weight limit allowed by the child
restraint manufacturer.
Once a child outgrows the height or weight limit
of the harness-equipped forward-facing child restraint, NISSAN recommends that the child be
CHILD RESTRAINTS
placed in a commercially available booster seat to
obtain proper seat belt fit. For a seat belt to fit
properly, the booster seat should raise the child
so that the shoulder belt is properly positioned
across the chest and the top, middle portion of
the shoulder. The shoulder belt should not cross
the neck or face and should not fall off the shoulder. The lap belt should lie snugly across the
lower hips or upper thighs, not the abdomen. A
booster seat can only be used in seating positions that have a three-point type seat belt. The
booster seat should fit the vehicle seat and have
a label certifying that it complies with Federal
Motor Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. Once the child has
grown so the shoulder belt is no longer on or near
the face and neck and the lap belt can be positioned properly across the lower hips or upper
thighs, use the seat belt without the booster seat.
ARS1098
PRECAUTIONS ON CHILD
RESTRAINTS
WARNING
WARNING
Never let a child stand or kneel on any seat
and do not allow a child in the cargo area.
The child could be seriously injured or
killed in a sudden stop or collision.
● Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use and installation of child restraints could result in
serious injury or death of a child or
other passengers in a sudden stop or
collision:
WRS0256
– Infants and children should never be
held on anyone’s lap. Even the strongest adult cannot resist the forces of
a collision.
– Do not put a seat belt around both a
child and another passenger.
– The child restraint must be used and
installed properly. Always follow all
of the child restraint manufacturer’s
instructions for installation and use.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-25
– NISSAN recommends that all child
restraints be installed in the rear
seat. Studies show that children are
safer when properly restrained in the
rear seat than in the front seat. If you
must install a forward-facing child
restraint in the front seat, refer to
“Forward-facing child restraint installation using the seat belts” in this
section.
– Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air
Bag System, never install a rearfacing child restraint in the front seat.
An inflating air bag could seriously
injure or kill a child. A rear-facing
child restraint must only be used in
the rear seat.
– Be sure to purchase a child restraint
that will fit the child and vehicle.
Some child restraints may not fit
properly in your vehicle.
– Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only those loads
imposed by correctly fitted child restraints. Under no circumstances are
they to be used to attach adult seat
belts, or other items or equipment to
the vehicle. Doing so could damage
the child restraint anchorages. The
child restraint will not be properly
installed using the damaged anchorage, and a child could be seriously
injured or killed in a collision.
– Never use the anchor points for adult
seat belts or harnesses.
– A child restraint with a top tether
strap should not be used in the front
passenger seat.
– Keep seatbacks as upright as possible after fitting the child restraint.
– Infants and children should always
be placed in an appropriate child restraint while in the vehicle.
● When the child restraint is not in use,
keep it secured with the LATCH system
or a seat belt. In a sudden stop or collision, loose objects can injure occupants
or damage the vehicle.
1-26 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
CAUTION
A child restraint in a closed vehicle can
become very hot. Check the seating surface and buckles before placing a child in
the child restraint.
This vehicle is equipped with a universal child
restraint anchor system, referred to as the LATCH
(Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) system. Some child restraints include rigid or
webbing-mounted attachments that can be connected to these anchors. For additional information, refer to “LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) system” in this section.
If you do not have a LATCH compatible child
restraint, the vehicle seat belts can be used.
Several manufacturers offer child restraints for
infants and children of various sizes. When selecting any child restraint, keep the following
points in mind:
● Choose only a restraint with a label certifying
that it complies with Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard 213 or Canadian Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard 213.
● Check the child restraint in your vehicle to be
sure it is compatible with the vehicle’s seat
and seat belt system.
● If the child restraint is compatible with your
vehicle, place your child in the child restraint
and check the various adjustments to be
sure the child restraint is compatible with
your child. Choose a child restraint that is
designed for your child’s height and weight.
Always follow all recommended procedures.
child restraint. Be sure to follow the child restraint
manufacturer’s instructions for installation.
The LATCH lower anchor points are provided to
install child restraints in the following positions
only:
● Rear bench seat – outboard seating positions
● If the combined weight of the child and child
restraint is less than 65 lbs (29.5 kg), you
may use either the LATCH anchors or the
seat belt to install the child restraint (not both
at the same time).
LATCH lower anchor
● If the combined weight of the child and child
restraint is greater than 65 lbs (29.5 kg), use
the vehicle’s seat belt (not the lower anchors) to install the child restraint.
LATCH system lower anchor locations bench seat
● Be sure to follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions for installation.
LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers
for CHildren) SYSTEM
Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use and installation of
child restraints could result in serious injury or death of a child or other passengers in a sudden stop or collision:
All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or
territories require that infants and small
children be restrained in an approved child
restraint at all times while the vehicle is
being operated. Canadian law requires the
top tether strap on forward-facing child restraints be secured to the designated anchor point on the vehicle.
WARNING
LRS2594
Your vehicle is equipped with special anchor
points that are used with LATCH system compatible child restraints. This system may also be
referred to as the ISOFIX or ISOFIX compatible
system. With this system, you do not have to use
a vehicle seat belt to secure the child restraint
unless the combined weight of the child and child
restraint exceeds 65 lbs (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the child and child restraint is
greater than 65 lbs (29.5 kg), use the vehicle’s
seat belt (not the lower anchors) to install the
– Attach LATCH system compatible
child restraints only at the locations
shown in the illustration.
– Do not secure a child restraint in the
rear bench center position using the
LATCH system anchors. The child restraint will not be secured properly.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-27
– Inspect the lower anchors by inserting your fingers into the lower anchor
area. Feel to make sure there are no
obstructions over the anchors such
as seat belt webbing or seat cushion
material. The child restraint will not
be secured properly if the lower anchors are obstructed.
– Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only those loads
imposed by correctly fitted child restraints. Under no circumstances are
they to be used to attach adult seat
belts, or other items or equipment to
the vehicle. Doing so could damage
the child restraint anchorages. The
child restraint will not be properly
installed using the damaged anchorages, and a child could be seriously
injured or killed in a collision.
WRS0700
LATCH lower anchor location
LATCH lower anchor location
The LATCH lower anchors are located at the rear
of the seat cushion near the seatback. A label is
attached to the seatback to help you locate the
LATCH lower anchors.
1-28 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2595
LATCH label locations rear bench
Top tether anchor
WARNING
● Do not allow cargo to contact the top
tether strap when it is attached to the
top tether anchor. Properly secure the
cargo so it does not contact the top
tether strap. Cargo that is not properly
secured or cargo that contacts the top
tether strap may damage it during a
collision. A child could be seriously injured or killed in a collision if the top
tether strap is damaged.
LRS0661
LATCH webbing-mounted attachment
Installing child restraint LATCH lower
anchor attachments
LATCH compatible child restraints include two
rigid or webbing-mounted attachments that can
be connected to two anchors located at certain
seating positions in your vehicle. With this system, you do not have to use a vehicle seat belt to
secure the child restraint. Check your child restraint for a label stating that it is compatible with
LATCH. This information may also be in the instructions provided by the child restraint manufacturer.
LRS0662
LATCH rigid-mounted attachment
When installing a child restraint, carefully read
and follow the instructions in this manual and
those supplied with the child restraint.
● Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only those loads
imposed by correctly fitted child restraints. Under no circumstances are
they to be used to attach adult seat
belts, or other items or equipment to
the vehicle. Doing so could damage the
child restraint anchorages. The child restraint will not be properly installed using the damaged anchorages, and a
child could be seriously injured or killed
in a collision.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-29
REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT
INSTALLATION USING LATCH
For additional information, refer to all Warnings
and Cautions in the “Child safety” and “Child
restraint” sections of this manual before installing
a child restraint.
LRS2596
1
䊊
2
䊊
Rear bench seat
Top tether strap
Anchor point
Top tether anchor point locations
Anchor points are located in the following locations:
Do not use the lower anchors if the combined
weight of the child and the child restraint exceeds
65 lbs (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the
child and the child restraint is greater than 65 lbs
(29.5 kg), use the vehicle’s seat belt (not the
lower anchors) to install the child restraint. Be
sure to follow the child restraint manufacturer’s
instructions for installation.
Follow these steps to install a rear-facing child
restraint in the rear bench seats using the LATCH
system:
1. Position the child restraint on the seat. Always follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
● Rear bench seat on the back side of the
seatback in the seating positions shown.
If you have any questions when installing a top
tether strap, consult a NISSAN dealer for details.
1-30 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
WRS0801
Rear-facing webbing-mounted – step 2
2. Secure the child restraint anchor attachments to the LATCH lower anchors. Check
to make sure the LATCH attachment is properly attached to the lower anchors.
WRS0802
Rear-facing rigid-mounted – step 2
LRS0673
Rear-facing – step 3
3. For child restraints that are equipped with
webbing-mounted attachments, remove any
additional slack from the anchor attachments. Press downward and rearward firmly
in the center of the child restraint with your
hand to compress the vehicle seat cushion
and seatback while tightening the webbing
of the anchor attachments.
LRS0674
Rear-facing – step 4
4. After attaching the child restraint, test it before you place the child in it. Push it from side
to side while holding the child restraint near
the LATCH attachment path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch
(25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it
forward and check to see if the LATCH attachment holds the restraint in place. If the
restraint is not secure, tighten the LATCH
attachment as necessary, or put the restraint
in another seat and test it again. You may
need to try a different child restraint or try
installing by using the vehicle seat belt (if
applicable). Not all child restraints fit in all
types of vehicles.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-31
5. Check to make sure the child restraint is
properly secured prior to each use. If the
child restraint is loose, repeat steps 2
through 4.
WARNING
The three-point seat belt with Automatic
Locking Retractor (ALR) must be used
when installing a child restraint. Failure to
use the ALR mode will result in the child
restraint not being properly secured. The
restraint could tip over or be loose and
cause injury to a child in a sudden stop or
collision. Also, it can change the operation
of the front passenger air bag. For additional information, refer to “Supplemental
air bag warning light” in this section.
WRS0256
REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT
INSTALLATION USING THE SEAT
BELTS
1-32 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
Follow these steps to install a rear-facing child
restraint using the vehicle seat belts in the rear
seats:
1. Child restraints for infants must be
used in the rear-facing direction and
therefore must not be used in the front
seat. Position the child restraint on the seat.
Always follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
WRS0256
Rear-facing – step 1
For additional information, refer to all Warnings
and Cautions in the “Child safety” and “Child
restraints” sections of this manual before installing a child restraint.
Do not use the lower anchors if the combined
weight of the child and the child restraint exceeds
65 lbs (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the
child and the child restraint is greater than 65 lbs
(29.5 kg), use the vehicle’s seat belt (not the
lower anchors) to install the child restraint. Be
sure to follow the child restraint manufacturer’s
instructions for installation.
WRS0761
Rear-facing – step 2
2. Route the seat belt tongue through the child
restraint and insert it into the buckle until you
hear and feel the latch engage. Be sure to
follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions for belt routing.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-33
LRS2395
Rear-facing – step 3
3. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully
extended. At this time, the seat belt retractor
is in the ALR mode (child restraint mode). It
reverts to the ELR mode when the seat belt
is fully retracted.
LRS2396
Rear-facing – step 4
4. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on the
shoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt.
1-34 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
WRS0762
Rear-facing – step 5
5. Remove any additional slack from the seat
belt; press downward and rearward firmly in
the center of the child restraint to compress
the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while
pulling up on the seat belt.
7. Check to make sure that the child restraint is
properly secured prior to each use. If the
seat belt is not locked, repeat steps 1
through 6.
After the child restraint is removed and the seat
belt fully retracted, the ALR mode (child restraint
mode) is canceled.
Follow these steps to install a forward-facing
child restraint in the rear bench seats using the
LATCH system:
1. Position the child restraint on the seat. Always follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
FORWARD-FACING CHILD
RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING
LATCH
LRS2397
Rear-facing – step 6
6. After attaching the child restraint, test it before you place the child in it. Push it from side
to side while holding the child restraint near
the seat belt path. The child restraint should
not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from
side to side. Try to tug it forward and check
to see if the belt holds the restraint in place.
If the restraint is not secure, tighten the seat
belt as necessary, or put the restraint in
another seat and test it again. You may need
to try a different child restraint. Not all child
restraints fit in all types of vehicles.
For additional information, refer to all Warnings
and Cautions in the “Child safety” and “Child
restraints” sections of this manual before installing a child restraint.
Do not use the lower anchors if the combined
weight of the child and the child restraint exceeds
65 lbs (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the
child and the child restraint is greater than 65 lbs
(29.5 kg), use the vehicle’s seat belt (not the
lower anchors) to install the child restraint. Be
sure to follow the child restraint manufacturer’s
instructions for installation.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-35
If the seating position does not have an
adjustable head restraint/headrest and it is
interfering with the proper child restraint fit,
try another seating position or a different
child restraint.
LRS2398
Forward-facing webbing-mounted – step 2
2. Secure the child restraint anchor attachments to the LATCH lower anchors. Check
to make sure the LATCH attachment is properly attached to the lower anchors.
If the child restraint is equipped with a top
tether strap, route the top tether strap and
secure the tether strap to the tether anchor
point. For additional information, refer to “Installing top tether strap” in this section. Do
not install child restraints that require the use
of a top tether strap in seating positions that
do not have a top tether anchor.
LRS2399
Forward-facing rigid-mounted – step 2
3. The back of the child restraint should be
secured against the vehicle seatback.
If necessary, adjust or remove the head
restraint/headrest to obtain the correct child
restraint fit. If the head restraint/headrest is
removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure
to reinstall the head restraint/headrest
when the child restraint is removed. For
additional information, refer to “Head
restraints/headrests” in this section for head
restraint/headrest adjustment information.
1-36 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
7. Check to make sure the child restraint is
properly secured prior to each use. If the
child restraint is loose, repeat steps 3
through 6.
LRS0671
Forward-facing – step 4
4. For child restraints that are equipped with
webbing-mounted attachments, remove any
additional slack from the anchor attachments. Press downward and rearward firmly
in the center of the child restraint with your
knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion
and seatback while tightening the webbing
of the anchor attachments.
5. Tighten the tether strap according to the
manufacturer’s instructions to remove any
slack.
WRS0697
Forward-facing – step 6
6. After attaching the child restraint, test it before you place the child in it. Push it from side
to side while holding the child restraint near
the LATCH attachment path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch
(25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it
forward and check to see if the LATCH attachment holds the restraint in place. If the
restraint is not secure, tighten the LATCH
attachment as necessary, or put the restraint
in another seat and test it again. You may
need to try a different child restraint. Not all
child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-37
Rear bench seat
OUTBOARD SEATING POSITIONS
1. Remove the head restraint/headrest and
store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall
the head restraint/headrest when the child
restraint is removed. For additional information, refer to “Head restraints/headrests” in
this section for head restraint/headrest adjustment, removal and installation information.
1 over the
2. Position the top tether strap 䊊
seatback.
LRS2597
1
䊊
2
䊊
Rear bench seat
Top tether strap
Anchor point
Installing top tether strap
The child restraint top tether strap must be used
when installing the child restraint with the LATCH
lower anchor attachments.
First, secure the child restraint with the LATCH
lower anchors.
3. Secure the tether strap to the tether anchor
2 on the back side of the seatback
point 䊊
behind the child restraint.
4. Tighten the tether strap according to the
manufacturer’s instructions to remove any
slack.
CENTER SEATING POSITION
1. Remove the head restraint/headrest and
store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall
the head restraint/headrest when the child
restraint is removed. For additional information, refer to “Head restraints/headrests” in
this section for head restraint/headrest adjustment, removal and installation information.
1-38 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1 over the
2. Position the top tether strap 䊊
seatback.
3. Secure the tether strap to the tether anchor
2 on the back side of the seatback
point 䊊
behind the child restraint.
4. Tighten the tether strap according to the
manufacturer’s instructions to remove any
slack.
If you have any questions when installing a
top tether strap, consult a NISSAN dealer
for details.
WARNING
Child restraint anchorages are designed
to withstand only those loads imposed by
correctly fitted child restraints. Under no
circumstances are they to be used to attach adult seat belts, or other items or
equipment to the vehicle. Doing so could
damage the child restraint anchorages.
The child restraint will not be properly
installed using the damaged anchorage,
and a child could be seriously injured or
killed in a collision.
Follow these steps to install a forward-facing
child restraint using the vehicle seat belt in the
rear seats or in the front passenger seat:
FORWARD-FACING CHILD
RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING
THE SEAT BELTS
1. If you must install a child restraint in
the front seat, it should be placed in a
forward-facing direction only. Move
the seat to the rearmost position. Child
restraints for infants must be used in
the rear-facing direction and, therefore, must not be used in the front seat.
WARNING
The three-point seat belt with Automatic
Locking Retractor (ALR) must be used
when installing a child restraint. Failure to
use the ALR mode will result in the child
restraint not being properly secured. The
restraint could tip over or be loose and
cause injury to a child in a sudden stop or
collision. Also, it can change the operation
of the front passenger air bag. For additional information, refer to “Front passenger air bag and status light” in this section.
2. Position the child restraint on the seat. Always follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
WRS0699
Forward-facing (front passenger seat) –
step 1
For additional information, refer to all Warnings
and Cautions in the “Child safety” and “Child
restraint” sections of this manual before installing
a child restraint.
Do not use the lower anchors if the combined
weight of the child and the child restraint exceeds
65 lbs (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the
child and the child restraint is greater than 65 lbs
(29.5 kg), use the vehicle’s seat belt (not the
lower anchors) to install the child restraint. Be
sure to follow the child restraint manufacturer’s
instructions for installation.
The back of the child restraint should be
secured against the vehicle seatback.
If necessary, adjust or remove the head
restraint/headrest to obtain the correct child
restraint fit. If the head restraint/headrest is
removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure
to reinstall the head restraint/headrest
when the child restraint is removed. For
additional information, refer to “Head
restraints/headrests” in this section for head
restraint/headrest adjustment, removal and
installation information.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-39
If the seating position does not have an
adjustable head restraint/headrest and it is
interfering with the proper child restraint fit,
try another seating position or a different
child restraint.
WRS0680
Forward-facing – step 3
3. Route the seat belt tongue through the child
restraint and insert it into the buckle until you
hear and feel the latch engage. Be sure to
follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions for belt routing.
If the child restraint is equipped with a top
tether strap, route the top tether strap and
secure the tether strap to the tether anchor
point. For additional information, refer to “Installing top tether strap” in this section. Do
not install child restraints that require the use
of a top tether strap in seating positions that
do not have a top tether anchor.
1-40 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2394
Forward-facing – step 4
4. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully
extended. At this time, the seat belt retractor
is in the ALR mode (child restraint mode). It
reverts to ELR mode when the seat belt is
fully retracted.
LRS0668
Forward-facing – step 5
5. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on the
shoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt.
WRS0681
Forward-facing – step 6
6. Remove any additional slack from the seat
belt; press downward and rearward firmly in
the center of the child restraint with your
knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion
and seatback while pulling up on the seat
belt.
7. Tighten the tether strap according to the
manufacturer’s instructions to remove any
slack.
WRS0698
Forward-facing – step 8
8. After attaching the child restraint, test it before you place the child in it. Push it from side
to side while holding the child restraint near
the seat belt path. The child restraint should
not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from
side to side. Try to tug it forward and check
to see if the belt holds the restraint in place.
If the restraint is not secure, tighten the seat
belt as necessary, or put the restraint in
another seat and test it again. You may need
to try a different child restraint. Not all child
restraints fit in all types of vehicles.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-41
9. Check to make sure the child restraint is
properly secured prior to each use. If the
seat belt is not locked, repeat steps 2
through 8.
LRS0865
Forward-facing – step 10
10. If the child restraint is installed in the front
passenger seat, place the ignition switch in
the ON position. The front passenger air bag
should illuminate. If this
status light
light is not illuminated refer to “Front passenger air bag and status light” in this section.
Move the child restraint to another
seating position. Have the system
checked by a NISSAN dealer.
After the child restraint is removed and the seat
belt is fully retracted, the ALR mode (child restraint mode) is canceled.
1-42 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2597
1
䊊
2
䊊
Rear row bench seat
Top tether strap
Anchor point
Installing top tether strap
The child restraint top tether strap must be used
when installing the child restraint with seat belts.
First, secure the child restraint with the seat belt.
Rear bench seat
OUTBOARD SEATING POSITIONS
1. Remove the head restraint/headrest and
store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall
the head restraint/headrest when the child
restraint is removed. For additional information, refer to “Head restraints/headrests” in
this section for head restraint/headrest adjustment, removal and installation information.
1 over the
2. Position the top tether strap 䊊
seatback.
3. Secure the tether strap to the tether anchor
2 on the back side of the seatback
point 䊊
behind the child restraint.
4. Tighten the tether strap according to the
manufacturer’s instructions to remove any
slack.
CENTER SEATING POSITION
1. Remove the head restraint/headrest and
store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall
the head restraint/headrest when the child
restraint is removed. For additional information, refer to “Head restraints/headrests” in
this section for head restraint/headrest adjustment, removal and installation information.
1 over the
2. Position the top tether strap 䊊
seatback.
3. Secure the tether strap to the tether anchor
2 on the back side of the seatback
point 䊊
behind the child restraint.
4. Tighten the tether strap according to the
manufacturer’s instructions to remove any
slack.
If you have any questions when installing a
top tether strap, consult a NISSAN dealer
for details.
WARNING
Child restraint anchorages are designed
to withstand only those loads imposed by
correctly fitted child restraints. Under no
circumstances are they to be used to attach adult seat belts, or other items or
equipment to the vehicle. Doing so could
damage the child restraint anchorages.
The child restraint will not be properly
installed using the damaged anchorage,
and a child could be seriously injured or
killed in a collision.
BOOSTER SEATS
For additional information on installing a booster
seat in your vehicle, follow the instructions outlined in this section.
Precautions on booster seats
WARNING
If a booster seat and seat belt are not used
properly, the risk of a child being injured
or killed in a sudden stop or collision
greatly increases:
– Make sure the shoulder portion of
the belt is away from the child’s face
and neck and the lap portion of the
belt does not cross the stomach.
– Make sure the shoulder belt is not
behind the child or under the child’s
arm.
– A booster seat must only be installed
in a seating position that has a
lap/shoulder belt.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-43
LRS2479
A.
Low back booster seat
B.
High back booster seat
LRS0453
LRS0464
Booster seats of various sizes are offered by
several manufacturers. When selecting any
booster seat, keep the following points in mind:
● Make sure the child’s head will be properly
supported by the booster seat or vehicle
seat. The seatback must be at or above the
center of the child’s ears. For example, if a
low back booster seat is chosen, the vehicle
seatback must be at or above the center of
the child’s ears. If the seatback is lower than
the center of the child’s ears, a high back
booster seat should be used.
● Choose only a booster seat with a label
certifying that it complies with Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or Canadian
Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.
● Check the booster seat in your vehicle to be
sure it is compatible with the vehicle’s seat
and seat belt system.
1-44 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
● If the booster seat is compatible with your
vehicle, place the child in the booster seat
and check the various adjustments to be
sure the booster seat is compatible with the
child. Always follow all recommended procedures.
All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or
territories require that infants and small
children be restrained in an approved child
restraint at all times while the vehicle is
being operated.
The instructions in this section apply to booster
seat installation in the rear seats or the front
passenger seat.
Booster seat installation
CAUTION
Do not use the lap/shoulder belt in the
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode
when using a booster seat with the seat
belts.
For additional information, refer to all Warnings
and Cautions in the “Child safety,” “Child restraint” and “Booster seats” sections of this
manual before installing a child restraint.
Follow these steps to install a booster seat in the
rear bench seats or in the front passenger seat:
WRS0699
LRS0454
1. If you must install a booster seat in the
front seat, move the seat to the rearmost position.
Front passenger position
3. The booster seat should be positioned on
the vehicle seat so that it is stable.
2. Position the booster seat on the seat. Only
place it in a front-facing direction. Always
follow the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions.
If necessary, adjust or remove the head
restraint/headrest to obtain the correct
booster
seat
fit.
If
the
head
restraint/headrest is removed, store it in a
secure place. Be sure to reinstall the
head restraint/headrest when the
booster seat is removed. For additional
information,
refer
to
“Head
restraints/headrests” in this section for head
restraint/headrest adjustment, removal and
installation information.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-45
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT
SYSTEM (SRS)
If the seating position does not have an
adjustable head restraint/headrest and it is
interfering with the proper booster seat fit,
try another seating position or a different
booster seat.
PRECAUTIONS ON SRS
This SRS section contains important information
concerning the following systems:
● Driver and passenger supplemental frontimpact air bag (NISSAN Advanced Air Bag
System)
4. Position the lap portion of the seat belt low
and snug on the child’s hips. Be sure to
follow the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions for adjusting the seat belt routing.
5. Pull the shoulder belt portion of the seat belt
toward the retractor to take up extra slack.
Be sure the shoulder belt is positioned
across the top, middle portion of the child’s
shoulder. Be sure to follow the booster seat
manufacturer’s instructions for adjusting the
seat belt routing.
6. Follow the warnings, cautions and instructions for properly fastening a seat belt
shown in “Three-point type seat belt with
retractor” in this section.
● Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag
● Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and rollover supplemental air bag
● Driver supplemental knee air bag
LRS0865
7. If the booster seat is installed in the front
passenger seat, place the ignition switch in
the ON position. The front passenger air bag
may or may not illuminate,
status light
depending on the size of the child and the
type of booster seat being used. For additional information, refer to “Front passenger
air bag and status light” in this section.
● Seat belt with pretensioner
Supplemental front-impact air bag system
The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System can help
cushion the impact force to the head and chest of
the driver and front passenger in certain frontal
collisions.
Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag system
This system can help cushion the impact force to
the chest area of the driver and front passenger in
certain side-impact collisions. The side air bags
are designed to inflate on the side where the
vehicle is impacted.
1-46 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and
rollover supplemental air bag system
This system can help cushion the impact force to
the head of occupants in the outboard seating
positions in certain side-impact or rollover collisions. In a side impact, the curtain air bags are
designed to inflate on the side where the vehicle
is impacted. In a rollover, curtain air bags on both
sides are designed to inflate and remain inflated
for a short time.
After placing the ignition switch in the ON
position, the supplemental air bag warning
light illuminates. The supplemental air bag
warning light will turn off after about 7 seconds if the system is operational.
Driver supplemental knee air bag
This system can help cushion the impact force to
the driver’s knees in certain collisions.
The SRS is designed to supplement the crash
protection provided by the driver and front passenger seat belts and is not a substitute for
them. Seat belts should always be correctly worn
and the occupant seated a suitable distance
away from the steering wheel, instrument panel
and door finishers. For additional information,
refer to “Seat belts” in this section for instructions
and precautions on seat belt usage.
The supplemental air bags operate only
when the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-47
the seatback and as far away as practical from the steering wheel or instrument panel. Always properly use the
seat belts.
● The driver and front passenger seat belt
buckles are equipped with sensors that
detect if the seat belts are fastened. The
NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System
monitors the severity of a collision and
seat belt usage then inflates the air
bags as needed. Failure to properly
wear seat belts can increase the risk or
severity of injury in an accident.
WRS0031
WARNING
● The front air bags ordinarily will not
inflate in the event of a side impact, rear
impact, rollover, or lower severity frontal collision. Always wear your seat
belts to help reduce the risk or severity
of injury in various kinds of accidents.
● The front passenger air bag will not
inflate if the passenger air bag status
light is lit or if the front passenger seat
is unoccupied. For additional information, refer to “Front passenger air bag
and status light” in this section.
● The seat belts and the front air bags are
most effective when you are sitting well
back and upright in the seat. The front
air bags inflate with great force. Even
with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System, if you are unrestrained, leaning
forward, sitting sideways or out of position in any way, you are at greater risk of
injury or death in a crash. You may also
receive serious or fatal injuries from the
front air bag if you are up against it
when it inflates. Always sit back against
1-48 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
● The front passenger seat is equipped
with an Occupant Classification Sensor
(weight sensor) that turns the front passenger air bag OFF under some conditions. This sensor is only used in this
seat. Failure to be properly seated and
wearing the seat belt can increase the
risk or severity of injury in an accident.
For additional information, refer to
“Front passenger air bag and status
light” in this section.
● Keep hands on the outside of the steering wheel. Placing them inside the
steering wheel rim could increase the
risk that they are injured when the front
air bag inflates.
ARS1133
ARS1041
WARNING
● Never let children ride unrestrained or
extend their hands or face out of the
window. Do not attempt to hold them in
your lap or arms. Some examples of
dangerous riding positions are shown
in the illustrations.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-49
ARS1042
1-50 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
ARS1043
ARS1044
ARS1045
ARS1046
WRS0431
● Children may be severely injured or
killed when the front air bags, side air
bags or curtain air bags inflate if they
are not properly restrained. Pre-teens
and children should be properly restrained in the rear seat, if possible.
Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bags and roof-mounted curtain
side-impact and rollover supplemental air
bags:
WARNING
● Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air
Bag System, never install a rear-facing
child restraint in the front seat. An inflating front air bag could seriously injure or kill your child. For additional
information, refer to “Child restraints”
in this section.
WARNING
● The side air bags and curtain air bags
ordinarily will not inflate in the event of
a frontal impact, rear impact, or lower
severity side collision. Always wear
your seat belts to help reduce the risk or
severity of injury in various kinds of
accidents.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-51
WARNING
SSS0162
1-52 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
SSS0159
● The seat belts, the side air bags and
curtain air bags are most effective when
you are sitting well back and upright in
the seat with both feet on the floor. The
side air bag and curtain air bag inflate
with great force. Do not allow anyone to
place their hand, leg or face near the
side air bag on the side of the seatback
of the front seat or near the side roof
rails. Do not allow anyone sitting in the
front seats or rear outboard seats to
extend their hand out of the window or
lean against the door. Some examples
of dangerous riding positions are
shown in the previous illustrations.
WARNING
● When sitting in the rear bench seat, do
not hold onto the seatback of the front
seat. If the side air bag inflates, you may
be seriously injured. Be especially careful with children, who should always be
properly restrained. Some examples of
dangerous riding positions are shown
in the illustrations.
● Do not use seat covers on the front
seatbacks. They may interfere with side
air bag inflation.
WRS0032
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-53
NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System
(front seats)
1. Supplemental front-impact air bag modules
2. Air bag Control Unit (ACU)
3. Occupant Classification Sensor (weight
sensor)
4. Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag modules
5. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and rollover supplemental air bags
6. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and rollover supplemental air bag inflators
7. Satellite sensors
8. Seat belt with pretensioner
9. Pressure sensors in door (driver’s side
shown; passenger side similar)
10. Driver supplemental knee air bag
11. Crash zone sensor
LRS2598
1-54 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
WARNING
To ensure proper operation of the passenger’s advanced air bag system, please observe the following items.
● Do not allow a passenger in the rear
bench seats to push or pull on the seatback pocket.
● Do not place heavy loads heavier than
2.2 lb (1 kg) on the seatback, head
restraint/headrest or in the seatback
pocket.
● Do not store luggage behind the seat
that can press into the seatback.
● Do not position the front passenger
seat so it contacts the rear bench seats.
If the front seat does contact the rear
bench seats, the air bag system may
determine a sensor malfunction has occurred and the front passenger air bag
status light may illuminate and the
supplemental air bag warning light may
flash.
● If a forward-facing child restraint is installed in the front passenger seat, do
not position the front passenger seat so
the child restraint contacts the instrument panel. If the child restraint does
contact the instrument panel, the system may determine the seat is occupied
and the passenger air bag may deploy
in a collision. Also the front passenger
air bag status light may not illuminate.
For additional information, refer to
“Child restraints” in this section for information about installing and using
child restraints.
● Confirm the operating condition with
the front passenger air bag status light.
● If you notice that the front passenger air
bag status light is not operating as described in this section, please take your
vehicle to a NISSAN dealer to check the
occupant classification system.
● Until you have confirmed with your
dealer that your passenger seat occupant classification system is working
properly, position the occupants in the
rear seating positions.
This vehicle is equipped with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System for the driver and front
passenger seats. This system is designed to
meet certification requirements under U.S. regulations. It is also permitted in Canada. All of the
information, cautions and warnings in this
manual must be followed.
The driver supplemental front-impact air bag is
located in the center of the steering wheel. The
passenger supplemental front-impact air bag is
mounted in the dashboard above the glove box.
The front air bags are designed to inflate in higher
severity frontal collisions, although they may inflate if the forces in another type of collision are
similar to those of a higher severity frontal impact.
They may not inflate in certain frontal collisions.
Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always an
indication of proper front air bag system operation.
The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System has dual
stage inflators. It also monitors information from
the crash zone sensor and the Air bag Control
Unit (ACU). Inflator operation is based on the
severity of a collision and seat belt usage for the
driver. For the front passenger, the Occupant
Classification Sensor is also monitored. Based
on information from the sensor, only one front air
bag may inflate in a crash, depending on the
crash severity. Additionally, the front passenger
air bag may be automatically turned off under
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-55
some conditions, depending on the weight detected on the passenger seat and how the seat
belt is used. If the front passenger air bag is OFF,
the passenger air bag status light will be illuminated (if the seat is unoccupied, the light will not
be illuminated, but the air bag will be off). For
additional information, refer to “Front passenger
air bag and status light” in this section. One front
air bag inflating does not indicate improper performance of the system.
If you have any questions about your air bag
system, please contact NISSAN or a NISSAN
dealer. If you are considering modification of your
vehicle due to a disability, you may also contact
NISSAN. Contact information is contained in the
front of this Owner’s Manual.
When a front air bag inflates, a fairly loud noise
may be heard, followed by the release of smoke.
This smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a
fire. Care should be taken to not inhale it, as it may
cause irritation and choking. Those with a history
of a breathing condition should get fresh air
promptly.
or other injuries. Front air bags, other than the
driver’s knee air bag, do not provide restraint to
the lower body.
Even with NISSAN Advanced Air Bags, seat
belts should be correctly worn and the driver and
passenger seated upright as far as practical
away from the steering wheel or instrument
panel. The front air bags inflate quickly in order to
help protect the front occupants. Because of this,
the force of the front air bag inflating can increase
the risk of injury if the occupant is too close to, or
is against, the front air bag module during inflation.
The front air bags deflate quickly after a collision.
The front air bags operate only when the
ignition switch is placed in the ON position.
After placing the ignition switch in the ON
position, the supplemental air bag warning
light illuminates. The supplemental air bag
warning light will turn off after about 7 seconds if the system is operational.
Front air bags, along with the use of seat belts,
help to cushion the impact force on the face and
chest of the front occupants. They can help save
lives and reduce serious injuries. However, an
inflating front air bag may cause facial abrasions
1-56 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS0865
Front passenger air bag and status light
WARNING
The front passenger air bag is designed to
automatically turn OFF under some conditions. Read this section carefully to learn
how it operates. Proper use of the seat,
seat belt and child restraints is necessary
for most effective protection. Failure to
follow all instructions in this manual concerning the use of seats, seat belts and
child restraints can increase the risk or
severity of injury in an accident.
Status light
The front passenger seat is equipped with an
Occupant Classification Sensor (weight sensor)
that turns the front passenger air bag on or off
depending on the weight applied to the front
passenger seat. The status of the front passenger air bag (ON or OFF) is indicated by a front
which is
passenger air bag status light
located on the instrument panel.
After the ignition switch is placed in the ⬙ON⬙
position, the front passenger air bag status light
on the instrument panel illuminates for about
7 seconds and then turns off or remains illuminated depending on the front passenger seat
occupied status. The light operates as follows:
● Unoccupied front passenger’s seat:
light is OFF and the front passenThe
ger air bag is OFF and will not inflate in a
crash.
● Front passenger’s seat occupied by a small
adult, child or child restraint as outlined in
the Safety section of the owner’s manual:
light illuminates to indicate that
The
the front passenger air bag is OFF and will
not inflate in a crash.
● Occupied front passenger seat and the passenger meets the conditions as outlined in
the Safety section of the owner’s manual:
light is OFF to indicate that the
The
front passenger air bag is operational.
In addition to the above, certain objects placed
on the front passenger seat may also cause the
light to operate as described above depending
on their weight.
For additional information related to the normal
operation and troubleshooting of this Occupant
Classification Sensor system, please refer to
“Normal operation” and “Troubleshooting” in this
section.
Front passenger air bag
The front passenger air bag is designed to automatically turn OFF when the vehicle is operated
under some conditions as described below in
accordance with U.S. regulations. If the front
passenger air bag is OFF it will not inflate in a
crash. The driver air bag and other air bags in your
vehicle are not part of this system.
The purpose of the regulation is to help reduce
the risk of injury or death from an inflating air bag
to certain front passenger seat occupants, such
as children, by requiring the air bag to be automatically turned OFF. Certain sensors are used to
meet the requirements.
The Occupant Classification Sensor in this vehicle is a weight sensor. It is designed to detect
an occupant and objects on the seat by weight.
For example, if a child is in the front passenger
seat, the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System is
designed to turn the front passenger air bag OFF
in accordance with the regulations. Also, if a child
restraint of the type specified in the regulations is
on the seat, its weight and the child’s weight can
be detected and cause the air bag to turn OFF.
Front passenger seat adult occupants who are
properly seated and using the seat belt as outlined in this manual should not cause the front
passenger air bag to be automatically turned
OFF. For small adults it may be turned OFF,
however if the occupant takes his/her weight off
the seat cushion (for example, by not sitting upright, by sitting on an edge of the seat, or by
otherwise being out of position), this could cause
the sensor to turn the air bag OFF. Always be
sure to be seated and wearing the seat belt
properly for the most effective protection by the
seat belt and supplemental air bag.
NISSAN recommends that pre-teens and children be properly restrained in a rear seat.
NISSAN also recommends that appropriate child
restraints and booster seats be properly installed
in a rear seat. If this is not possible, the Occupant
Classification Sensor is designed to operate as
described above to turn the front passenger air
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-57
bag OFF for specified child restraints as required
by the regulations. Failing to properly secure
child restraints and to use the ALR mode may
allow the restraint to tip or move in a collision or
sudden stop. This can also result in the passenger air bag inflating in a crash instead of being
OFF. For additional information, refer to “Child
restraints” in this section for proper use and installation.
If the front passenger seat is not occupied, the
front passenger air bag is designed not to inflate
in a crash. However, heavy objects placed on the
seat could result in air bag inflation, because of
the object’s weight detected by the Occupant
Classification Sensor. Other conditions could
also result in air bag inflation, such as if a child is
standing on the seat, or if two children are on the
seat, contrary to the instructions in this manual.
Always be sure that you and all vehicle occupants
are seated and restrained properly.
person is a small adult, or is not sitting on the seat
properly or not using the seat belt properly.
If a child restraint must be used in the front seat,
the front passenger air bag status light may or
may not be illuminated, depending on the size of
the child and the type of child restraint being
used. If the air bag status light is not illuminated
(indicating that the air bag might inflate in a
crash), it could be that the child restraint or seat
belt is not being used properly. Make sure that
the child restraint is installed properly, the seat
belt is used properly and the occupant is positioned properly. If the air bag status light is not
illuminated, reposition the occupant or child restraint in a rear seat.
Using the front passenger air bag status light, you
can monitor when the front passenger air bag is
automatically turned OFF with the seat occupied.
The light will not illuminate when the front passenger seat is unoccupied.
If the front passenger air bag status light will not
illuminate even though you believe that the child
restraint, the seat belts and the occupant are
properly positioned, the system may be sensing
an unoccupied seat (in which case the air bag is
OFF). A NISSAN dealer can check that the system is OFF by using a special tool. However, until
you have confirmed with your dealer that your air
bag is working properly, reposition the occupant
or child restraint in a rear seat.
If an adult occupant is in the seat but the front
passenger air bag status light is illuminated (indicating that the air bag is OFF), it could be that the
The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System and front
passenger air bag status light will take a few
seconds to register a change in the passenger
seat status. For example, if a large adult who is
1-58 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
sitting in the front passenger seat exits the vehicle, the front passenger air bag status light will
go from OFF to ON for a few seconds and then to
OFF. This is normal system operation and does
not indicate a malfunction.
If a malfunction occurs in the front passenger air
bag system, the supplemental air bag warning
, located in the meter and gauges area
light
of the instrument panel, will blink. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.
Normal operation
In order for the occupant classification system to
classify the right front passenger based on
weight, please follow the precautions and steps
outlined below:
Precautions
● Make sure there are no objects weighing
over 2.2 lbs (1 kg) hanging on the seat or
placed in the seatback pocket.
● Make sure that a child seat or other object is
not pressing against the rear of the seatback.
● Make sure that a rear passenger is not pushing or pulling on the back of the front passenger’s seat.
● Make sure that the front seat or seatback is
not forced back against an object on the
seat or floor behind it.
● Make sure that there is no object placed
under the front passenger’s seat.
Steps
1. Adjust the seat as outlined in the “Seats”
section of the Owner’s Manual. Sit upright,
leaning against the seatback, and centered
on the seat cushion with your feet comfortably extended to the floor.
2. Make sure there are no objects on the occupant’s lap.
3. Fasten the seat belt as outlined in the “Seat
belts” section of the Owner’s Manual.
NOTE:
This vehicle’s occupant classification system locks the classification during driving
so it is important that you confirm that the
front passenger is properly classified prior
to driving. Also, the occupant classification
system may recalculate the weight of the
occupant when the vehicle comes to a stop
(i.e stop light, stop sign etc.), so front passenger seat occupants should continue to
remain seated as outlined above.
Troubleshooting
If you think the front passenger air bag status light
is incorrect:
1. If the light is ON with no front passenger and
no objects on the front passenger seat:
● The front seat or seatback is forced back
against an object on the seat or floor behind
it.
● An object placed under the front passenger’s seat.
● An object placed between the seat cushion
and center console or between door and
cushion.
If the vehicle is moving, please come to a stop
when it is safe to do so. Check and correct any of
the above conditions. Restart the vehicle and
wait one minute.
NOTE:
A system check will be performed during
which the front passenger air bag status
light will remain lit for about 7 seconds
initially.
4. Remain in this position for 30 seconds allowing the system to classify the front passenger before the vehicle is put into motion.
This may be due to the following conditions that
may be interfering with the weight sensors:
5. Ensure proper classification by checking the
front passenger air bag status light.
● An object weighing over 2.2 lbs (1 kg) hanging on the seat or placed in the seatback
pocket.
If the light is still on after this, the vehicle should
be checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as
possible.
● A child seat or other object pressing against
the rear of the seatback.
2. If the light is ON with an adult occupying the
front passenger seat:
● A rear passenger pushing or pulling on the
back of the front passenger’s seat.
● Occupant is a small adult → the air bag light
is functioning as intended. The front passenger air bag is suppressed.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-59
However, if the occupant is not a small adult, then
this may be due to the following conditions that
may be interfering with the weight sensors:
● Occupant is not sitting upright, leaning
against the seatback, and centered on the
seat cushion with feet comfortably extended
to the floor.
● A child seat or other object pressing against
the rear of the seatback.
● A rear passenger pushing or pulling on the
back of the front passenger’s seat.
● The front seat or seatback is forced back
against an object on the seat or floor behind
it.
● An object placed under the front passenger’s seat.
● An object placed between the seat cushion
and center console or between the seat
cushion and the door.
If the vehicle is moving, please come to a stop
when it is safe to do so. Check and correct any of
the above conditions. Restart the vehicle and
wait one minute.
NOTE:
A system check will be performed during
which the front passenger air bag status
light will remain lit for about 7 seconds
initially.
If the light is still on after this, the person should
be advised not to ride in the front passenger seat
and the vehicle should be checked by a NISSAN
dealer as soon as possible.
3. If the light is OFF with small adult, child or
child restraint occupying the front passenger seat.
This may be due to the following conditions
that may be interfering with the weight sensors:
● Small adult or child is not sitting upright,
leaning against the seatback, and centered
on the seat cushion with feet comfortably
extended to the floor.
● The child restraint is not properly installed,
as outlined in the “Child restraints” section of
the Owner’s Manual.
● An object weighing over 2.2 lbs (1 kg) hanging on the seat or placed in the seatback
pocket.
● A child seat or other object pressing against
the rear of the seatback.
1-60 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
● A rear passenger pushing or pulling on the
back of the front passenger’s seat.
● The front seat or seatback is forced back
against an object on the seat or floor behind
it.
● An object placed under the front passenger’s seat.
● An object placed between the seat cushion
and center console.
If the vehicle is moving, please come to a stop
when it is safe to do so. Check and correct any of
the above conditions. Restart the vehicle and
wait one minute.
NOTE:
A system check will be performed during
which the front passenger air bag status
light will remain lit for about 7 seconds
initially.
If the light is still OFF after this, the small adult,
child or child restraint should be repositioned in
the rear seat and the vehicle should be checked
by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.
Other supplemental front-impact air bag
precautions
WARNING
● Do not place any objects on the steering
wheel pad or on the instrument panel.
Also, do not place any objects between
any occupant and the steering wheel or
instrument panel. Such objects may become dangerous projectiles and cause
injury if the front air bags inflate.
● Immediately after inflation, several
front air bag system components will be
hot. Do not touch them; you may severely burn yourself.
● No unauthorized changes should be
made to any components or wiring of
the supplemental air bag system. This is
to prevent accidental inflation of the
supplemental air bag or damage to the
supplemental air bag system.
● Do not make unauthorized changes to
your vehicle’s electrical system, suspension system or front end structure.
This could affect proper operation of
the front air bag system.
● Tampering with the front air bag system
may result in serious personal injury.
Tampering includes changes to the
steering wheel and the instrument
panel assembly by placing material
over the steering wheel pad and above
the instrument panel or by installing
additional trim material around the air
bag system.
● Removing or modifying the front passenger seat may affect the function of
the air bag and result in serious personal injury.
● Modifying or tampering with the front
passenger seat may result in serious
personal injury. For example, do not
change the front seats by placing material on the seat cushion or by installing
additional trim material, such as seat
covers, on the seat that are not specifically designed to assure proper air bag
operation. Additionally, do not stow any
objects under the front passenger seat
or the seat cushion and seatback. Such
objects may interfere with the proper
operation of the Occupant Classification Sensor (weight sensor).
● No unauthorized changes should be
made to any components or wiring of
the seat belt system. This may affect the
front air bag system. Tampering with
the seat belt system may result in serious personal injury.
● Work on and around the front air bag
system should be done by a NISSAN
dealer. Installation of electrical equipment should also be done by a NISSAN
dealer. The Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) wiring harnesses* should
not be modified or disconnected. Unauthorized electrical test equipment and
probing devices should not be used on
the air bag system.
● A cracked windshield should be replaced immediately by a qualified repair
facility. A cracked windshield could affect the function of the supplemental air
bag system.
*The SRS wiring harness connectors are
yellow and orange for easy identification.
When selling your vehicle, we request that you
inform the buyer about the front air bag system
and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections
in this Owner’s Manual.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-61
the side where the vehicle is impacted. They may
not inflate in certain side collisions.
Curtain air bags are also designed to inflate in
certain types of rollover collisions or near rollovers. As a result, certain vehicle movements (for
example, during severe off-roading) may cause
the curtain air bags to inflate.
Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always an
indication of proper side air bag and curtain air
bag operation.
LRS2501
Front seat-mounted side-impact
supplemental air bag and roofmounted curtain side-impact and
rollover supplemental air bag systems
The side air bags are located in the outside of the
seatback of the front seats. The curtain air bags
are located in the side roof rails in both rows. All
of the information, cautions and warnings
in this manual apply and must be followed.
The side air bags and curtain air bags are designed to inflate in higher severity side collisions,
although they may inflate if the forces in another
type of collision are similar to those of a higher
severity impact. They are designed to inflate on
When the side air bags and curtain air bags
inflate, a fairly loud noise may be heard, followed
by release of smoke. This smoke is not harmful
and does not indicate a fire. Care should be taken
not to inhale it, as it may cause irritation and
choking. Those with a history of a breathing condition should get fresh air promptly.
Side air bags, along with the use of seat belts,
help to cushion the impact force on the chest of
the front occupants. Curtain air bags help to
cushion the impact force to the head of occupants in the front and rear outboard seating positions in all rows. They can help save lives and
reduce serious injuries. However, an inflating
side air bag or curtain air bag may cause abrasions or other injuries. Side air bags and curtain
air bags do not provide restraint to the lower
body.
1-62 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
The seat belts should be correctly worn and the
driver and passenger seated upright as far as
practical away from the side air bag. Rear seat
passengers should be seated as far away as
practical from the door finishers and side roof
rails. The side air bags and curtain air bags inflate
quickly in order to help protect the occupants.
Because of this, the force of the side air bags and
curtain air bags inflating can increase the risk of
injury if the occupant is too close to, or is against,
these air bag modules during inflation. The side
air bag will deflate quickly after the collision is
over.
The curtain air bag will remain inflated for a short
time.
The side air bags and curtain air bags operate only when the ignition switch is
placed in the ON position.
After placing the ignition switch in the ON
position, the supplemental air bag warning
light illuminates. The supplemental air bag
warning light will turn off after about 7 seconds if the system is operational.
WARNING
● Do not place any objects near the seatback of the front seats. Also, do not
place any objects (an umbrella, bag,
etc.) between the front door finisher
and the front seat. Such objects may
become dangerous projectiles and
cause injury if a side air bag inflates.
● Right after inflation, several side air bag
and curtain air bag system components
will be hot. Do not touch them; you may
severely burn yourself.
● No unauthorized changes should be
made to any components or wiring of
the side air bag and curtain air bag
systems. This is to prevent damage to or
accidental inflation of the side air bag
and curtain air bag systems.
● Do not make unauthorized changes to
your vehicle’s electrical system, suspension system or side panel. This
could affect proper operation of the curtain air bag systems.
● Tampering with the side air bag system
may result in serious personal injury.
For example, do not change the front
seats by placing material near the seatbacks or by installing additional trim
material, such as seat covers, around
the side air bag.
● Work around and on the side air bag
and curtain air bag systems should be
done by a NISSAN dealer. Installation
of electrical equipment should also be
done by a NISSAN dealer. The SRS wiring harnesses* should not be modified
or disconnected. Unauthorized electrical test equipment and probing devices
should not be used on the side air bag
or curtain air bag systems.
* The SRS wiring harness or connectors are
yellow or orange for easy identification.
When selling your vehicle, we request that you
inform the buyer about the side air bags and
curtain air bag system and guide the buyer to the
appropriate sections in this Owner’s Manual.
LRS2599
Driver supplemental knee air bag
The knee air bag is located in the knee bolster, on
the driver’s side. The knee air bag is located on
the driver’s side of the vehicle only. All of the
information, cautions and warnings in this
manual apply and must be followed. The
knee air bag is designed to inflate in higher severity frontal collisions, although it may inflate if
the forces in another type of collision are similar
to those of a higher severity frontal impact. It may
not inflate in certain collisions.
Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always an
indication of proper knee air bag operation.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-63
When the knee air bag inflates, a fairly loud noise
may be heard, followed by release of smoke. This
smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire.
Care should be taken not to inhale it, as it may
cause irritation and choking. Those with a history
of a breathing condition should get fresh air
promptly.
The knee air bag helps to cushion the impact
force on the knees of the driver. It can help
reduce serious injuries. However, an inflating
knee air bag may cause abrasions or other injuries. The knee air bag provides restraint to the
lower body.
The knee air bag inflates quickly in order to help
protect the occupants. Because of this, the force
of the knee air bag inflating can increase the risk
of injury if the occupant is too close to, or is
against, this air bag module during inflation. The
knee air bag will deflate quickly after the collision
is over OR the knee air bag will remain inflated for
a short time.
The knee air bag operates only when the
ignition switch is placed in the ON position.
After placing the ignition switch in the ON
position, the supplemental air bag warning
light illuminates. The supplemental air bag
warning light will turn off after about 7 seconds if the system is operational.
WARNING
● Do not place any objects between the
knee bolster and the driver’s seat. Such
objects may become dangerous projectiles and cause injury if a knee air bag
inflates.
● Right after inflation, the knee air bag
system components will be hot. Do not
touch them; you may severely burn
yourself.
● No unauthorized changes should be
made to any components or wiring of
the knee air bag system. This is to prevent damage to or accidental inflation
of the knee air bag system.
● Work around, or on, the knee air bag
system should be done by a NISSAN
dealer. Installation of electrical equipment should also be done by a NISSAN
dealer. The SRS wiring harnesses*
should not be modified or disconnected. Unauthorized electrical test
equipment and probing devices should
not be used on the knee air bag system.
* The SRS wiring harness or connectors are
yellow or orange for easy identification.
When selling your vehicle, we request that you
inform the buyer about the knee air bag system
and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections
in this manual.
● Do not make unauthorized changes to
your vehicle’s electrical system or suspension system. This could affect
proper operation of the knee air bag
system.
Seat belts with pretensioners (front
seats)
● Tampering with the knee air bag system
may result in serious personal injury.
For example, do not change the driver
knee bolster or install additional trim
material around the knee air bag.
● If the vehicle becomes involved in a
collision but a pretensioner is not activated, be sure to have the pretensioner
system checked and, if necessary, replaced by a NISSAN dealer.
1-64 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
WARNING
● No unauthorized changes should be
made to any components or wiring of
the pretensioner system. This is to prevent damage to or accidental activation
of the pretensioners. Tampering with
the pretensioner system may result in
serious personal injury.
When a pretensioner activates, smoke is released and a loud noise may be heard. This
smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire.
Care should be taken not to inhale it, as it may
cause irritation and choking. Those with a history
of a breathing condition should get fresh air
promptly.
● Work around and on the pretensioner
system should be done by a NISSAN
dealer. Installation of electrical equipment should also be done by a NISSAN
dealer. Unauthorized electrical test
equipment and probing devices should
not be used on the pretensioner system.
After pretensioner activation, load limiters allow
the seat belt to release webbing (if necessary) to
reduce forces against the chest.
● If you need to dispose of a pretensioner
or scrap the vehicle, contact a NISSAN
dealer. Incorrect disposal procedures
could cause personal injury.
The pretensioner system may activate with the
supplemental air bag system in certain types of
collisions. Working with the seat belt retractor,
the pretensioner helps tighten the seat belt when
the vehicle becomes involved in certain types of
collisions, helping to restrain front seat occupants.
is
The supplemental air bag warning light
used to indicate malfunctions in the pretensioner
system. For additional information, refer to
⬙Supplemental air bag warning light” in this section. If the operation of the supplemental air bag
warning light indicates there is a malfunction,
have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.
When selling your vehicle, we request that you
inform the buyer about the pretensioner system
and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections
in this Owner’s Manual.
LRS2617
1. SRS Air Bag Warning Labels
The warning labels are located on the surface of the sun visor.
SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG
WARNING LABELS
Warning labels about the supplemental frontimpact air bag system are placed in the vehicle as
shown in the illustration.
The pretensioner is encased with the seat belt
retractor. These seat belts are used the same way
as conventional seat belts.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-65
If any of the following conditions occur, the front
air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag, knee air bag
and pretensioner systems need servicing:
WARNING
Extreme Hazard! Do not use a rear-facing
child restraint on a seat protected by an air
bag in front of it!
● The supplemental air bag warning light remains on after approximately 7 seconds.
● The supplemental air bag warning light
flashes intermittently.
● The supplemental air bag warning light does
not come on at all.
LRS0100
SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG
WARNING LIGHT
The supplemental air bag warning light,
displaying
in the instrument panel, monitors the circuits for the air bag systems, pretensioners and all related wiring.
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, the supplemental air bag warning light
illuminates for about 7 seconds and then turns
off. This means the system is operational.
1-66 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
Under these conditions, the front air bag, side air
bag, curtain air bag, knee air bag or pretensioner
systems may not operate properly. They must be
checked and repaired. Take your vehicle to the
nearest NISSAN dealer.
WARNING
If the supplemental air bag warning light
is on, it could mean that the front air bag,
side air bag, curtain air bag, knee air bag
and/or pretensioner systems will not operate in an accident. To help avoid injury to
yourself or others, have your vehicle
checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as
possible.
Repair and replacement procedure
The front air bags, side air bags, curtain air bags,
knee air bag and pretensioners are designed to
inflate on a one-time-only basis. As a reminder,
unless it is damaged, the supplemental air bag
warning light remains illuminated after inflation
has occurred. Repair and replacement of these
supplemental air bag systems should be done
only by a NISSAN dealer.
When maintenance work is required on the vehicle, the front air bags, side air bags, curtain air
bags, knee air bag, pretensioners and related
parts should be pointed out to the person performing the maintenance. The ignition switch
should always be in the LOCK position when
working under the hood or inside the vehicle.
WARNING
● Once a front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag, or knee air bag has inflated,
the air bag module will not function
again and must be replaced. Additionally, the activated pretensioners must
also be replaced. The air bag module
and pretensioner should be replaced by
a NISSAN dealer. The air bag module
and pretensioner cannot be repaired.
● The front air bag, side air bag, curtain
air bag, knee air bag systems and the
pretensioner system should be inspected by a NISSAN dealer if there is
any damage to the front end or side
portion of the vehicle.
● If you need to dispose of a supplemental air bag or pretensioner or scrap the
vehicle, contact a NISSAN dealer. Incorrect disposal procedures could cause
personal injury.
● If there is an impact to your vehicle from
any direction, your Occupant Detection
Sensor (ODS) should be checked by a
NISSAN dealer to verify it is still functioning correctly. The ODS should be
checked even if no air bags deploy as a
result of the impact. Failure to verify
proper ODS function may result in an
improper air bag deployment resulting
in injury or death.
Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-67
2 Instruments and controls
Instrument panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
Meters and gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Speedometer and odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders . . . . . . . 2-7
Checking bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
Audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
Vehicle Information Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
How to use the vehicle information display . . . . . . . 2-15
Startup display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15
Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16
Vehicle information display warnings and
indicators. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22
Security systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25
Vehicle security system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25
NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
Windshield wiper and washer switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27
Switch operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28
Rear window wiper and washer switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
Rear window and outside mirror (if so equipped)
defroster switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30
Headlight and turn signal switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30
Headlight control switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30
Daytime running light system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32
Instrument brightness control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
Fog light switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34
Heated steering wheel (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34
Heated seats (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
Heated 2nd row seats (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36
Climate controlled seat switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . 2-37
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off switch . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38
Power outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
12v outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40
Seatback pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40
Sunglasses holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
Cup holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
Glove box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43
Console box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43
Luggage hooks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44
Roof rack (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45
Power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45
Power moonroof (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-48
Interior light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50
Console light (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50
Map lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-51
Personal Lights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-51
HomeLink® universal transceiver (if so equipped) . . . . 2-51
Programming HomeLink® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-52
Programming HomeLink® for Canadian
customers and gate openers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53
Operating the HomeLink® universal
transceiver. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54
Programming trouble-diagnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54
Clearing the programmed information . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54
Reprogramming a single HomeLink® button. . . . . . 2-55
If your vehicle is stolen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55
INSTRUMENT PANEL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
LIC2999
2-2 Instruments and controls
Vent (P. 4-25)
Headlight/fog light (if so equipped)/turn
signal switch (P. 2-30)
Supplemental front-impact air bag
(P. 1-46)
Meters, gauges, warning/indicator
lights and Vehicle Information Display
(P. 2-3, P. 2-7, P. 2-14)
Windshield wiper/washer switch and
rear window wiper/washer switch
(P. 2-27)
Vent (P. 4-25)
Hazard warning flasher switch (P. 6-2)
Radio (P. 4-38)
Front passenger supplemental air bag
(P. 2-25)
Vent (P. 4-25)
Glove box (P. 2-43)
Front passenger air bag warning status
light (P. 1-46)
Power outlet (P. 2-39)
Heater and air conditioning controls
(P. 4-26)
Shift lever (P. 5-16)
Push-button ignition switch (P. 5-10)
METERS AND GAUGES
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
Cruise control main/Intelligent Cruise
Control (ICC) (if so equipped) set
switches (P. 5-33)
Driver supplemental knee air bag
(P. 1-46)
Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System/
Audio control switches (P. 4-29)
Hood release (P. 3-22)/Fuel door
release (P. 3-27)
Fuse box (P. 8-22)
Power liftgate main switch
(if so equipped) (P. 3-23)
Heated steering wheel switch (if so
equipped) (P. 2-34)
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF
switch (P. 2-38)
Instrument brightness control
(P. 2-30)/Twin trip odometer reset
switch (P. 2-3)
*: Refer to the separate Navigation System Owner’s Manual (if so equipped).
Refer to the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details.
LIC2920
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Tachometer
Warning/indicator lights
Vehicle Information Display/Odometer/
Twin trip odometer
Speedometer
Fuel gauge
6.
Engine coolant temperature gauge
Instruments and controls 2-3
The odometer records the total distance the vehicle has been driven.
The twin trip odometer records the distance of
individual trips.
LIC2255
SPEEDOMETER AND ODOMETER
This vehicle is equipped with a speedometer and
odometer. The speedometer is located on the
right side of the meter cluster. The odometer is
located within the Vehicle Information Display.
Speedometer
The speedometer indicates vehicle speed.
Odometer/Twin trip odometer
1 are
The odometer and the twin trip odometer 䊊
displayed below the vehicle information display
when the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position.
2-4 Instruments and controls
LIC2921
Changing the display:
2 switch on the instruPush the TRIP RESET 䊊
ment panel to change the display as follows:
Trip
Trip
→ Trip
→ Odometer Milage →
Resetting the trip odometer
2 for more
Pushing the TRIP RESET switch 䊊
than 1 second resets the currently displayed trip
odometer to zero.
CAUTION
If the gauge indicates coolant temperature near the hot (H) end of the normal
range, reduce vehicle speed to decrease
temperature. If the gauge is over the normal range, stop the vehicle as soon as
safely possible. If the engine is overheated, continued operation of the vehicle
may seriously damage the engine. For additional information, refer to “If your vehicle overheats” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual for
immediate action required.
LIC3114
TACHOMETER
The tachometer indicates engine speed in revolutions per minute (rpm). Do not rev engine into
1 .
the red zone 䊊
CAUTION
When engine speed approaches the red
zone, reduce engine speed. Operating the
engine in the red zone may cause serious
engine damage.
LIC3189
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
GAUGE
The gauge indicates the engine coolant temperature. The engine coolant temperature is within the
1 when the gauge needle points
normal range 䊊
within the zone shown in the illustration.
The engine coolant temperature varies with the
outside air temperature and driving conditions.
Instruments and controls 2-5
indicates that the fuel-filler door is
The
located on the driver’s side of the vehicle.
CAUTION
● If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the
Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may
come on. Refuel as soon as possible.
light
After a few driving trips. the
should turn off. If the light remains on
after a few driving trips, have the vehicle
inspected by a NISSAN dealer.
LIC2222
FUEL GAUGE
The gauge indicates the approximate fuel level
in the tank.
The gauge may move slightly during braking,
turning, acceleration, or going up or down hills.
The gauge needle returns to 0 (Empty) after the
ignition switch is placed in the OFF position.
The low fuel warning light comes on when the
amount of fuel in the tank is getting low.
Refill the fuel tank before the gauge registers 0 (Empty).
2-6 Instruments and controls
● For additional information, refer to
“Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)” in
this section.
WARNING/INDICATOR LIGHTS AND
AUDIBLE REMINDERS
or
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS)
warning light
Master warning light
Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)
or
Brake warning light
Power steering warning light
Security indicator light
Charge warning light
Seat belt warning light and chime
Side light and headlight indicator light (green)
Engine oil pressure warning light
Supplemental air bag warning light
Slip indicator light
Forward Emergency Braking system warning light
(if so equipped)
Front fog light indicator light (if so equipped)
Turn signal/hazard indicator lights
Low tire pressure warning light
Front passenger air bag status light
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off indicator
light
Low windshield-washer fluid warning light
High beam indicator light (blue)
CHECKING BULBS
With all doors closed, apply the parking brake
and place the ignition switch to the ON position
without starting the engine. The following lights
will come on:
,
,
,
,
The following lights come on briefly and then go
off:
,
,
,
,
If any light fails to come on, it may indicate
a burned-out bulb or an open circuit in the
electrical system. Have the system repaired
promptly.
WARNING LIGHTS
For additional information, refer to “Vehicle information display” in this section.
Instruments and controls 2-7
or
Anti-lock Braking
System (ABS)
warning light
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, the ABS warning light illuminates and
then turns off. This indicates the ABS is operational.
If the ABS warning light illuminates while the
engine is running or while driving, it may indicate
the ABS is not functioning properly. Have the
system checked by a NISSAN dealer.
If an ABS malfunction occurs, the anti-lock function is turned off. The brake system then operates
normally but without anti-lock assistance. For
additional information, refer to “Brake system” in
the “Starting and driving” section of this manual.
or
Brake warning light
This light functions for both the parking brake and
the foot brake systems.
Low brake fluid warning light
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, the light warns of a low brake fluid level.
If the light comes on while the engine is running
with the parking brake not applied, stop the vehicle and perform the following:
2-8 Instruments and controls
1. Check the brake fluid level. Add brake fluid
as necessary. For additional information, refer to “Brake fluid” in the “Maintenance and
do-it-yourself” section of this manual.
2. If the brake fluid level is correct, have the
warning system checked by a NISSAN
dealer.
WARNING
● Your brake system may not be working
properly if the warning light is on. Driving could be dangerous. If you judge it
to be safe, drive carefully to the nearest
service station for repairs. Otherwise,
have your vehicle towed.
● Pressing the brake pedal with the engine stopped and/or a low brake fluid
level may increase your stopping distance and braking will require greater
pedal effort as well as pedal travel.
● If the brake fluid
MINIMUM or MIN
fluid reservoir, do
brake system has
NISSAN dealer.
level is below the
mark on the brake
not drive until the
been checked at a
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning
indicator
When the parking brake is released and the
brake fluid level is sufficient, if both the brake
warning light and the ABS warning light illuminates, it may indicate the ABS is not functioning
properly. Have the brake system checked and, if
necessary, repaired by a NISSAN dealer
promptly. Avoid high-speed driving and abrupt
braking. For additional information, refer to “Antilock Braking System (ABS) warning light” in this
section.
Charge warning light
If this light comes on while the engine is running,
it may indicate the charging system is not functioning properly. Turn the engine off and check
the generator belt. If the belt is loose, broken,
missing, or if the light remains on, see a NISSAN
dealer immediately.
CAUTION
● Do not continue driving if the generator
belt is loose, broken or missing.
Engine oil pressure warning
light
This light warns of low engine oil pressure. If the
light flickers or comes on during normal driving,
pull off the road in a safe area, stop the engine
immediately and call a NISSAN dealer or other
authorized repair shop.
The engine oil pressure warning light is not
designed to indicate a low oil level. Use the
dipstick to check the oil level. For additional information, refer to “Engine oil” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual.
CAUTION
Running the engine with the engine oil
pressure warning light on could cause serious damage to the engine almost immediately. Such damage is not covered by
warranty. Turn off the engine as soon as it
is safe to do so.
Forward Emergency Braking
system warning light (if so
equipped)
This light illuminates when the Forward Emergency Braking system is set to OFF on the meter
display.
If the light illuminates when the Forward Emergency Braking system is ON, it may indicate that
the system is unavailable. For additional information, refer to “Forward Emergency Braking system” in the “Starting and driving” section of this
manual.
Low tire pressure warning light
tire pressure warning light. Use a tire pressure gauge to check the tire pressure.
Your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) that monitors the tire
pressure of all tires except the spare.
The “Tire Pressure Low - Add Air” warning appears each time the ignition switch is placed in
the ON position as long as the low tire pressure
warning light remains illuminated.
The low tire pressure warning light warns of low
tire pressure or indicates that the TPMS is not
functioning properly.
After the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, this light illuminates for about 1 second
and turns off.
Low tire pressure warning
If the vehicle is being driven with low tire
pressure, the warning light will illuminate.
A “Tire Pressure Low Add Air” warning also
appears in the vehicle information display.
When the low tire pressure warning light
illuminates, you should stop and adjust the
tire pressure of all four tires to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the
Tire and Loading Information label located
in the driver’s door opening. The low tire
pressure warning light does not automatically turn off when the tire pressure is adjusted. After the tire is inflated to the recommended pressure, the vehicle must be
driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h)
to activate the TPMS and turn off the low
For additional information, refer to “Vehicle information display” in the “Instruments and controls”
section and “Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)” in the “Starting and driving” section and
in the “In case of emergency” section of this
manual.
TPMS malfunction
If the TPMS is not functioning properly, the low
tire pressure warning light will flash for approximately one minute when the ignition switch is
placed in the ON position. The light will remain on
after the one minute. Have the system checked
by a NISSAN dealer. The “Tire Pressure Low Add
Air” warning does not appear if the low tire pressure warning light illuminates to indicate a TPMS
malfunction.
For additional information, refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” in the “Starting and
driving” section and “Tire pressure” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this
manual.
Instruments and controls 2-9
WARNING
● Radio waves could adversely affect
electric medical equipment. Those who
use a pacemaker should contact the
electric medical equipment manufacturer for the possible influences before
use.
● If the light does not illuminate with the
ignition switch placed in the ON position, have the vehicle checked by a
NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.
● If the light illuminates while driving,
avoid sudden steering maneuvers or
abrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed,
pull off the road to a safe location and
stop the vehicle as soon as possible.
Driving with under-inflated tires may
permanently damage the tires and increase the likelihood of tire failure. Serious vehicle damage could occur and
may lead to an accident and could result
in serious personal injury or death.
Check the tire pressure for all four tires.
Adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on
the Tire and Loading Information label
located in the driver’s door opening to
turn the low tire pressure warning light
OFF. If the light still illuminates while
driving after adjusting the tire pressure,
a tire may be flat. If you have a flat tire,
replace it with a spare tire as soon as
possible.
● When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel
is replaced tire pressure will not be indicated, the TPMS will not function and
the low tire pressure warning light will
flash for approximately 1 minute. The
light will remain on after 1 minute. Contact a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible for tire replacement and/or system resetting.
● Replacing tires with those not originally
specified by NISSAN could affect the
proper operation of the TPMS.
CAUTION
● TPMS is not a substitute for the regular
tire pressure check. Be sure to check
the tire pressure regularly.
● If the vehicle is being driven at speeds
of less than 16 MPH (25 km/h), the
TPMS may not operate correctly.
● Be sure to install the specified size of
tires to the 4 wheels correctly.
2-10 Instruments and controls
Low windshield-washer fluid
warning light
This light comes on when the windshield-washer
fluid is at a low level. Add windshield-washer
fluid, as necessary. For additional information,
refer to “Windshield-washer fluid” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual.
Master warning light
When the ignition switch is in the ON position,
the master warning light illuminates if any of the
following are displayed on the vehicle information
display:
● No key warning
● Low fuel warning
● Low washer fluid warning
● Parking brake release warning
● Door open warning
● Loose fuel cap warning (if so equipped)
● Check tire pressure warning
For additional information, refer to “Vehicle Information Display” in this section.
Power steering warning light
WARNING
● If the engine is not running or is turned
off while driving, the power assist for
the steering will not work. Steering will
be harder to operate.
● When the power steering warning light
illuminates with the engine running,
there will be no power assist for the
steering. You will still have control of
the vehicle, but the steering will be
much harder to operate. Have the power
steering system checked by a NISSAN
dealer.
When the ignition switch is in the ON position,
the power steering warning light illuminates. After
starting the engine, the power steering warning
light turns off. This indicates that the power steering system is operational. If the power steering
warning light illuminates while the engine is running, it may indicate the power steering system is
not functioning properly and may need servicing.
Have the power steering system checked by a
NISSAN dealer. For additional information, refer
to “Power steering” in the “Starting and driving”
section of this manual.
Seat belt warning light and
chime
The light and chime remind you to fasten your
seat belts. The light illuminates whenever the
ignition switch is placed in the ON or START
position and remains illuminated until the driver’s
seat belt is fastened. At the same time, the chime
sounds for about 6 seconds unless the driver’s
seat belt is securely fastened.
The seat belt warning light may also illuminate if
the front passenger’s seat belt is not fastened
when the front passenger’s seat is occupied . For
7 seconds after the ignition switch is placed in
the ON position, the system does not activate the
warning light for the front passenger.
For additional information, refer to “Seat belts” in
the “Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental
restraint system” section of this manual.
Supplemental air bag warning
light
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON or
START position, the supplemental air bag warning light illuminates for about 7 seconds and then
turns off. This means the system is operational.
Instruments and controls 2-11
If any of the following conditions occur, the front
air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag, knee air bag,
and pretensioner systems need servicing and
your vehicle must be taken to a NISSAN dealer:
● The supplemental air bag warning light remains on after approximately 7 seconds.
● The supplemental air bag warning light
flashes intermittently.
● The supplemental air bag warning light does
not come on at all.
Unless checked and repaired, the supplemental
restraint system (air bag system) and/or the seat
belts with pretensioner system may not function
properly. For additional information, refer to
“Supplemental restraint system (SRS)” in the
“Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section of this manual.
WARNING
If the supplemental air bag warning light
is on, it could mean that the front air bag,
side air bag, curtain air bag, knee air bag,
and/or pretensioner systems will not operate in an accident. To help avoid injury to
yourself or others, have your vehicle
checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as
possible.
2-12 Instruments and controls
INDICATOR LIGHTS
For additional information, refer to “Vehicle information display” in this section.
Front fog light indicator light (if
so equipped)
The front fog light indicator light illuminates when
the front fog lights are ON. For additional information, refer to “Fog light switch” in this section.
Front passenger air bag status
light
The front passenger air bag status light will be lit
and the passenger front air bag will be OFF
depending on how the front passenger seat is
being used.
For additional information, refer to “Front passenger air bag and status light” in the “Safety —
Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section of this manual.
High beam indicator light
(blue)
This blue light comes on when the headlight high
beams are on and goes out when the low beams
are selected.
The high beam indicator light also comes on
when the passing signal is activated.
Malfunction Indicator Light
(MIL)
If this indicator light comes on steady or blinks
while the engine is running, it may indicate a
potential emission control malfunction.
The MIL may also come on steady if the fuel-filler
cap is loose or missing, or if the vehicle runs out
of fuel. Check to make sure the fuel-filler cap is
installed and closed tightly, and that the vehicle
has at least 3 gallons (11.4 liters) of fuel in the
fuel tank.
light should
After a few driving trips, the
turn off if no other potential emission control
system malfunction exists.
If this indicator light comes on steady for 20 seconds and then blinks for 10 seconds when the
engine is not running, it indicates that the vehicle
is not ready for an emission control system
inspection/maintenance test. For additional information,
refer
to
“Readiness
for
inspection/maintenance (I/M) test” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this
manual.
Operation
The MIL will come on in one of two ways:
● MIL on steady — An emission control system
malfunction has been detected. Check the
fuel-filler cap if the LOOSE FUEL CAP
warning appears in the vehicle information
display. If the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, tighten or install the cap and continue to
light should turn
drive the vehicle. The
light
off after a few driving trips. If the
does not turn off after a few driving trips,
have the vehicle inspected by a NISSAN
dealer. You do not need to have your vehicle
towed to the dealer.
● MIL blinking — An engine misfire has been
detected which may damage the emission
control system. To reduce or avoid emission
control system damage:
– do not drive at speeds above 45 MPH
(72 km/h).
– avoid hard acceleration or deceleration.
– avoid steep uphill grades.
– if possible, reduce the amount of cargo
being hauled or towed.
The MIL may stop blinking and come on steady.
Have the vehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer.
You do not need to have your vehicle towed to the
dealer.
CAUTION
Continued vehicle operation without having the emission control system checked
and repaired as necessary could lead to
poor driveability, reduced fuel economy,
and possible damage to the emission control system.
Security indicator light
This light blinks when the ignition switch is
placed in the OFF, LOCK or ACC (if so
equipped) position.
The blinking security indicator light indicates that
the security systems equipped on the vehicle are
operational.
For additional information, refer to “Security systems” in this section.
Side light and headlight
indicator light (green)
The side light and headlight indicator light illuminates when the side light or headlight position is
selected. For additional information, refer to
“Headlight and turn signal switch” in this section.
Slip indicator light
This indicator will blink when the VDC system is
operating, thus alerting the driver to the fact that
the road surface is slippery and the vehicle is
nearing its traction limits.
You may feel or hear the system working; this is
normal.
The light will blink for a few seconds after the
VDC system stops limiting wheel spin.
indicator light also comes on when
The
you place the ignition switch in the ON position.
The light will turn off after approximately 2 seconds if the system is operational. If the light does
not come on have the system checked by a
NISSAN dealer.
Turn signal/hazard indicator
lights
The appropriate light flashes when the turn signal
switch is activated.
Both lights flash when the hazard switch is turned
on.
Instruments and controls 2-13
VEHICLE INFORMATION DISPLAY
Vehicle Dynamic Control
(VDC) OFF indicator light
This indicator light comes on when the VDC off
switch is pushed to OFF. This indicates the VDC
system is not operating.
Push the VDC off switch again or restart the
engine and the system will operate normally. For
additional information, refer to “Vehicle Dynamic
Control (VDC) system” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual.
The VDC light also comes on when you place the
ignition switch in the ON position. The light will
turn off after about 2 seconds if the system is
operational. If the light stays on or comes on
indicator light while you are
along with the
driving, have the VDC system checked by a
NISSAN dealer.
While the VDC system is operating, you might
feel slight vibration or hear the system working
when starting the vehicle or accelerating, but this
is normal.
AUDIBLE REMINDERS
Brake pad wear warning
The disc brake pads have audible wear warnings.
When a disc brake pad requires replacement, it
makes a high pitched scraping sound when the
vehicle is in motion, whether or not the brake
2-14 Instruments and controls
pedal is depressed. Have the brakes checked as
soon as possible if the warning sound is heard.
Key left reminder chime
A chime sounds if the driver’s door is opened
while the ignition switch is placed in the ACC or
OFF position with the Intelligent Key left in the
vehicle. Make sure the ignition switch is placed in
the LOCK position, and take the Intelligent Key
with you when leaving the vehicle.
Light reminder chime
With the ignition switch placed in the OFF position, a chime sounds when the driver’s door is
opened if the headlights or parking lights are on.
Turn the headlight control switch off before leaving the vehicle.
NISSAN Intelligent Key® Lock-in
Prevention
The Intelligent Key buzzer sounds if the Intelligent
Key is left inside the vehicle when the doors are
closed and locked. When the buzzer sounds, be
sure to take the Intelligent key with you when
leaving the vehicle. For additional information,
refer to “NISSAN Intelligent Key®” in the “Predriving checks and adjustments” section of this
manual.
LIC2205
The vehicle information display is located to the
left of the speedometer. It displays such items as:
● Vehicle settings
● Trip computer information
● Drive system warnings and settings
● Forward Emergency Braking system (if so
equipped)
● Predictive Forward Collision warning system
(if so equipped)
● Blind Spot Warning system (if so equipped)
● Rear cross traffic alert system (if so
equipped)
● Cruise control system information
3.
● Intelligent Cruise Control system information
(if so equipped)
— scroll up or down the vehicle information menu items.
and
buttons also
The OK,
control audio and control panel functions. For
additional information, refer to “Steering wheel
switch for audio control” in “Display screen,
heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems”
section of this manual.
● NISSAN Intelligent Key® operation information
● Indicators and warnings
● Tire Pressure information
STARTUP DISPLAY
The display will be interrupted when a text message is received, and can be operated via steering wheel mounted switch (models with Navigation).
When the vehicle in placed in the ON or ACC
position the screens that display in the vehicle
information display include:
LIC3010
● Active system status (if so equipped)
HOW TO USE THE VEHICLE
INFORMATION DISPLAY
● Trip computer
The vehicle information display can be changed
and OK located on the
using the buttons
steering wheel.
● Fuel economy
1. OK — change or select an item in the vehicle
information display
2.
— go back or forward through
the vehicle information menu items or to
change from one display screen to the next
(i.e. trip, TPMS, Fuel economy)
● Tire pressure information
● Warnings
● Outside air temperature
● Odometer/Twin Trip Odometer
● Audio
● Navigation
● Settings
Instruments and controls 2-15
Warnings will only display if there are any present. For additional information on warnings and
indicators, refer to “Vehicle information display
warnings and indicators” in this section.
To control what items display in the vehicle information display, refer to “Main menu selection” in
this section.
SETTINGS
The setting mode allows you to change the information displayed in the vehicle information display:
Driver Assistance
Main Menu Selection
To change the status, warnings or turn on or off
any of the systems/warnings displayed in the
“Driver Assistance” menu:
The items that display can be enabled/disabled
when the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position. To change the items that display.
button to select and the OK butUse the
ton to change a menu item:
button to select and the OK butUse the
ton to change a menu item:
● Home
● Driving Aids (if so equipped)
– Emergency
equipped)
Brake
ON/OFF
(if
so
● Audio
● Navigation
– Blind Spot ON/OFF (if so equipped)
● Drive computer
● Customize Display
– Driver Attention Alert ON/OFF (if so
equipped)
● Fuel Economy
● Vehicle Settings
– Timer Alert
● Maintenance
– Low Temperature Alert ON/OFF
● Driver Assistance
● Clock
● TPMS Settings
● Unit / Language
● Key-Linked Settings
● Factory Reset
● Parking Aids (if so equipped)
– Moving Object ON/OFF (if so equipped)
Customize Display
The Customize Display allows the customer to
choose from various meter selections.
The meter settings can be changed using
and the OK button.
the
2-16 Instruments and controls
● Driving Aids
● Tire Pressures
Car Icon Color
The color of the vehicle that displays in the vehicle information display when the ignition switch
is placed in the ON position can be changed.
ECO Info Settings
The
following
information
can
be
enabled/disabled to display in the vehicle information display when the ignition switch is placed
in the ON posi tion.
From the “Customize Display” select “ECO Info
Settings” to display the information when the
ignition switch is placed in the ON position.
● ECO Drive Report – select “On” or “Off” to
display the information when the ignition
switch is placed in the ON position.
● View History - select to display the vehicle’s
information history.
Navigation (if so equipped)
This setting allows the customer to
enable/disable the alert for navigation in the vehicle information display.
1. Use the
buttons to select “Navigation”.
2. Press the OK button to turn ON/OFF the
alert.
3. Press the OK button to change the “View
Mode” between “City” and “Arrow”.
Welcome Effects
The welcome screen display can be adjusted
when the ignition switch is placed in the ACC or
or
button to
ON position. Press the
toggle through the menu options. Press the OK
button to turn ON/OFF the following:
● Gauges
● Animation
Vehicle Settings
Exterior Door Switches
The vehicle settings allows the customer to
change settings for interior lights, turn signals,
intelligent key settings, unlock settings and other
vehicle settings.
When this item is turned on, the request switches
on the doors are activated. From the Vehicle
Settings menu, select “Ext. Door Switch”. Use
the OK button to toggle between on and off.
When “ON is highlighted, Ext. Door Switch is
turned on. When “ON” is greyed-out, this item is
turned off.
The vehicle settings can be changed using
the
,
, and the OK buttons.
Lighting
Select the Lighting menu option to adjust the
following:
● Accent Lighting
● Light Sensitivity - The light sensitivity can be
set to illuminate earlier based on the brightness outside the vehicle. Press OK to
change the sensitivity timing.
● Light Off Delay - The duration of the automatic headlights can be changed from 0 to
180 seconds. Press OK to change the duration.
Turn Indicator
The 3 flash pass can be set to be ON or OFF.
From the Turn Indicator menu, select “3 Flash
Pass”. Use the OK button to turn this feature ON
or OFF.
I-Key Door Unlock (if so equipped)
When this item is turned on, the request switch
on the doors is activated. From the Vehicle Settings menu, select “I-Key Door Unlock”. Use the
OK button to activate this function.
Answer Back Horn (if so equipped)
When the answer back horn is on, the horn will
chirp and the hazard indicators will flash once
when locking the vehicle with the Intelligent Key.
Selective Unlock
When this item is turned on and when the door
handle request switch on the driver’s or front
passenger’s side door is pushed, only the corresponding door is unlocked first. The remaining
doors can be unlocked if the door unlock operation is performed again within 1 minute. When
this item is turned to OFF, all the doors will be
unlocked after the door unlock operation is performed once. From the Vehicle Settings menu,
Instruments and controls 2-17
select ”Locking” then “Selective Unlock”. Use the
OK button to toggle between on and off. When
“ON” is highlighted, “Selective Unlock” is turned
on. When “ON” is greyed-out, this item is turned
off.
Wipers
The speed dependent feature can be set to be
ON or OFF. From the Wipers menu, select
“Speed Dependent”. Use the OK button to turn
this feature ON or OFF.
Driving Position (if so equipped)
The driving position has two features that can be
set to be ON or OFF. From the Driving position
menu, select “Exit Seat Slide” or “Exit Steering
Up”. Use the OK button to turn this feature ON or
OFF.
Remote engine start (if so equipped)
The remote engine start feature can be set to be
ON or OFF. From the Remote engine start menu,
use the OK button to turn this feature ON or OFF.
2-18 Instruments and controls
Maintenance
WARNING
The maintenance mode allows you to set alerts
for the reminding of maintenance intervals. To
change an item:
or
button to toggle
1. Push the
through the menu items, and select “Settings” and press OK.
2. Select “Maintenance” using the
ton and press OK.
but-
Oil and Filter
This indicator appears when the customer set
distance comes for changing the engine oil and
filter. You can set or reset the distance for checking or replacing these items. For scheduled maintenance items and intervals, see your “NISSAN
Service and Maintenance Guide.”
Tire
This indicator appears when the customer set
distance is reached for replacing tires. You can
set or reset the distance for replacing tires.
The tire replacement indicator is not a
substitute for regular tire checks, including tire pressure checks. For additional
information, refer to “Changing wheels
and tires” in the “Maintenance and do-ityourself” section of this manual. Many factors including tire inflation, alignment,
driving habits and road conditions affect
tire wear and when tires should be replaced. Setting the tire replacement indicator for a certain driving distance does
not mean your tires will last that long. Use
the tire replacement indicator as a guide
only and always perform regular tire
checks. Failure to perform regular tire
checks, including tire pressure checks
could result in tire failure. Serious vehicle
damage could occur and may lead to a
collision, which could result in serious
personal injury or death.
Other
This indicator appears when the customer set
distance is reached for checking or replacing
maintenance items other than the engine oil, oil
filter and tires. Other maintenance items can include such things as air filter or tire rotation. The
distance for checking or replacing the items can
be set or reset.
Clock
To set the clock for system with navigation, press
the “MENU” button. For systems without navigation, press the “SETTING” button. For additional
information on how to set the clock, refer to the
“Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio
and phone systems” section of this manual or the
separate Navigation Owner’s Manual.
TPMS Settings
The unit for tire pressure that displays in the
vehicle information display can be changed to:
to the separate Navigation Owner’s Manual. Use
buttons to choose from he following
the
menu options:
● Mileage/Fuel
● Tire Pressures
● Temperature
● Language
Mileage/Fuel
The unit for the mileage that displays in the vehicle information display can be changed to:
Use the
buttons and the OK button to
select and change the unit.
Temperature
The temperature that displays in the vehicle information display can be changed from:
● °F (Fahrenheit)
● °C (Celsius)
Use the OK button to toggle choices.
Language
The language of the vehicle information display
can be changed to:
● psi
● miles, MPG
● kPa
● km/h, km/l
● English
● km/h, l/100km
● French
● bar
● kgf/cm
2
Use the
buttons and the OK button to
select and change the unit.
Unit/Language
Select “Unit/Language” to adjust vehicle units
and language on the Vehicle Information Display.
The vehicle information display language can
also be changed by operating the navigation unit
(if so equipped). For additional information, refer
buttons and the OK button to
Use the
select and change the unit.
Tire Pressures
The unit for tire pressure that displays in the
vehicle information display can be changed to:
● psi
● kPa
● bar
● Spanish
buttons and the OK button to
Use the
select and change the language of the vehicle
information display.
Key-Linked Settings
The Key-Linked Setting can be turned
ON/OFF/Later using the OK button. It will display
the key synchronized and in use for this vehicle.
● kgf/cm2
Instruments and controls 2-19
Factory Reset
The settings in the vehicle information display can
be reset back to the factory default. To reset the
vehicle information display:
buttons to select “Set1. Use the
tings”, and press the OK button.
2. Select “Factory Reset” using the
tons and press the OK button.
but-
3. Select “YES” to return all settings back to
default by pressing the OK button.
2-20 Instruments and controls
LIC3248
Instruments and controls 2-21
VEHICLE INFORMATION DISPLAY
WARNINGS AND INDICATORS
1. Engine start operation
2. No Key Detected
3. Shift to Park
4. Key Battery Low
5. Engine start operation for Intelligent Key system (if I-Key battery level is low)
18. All Wheel Drive (AWD) Tire Size Incorrect
See Owner’s Manual (if so equipped)
19. Battery Voltage Low Charge Battery
20. Shipping Mode On Push Storage Fuse
21. Power will turn off to save the battery
22. Power turned off to save the battery
23. Reminder: Turn OFF headlights
24. Alarm – Time for a break?
6. Key ID Incorrect
25. Driver Attention Alert — Take a Break?
7. Release Parking Brake
26. Driver Attention Alert Malfunction
8. Low Fuel
27. Low Outside Temperature
9. Low Washer Fluid
28. Cruise indicators
10. Door/Liftgate Open
29. Transmission Shift Position Indicator
11. I-Key System Error: See Owner’s Manual
30. CVT Error: See Owner’s Manual
12. Loose Fuel Cap
31. BSW/RCTA system malfunction: See Owner’s Manual (if so equipped)
13. Tire Pressure Low – Add Air
14. Flat Tire – Visit Dealer (if so equipped)
15. Low Oil Pressure Stop Vehicle
32. FEB/PFCW system malfunction: See Owner’s Manual (if so equipped)
33. ICC system On indicator (if so equipped)
This indicator means that the engine will start by
pushing the ignition switch with the brake pedal
depressed. You can start the engine from any
position of the ignition switch.
No Key Detected
This warning appears when the Intelligent Key is
left outside the vehicle with the ignition switch in
the ON position. Make sure the Intelligent Key is
inside the vehicle.
For additional information about the Intelligent
Key, refer to “NISSAN Intelligent Key®” in the
“Pre-driving checks and adjustments” section of
this manual.
Shift to Park
This warning illuminates when the ignition switch
is in the ACC or OFF position and the shift lever
is not in P (Park) position. Also, a chime sounds
when the ignition switch is in the ACC or OFF
position.
If this warning illuminates, move the shift lever to
the P (Park) position or start the engine.
Key Battery Low
16. All Wheel Drive (AWD) Error: See Owner’s
Manual (if so equipped)
Engine start operation
This indicator illuminates when the Intelligent Key
battery is running out of power.
17. All Wheel Drive (AWD) High Temp. Stop
Vehicle (if so equipped)
This indicator appears when the shift lever is in
the P (Park) position.
If this indicator illuminates, replace the battery
with a new one. For additional information, refer
2-22 Instruments and controls
to “Battery replacement” in the “Maintenance and
do-it-yourself” section of this manual.
Engine start operation for Intelligent Key
system (if I-Key battery level is low)
This indicator appears when the battery of the
Intelligent Key is low and when the Intelligent Key
system and the vehicle are not communicating
normally.
If this appears, touch the ignition switch with the
Intelligent Key while depressing the brake pedal.
For additional information, refer to “NISSAN Intelligent Key® battery discharge” in the “Starting
and driving” section of this manual.
Key ID Incorrect
This warning appears when the ignition switch is
placed from the OFF position and the Intelligent
Key is not recognized by the system. You cannot
start the engine with an unregistered key.
For additional information, refer to “NISSAN Intelligent Key®” in the “Pre-driving checks and
adjustments” section of this manual.
Release Parking Brake
This warning illuminates in the message area of
the vehicle information display when the parking
brake is set and the vehicle is driven.
Low Fuel
This warning illuminates when the fuel level in the
fuel tank is getting low. Refuel as soon as it is
convenient, preferably before the fuel gauge
reaches 0 (Empty). There will be a small reserve of fuel in the tank when the fuel
gauge needle reaches 0 (Empty).
Low Washer Fluid
This warning illuminates when the windshieldwasher fluid is at a low level. Add windshieldwasher fluid as necessary. For additional information, refer to “Windshield-washer fluid” in the
“Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this
manual.
Door/liftgate Open
This warning illuminates when a door has been
opened when the engine is running.
I-Key System Error: See Owner’s Manual
After the ignition switch is pushed to the ON
position, this light comes on for a period of time
and then turns off.
The I-Key System Error message warns of a
malfunction with the Intelligent Key system. If the
light comes on while the engine is stopped, it may
be impossible to start the engine.
If the light comes on while the engine is running,
you can drive the vehicle. However in these
cases, contact a NISSAN dealer for repair as
soon as possible.
Loose Fuel Cap
This warning appears when the fuel-filler cap is
not tightened correctly after the vehicle has been
refueled. For additional information, refer to
“Fuel-filler cap” in the “Pre-driving checks and
adjustments” section of this manual.
Tire Pressure Low - Add Air
This warning appears when the low tire pressure
warning light in the meter illuminates and low tire
pressure is detected. If this warning appears,
stop the vehicle and adjust the tire pressures of
all four tires to the recommended COLD tire
pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Information label. For additional information, refer to
“Low tire pressure warning light” in this section
and “Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)”
in the “Starting and driving” section of this
manual.
Flat Tire – Visit Dealer (if so equipped)
This warning appears when the low tire pressure
warning light in the meter illuminates and one or
more flat tires are detected while driving. A chime
also sounds for approximately 10 seconds.
Instruments and controls 2-23
Low Oil Pressure Stop Vehicle
This warning appears in message area of the
vehicle information display if low oil pressure is
detected. This gauge is not designed to indicate
low oil level. The low oil pressure warning is
not designed to indicate a low oil level. Use
the dipstick to check the oil level. For additional
information, refer to “Engine oil” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual.
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) Error See Owner’s
Manual (if so equipped)
This warning appears when the all-wheel drive
system is not functioning properly while the engine is running.
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) High Temp. Stop
Vehicle (if so equipped)
This warning may appear while trying to free a
stuck vehicle due to increased oil temperature.
The driving mode may change to 2-Wheel Drive
(2WD). If this warning is displayed, stop the
vehicle with the engine idling, as soon as it is safe
to do so. Then if the warning turns off, you can
continue driving.
2-24 Instruments and controls
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) Tire Size Incorrect
See Owner’s Manual (if so equipped)
This warning may appear if there is a large difference between the diameters of the front and rear
wheels. Pull off the road in a safe area, with the
engine idling. Check that all the tire sizes are the
same, that the tire pressure is correct and that the
tires are not excessively worn.
Battery Voltage Low Charge Battery
This warning appears when the battery is low and
needs to be charged.
Shipping Mode On Push Storage Fuse
This warning may appear if the extended storage
fuse switch is not pushed in (switched on). When
this warning appears, push in (switch on) the
extended storage fuse switch to turn off the
warning. For additional information, refer to
“Fuses” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself”
section of this manual.
Power will turn off to save the battery
This message appears in the vehicle information
display after a period of time if the ignition switch
is in ACC or the ON position and if the vehicle is
in P (Park). For additional information, refer to
“Push-button ignition switch positions” in the
“Starting and driving” section of this manual.
Power turned off to save the battery
This message appears after the ignition switch is
automatically turned to off. For additional information, refer to “Push-button ignition switch positions” in the “Starting and driving” section of this
manual.
Reminder: Turn OFF headlights
This warning appears when the headlights are
left in the ON position when exiting the vehicle.
Place the headlight switch in the OFF or AUTO
position. For additional information, refer to
“Headlight and turn signal switch” in this section.
Alarm - Time for a break? (if so equipped)
This indicator appears when the driver selected
set time is reached. The time can be set up to six
hours.
Driver Attention Alert - Take a Break?
This alert appears when the system has detected
that the driver may be displaying fatigue or a lack
of attention.
Driver Attention Alert Malfunction
This warning appears when the Driver Attention
Alert system is not functioning properly. For additional information, refer to “Driver Attention
Alert” in the “Starting and driving” section of this
manual.
SECURITY SYSTEMS
Low Outside Temperature
This warning appears if the outside temperature
is below 37°F (3°C). The temperature can be
changed to display in Celsius or Fahrenheit. For
additional information, refer to “Temperature” in
this section.
BSW/RCTA System Malfunction: See
Owner’s Manual (if so equipped)
Cruise indicators
This warning appears when the Blind Spot
Warning/Rear Cross Traffic Alert systems are not
functioning properly. For additional information,
refer to “Blind Spot Warning system” and “Rear
Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA) system” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual.
This indicator shows the cruise control system
status.
FEB/PFCW System Malfunction: See
Owner’s Manual (if so equipped)
When cruise control is activated, a green circle
will illuminate to indicate it is set. The vehicle
information display will also display the speed the
cruise control was set at. If you accelerate past
the set speed, the speed will blink until you either
cancel cruise control or go back to the set speed.
If cruise control is on and cancelled, the speed
will be displayed to show the speed the vehicle
will return to if the resume button his activated.
This warning appears when the Forward Emergency Braking/Predictive Forward Collision
warning systems are not functioning properly. For
additional information, refer to “Forward Emergency Braking System” and “Predictive Forward
Collision Warning” in the “Starting and driving”
section of this manual.
Transmission Shift Position Indicator
This indicator shows the Intelligent Cruise Control (ICC) system status. The status is shown by
the color. For additional information, refer to “Intelligent Cruise Control (ICC) System” in the
“Starting and driving” section of this manual.
This indicator shows the transmission shift position.
CVT Error: See Owner’s Manual
This warning illuminates when the there is a problem with the CVT system. If this warning comes
on, have the system checked by a NISSAN
dealer.
Intelligent Cruise Control (ICC) system ON
indicator (if so equipped)
LIC2930
Your vehicle has two types of security systems:
● Vehicle security system
● NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer system
VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM
The vehicle security system provides visual and
audible alarm signals if someone opens the
doors, trunk, liftgate or the hood when the system
is armed. It is not, however, a motion detection
type system that activates when a vehicle is
moved or when a vibration occurs.
The system helps deter vehicle theft but cannot
prevent it, nor can it prevent the theft of interior or
exterior vehicle components in all situations. Al-
Instruments and controls 2-25
ways secure your vehicle even if parking for a
brief period. Never leave your Intelligent Key in
the vehicle, and always lock the vehicle when
unattended. Be aware of your surroundings, and
park in secure, well-lit areas whenever possible.
Many devices offering additional protection, such
as component locks, identification markers, and
tracking systems, are available at auto supply
stores and specialty shops. A NISSAN dealer
may also offer such equipment. Check with your
insurance company to see if you may be eligible
for discounts for various theft protection features.
How to arm the vehicle security
system
1. Close all windows. (The system can be
armed even if the windows are open.)
2. Remove the Intelligent Key from the vehicle.
3. Close all doors, hood and trunk/liftgate.
Lock all doors. The doors can be locked with
the Intelligent Key, door handle request
switch (if so equipped), or mechanical key.
security indicator
4. Confirm that the
light stays on for about 30 seconds. The
vehicle security system is now pre-armed.
The vehicle security system will automatically shift into the armed phase. The
security light begins to flash once every
2-26 Instruments and controls
three seconds. If during the pre-armed
phase one of the following occurs, the system will not arm:
● Any door is unlocked with the mechanical
key, the intelligent key or door request
switch (if so equipped).
● Ignition switch is placed in ACC or ON
position.
● Even when the driver and/or passengers are in the vehicle, the system will
activate with all the doors, hood and
trunk lid locked with the ignition switch
placed in the LOCK position. When
placing the ignition switch in the ACC
or ON position, the system will be released.
Vehicle security system activation
The vehicle security system will give the following
alarm:
● The headlights blink and the horn sounds
intermittently but synchronously.
● The alarm automatically turns off after a period of time. However, the alarm reactivates if
the vehicle is tampered with again.
The alarm is activated by:
● opening any door or hood without using the
key or Intelligent Key (even if the door is unlocked by releasing the door inside lock knob).
How to stop an activated alarm
The alarm stops only by unlocking a door or the
trunk/liftgate with the mechanical key, pressing
button on the Intelligent Key, or pressthe
ing the request switch on the driver’s or passenger’s door with the Intelligent Key in range of the
door handle.
NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER
SYSTEM
The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System will not
allow the engine to start without the use of a
registered key.
Never leave these keys in the vehicle.
FCC Notice:
For USA:
This device complies with part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may
not cause harmful interference, and (2) this
device must accept any interference received, including interference that may
cause undesired operation.
WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER
SWITCH
NOTE:
WARNING
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
In freezing temperatures the washer solution may freeze on the window and obscure your vision which may lead to an
accident. Warm the window with the defroster before you wash the window.
For Canada:
This device complies with Industry Canada
license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation
of the device.
CAUTION
● Do not operate the washer continuously
for more than 30 seconds.
● Do not operate the washer if the reservoir tank is empty.
LIC0474
Security indicator light
The security indicator light blinks whenever the
ignition switch is placed in the OFF, LOCK or ACC
position. This function indicates the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System is operational.
If the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System is malfunctioning, the light will remain on while the
ignition switch is placed in the ON position.
If the light still remains on and/or the engine will not start, see a NISSAN dealer for
NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System service as soon as possible. Please bring all
registered keys that you have when visiting
a NISSAN dealer for service.
● Do not fill the window washer reservoir
with washer fluid concentrates at full
strength. Some methyl alcohol based
washer fluid concentrates may permanently stain the grille if spilled while
filling the window washer reservoir.
● Pre-mix washer fluid concentrates with
water to the manufacturer’s recommended levels before pouring the fluid
into the window washer reservoir. Do
not use the window washer reservoir to
mix the washer fluid concentrate and
water.
Instruments and controls 2-27
4 to have one sweep operation
Lift the lever up 䊊
(MIST) of the wiper.
If the windshield wiper operation is interrupted by
snow or ice, the wiper may stop moving to protect
its motor. If this occurs, turn the wiper switch to
the OFF position and remove the snow or ice that
is on and around the wiper arms. In approximately
1 minute, turn the switch on again to operate the
wiper.
5 to operate the
Pull the lever toward you 䊊
washer. The wiper will also operate several times.
LIC3028
SWITCH OPERATION
The windshield wiper and washer operates when
the ignition switch is in the ON position.
Push the lever down to operate the wiper at the
following speed:
1
䊊
2
䊊
3
䊊
2-28 Instruments and controls
Intermittent (INT) — intermittent operation
can be adjusted by turning the knob toward
A (Slower) or away 䊊
B (Faster).
䊊
Low (LO) — continuous low speed operation
High (HI) — continuous high speed operation
REAR WINDOW WIPER AND
WASHER SWITCH
3 to operate the
Push the switch forward 䊊
washer. The wiper will also operate several times.
WARNING
In freezing temperatures the washer solution may freeze on the window and obscure your vision. Warm the rear window
with the defroster before you wash the
rear window.
CAUTION
● Do not operate the washer continuously
for more than 30 seconds.
● Do not operate the washer if the reservoir is empty.
● Do not fill the windshield-washer fluid
reservoir with washer fluid concentrates at full strength. Some methyl alcohol based washer fluid concentrates
may permanently stain the grille if
spilled while filling the windshieldwasher fluid reservoir.
● Pre-mix washer fluid concentrates with
water to the manufacturer’s recommended levels before pouring the fluid
into the windshield-washer fluid reservoir. Do not use the windshield-washer
fluid reservoir to mix the washer fluid
concentrate and water.
LIC3101
If the rear window wiper operation is interrupted
by snow, etc., the wiper may stop moving to
protect its motor. If this occurs, turn the wiper
switch to OFF and remove the snow, etc. on and
around the wiper arms. After about 1 minute, turn
the switch ON again to operate the wiper.
The rear window wiper and washer operate when
the ignition switch is in the ON position. Turn the
switch clockwise from the OFF position to operate the wiper.
1
䊊
2
䊊
Intermittent (INT) — intermittent operation
(not adjustable)
Low (ON) — continuous low speed operation
Instruments and controls 2-29
REAR WINDOW AND OUTSIDE
MIRROR (if so equipped)
DEFROSTER SWITCH
HEADLIGHT AND TURN SIGNAL
SWITCH
NOTE:
The top and bottom few rows of wires on
the rear window are not part of the rear
window defroster system. These wires
make up the antenna for the audio system.
LIC2923
LIC3027
To defrost the rear window glass and outside
mirrors (if so equipped), start the engine and
push the rear window defroster switch on. The
rear window defroster indicator light on the
switch comes on. Push the switch again to turn
the defroster off.
HEADLIGHT CONTROL SWITCH
The rear window defroster automatically turns off
after approximately 15 minutes.
2
䊊
CAUTION
When cleaning the inner side of the rear
window, be careful not to scratch or damage the rear window defroster.
2-30 Instruments and controls
Lighting
1
䊊
When turning the switch to the
position, the front parking, tail, license plate and
instrument panel lights come on.
When turning the switch to the
position, the headlights come on and daytime
running lights switch to front parking All the
other lights remain on.
NOTE:
CAUTION
Autolight activation sensitivity and the time
delay for autolight shutoff can be adjusted.
For additional information, refer to “Vehicle information display” in this section.
To turn on the autolight system:
Use the headlights only with the engine
running to avoid discharging the vehicle
battery.
1. Turn the headlight switch to the AUTO posi1 .
tion 䊊
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
3. The autolight system automatically turns the
headlights on and off.
SIC3268
Autolight system
The autolight system allows the headlights to turn
on and off automatically. The autolight system
can:
● Turn on the headlights, front parking, tail,
license plate and instrument panel lights automatically when it is dark.
Initially, if the ignition switch is turned OFF and a
door is opened and left open, the headlights
remain ON for a period of time. If another door is
opened while the headlights are on, then the
timer is reset.
To turn the autolight system off, turn the switch to
, or
position.
the OFF,
● Turn off all the lights (except daylight running
lights) when it is light.
● Keep all the lights on for a period of time after
you place the ignition switch in the OFF
position and all doors are closed.
Instruments and controls 2-31
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM
LIC2237
Be sure you do not put anything on top of
the autolight sensor located in the top side
1 of the instrument panel. The autolight
䊊
sensor controls the autolight; if it is covered, the autolight sensor reacts as if it is
dark out and the headlights will illuminate.
If this occurs while parked with the engine
off and the ignition switch placed in the ON
position, your vehicle’s battery could become discharged.
SIC3269
Headlight beam select
1
䊊
2
䊊
3
䊊
To select the high beam function, push the
lever forward. The high beam lights come on
light illuminates.
and the
Pull the lever back to select the low beam.
Pulling and releasing the lever flashes the
headlight high beams on and off.
Battery saver system
The battery saver automatically turns off the ignition after a period of time when the ignition switch
is left in the ACC (if so equipped) or ON position.
2-32 Instruments and controls
The daytime running lights automatically illuminate when the engine is started with the parking
brake released. The daytime running lights operate with the headlight switch in the OFF position
position. Turn the headlight switch
or in the
to the
position for full illumination when
driving at night.
If the parking brake is applied before the engine is
started, the daytime running lights do not illuminate. The daytime running lights illuminate when
the parking brake is released. The daytime running lights will remain on until the ignition switch
is placed in the OFF position.
WARNING
When the daytime running light system is
active, tail lights on your vehicle are not
on. It is necessary at dusk to turn on your
headlights. Failure to do so could cause
an accident injuring yourself and others.
Lane change signal
2
䊊
Move the lever up or down until the turn
signal begins to flash, but the lever does not
latch, to signal a lane change. Hold the lever
until the lane change is completed.
Move the lever up or down until the turn
signal begins to flash, but the lever does not
latch, and release the lever. The turn signal
will automatically flash three times.
Choose the appropriate method to signal a lane
change based on road and traffic conditions.
LIC2624
INSTRUMENT BRIGHTNESS
CONTROL
A to decrease the brightPush the “-” button 䊊
ness of instrument panel lights when driving at
night.
B to increase the brightPush the “+” button 䊊
ness of instrument panel lights when driving at
night.
SIC3271
TURN SIGNAL SWITCH
Turn signal
1
䊊
Move the lever up or down to signal the
turning direction. When the turn is completed, the turn signal cancels automatically.
Instruments and controls 2-33
HORN
HEATED STEERING WHEEL (if so
equipped)
SIC3272
WIC0249
LIC0421
FOG LIGHT SWITCH (if so equipped)
To sound the horn, push near the horn icon on the
steering wheel.
The heated steering wheel system is designed to
operate only when the surface temperature of the
steering wheel is below 68°F (20°C).
To turn the fog lights on, turn the headlight switch
to the
position, then turn the fog light
switch to the
position.
To turn the fog lights on with the headlight switch
in the AUTO position, the headlights must be on,
then turn the fog light switch to the
position.
To turn the fog lights off, turn the fog light switch
to the OFF position.
The headlights must be on and the low beams
selected for the fog lights to operate. The fog
lights automatically turn off when the high beam
headlights are selected.
2-34 Instruments and controls
WARNING
Do not disassemble the horn. Doing so
could affect proper operation of the
supplemental front air bag system. Tampering with the supplemental front air bag
system may result in serious personal
injury.
Push the heated steering wheel switch to warm
the steering wheel after the engine starts. The
indicator light will come on.
If the surface temperature of the steering wheel is
below 68°F (20°C), the system will heat the
steering wheel and cycle off and on to maintain a
temperature above 68°F (20°C). The indicator
light will remain on as long as the system is on.
Push the switch again to turn the heated steering
wheel system off manually. The indicator light will
go off.
HEATED SEATS (if so equipped)
NOTE:
WARNING
If the surface temperature of the steering
wheel is above 68°F (20°C) when the switch
is turned on, the system will not heat the
steering wheel. This is not a malfunction.
Do not use or allow occupants to use the
seat heater if you or the occupants cannot
monitor elevated seat temperatures or
have an inability to feel pain in body parts
that contact the seat. Use of the seat
heater by such people could result in serious injury.
CAUTION
LIC2876
The front seats are warmed by built-in heaters.
1. Start the engine.
2. Push the LO or HI position of the switch, as
desired. The indicator light in the switch will
illuminate.
The heater is controlled by a thermostat,
automatically turning the heater on and off.
The indicator light will remain on as long as
the switch is on.
3. When the seat is warmed or before you
leave the vehicle, be sure to turn the switch
off.
● The battery could run down if the seat
heater is operated while the engine is
not running.
● Do not use the seat heater for extended
periods or when no one is using the
seat.
● Do not put anything on the seat which
insulates heat, such as a blanket, cushion, seat cover, etc. Otherwise, the seat
may become overheated.
● Do not place anything hard or heavy on
the seat or pierce it with a pin or similar
object. This may result in damage to the
heater.
● Any liquid spilled on the heated seat
should be removed immediately with a
dry cloth.
Instruments and controls 2-35
HEATED 2ND ROW SEATS (if so
equipped)
● When cleaning the seat, never use
gasoline, benzine, thinner, or any similar materials.
● If any malfunctions are found or the
heated seat does not operate, turn the
switch off and have the system checked
by your NISSAN dealer.
WARNING
Do not use or allow occupants to use the
seat heater if you or the occupants cannot
monitor elevated seat temperatures or
have an inability to feel pain in body parts
that contact the seat. Use of the seat
heater by such people could result in serious injury.
CAUTION
● The battery could run down if the seat
heater is operated while the engine is
not running.
● Do not use the seat heater for extended
periods or when no one is using the
seat.
● Do not put anything on the seat which
insulates heat, such as a blanket, cushion, seat cover, etc. Otherwise, the seat
may become overheated.
● Do not place anything hard or heavy on
the seat or pierce it with a pin or similar
object. This may result in damage to the
heater.
● Any liquid spilled on the heated seat
should be removed immediately with a
dry cloth.
2-36 Instruments and controls
● When cleaning the seat, never use
gasoline, benzine, thinner, or any similar materials.
● If any malfunctions are found or the
heated seat does not operate, turn the
switch off and have the system checked
by a NISSAN dealer.
CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEAT
SWITCH (if so equipped)
3. When the seat is warmed or before you
leave the vehicle, be sure to turn the switch
off.
LIC2876
SIC4334
The 2nd row seats are warmed by built-in heaters. The switches are located on the rear of the
front center console and can be operated independently of each other.
The climate controlled seat warms up or cools
down the front seat by blowing warm or cool air
from under the surface of the seat. The climate
control switch is located on the center console.
1. Start the engine.
2. Push the LO or HI position of the switch, as
desired. The indicator light in the switch will
illuminate.
The heater is controlled by a thermostat,
automatically turning the heater on and off.
The indicator light will remain on as long as
the switch is on.
The climate controlled seat can be operated as
follows:
1. Start the engine.
A to the heat side 䊊
1
2. Turn the control knob 䊊
2 . The indicator light 䊊
B on
or the cool side 䊊
the control knob will illuminate.
Instruments and controls 2-37
VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC)
OFF SWITCH
3. Adjust the desired amount of air using the
control knob. The climate controlled seat
blower remains on low speed for approximately 60 seconds after turning the switch
on or selecting the desired temperature.
4. When the vehicle’s interior is warmed or
cooled, or before you leave the vehicle, be
sure to turn the control knob to the Off
B on
(center) position. The indicator light 䊊
the control knob goes off with the switch in
the off (center) position.
To check the air filter for the climate controlled
seat, contact a NISSAN dealer.
WARNING
Do not use or allow occupants to use the
climate controlled seats if you or the occupants can not monitor seat temperatures or have an inability to feel pain in
those body parts in contact with the seat.
Use of the climate controlled seats by
such people could result in serious injury.
2-38 Instruments and controls
CAUTION
● The battery could run down if the climate control seat is operated while the
engine is not running.
● Do not use the climate control seat for
extended periods or when no one is
using the seat.
● Do not put anything on the seat which
insulates heat, such as a blanket, cushion, seat cover, etc. Otherwise, the seat
may become overheated.
● Do not place anything hard or heavy on
the seat or pierce it with a pin or similar
objects. This may result in damage to
the climate controlled seat.
● Any liquid spilled on the seat should be
removed immediately with a dry cloth
● The climate controlled seat has an air
filter. Do not operate the climate controlled seat without an air filter. This
may result in damage to the system.
● When cleaning the seat, never use
gasoline, benzine, thinner, or any similar materials.
● If any malfunctions are found or the
climate controlled seat does not operate, turn the switch off and have the
system checked by your NISSAN dealer.
LIC1548
The vehicle should be driven with the VDC system on for most driving conditions.
If the vehicle is stuck in mud or snow, the VDC
system reduces the engine output to reduce
wheel spin. The engine speed will be reduced
even if the accelerator is depressed to the floor. If
maximum engine power is needed to free a stuck
vehicle, turn the VDC system off.
To turn off the VDC system, push the VDC OFF
indicator will come on.
switch. The
Push the VDC OFF switch again or restart the engine
to turn on the system. For additional information, refer
to “Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system” in the
“Starting and driving” section of this manual.
POWER OUTLETS
LIC3002
Instrument Panel
12V OUTLETS
The power outlets are for powering electrical
accessories such as cellular telephones. They
are rated at 12 volt, 120W (10A) maximum.
The front and center console power outlets are
powered only when the ignition switch is in the
ACC (if so equipped) or ON position.
LIC2616
Center Console
CAUTION
● The outlet and plug may be hot during
or immediately after use.
● Only certain power outlets are designed
for use with a cigarette lighter unit. Do
not use any other power outlet for an
accessory lighter. See your NISSAN
dealer for additional information.
● Do not use with accessories that exceed
a 12 volt, 120W (10A) power draw.
LIC2617
Cargo Area
● Use power outlets with the engine running to avoid discharging the vehicle
battery.
● Avoid using power outlets when the air
conditioner, headlights or rear window
defroster is on.
● Before inserting or disconnecting a
plug, be sure the electrical accessory
being used is turned OFF.
● Do not use double adapters or more
than one electrical accessory.
Instruments and controls 2-39
STORAGE
● Push the plug in as far as it will go. If
good contact is not made, the plug may
overheat or the internal temperature
fuse may open.
● Do not place heavy loads heavier than
2.2 lbs. (1 kg) on the seatback, head
restraint/headrest or in the seatback
pocket.
● When not in use, be sure to close the
cap. Do not allow water or any other
liquid to contact the outlet.
LIC2618
SEATBACK POCKETS
There is a pocket located on the back of the driver
and passenger seats. These pockets can be
used to store maps.
WARNING
To ensure proper operation of the passenger’s advanced air bag system, please observe the following items:
● Do not allow a passenger in the 2nd row
to push or pull on the seatback pocket
or headrest.
2-40 Instruments and controls
CAUTION
● Do not use for anything other than
sunglasses.
● Do not leave sunglasses in the sunglasses holder while parking in direct
sunlight. The heat may damage the
sunglasses.
LIC2914
LIC2312
SUNGLASSES HOLDER
To open the sunglasses holder, push and release.
Front console
CUP HOLDERS
Only store one pair of sunglasses in the holder.
WARNING
Keep the sunglasses holder closed while
driving to prevent an accident.
Instruments and controls 2-41
CAUTION
● Avoid abrupt starting and braking when
the cup holder is being used to prevent
spilling the drink. If the liquid is hot, it
can scald you or your passenger. Spilled
liquid can also damage the seat climate
system.
● Use only soft cups in the cup holder.
Hard objects can injure you in an
accident.
LIC2915
Bench seat
CAUTION
Do not recline the rear seatback when you
use the cup holders on the rear armrest.
Doing so may cause the beverages to spill
over, and if they are hot, they may scald
the passengers.
2-42 Instruments and controls
LIC2622
Bottle holder — front
CAUTION
● Do not use bottle holder for any other
objects that could be thrown about in
the vehicle and possibly injure people
during sudden braking or an accident.
● Do not use bottle holder for open liquid
containers.
LIC2933
Bottle holder — rear
LIC3003
LIC2916
GLOVE BOX
CONSOLE BOX
Open the glove box by pulling the handle.
To open the console box, press in on the lever
and raise the lid.
Use the master key to lock or unlock the glove
box. The valet key (if so equipped) cannot be
used to lock or unlock the glove box.
To close, push the lid down until the lock latches.
WARNING
Keep glove box lid closed while driving to
help prevent injury in an accident or a
sudden stop.
Instruments and controls 2-43
WARNING
● Properly secure all cargo with ropes or
straps to help prevent it from sliding or
shifting. Do not place cargo higher than
the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause
personal injury.
● Use suitable ropes and hooks to secure
cargo.
LTI2113
LUGGAGE HOOKS
When securing items using luggage hooks located on the back of the seat or side finisher do
not apply a load over more than 6.5 lbs (29 N) to
a single hook.
The luggage hooks that are located on the floor
should have loads less than 110 lbs (490 N) to a
single hook.
The luggage hooks can be used to secure cargo
with ropes or other types of straps.
2-44 Instruments and controls
● Never allow anyone to ride in the luggage area. It is extremely dangerous to
ride in a cargo area inside of a vehicle.
In a collision, people riding in these
areas are more likely to be seriously
injured or killed.
● Do not allow people to ride in any area
of your vehicle that is not equipped with
seats and seat belts.
● The child restraint top tether strap may
be damaged by contact with items in
the cargo area. Secure any items in the
cargo area. Your child could be seriously injured or killed in a collision if
the top tether strap is damaged.
● Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a
seat and using a seat belt properly.
LIC3006
ROOF RACK (if so equipped)
Genuine NISSAN accessory cross bars are available through your NISSAN dealer. Contact an
NISSAN dealer for crossbar or other equipment
information.
Always distribute the luggage evenly on the cross
bars. Do not load more than 100 lb (45 kg) on the
cross bars. Observe the maximum load limit
shown on the cross bars or roof carriers when
you attach them on the roof cross bars. Contact
an NISSAN dealer for crossbar or other equipment information.
WINDOWS
Do not apply any load directly to the roof side
rails. Cross bars must be installed before applying load/cargo/luggage to the roof of the vehicle.
Be careful that your vehicle does not exceed the
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or its
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR front and
rear). The GVWR and GAWR are located on the
F.M.V.S.S. or C.V.M.S.S. certification label (located on the driver’s door pillar). For additional
information regarding GVWR and GAWR, refer
to “Vehicle loading information” in the “Technical
and customer information” section of this manual.
WARNING
● Drive extra carefully when the vehicle is
loaded at or near the cargo carrying
capacity, especially if the significant
portion of that load is carried on the
cross bars.
● Heavy loading of the cross bars has the
potential to affect the vehicle stability
and handling during sudden or unusual
handling maneuvers.
● Properly secure all cargo with ropes or
straps to help prevent it from sliding or
shifting. In a sudden stop or collision,
unsecured cargo could cause personal
injury.
CAUTION
Always install the cross bars onto the roof
side rails before loading cargo of any kind.
Loading cargo directly onto the roof side
rails or the vehicle’s roof may cause vehicle damage.
POWER WINDOWS
WARNING
● Make sure that all passengers have
their hands, etc. inside the vehicle while
it is in motion and before closing the
windows. Use the window lock switch to
prevent unexpected use of the power
windows.
● Do not leave children unattended inside
the vehicle. They could unknowingly activate switches or controls and become
trapped in a window. Unattended children could become involved in serious
accidents.
The power windows operate when the ignition
switch is placed in the ON position, or for a
period of time after the ignition switch is placed in
the OFF position. If the driver’s or passenger’s
door is opened during this period of time, the
power to the windows is canceled.
● Roof rack cross bars should be evenly
distributed.
● Do not exceed maximum roof rack cross
bars load.
Instruments and controls 2-45
Driver’s side power window switch
The driver’s side control panel is equipped with
switches to open or close all of the windows.
To open a window, push the switch to the first
detent and continue to hold down until the desired window position is reached. To close a
window, pull the switch to the first detent and
continue to hold up until the desired window
position is reached.
Locking passengers’ windows
LIC2396
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Window lock button
Power door lock switch
Driver side automatic switch
Front passenger side switch
Left rear passenger side switch
Right rear passenger side switch
2-46 Instruments and controls
When the window lock switch is depressed, only
the driver’s side window can be opened or
closed. Push it again to cancel the window lock
function.
LIC2397
Front passenger’s power window
switch
The passenger’s window switch operates only
the corresponding passenger’s window. To open
1
the window partially, push the switch down 䊊
lightly until the desired window position is
reached. To close the window partially, pull the
2 until the desired window position is
switch up 䊊
reached.
Depending on the environment or driving
conditions, the auto-reverse function may
be activated if an impact or load similar to
something being caught in the window occurs.
WARNING
There are some small distances immediately before the closed position which
cannot be detected. Make sure that all
passengers have their hands, etc., inside
the vehicle before closing the window.
LIC2663
LIC0410
Rear power window switch
Automatic operation
The rear power window switches open or close
only the corresponding windows. To open the
1 . To
window, push the switch and hold it down 䊊
2 .
close the window, pull the switch up 䊊
To fully open a window, press the window switch
down to the second detent and release it; it need
not be held. The window automatically opens all
the way. To stop the window, lift the switch up
while the window is opening.
If the vehicle’s battery is disconnected, replaced,
or jump started, the power window auto-reverse
function may not operate properly. If this occurs,
please contact the dealer to re-initialize the
power window auto-reverse system.
If the control unit detects something caught in a
window equipped with automatic operation, as it
is closing, the window will be immediately lowered.
To fully close a window, pull the switch up to the
second detent and release it; it need not be held.
To stop the window, press the switch down while
the window is closing.
Auto-reverse function
The auto-reverse function can be activated when
a window is closed by automatic operation.
Instruments and controls 2-47
POWER MOONROOF (if so equipped)
automatically open or close all the way. To stop
the roof, push the switch once more while it is
opening or closing.
Sliding the moonroof (Type B - if so
equipped)
To open the moonroof, push the switch to the
1 position and release it; it need not be
open 䊊
held. The roof will automatically open and stop
slightly before the fully open position to reduce
wind noise.
LIC2644
The moonroof will only operate when the ignition
switch is placed in the ON position. The moonroof is operational for a period of time, even if the
ignition switch is placed in the ACC (if so
equipped) or OFF position. If the driver’s door or
the front passenger’s door is opened during this
period of time, the power to the moonroof is
canceled.
Sliding the moonroof (Type A - if so
equipped)
To fully open or close the moonroof, push the
1 or close 䊊
2 position and
switch to the open 䊊
release it; it need not be held. The roof will
2-48 Instruments and controls
Press the switch again to fully open the moonroof.
2
To close the moonroof, push the switch to the 䊊
position and release it. The roof will automatically
close all the way.
To stop the moonroof, push the switch once more
while it is opening or closing.
Tilting the moonroof
To tilt up, first close the moonroof, then push the
1 and release it; it
switch to the tilt up position 䊊
need not be held. To tilt down the moonroof, push
2 .
the switch to the tilt down position 䊊
Auto-reverse function (when closing or
tilting down the moonroof)
The auto-reverse function can be activated when
the moonroof is closed or tilted down by automatic operation when the ignition switch is
placed in the ON position or for a period of time
after the ignition switch is placed in the OFF
position.
Depending on the environment or driving
conditions, the auto-reverse function may
be activated if an impact or load similar to
something being caught in the moonroof
occurs.
WARNING
There are some small distances immediately before the closed position which
cannot be detected. Make sure that all
passengers have their hands, etc., inside
the vehicle before closing the moonroof.
When closing
If the control unit detects something caught in the
moonroof as it moves to the front, the moonroof
will immediately open backward.
When tilting down
Panoramic sunshade
If the control unit detects something caught in the
moonroof as it tilts down, the moonroof will immediately tilt up.
The panoramic sunshade operates when the ignition switch is in the ON position. When opening
or closing the sunshade the switch need not be
held.
If the auto-reverse function malfunctions and repeats opening or tilting up the moonroof, keep
pushing the tilt down switch within 5 seconds
after it happens; the moonroof will fully close
gradually. Make sure nothing is caught in the
moonroof.
WARNING
● In an accident you could be thrown from
the vehicle through an open moonroof.
Always use seat belts and child
restraints.
● Do not allow anyone to stand up or
extend any portion of their body out of
the moonroof opening while the vehicle
is in motion or while the moonroof is
closing.
CAUTION
● Remove water drops, snow, ice or sand
from the moonroof before opening.
● Do not place heavy objects on the
moonroof or surrounding area.
To open the sunshade:
● To fully open the sunshade, push the switch
1 toward the open position.
䊊
To close the sunshade:
● To fully close the sunshade, push the switch
2 toward the close position.
䊊
WARNING
● To avoid personal injury, keep your
hands, fingers and head away from the
sunshade arm, the arm rail and sunshade inlet port.
● Do not allow children near the rear sunshade system. They could be injured.
● Do not place objects on or near the rear
sunshade. This could cause improper
operation or damage it.
● Do not pull or push the rear sunshade.
This could cause improper operation or
damage it.
CAUTION
● Do not place objects (such as newspapers, handkerchiefs, etc.) on the sunshade inlet port. Doing so may entangle
these objects in the sunshade when it is
extending or retracting, causing improper operation or damage to the
sunshade.
● Do not push the sunshade arm with
your hands, etc., as this may deform it.
Improper operation or damage to the
sunshade may result.
● Do not put any object into the sunshade
inlet port as this may result in improper
operation or damage the sunshade.
● Do not hang any object on the arm rail
as this may result in improper operation
or damage the sunshade.
● Do not forcefully pull the sunshade. Doing so may elongate the sunshade. Improper operation or damage to the sunshade may result.
If the moonroof does not close
Have your NISSAN dealer check and repair the
moonroof.
Instruments and controls 2-49
INTERIOR LIGHT
2 is pushed, the interior
When the OFF switch 䊊
lights will illuminate when pushed. When the
DOOR/OFF switch is pressed and the ON
switch is pressed, all of the lights will come on.
NOTE:
The footwell lights and step lights illuminate when the driver and passenger doors
are open regardless of the interior light
switch position. These lights will turn off
automatically after a period of time while
doors are open to prevent the battery from
becoming discharged.
LIC2302
1 is pressed, the footwell
When the ON switch 䊊
lights (if so equipped), step lights (if so
equipped), map lights and rear personal lights
will automatically turn on and stay on for a period
of time when:
● The doors are unlocked by the Intelligent
Key, a key or the request switch (if so
equipped) while all doors are closed and the
ignition switch is in the OFF position.
● The driver’s door is opened and then closed
while the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
● When individually pushed.
2-50 Instruments and controls
CAUTION
Do not use for extended periods of time
with the engine stopped. This could result
in a discharged battery.
LIC2303
CONSOLE LIGHT (if so equipped)
The console light will turn on whenever the parking lights or headlights are illuminated.
The console light brightness can be adjusted
with the illumination brightness control in the
vehicle information display.
MAP LIGHTS
PERSONAL LIGHTS
HOMELINK® UNIVERSAL
TRANSCEIVER (if so equipped)
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver provides
a convenient way to consolidate the functions of
up to three individual hand-held transmitters into
one built-in device.
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver:
● Will operate most Radio Frequency devices
such as garage doors, gates, home and office lighting, entry door locks and security
systems.
LIC2304
Push the button to turn the map lights on. To turn
them off, press the button again.
CAUTION
Do not use for extended periods of time
with the engine stopped. This could result
in a discharged battery.
LIC1083
Rear personal lights
To turn the rear personal lights on, press the
switch. To turn them off, press the switch again.
● Is powered by your vehicle’s battery. No
separate batteries are required. If the vehicle’s battery is discharged or is disconnected, HomeLink® will retain all programming.
When the HomeLink® Universal Transceiver is programmed, retain the original
transmitter for future programming procedures (Example: new vehicle purchases).
Upon sale of the vehicle, the programmed
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver buttons
should be erased for security purposes. For
additional information, refer to “Programming HomeLink®” in this section.
Instruments and controls 2-51
WARNING
● Do not use the HomeLink® Universal
Transceiver with any garage door
opener that lacks safety stop and reverse features as required by federal
safety standards. (These standards became effective for opener models
manufactured after April 1, 1982). A garage door opener which cannot detect
an object in the path of a closing garage
door and then automatically stop and
reverse, does not meet current federal
safety standards. Using a garage door
opener without these features increases the risk of serious injury or
death.
● During the programming procedure
your garage door or security gate will
open and close (if the transmitter is
within range). Make sure that people or
objects are clear of the garage door,
gate, etc. that you are programming.
● Your vehicle’s engine should be turned
off while programming the HomeLink®
Universal Transceiver.
2-52 Instruments and controls
PROGRAMMING HOMELINK®
If you have any questions or are having difficulty
programming your HomeLink® buttons, refer to
the HomeLink® web site at: www.homelink.com
or call 1-800-355-3515.
NOTE:
Place the ignition switch in the ACC position (if so equipped) when programming
HomeLink®. It is also recommended that a
new battery be placed in the hand-held
transmitter of the device being programmed to HomeLink® for quicker programming and accurate transmission of
the radio-frequency.
1. Position the end of your hand-held transmitter 1–3 in (2–8 cm) away from the
HomeLink®
surface,
keeping
the
1 in view.
HomeLink® indicator light 䊊
LIC2365
2. Using both hands, simultaneously press and
hold the desired HomeLink® button and
hand-held transmitter button. DO NOT re1
lease until the HomeLink® indicator light 䊊
flashes slowly and then rapidly. When the
indicator light flashes rapidly, both buttons
may be released. (The rapid flashing indicates successful programming.)
NOTE:
Some devices may require you to replace
Step 2 with the cycling procedure noted in
“Programming HomeLink® for Canadian
customers and gate openers” in this section.
Do not stand on your vehicle to perform
the next steps.
4. At the receiver located on the garage door
opener motor in the garage, locate the
“learn” or “smart” button (the name and color
of the button may vary by manufacturer but it
is usually located near where the hanging
antenna wire is attached to the unit). If there
is difficulty locating the button, reference the
garage door opener’s manual.
5. Press and release the “learn” or “smart” button.
LIC2366
3. Press and hold the programmed
HomeLink® button and observe the indicator light.
● If
the
indicator
light
䊊 is
solid/continuous, programming is
complete and your device should activate when the HomeLink® button is
pressed and released.
1
1 blinks rapidly for
● If the indicator light 䊊
two seconds and then turns to a
solid/continuous light, continue
with Steps 4-6 for a rolling code device.
A second person may make the following
steps easier. Use a ladder or other device.
6. Return to the vehicle and firmly press and
hold the trained HomeLink® button for two
seconds and release. Repeat the
“press/hold/release” sequence up to three
times to complete the training process.
HomeLink® should now activate your rolling
code equipped device.
7. If you have any questions or are having difficulty programming your HomeLink® buttons,
refer to the HomeLink® web site at:
www.homelink.com or call 1-800-355-3515.
PROGRAMMING HOMELINK® FOR
CANADIAN CUSTOMERS AND
GATE OPENERS
Canadian radio-frequency laws require transmitter signals to “time-out” (or quit) after several
seconds of transmission – which may not be long
enough for HomeLink® to pick up the signal
during training. Similar to this Canadian law,
some U.S. gate operators are designed to “timeout” in the same manner.
If you live in Canada or you are having difficulties
training a gate operator or garage door opener
by using the “Training” procedures, replace
“Programming HomeLink®” Step 2 with the following:
NOTE:
When programming a garage door opener,
etc., unplug the device during the “cycling”
process to prevent possible damage to the
garage door opener components.
1. For additional information, refer to “Programming HomeLink®” step 1 in this section.
2. Using both hands, simultaneously press and
hold the desired HomeLink® button and the
hand-held transmitter button. During training, your hand-held transmitter may auto-
Instruments and controls 2-53
matically stop transmitting. Continue to
press and hold the desired HomeLink® button while you press and re-press (“cycle”)
your hand-held transmitter every 2 seconds
until the frequency signal has been learned.
The HomeLink® indicator light will flash
slowly and then rapidly after several seconds
upon successful training. DO NOT release
until the HomeLink® indicator light flashes
slowly and then rapidly. When the indicator
light flashes rapidly, both buttons may be
released. The rapid flashing indicates successful training.
Proceed with “Programming HomeLink®”
step 3 to complete.
If the device was unplugged during the programming procedure, remember to plug it
back in when programming is completed.
OPERATING THE HOMELINK®
UNIVERSAL TRANSCEIVER
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver, after it is
programmed, can be used to activate the programmed device. To operate, simply press and
release
the
appropriate
programmed
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver button. The
amber indicator light will illuminate while the signal is being transmitted.
For convenience, the hand-held transmitter of the
device may also be used at any time.
2-54 Instruments and controls
PROGRAMMING TROUBLEDIAGNOSIS
CLEARING THE PROGRAMMED
INFORMATION
If the HomeLink® does not quickly learn the
hand-held transmitter information:
The following procedure clears the programmed
information from both buttons. Individual buttons
cannot be cleared. However, individual buttons
can be reprogrammed. For additional information, refer to “Reprogramming a single
HomeLink® button” in this section.
● replace the hand-held transmitter batteries
with new batteries.
● position the hand-held transmitter with its
battery area facing away from the
HomeLink® surface.
● press and hold both the HomeLink® and
hand-held transmitter buttons without interruption.
● position the hand-held transmitter 1 - 3 in
(26 - 76 mm) away from the HomeLink®
surface. Hold the transmitter in that position
for up to 15 seconds. If HomeLink® is not
programmed within that time, try holding the
transmitter in another position – keeping the
indicator light in view at all times.
If you have any questions or are having difficulty
programming your HomeLink® buttons, refer to
the HomeLink® web site at: www.homelink.com
or call 1-800-355-3515.
To clear all programming:
1. Press and hold the two outer HomeLink®
buttons until the indicator light begins to
flash in approximately 10 seconds. Do not
hold for longer than 20 seconds.
2. Release both buttons.
HomeLink® is now in the programming mode
and can be programmed at any time beginning
with “Programming HomeLink®” - Step 1.
IF YOUR VEHICLE IS STOLEN
For Canada:
1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink® button. DO NOT release the button.
If your vehicle is stolen, you should change the
codes of any non-rolling code device that has
been programmed into HomeLink®. Consult the
Owner’s Manual of each device or call the manufacturer or dealer of those devices for additional
information.
2. The indicator light will begin to flash after
20 seconds. Without releasing the
HomeLink® button, proceed with “Programming HomeLink®” - Step 1.
When your vehicle is recovered, you will
need to reprogram the HomeLink® Universal Transceiver with your new transmitter
information.
This device complies with Industry Canada
license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any
received, including interference that may
cause undesired operation of the device.
REPROGRAMMING A SINGLE
HOMELINK® BUTTON
To reprogram a HomeLink® Universal Transceiver button, complete the following:
For questions or comments, contact HomeLink®
at: www.homelink.com or 1–800–355–3515
(except Mexico).
FCC Notice:
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver button
has now been reprogrammed. The new device
can be activated by pushing the HomeLink®
button that was just programmed. This procedure
will not affect any other programmed HomeLink®
buttons.
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may
not cause harmful interference, and (2) this
device must accept any interference received, including interference that may
cause undesired operation.
For USA:
NOTE:
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
Instruments and controls 2-55
MEMO
2-56 Instruments and controls
3 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
NISSAN Intelligent Key® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Locking with key. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Locking with inside lock knob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
Locking with power door lock switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Automatic door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
NISSAN Intelligent Key® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
Operating range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
Door locks/unlocks precaution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
NISSAN Intelligent Key® Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
How to use the remote keyless entry
function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12
Warning signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16
Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
Remote Engine Start (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19
Remote engine start operating range . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19
Remote starting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20
Extending engine run time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20
Canceling a remote start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20
Conditions the remote start will not work . . . . . . . . . 3-21
Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22
Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22
Operating the manual liftgate
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23
Operating the power liftgate (if so equipped) . . . . . 3-23
Power liftgate main switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26
Liftgate release. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26
Liftgate position setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27
Fuel-filler door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27
Opener operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27
Fuel-filler cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27
Tilt/telescopic steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-29
Manual operation (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30
Automatic operation (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30
Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31
Vanity mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32
Card holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32
Rearview mirror (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32
Automatic Anti-glare rearview mirror
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33
Outside mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33
Automatic drive positioner (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . 3-35
Memory storage function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35
Entry/exit function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36
System operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37
KEYS
LPD0350
Type A (if so equipped)
1.
2.
3.
Intelligent Key (two sets)
Mechanical key
Key number plate (one plate)
3-2 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
LPD2279
Type B (if so equipped)
LPD2052
Type C (if so equipped)
NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY®
Your vehicle can only be driven with the Intelligent
Keys which are registered to your vehicle’s Intelligent Key system components and NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System components. As many
as four Intelligent Keys can be registered and
used with one vehicle. The new keys must be
registered by a NISSAN dealer prior to use with
the Intelligent Key system and NISSAN Vehicle
Immobilizer System of your vehicle. Since the
registration process requires erasing all memory
in the Intelligent Key components when registering new keys, be sure to take all Intelligent Keys
that you have to the NISSAN dealer.
A key number plate is supplied with your keys.
Record the key number and keep it in a safe place
(such as your wallet), not in the vehicle. If you lose
your keys, see a NISSAN dealer for duplicates by
using the key number. NISSAN does not record
key numbers so it is very important to keep track
of your key number plate.
A key number is only necessary when you have
lost all keys and do not have one to duplicate
from. If you still have a key, a NISSAN dealer can
duplicate it.
CAUTION
Listed below are conditions or occurrences which will damage the Intelligent
Key:
● Do not allow the Intelligent Key, which
contains electrical components, to
come into contact with water or salt
water. This could affect the system
function.
● Wetting may damage the Intelligent
Key. If the Intelligent Key gets wet, immediately wipe until it is completely dry.
● Do not place the Intelligent Key for an
extended period in an area where temperatures exceed 60°C (140°F).
● Do not attach the Intelligent Key with a
key holder that contains a magnet.
● Do not place the Intelligent Key near
equipment that produces a magnetic
field, such as a TV, audio equipment and
personal computers.
If an Intelligent Key is lost or stolen,
NISSAN recommends erasing the ID code
of that Intelligent Key from the vehicle.
This may prevent the unauthorized use of
the Intelligent Key to operate the vehicle.
For information regarding the erasing
procedure, contact a NISSAN dealer.
SPA1951
Mechanical key
The Intelligent Key contains the mechanical key.
To remove the mechanical key, release the lock
knob on the back of the Intelligent Key.
● Do not drop the Intelligent Key.
To install the mechanical key, firmly insert it into
the Intelligent Key until the lock knob returns to
the lock position.
● Do not strike the Intelligent Key sharply
against another object.
Use the mechanical key to lock or unlock the
driver’s door.
● Do not change or modify the Intelligent
Key.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-3
DOORS
CAUTION
Always carry the mechanical key installed
in the Intelligent Key slot.
For additional information, refer to “Doors” in this
section.
Valet hand-off
When you have to leave a key with a valet, give
them the Intelligent Key itself and keep the mechanical key with you to protect your belongings.
To prevent the glove box from being opened
during valet hand-off, follow the procedure below.
When the doors are locked using one of the
following methods, the doors cannot be opened
using the inside or outside door handles. The
doors must be unlocked to open the doors.
WARNING
● Always have the doors locked while
driving. Along with the use of seat belts,
this provides greater safety in the event
of an accident by helping to prevent
persons from being thrown from the
vehicle. This also helps keep children
and others from unintentionally opening the doors, and will help keep out
intruders.
1. Remove the mechanical key from the Intelligent Key.
● Before opening any door, always look
for and avoid oncoming traffic.
2. Lock the glove box with the mechanical key.
● Do not leave children unattended inside
the vehicle. They could unknowingly activate switches or controls. Unattended
children could become involved in serious accidents.
3. Hand the Intelligent Key to the valet and
keep the mechanical key with you.
For additional information, refer to “Storage” in
the “Instruments and controls” section of this
manual.
3-4 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
LOCKING WITH KEY
LPD2129
Driver’s side
Manual
To lock a door, turn the key toward the front of the
1 . To unlock, turn the key toward the rear
vehicle 䊊
2 .
䊊
Opening and closing windows
The driver’s door key operation allows you to
open and close windows equipped with automatic operation at the same time.
● To open the windows, turn the driver’s door
key toward the rear of the vehicle for longer
than 1 second after the door is unlocked.
● To close the windows, turn the driver’s door
key toward the front of the vehicle for longer
than 1 second after the door is locked.
Windows stop when the key cylinder is released.
LPD0461
Driver’s side
LPD2092
Inside lock
Power
The power door lock system allows you to lock or
unlock all doors at the same time.
Turning the key toward the front 䊊 of the vehicle
locks all doors.
1
2 of the
Turning the key one time toward the rear 䊊
vehicle unlocks that door. From that position,
3 (where the key can
returning the key to neutral 䊊
only be removed and inserted) and turning it
4 within 45 seconds
toward the rear again 䊊
unlocks all doors.
LOCKING WITH INSIDE LOCK
KNOB
To lock the door without the key, move the inside
1 , then close the
lock knob to the lock position 䊊
door.
To unlock the door without the key, move the
2 .
inside lock knob to the unlock position 䊊
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-5
AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS
● All doors lock automatically when the vehicle
speed reaches 15 MPH (24 km/h).
● All doors unlock automatically when the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position.
The automatic unlock function can be deactivated or activated. To deactivate or activate the automatic door unlock system, perform
the following procedure:
1. Close all doors.
When the automatic door unlock system is deactivated, the doors do not unlock when the ignition
switch is placed in the OFF position. To unlock
the door manually, use the inside lock knob or the
power door lock switch (driver’s or front passenger’s side).
NOTE:
The automatic door unlock function can be
changed using the Vehicle Settings in the
vehicle information display. The “Selective
Unlock” choices are:
2. Place the ignition switch in the ON position.
● ON
● OFF
LOCKING WITH POWER DOOR
LOCK SWITCH
3. Within 20 seconds of performing Step 2,
push and hold the power door lock switch to
position (UNLOCK) for more than
the
five seconds.
To lock all the doors without a key, push the door
lock switch (driver’s or front passenger’s side) to
1 . When locking the door this
the lock position 䊊
way, be certain not to leave the key inside the
vehicle.
4. When activated, the hazard indicator will
flash twice. When deactivated, the hazard
indicator will flash once.
LPD2093
To unlock all the doors without a key, push the
door lock switch (driver’s or front passenger’s
2 .
side) to the unlock position 䊊
3-6 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
5. The ignition switch must be placed in the
OFF and ON position again between each
setting change.
NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY®
WARNING
● Radio waves could adversely affect
electric medical equipment. Those who
use a pacemaker should contact the
electric medical equipment manufacturer for the possible influences before
use.
LPD0420
CHILD SAFETY REAR DOOR LOCK
Child safety locks help prevent the rear doors
from being opened accidentally, especially when
small children are in the vehicle.
The child safety lock levers are located on the
edge of the rear doors.
When the lever is in the LOCK position, the
door can be opened only from the outside.
● The Intelligent Key transmits radio
waves when the buttons are pressed.
The FAA advises the radio waves may
affect aircraft navigation and communication systems. Do not operate the Intelligent Key while on an airplane. Make
sure the buttons are not operated unintentionally when the unit is stored for a
flight.
● Never leave the Intelligent Key in the
vehicle when you leave the vehicle.
The Intelligent Key system can operate all the
door locks using the remote control function or
pushing the request switch on the vehicle without
taking the key out from a pocket or purse. The
operating environment and/or conditions may affect the Intelligent Key system operation.
Be sure to read the following before using the
Intelligent Key system.
CAUTION
Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key with
you when operating the vehicle.
The Intelligent Key is capable of receiving and
transmitting radio waves. The Intelligent Key system transmits weak radio waves from various
distances. Environmental conditions may interfere with the operation of the Intelligent Key system under the following operating conditions:
● When operating near a location where
strong radio waves are transmitted, such as
a TV tower, power station and broadcasting
station.
● When in possession of wireless equipment,
such as a cellular telephone, transceiver,
and CB radio.
● When the Intelligent Key is in contact with or
covered by metallic materials.
● When any type of radio wave remote control
is used nearby.
● When the Intelligent Key is placed near an
electric appliance such as a personal computer.
● When the vehicle is parked near a parking
meter.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-7
When the Intelligent Key battery is discharged or
strong radio waves are present near the operating location, the Intelligent Key operating range
becomes narrower, and the Intelligent Key may
not function properly.
In such cases, correct the operating conditions
before using the Intelligent Key function or use
the mechanical key.
Although the life of the battery varies depending
on the operating conditions, the battery’s life is
approximately two years. If the battery is discharged, replace it with a new one.
The operating range is within 31.5 in (80 cm)
1 .
from each request switch 䊊
If the Intelligent Key is too close to the door glass,
handle or rear bumper, the request switches may
not function.
When the Intelligent Key battery is low, an indicator illuminates in the Vehicle Information Display. For additional information, refer to “Vehicle
Information Display” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this manual.
When the Intelligent Key is within the operating
range, it is possible for anyone, even someone
who does not carry the Intelligent Key, to push the
request switch to lock/unlock the doors.
Since the Intelligent Key is capable of receiving
radio waves, if the key is left near equipment
which transmits strong radio waves, such as signals from a TV and personal computer, the battery life may become shorter.
For additional information regarding replacement
of a battery, refer to “Battery replacement” in the
“Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this
manual.
As many as four Intelligent Keys can be registered and used with one vehicle. For information
about the purchase and use of additional Intelligent Keys, see a NISSAN dealer.
3-8 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
LPD2286
OPERATING RANGE
The Intelligent Key functions can only be used
when the Intelligent Key is within the specified
1 .
operating range from the request switch 䊊
● To prevent the Intelligent Key from being left
inside the vehicle, make sure you carry the
Intelligent Key with you and then lock the
doors.
● Do not pull the door handle before pushing
the door handle request switch. The door
will be unlocked but will not open. Release
the door handle once and pull it again to
open the door.
WPD0375
DOOR LOCKS/UNLOCKS
PRECAUTION
● Do not push the door handle request switch
with the Intelligent Key held in your hand as
illustrated. The close distance to the door
handle will cause the Intelligent Key system
to have difficulty recognizing that the Intelligent Key is outside the vehicle.
LPD2301
NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY®
OPERATION
You can lock or unlock the doors without taking
the Intelligent Key out of your pocket or bag.
When you carry the Intelligent Key with you, you
can lock or unlock all doors by pushing the door
handle request switch within the range of operation.
● After locking with the door handle request
switch, verify the doors are securely locked
by testing them.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-9
● Doors do not lock by pushing the door
handle request switch while any door is
open. However, doors lock with the mechanical key even if any door is open.
● Doors do not lock with the door handle
request switch with the Intelligent Key inside
the vehicle and a beep sounds to warn you.
However, when an Intelligent Key is inside
the vehicle, doors can be locked with another Intelligent Key.
CAUTION
LPD2300
Locking doors
1. Move the shift lever to the P (Park) position,
place the ignition switch in the LOCK position and make sure you carry the Intelligent
Key with you.
2. Close all doors.
3. Push any door handle request switch while
carrying the Intelligent Key with you.
4. All doors and the rear liftgate will lock.
5. The hazard warning lights flash twice, the
outside buzzer sounds twice, and the front
and tail lights will turn on for 10 seconds.
3-10 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
LPD2278
NOTE:
● Request switches for all doors and liftgate can be deactivated when the Intelligent Key Door Lock setting is
switched to OFF in the Vehicle Settings
of the vehicle information display. For
additional information, refer to “Vehicle information display” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this
manual.
● Doors lock with the door handle request
switch while the ignition switch is not in the
LOCK position.
● After locking the doors using the request switch, make sure that the doors
have been securely locked by operating
the door handles or the rear liftgate
opener switch.
● When locking the doors using the request switch, make sure to have the
Intelligent Key in your possession before operating the request switch to
prevent the Intelligent Key from being
left in the vehicle.
● The request switch is operational only
when the Intelligent Key has been detected by the Intelligent Key system.
Lockout protection
To prevent the Intelligent Key from being accidentally locked in the vehicle, lockout protection
is equipped with the Intelligent Key system.
When any door is open, the doors are locked,
and then the Intelligent Key is put inside the
vehicle and all the doors are closed; a chime will
sound and the lock will automatically unlock.
NOTE:
The doors may not lock when the Intelligent Key is in the same hand that is operating the request switch to lock the door.
Put the Intelligent Key in a purse, pocket or
your other hand.
CAUTION
The lockout protection may not function
under the following conditions:
● When the Intelligent Key is placed on
top of the instrument panel.
● When the Intelligent Key is placed inside the glove box or a storage bin.
● When the Intelligent Key is placed inside the door pockets.
● When the Intelligent Key is placed inside or near metallic materials.
LPD2300
Unlocking doors
1. Carry the Intelligent Key.
2. Push the door handle request switch.
3. The door on which the request switch was
pressed will unlock and the hazard warning
lights flash once, the outside buzzer sounds
once, and the front and tail lights will turn on
for 30 seconds.
LPD2278
NOTE:
If Selective Unlock is turned off in the Vehicle Settings, all doors will unlock upon
first request switch press.
For power liftgate opening:
1. Carry the Intelligent Key.
2. Press the power liftgate request switch.
4. Push the door handle request switch again
within one minute to unlock the remaining
doors.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-11
NOTE:
● Locking the doors with the remote control.
Request switches for all doors and liftgate
can be deactivated when the Intelligent Key
Door Lock setting is switched to OFF in the
Vehicle Settings of the vehicle information
display. For additional information, refer to
“Vehicle information display” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this
manual.
● Switching the room light switch to the OFF
position.
If a door handle is pulled while unlocking the
doors, that door may not be unlocked. Returning
the door handle to its original position will unlock
the door. If the door does not unlock after returning the door handle, push the door handle request switch to unlock the door.
All doors will be locked automatically unless one
of the following operations is performed within
one minute after pushing the request switch.
● Opening any door.
● Pushing the ignition switch.
The interior light timer illuminates for a period of
time when a door is unlocked and the room light
switch is in the DOOR position.
The interior light can be turned off without waiting
by performing one of the following operations:
● Placing the ignition switch in the ON position.
3-12 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
● Switching the Auto Room Lamp to the OFF
position in Vehicle Settings of the vehicle
information display. For additional information, refer to “Vehicle information display” in
the “Instruments and controls” section.
HOW TO USE THE REMOTE
KEYLESS ENTRY FUNCTION
The remote keyless entry function can operate all
door locks using the remote keyless function of
the Intelligent Key. The remote keyless function
can operate at a distance of 33 ft (10 m) away
from the vehicle. The operating distance depends upon the conditions around the vehicle.
The remote keyless entry function will not function under the following conditions:
● When the Intelligent Key is not within the
operational range.
● When the Intelligent Key battery is discharged.
CAUTION
When locking the doors using the Intelligent Key, be sure not to leave the key in
the vehicle.
CAUTION
After locking the doors using the Intelligent Key, be sure that the doors have been
securely locked by operating the door
handles.
WPD0359
Locking doors
WPD0360
Unlocking doors
1. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK position.
1. Press the
Key.
2. Close all doors.
2. The driver’s door will unlock and the hazard
warning lights flash once, and the front and
tail lights will turn on for 30 seconds.
3. Press the
Key.
button on the Intelligent
4. The hazard warning lights flash twice, the
horn beeps once, and the front and tail lights
will turn on for 10 seconds.
button on the Intelligent
button again within one
3. Press the
minute to unlock the remaining doors.
5. All doors will be locked.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-13
NOTE:
The unlocking operation can be changed in
Selective door unlock in the Vehicle Settings of the vehicle information display. For
additional information, refer to “Vehicle information display” in the “Instruments and
controls” section of this manual.
● Switching the room light switch to the OFF
position.
● Switching the Auto Room Lamp to the OFF
position in Vehicle Settings of the vehicle
information display. For additional information, refer to “Vehicle information display” in
the “Instruments and controls” section of this
manual.
NOTE:
Opening windows
If Selective Unlock is turned off in the Vehicle Settings, all doors will unlock upon
press of the Intelligent Key
the first
remote.
All doors will be locked automatically unless one
of the following operations is performed within
button:
one minute after pressing the
The Intelligent Key allows you to simultaneously
open windows equipped with automatic operation.
● Opening any doors.
● Pushing the ignition switch.
The interior light illuminates for a period of time
when a door is unlocked and the room light
switch is in the DOOR position.
The light can be turned off without waiting by
performing one of the following operations:
● Placing the ignition switch in the ON position.
● Locking the doors with the Intelligent Key.
3-14 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
● To open the windows, press and hold
button on the Intelligent Key for
the
longer than 3 seconds.
The door windows will lower while holding down
the
button on the Intelligent Key.
NOTE:
The windows will stop lowering at the time
button is released.
the
The door windows cannot be closed by
using the Intelligent Key.
WPD0414
Releasing the rear liftgate (if so
equipped)
The rear liftgate can be opened and closed by
performing the following:
button (if so equipped) for
● Press the
longer than 1 second to open the rear liftgate.
button (if so equipped)
● Press the
again for longer than 1 second to close the
rear liftgate.
button (if so equipped) is
When the
pressed during the open or close process the
liftgate will reverse.
● Back door open request switch pressed
with the Intelligent key is in range of the back
door request switch area.
Using the interior light
Press the
button on the Intelligent Key
once to turn on the interior lights.
For additional information, refer to “Interior light”
in the “Instruments and controls” section in this
manual.
WPD0415
WPD0362
Using the panic alarm
Answer back horn feature
If you are near your vehicle and feel threatened,
you may activate the panic alarm to call attention
button on the
by pressing and holding the
Intelligent Key for longer than 1 second.
The panic alarm and headlights will stay on for a
period of time.
If desired, the answer back horn feature can be
deactivated using the Intelligent Key. When it is
button is
deactivated and the LOCK
pushed, the hazard indicator lights flash twice.
button is pushed, neiWhen the UNLOCK
ther the hazard indicator lights nor the horn operates.
The panic alarm stops when:
● It has run for a period of time, or
● Any button is pressed on the Intelligent Key.
● The request switch on the driver or passenger door is pushed and the Intelligent Key is
in range of the door handle.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-15
NOTE:
WARNING SIGNALS
If you change the answer back horn and
light flash feature with the Intelligent Key,
the vehicle information display screen will
show the current mode after the ignition
switch has been cycled from the OFF to the
ON position. The vehicle information display screen can also be used to change the
answer back horn mode.
To help prevent the vehicle from moving unexpectedly by erroneous operation of the Intelligent
Key or to help prevent the vehicle from being
stolen, a chime or buzzer sounds from inside and
outside the vehicle and a warning is displayed in
the instrument panel.
To deactivate: Press and hold the
and
buttons for at least 2 seconds.
The hazard warning lights will flash three times to
confirm that the answer back horn feature has
been deactivated.
To activate: Press and hold the
and
buttons for at least 2 seconds once
more.
The hazard warning lights will flash once and the
horn will sound once to confirm that the horn
beep feature has been reactivated.
Deactivating the horn beep feature does not silence the horn if the alarm is triggered.
3-16 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
When a chime or beep sounds or a warning is
displayed, be sure to check the vehicle and the
Intelligent Key.
For additional information, refer to the “Troubleshooting guide” in this section and “Vehicle information display” in the “Instruments and controls”
section of this manual.
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
Verify the location of all Intelligent Keys that are
programmed for the vehicle. If another Intelligent
Key is in range or inside the vehicle, the vehicle
system may respond differently than expected.
Symptom
The Shift to Park warning appears on the
When stopping the engine
display and the inside warning chime
sounds continuously.
When shifting the shift lever to the P (Park) The Push ignition to OFF warning appears
position
in the display.
The Door Open warning appears on the
When opening the driver’s door to get out
display and the inside warning chime
of the vehicle
sounds continuously.
The No Key Detected warning appears on
the display, the outside chime sounds three
times and the inside warning chime sounds
When closing the door after getting out of
for approximately three seconds.
the vehicle
The Shift to Park warning appears on the
display and the inside and outside chimes
sound continuously.
When closing the door with the inside lock The outside chime sounds for approximately
knob turned to LOCK
three seconds and all the doors unlock.
When pushing the door handle request
The outside chime sounds for approximately
switch or the LOCK button on the Intellitwo seconds.
gent Key to lock the door
Possible Cause
Remedy
Move the shift lever to the P (Park) position.
The shift lever is not in the P (Park) position.
The ignition switch is in the ACC position.
Place the ignition switch in the OFF
position.
The ignition switch is in the ACC position.
Place the ignition switch in the ON position
or close the driver’s door.
The ignition switch is in the ACC or ON
position.
Place the ignition switch in the OFF
position.
The ignition switch is in the ACC or OFF
position and the shift lever is not in the P
(Park) position.
Move the shift lever to the P (Park) position
and place the ignition switch in the OFF
position.
The Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle.
Carry the Intelligent Key with you.
The Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle.
Carry the Intelligent Key with you.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-17
Symptom
When pushing the ignition switch to start
the engine
When pushing the ignition switch
Possible Cause
The Intelligent Key battery indicator appears
The battery charge is low.
on the display.
The No Key Detected warning appears on
the display, the inside chime sounds three
times.
The Intelligent Key system warning light in
the meter illuminates in yellow.
3-18 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
Remedy
Replace the battery with a new one. (For
additional information, refer to “Battery replacement” in the “Maintenance and do-ityourself” section.)
The Intelligent Key is not in the vehicle.
Carry the Intelligent Key with you.
It warns of a malfunction with the Intelligent
Key system.
Contact a NISSAN dealer.
REMOTE ENGINE START (if so
equipped)
Other conditions may affect the function of the
Remote Engine Start feature. For additional information, refer to “Conditions the remote start will
not work” in this section.
Other conditions can affect the performance of
the Intelligent Key transmitter. For additional information, refer to “NISSAN Intelligent Key®” in
this section.
REMOTE ENGINE START
OPERATING RANGE
CAUTION
LPD2293
LPD2060
The
button will be on the NISSAN Intelligent Key® if the vehicle has remote engine start.
This feature allows the engine to start from outside the vehicle.
The following features may be affected when the
remote start feature is used:
● Vehicles equipped with heated seats may
have this feature come on during a remote
start depending on the seat heater switch
position. For additional information, refer to
“Heated seats” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this manual.
● The vehicle’s automatic climate control system will set the cabin temperature appropriately before the customer unlocks and enters the vehicle. For additional information,
refer to “Remote engine start logic” in the
“Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio, and phone systems” section of this
manual.
Laws in some local communities may restrict the
use of remote starters. For example, some laws
require a person using remote start to have the
vehicle in view. Check local regulations for any
requirements.
When the Intelligent Key battery is discharged or other strong radio wave
sources are present near the operating
location, the Intelligent Key operating
range becomes narrower, and the Intelligent Key may not function properly.
The remote engine start function can only be
used when the Intelligent Key is within the specified operating range from the vehicle.
The remote engine start operating range is approximately 197 ft (60 m) from the vehicle.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-19
REMOTE STARTING THE VEHICLE
To use the remote start feature to start the engine
perform the following:
1. Aim the Intelligent Key at the vehicle.
2. Press the
doors.
LOCK button to lock all
3. Within 5 seconds press and hold the
remote start button until the turn signal lights
flash and the tail lamps turn on. If the vehicle
is not within view press and hold the
remote start button for at least 2 seconds.
The following events will occur when the engine
starts:
● The parking lights will turn on and remain on
as long as the engine is running.
● The doors will be locked and the climate
control system may come on.
● The engine will continue to run for 10 minutes. Repeat the steps to extend the time for
an additional ten minutes. For additional information, refer to “Extending engine run
time” in this section.
3-20 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
Depress and hold the brake then press the pushbutton ignition switch to the ON position before
driving. For additional information, refer to “Driving the vehicle” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual.
EXTENDING ENGINE RUN TIME
The remote start feature can be extended one
time by performing the steps listed in “Remote
starting the vehicle” in this section. Run time will
be calculated as follows:
CANCELING A REMOTE START
To cancel a remote start, perform one of the
following:
● Aim the Intelligent Key at the vehicle and
until the parking lights turn off.
press
● Turn on the hazard warning flashers.
● Cycle the ignition switch ON and then OFF.
● The extended engine run time has expired.
● The first 10 minute run time will start when
the remote start function is performed.
● The first 10 minute timer has expired.
● The second 10 minutes will start immediately when the remote start function is performed again. For example, if the engine has
been running for 5 minutes, and 10 minutes
are added, the engine will run for a total of
15 minutes.
● The shift lever is moved out of park.
● Extending engine run time will bring you to
the two remote start limit.
● The ignition switch is pushed with an Intelligent Key in the vehicle but the brake pedal is
not depressed.
A maximum of two remote starts, or a single start
with an extension, are allowed between ignition
cycles. The ignition switch must be cycled to the
ON position and then back to the OFF position
before the remote start procedure can be used
again.
● The engine hood has been opened.
● The alarm sounds due to illegal entry into the
vehicle.
● The ignition switch is pushed without an
Intelligent Key in the vehicle.
CONDITIONS THE REMOTE START
WILL NOT WORK
remains
● The I–Key Indicator Light
solid in the vehicle information display.
The remote start will not operate if any of the
following conditions are present:
● The alarm sounds due to illegal entry into the
vehicle.
● “Remote Engine Start” is turned off in the
“Locking” section of the Vehicle Settings
menu.
● Two remote vehicle starts, or a single remote
start with an extension, have already been
used.
● The ignition switch is placed in the ON position.
● The vehicle is not in P (Park).
● The hood is not securely closed.
● The hazard warning lights are on.
● The engine is still running. The engine must
be completely stopped. Wait at least 6 seconds if the engine goes from running to off.
This is not applicable when extending engine run time.
is not pressed
● The remote start button
and held for at least 2 seconds.
is not pressed
● The remote start button
and held within 5 seconds of pressing the
lock button.
● There is a detected registered key already
inside of the vehicle.
● The Remote Start function has been
switched to the OFF position in Vehicle Settings of the vehicle information display. For
additional information, refer to “Vehicle information display” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this manual.
The remote engine start may display a warning or
indicator in the vehicle information display. For
additional information and an explanation of the
warning or indicator, refer to “Vehicle information
display” in the “Instruments and controls” section
of this manual.
● The brake is pressed.
● The doors are not closed and locked.
● The trunk or back door is open.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-21
HOOD
LIFTGATE
WARNING
● Always be sure the liftgate has been
closed securely to prevent it from opening while driving.
● Do not drive with the liftgate open. This
could allow dangerous exhaust gases
to be drawn into the vehicle. Refer to
“Exhaust gas (carbon monoxide)” in the
“Starting and driving” section of this
manual.
LPD2287
1
䊊
2
䊊
1 located
Pull the hood lock release handle 䊊
below the driver side instrument panel until
the hood springs up slightly.
2 in between the hood and
Locate the lever 䊊
grille and push the lever sideways with your
3 .
fingertips and raise the hood 䊊
When closing the hood, lower it slowly and make
sure it locks into place.
3-22 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
WARNING
● Make sure the hood is completely
closed and latched before driving. Failure to do so could cause the hood to fly
open and result in an accident.
● If you see steam or smoke coming from
the engine compartment, to avoid injury
do not open the hood.
● Do not leave children unattended inside
the vehicle. They could unknowingly activate switches or controls. Unattended
children could become involved in serious accidents.
● Always be sure that hands and feet are
clear of the door frame to avoid injury
while closing the liftgate.
CAUTION
Do not use accessory carriers that attach
to the rear hatch. Doing so will cause damage to the vehicle.
** Click HERE to see the "Owner's Manual Supplement" beginning on page 2. **
LPD2358
LPD2318
OPERATING THE MANUAL
LIFTGATE (if so equipped)
The power door lock system allows you to lock or
unlock all doors including the liftgate simultaneously.
LPD2212
Liftgate switch
OPERATING THE POWER LIFTGATE
(if so equipped)
WARNING
A
To open the liftgate, press the request switch 䊊
and pull up on the handle.
● Make sure that all passengers have
their hands, etc., inside the vehicle before closing the liftgate.
To close, lower and push the liftgate down securely.
● Do not leave children unattended inside
the vehicle. They could unknowingly activate switches or controls. Unattended
children could become involved in serious accidents.
Instrument panel switch
NOTE:
To open, close or reverse the power liftgate,
the shift lever must be in P (Park). Also, the
power liftgate will not operate if battery
voltage is low.
Power Open:
The power liftgate automatically moves from the
fully closed position to the fully open position in
approximately 5 – 8 seconds. The power open
feature can be activated by the switch on the
Intelligent Key, the instrument panel switch, the
glove box switch and the liftgate request switch.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-23
** Click HERE to see the "Owner's Manual Supplement" beginning on page 2. **
The hazard lights flash and a chime sounds to
indicate the power open sequence has been
started.
Power Close:
The power liftgate automatically moves from the
fully open position to the secondary position.
When the liftgate reaches the secondary position, the cinching motor engages and pulls the
liftgate to its primary latch position. Power close
takes approximately 7 – 10 seconds. The power
close feature can be activated by the switch on
the Intelligent Key, the instrument panel and the
A . The hazard lights flash
liftgate opener switch 䊊
and a chime sounds to indicate the power close
sequence has been started.
LPD2295
Liftgate opener switch
● The liftgate can be opened by the instrument
panel switch, liftgate request switch and the
Intelligent Key even if the vehicle is locked.
The liftgate will individually unlock and open.
Once the liftgate is closed, the vehicle will
remain in the unlock status.
● The Intelligent Key button must be held for
1 second before the liftgate opens.
● The liftgate must be unlocked to open it with
A.
the liftgate opener switch 䊊
A warning chime will sound if the shift lever is
moved out of P (Park) during a power open
operation.
3-24 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
A is activated
● If the liftgate opener switch 䊊
while the cinching motor is engaged, the
cinching motor will disengage and release
the latch.
● The Intelligent Key button must be held for
1 second before the liftgate closes.
Reverse:
The power liftgate will reverse direction immediately during power open or power close if the
Intelligent Key, instrument panel or liftgate switch
A is
is pushed or if the liftgate opener switch 䊊
pushed. A chime will sound to announce the
reversal.
Auto Reverse:
If an obstacle is detected during power open or
power close, a warning chime will sound and the
liftgate will reverse direction and return to the full
** Click HERE to see the "Owner's Manual Supplement" beginning on page 2. **
open or full close position. If a second obstacle is
detected, the liftgate motion will stop and the
liftgate will enter manual mode.
To close, lower and push the liftgate down securely.
Auto Power Back Door System Battery
Power Saving Mode:
The vehicle goes into power saving mode when
the liftgate is open for a long time (approximately
12 hours). This is to prevent deterioration of the
battery. The power saving mode automatically
cuts the power supply of the power liftgate door.
A pinch strip is mounted on each side of the
liftgate. If an obstacle is detected by a pinch strip
during power close, the liftgate will reverse direction and return to the full open position.
NOTE:
If the pinch strip is damaged or removed,
the power close function will not operate.
When the power to the liftgate is cut off, the
manual mode must be performed. After the
manual mode is performed, the power liftgate
function is restored.
WARNING
There are some small distances immediately before the closed position which
cannot be detected. Make sure that all
passengers have their hands, etc., inside
the vehicle before closing the liftgate.
LPD2297
Manual Mode:
If power operation is not available, the liftgate
may be operated manually. Power operation may
not be available if the power liftgate main switch
is in the ON position, if multiple obstacles have
been detected in a single power cycle, or if
battery voltage is low.
NOTE:
When a battery voltage is lower than approximately 11V, the power back door may
not operate after automatic return.
If the power liftgate opener switch is pushed
during power open or close, the power operation
will be canceled and the liftgate can be operated
manually.
To open the liftgate manually, press the liftgate
opener switch and lift the liftgate.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-25
LIFTGATE RELEASE
WARNING
● Always be sure the liftgate has been
closed securely to prevent it from opening while driving.
● Do not drive with the liftgate open. This
could allow dangerous exhaust gases
to be drawn into the vehicle. For additional information, refer to “Exhaust
gas (carbon monoxide)” in the “Starting
and driving” section of this manual.
SPA2547
POWER LIFTGATE MAIN SWITCH
The power liftgate operation can be turned on or
off by the power liftgate main switch in the glove
box.
When the power liftgate main switch is pushed to
the OFF position, the power operation is not
available by the power liftgate switch on the
A or
liftgate close switch or liftgate open switch 䊊
B.
䊊
Power operation is available when in the OFF
position by the instrument panel switch and the
key fob button.
3-26 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
● To avoid personal injury, do not attempt
to activate the power liftgate if one or
both of the liftgate gas stays are removed.
CAUTION
● If the power liftgate does not stay open or
if the liftgate unexpectedly closes at any
time while a continuous warning chime
sounds, do not operate the liftgate. There
may be a pressure loss in one or both of
the liftgate gas stays. Have the liftgate
inspected by a NISSAN dealer.
● Do not activate the power liftgate if one
or both of the liftgate gas stays are
removed. Damage to the liftgate or
power liftgate mechanisms may occur.
LPD2319
Liftgate release (manual and power)
The liftgate release mechanism allows the liftgate
to be opened in the event of a discharged battery.
To release the liftgate from the inside of the
vehicle, perform the following operations:
1. Position the rear bench seat forward. For
additional information, refer to “Rear bench
seat adjustment” in the “Safety — seats, seat
belts and supplemental restraint system”
section of this manual.
2. Insert a suitable tool into the top access
opening at about a 45 degree angle and
rotate to the left until the lock releases.
FUEL-FILLER DOOR
3. Push the liftgate up to open.
FUEL-FILLER CAP
NOTE:
WARNING
If you had to open the liftgate using this
procedure, have your vehicle checked by a
NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.
● Gasoline is extremely flammable and
highly explosive under certain conditions. You could be burned or seriously
injured if it is misused or mishandled.
Always stop the engine and do not
smoke or allow open flames or sparks
near the vehicle when refueling.
LIFTGATE POSITION SETTING
The liftgate can be set to open to a specific height
by performing the following:
1. Open the liftgate using the request switch or
the Intelligent Key.
2. Pull the liftgate down to the desired position
and hold the liftgate (the liftgate will have
some resistance when being manually adjusted).
3. While holding the liftgate in position, press
located
and hold the liftgate switch
on the liftgate for approximately 5 seconds
or until two beeps are heard.
The liftgate will open to the selected position
setting. To change the position of the liftgate,
repeat Steps 1-3 for setting the position of the
liftgate.
LPD2022
OPENER OPERATION
The fuel-filler lid release is located below the
instrument panel. To open the fuel-filler lid, pull
the release. To lock, close the fuel-filler lid securely.
● Do not attempt to top off the fuel tank
after the fuel pump nozzle shuts off
automatically. Continued refueling may
cause fuel overflow, resulting in fuel
spray and possibly a fire.
● Use only an original equipment type
fuel-filler cap as a replacement. It has a
built-in safety valve needed for proper
operation of the fuel system and emission control system. An incorrect cap
can result in a serious malfunction and
possible injury. It could also cause
Malfunction Indicator Light
the
(MIL) to come on.
● Never pour fuel into the throttle body to
attempt to start your vehicle.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-27
● Do not fill a portable fuel container in
the vehicle or trailer. Static electricity
can cause an explosion of flammable
liquid, vapor or gas in any vehicle or
trailer. To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death when filling portable fuel
containers:
– Always place the container on the
ground when filling.
– Do not use electronic devices when
filling.
– Keep the pump nozzle in contact
with the container while you are filling it.
– Use only approved portable fuel containers for flammable liquid.
CAUTION
● Do not use E-15 or E-85 fuel in your
vehicle. For additional information, refer to the “Recommended fuel” in the
“Technical and consumer information”
section of this manual.
3-28 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
● The LOOSE FUEL CAP warning will appear if the fuel-filler cap is not properly
tightened. It may take a few driving trips
for the message to be displayed. Failure
to tighten the fuel-filler cap properly
after the LOOSE FUEL CAP warning apMalfunction
pears may cause the
Indicator Light (MIL) to illuminate.
● Failure to tighten the fuel-filler cap
Malfuncproperly may cause the
tion Indicator Light (MIL) to illuminate.
light illuminates because
If the
the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing,
tighten or install the cap and continue
light
to drive the vehicle. The
should turn off after a few driving trips.
light does not turn off after a
If the
few driving trips, have the vehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer.
● For additional information, refer to the
“Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)” in
the “Instruments and Controls” section
in this manual.
● If fuel is spilled on the vehicle body,
flush it away with water to avoid paint
damage.
LPD2288
To remove the fuel-filler cap:
1. Turn the fuel-filler cap counterclockwise to
remove.
1
2. Put the fuel-filler cap on the cap holder 䊊
while refueling.
To install the fuel-filler cap:
1. Insert the fuel-filler cap straight into the fuelfiller tube.
2. Turn the fuel-filler cap clockwise until a
single click is heard.
TILT/TELESCOPIC STEERING
next button on the steering
3. Press the
wheel for about one second to turn off the
LOOSE FUEL CAP warning message after
tightening the fuel-filler cap.
LPD2298
LOOSE FUEL CAP warning
The LOOSE FUEL CAP warning message appears in the vehicle information display when the
fuel-filler cap is not tightened correctly after the
vehicle has been refueled. It may take a few
driving trips for the message to be displayed. To
turn off the warning message, perform the following:
WARNING
● Do not adjust the steering wheel while
driving. You could lose control of your
vehicle and cause an accident.
● Do not adjust the steering wheel any
closer to you than is necessary for
proper steering operation and comfort.
The driver’s air bag inflates with great
force. If you are unrestrained, leaning
forward, sitting sideways or out of position in any way, you are at greater risk of
injury or death in a crash. You may also
receive serious or fatal injuries from the
air bag if you are up against it when it
inflates. Always sit back against the
seatback and as far away as practical
from the steering wheel. Always use the
seat belts.
1. Remove and install the fuel-filler cap as soon
as possible. For additional information, refer
to “Fuel-filler cap” in this section.
2. Tighten the fuel-filler cap until it clicks.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-29
CAUTION
For vehicles with automatic drive positioner: Failure to reset the tilt and telescoping functions of the steering wheel,
after the vehicle’s battery has been discharged, may prevent the steering wheel
position from being adjusted.
LPD2339
WPD0366
MANUAL OPERATION (if so
equipped)
AUTOMATIC OPERATION (if so
equipped)
Tilt and telescopic operation
Tilt and telescopic operation
1 down:
Pull the lock lever 䊊
● Adjust the steering wheel up or down in
2 to the desired position.
direction 䊊
● Adjust the steering wheel forward or back3 to the desired position.
ward in direction 䊊
1 up firmly to lock the
Push the lock lever 䊊
steering wheel in place.
3-30 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
1
To adjust the steering wheel move the switch 䊊
in the following directions:
● Adjust the steering wheel up or down in
2 to the desired tilt position.
direction 䊊
● Adjust the steering wheel forward or back3 to the desired teleward in direction 䊊
scopic position.
For vehicles with automatic drive positioner: Both
the tilt and telescopic steering operation must be
reset after the vehicle’s battery has been discharged in order to prevent the tilt and telescopic
operation from locking in one position. When the
battery has been recharged or replaced, perform
the following:
1 so
● For tilt operation: Adjust the switch 䊊
the steering wheel moves to the highest
2 that can be reached.
position 䊊
● For telescopic operation: Adjust the switch
1 so the steering wheel moves to the most
䊊
3 that can
forward and backward position 䊊
be reached.
Performing these operations resets the range of
the steering wheel’s tilt and telescopic function.
SUN VISORS
1
䊊
Entry/Exit function
The automatic drive positioner system will make
the steering wheel move up automatically when
the driver’s door is opened and the ignition
switch is in the LOCK position. This lets the driver
get into and out of the seat more easily. The
steering wheel moves back into position when
the driver’s door is closed and the ignition switch
is pushed.
2
䊊
3
䊊
To block glare from the front, swing down the
main sun visor.
To block glare from the side, remove the
main sun visor from the center mount and
swing the visor to the side.
To extend the sun visor, slide in or out as
needed.
CAUTION
For additional information, refer to “Automatic
drive positioner” in this section.
● Do not store the sun visor before returning the extension to its original
position.
● Do not pull the extension sun visor
forcedly downward.
WPD0344
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-31
MIRRORS
LPD2289
LPD2340
WPD0126
VANITY MIRRORS
CARD HOLDER
REARVIEW MIRROR (if so equipped)
To access the vanity mirror, pull the sun visor
down and flip open the mirror cover. The vanity
mirror will illuminate when the mirror cover is
open.
Do not view information while operating the vehicle.
1 to reduce glare from
Use the night position 䊊
the headlights of vehicles behind you at night.
2 when driving in daylight
Use the day position 䊊
hours.
WARNING
Use the night position only when necessary, because it reduces rear view clarity.
3-32 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
NOTE:
Do not hang any objects over the sensors
1 or apply glass cleaner to the sensors.
䊊
Doing so will reduce the sensitivity of the
sensors, resulting in improper operation.
2 will illuminate when the
The indicator light 䊊
automatic anti-glare feature is operating.
● To turn off the anti-glare feature, press
button. The indicator light will turn
the
off.
LPD0469
AUTOMATIC ANTI-GLARE
REARVIEW MIRROR (if so equipped)
The inside mirror is designed so that it automatically dims during night time conditions and according to the intensity of the headlights of the
vehicle following you. The automatic anti-glare
feature is activated when the ignition switch is in
the ON position.
● To turn on the anti-glare feature, press
the | button again. The indicator light will
turn on.
For information on HomeLink® Universal Transceiver operation, refer to the “HomeLink® Universal Transceiver” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this manual.
OUTSIDE MIRRORS
WARNING
● Do not adjust the mirrors while driving.
You could lose control of your vehicle
and cause an accident.
● Objects viewed in the outside mirror on
the passenger side are closer than they
appear. Be careful when moving to the
right. Using only this mirror could cause
an accident. Use the inside mirror or
glance over your shoulder to properly
judge distances to other objects.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-33
WARNING
● Objects viewed in the outside mirror on
the passenger side are closer than they
appear. Be careful when moving to the
right. Using only this mirror could cause
an accident. Use the inside mirror or
glance over your shoulder to properly
judge distances to other objects.
● Do not adjust the mirrors while driving.
You could lose control of your vehicle
and cause an accident.
LPD2299
LPD2112
Electric control type
Manual folding outside mirrors
The outside mirror remote control will operate
only when the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON
position.
Pull the outside mirror toward the door to fold it.
1 to select the left or right
Move the small switch 䊊
mirror. Adjust each mirror to the desired position
2 .
using the large switch 䊊
Reverse tilt-down feature (if so
equipped)
The reverse tilt-down feature will turn both outside mirror surfaces downward to provide better
rear visibility close to the vehicle when the mirror
control switch is in either the L or R position.
The mirrors automatically returns to their original
position when you shift out of R (Reverse).
3-34 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
AUTOMATIC DRIVE POSITIONER (if
so equipped)
The outside mirror surfaces will return to their
original position when one of the following has
occurred:
● The shift lever is moved to any position other
than R (Reverse).
The automatic drive positioner system has two
features:
● Memory storage function
● Entry/exit function
● The outside mirror control switch is set to the
neutral or center position.
● The ignition switch is placed in the OFF
position.
NOTE:
If the outside mirror control switch is in the
Center position, mirror surface will NOT
turn downward when the shift lever is
moved to R (Reverse).
For additional information regarding this feature,
refer to “Automatic drive positioner” in this section.
Heated mirrors (if so equipped)
Some outside mirrors can be heated to defrost,
defog, or de-ice for improved visibility. For additional information, refer to “Rear window and
outside mirror (if so equipped) defroster switch”
in the “Instruments and controls” section of this
manual.
LPD2291
MEMORY STORAGE FUNCTION
Two positions for the driver’s seat, steering column
(if so equipped), and outside mirrors can be stored
in the automatic drive positioner memory. Follow
these procedures to use the memory system.
1. Place the ignition in the ON or ACC position
(The vehicle should be stopped while setting
the memory).
2. Adjust the driver’s seat, steering column (if
so equipped), and outside mirrors to the
desired positions by manually operating
each adjusting switch. For additional information, refer to “Seats” in the “Safety—
Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-35
system” section of this manual, and
“Tilt/Telescopic Steering” and “Outside mirrors” in this section.
Linking an Intelligent Key to the meter
display (if so equipped)
3. Push the SET switch and, within 5 seconds,
push the memory switch (1 or 2).
Each Intelligent Key, up to a maximum of four, can
be linked to the meter display.
4. The indicator light for the pushed memory
switch will come on and stay on for approximately 5 seconds.
1. Make sure to turn ON the “Key Link Settings” in the meter to enable the system for
desired Intelligent Key.
5. The chime will sound if the memory has been
stored.
2. When the system is enabled, the recognized
Intelligent Key is displayed at start up, as well
as within “Key Link Settings”.
NOTE:
If a NEW memory position is stored in the
same memory switch, the previous memory
position will be overwritten by the new
stored position.
Confirming memory storage
Push the SET switch.
● If a memory position has not been stored in
the switch (1 or 2) the indicator light for the
respective switch will come ON for approximately 0.5 seconds.
● If a memory position has been stored in the
switch (1 or 2) then the indicator light for the
respective switch will stay on for approximately 5 seconds.
3-36 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3. When the system is active, the meter setting
items are memorized for each Intelligent Key
that has been enabled in the system.
a. Ignition from ON position to the OFF
b. Unlock door with the desired Intelligent
Key
c. The desired Intelligent Key number should
appear on the meter display.
The system contains a ON/OFF setting for when
the settings are not to be memorized.
ENTRY/EXIT FUNCTION
This system is designed so that the driver’s seat
and automatic operation steering column will automatically move when the shift lever is in the P
(Park) position. This allows the driver to get into
and out of the driver’s seat more easily.
4. The auto drive positioner system is memorized automatically when the ignition switch
is turned from ON to OFF by the Intelligent
Key with no need to set separate buttons for
recalling and memorizing positions.
The driver’s seat will slide backward and the
steering wheel will move up:
5. If two Intelligent Keys are in the vehicle, the
system will recognize the Intelligent Key that
was used most recently, such as to
unlock/lock the door.
● When the ignition switch is turned from
ACC to OFF with the driver’s door open.
6. If there is a desire to change to another
Intelligent Key while in the vehicle, the user
must turn the ignition OFF and initiate communication from the desired Intelligent Key.
● When the driver’s door is opened and the
ignition switch is in the OFF position.
The driver’s seat and steering wheel will return to
the previous position:
● When the ignition switch is turned to ACC or
ON while the shift lever is in the P (Park)
position.
The entry/exit function can be adjusted or canceled through the Vehicle Settings in the vehicle
information display by performing the following:
SYSTEM OPERATION
● Switch the Exit Seat Slide from ON to OFF.
The automatic drive positioner system will not
work or will stop operating under the following
conditions:
● Switch the Exit Steering UP from ON to
OFF.
● When the vehicle speed is above 4 MPH
(7 km/h).
Restarting the entry/exit function
If the battery cable is disconnected or if the fuse
opens, the stored memory positions may be lost
and some of the functions will be restricted.
1. Drive the vehicle over 25 MPH (40 km/h).
OR
2. Open and close the driver’s door more than
2 times with the ignition switch in the OFF
position.
● When any of the memory switches are
pushed while the automatic drive positioner
is operating.
● When the adjusting switch for the driver’s
seat and steering column is turned on while
the automatic drive positioner is operating.
● When the seat has already been moved to
the memorized position.
● When no seat position is stored in the
memory switch.
The entry/exit function should now work properly.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-37
4 Display screen, heater, air conditioner,
audio and phone systems
RearView Monitor without Navigation System
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
How to read the displayed lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Adjusting the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4
Difference between predicted and actual
distances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4
RearView Monitor with Navigation System
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
How to read the displayed lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8
Adjusting the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
How to turn on and off predictive course
lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
Difference between predicted and actual
distances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
Around View® Monitor (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12
Available views . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
Difference between predictive and actual
distances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17
How to switch the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20
Moving Object Detection (MOD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20
Around View® Monitor Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23
View malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23
How to adjust the screen view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24
Operating tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24
Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
Heater and Air Conditioner (automatic). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26
Automatic operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27
Manual operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28
Operating tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28
Servicing air conditioner. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29
Audio system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29
Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29
FM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
AM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
Satellite radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
Audio operation precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31
FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD)
player (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38
USB (Universal Serial Bus) Connection Port
(models without Navigation System)
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-42
iPod®* player operation without Navigation
System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-44
Bluetooth® streaming audio without
Navigation System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46
CD care and cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47
Steering wheel switch for audio control . . . . . . . . . . 4-48
NissanConnectSM Mobile Apps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-49
Registering NissanConnectSM Mobile Apps . . . . . . 4-49
Connect Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-50
Application Download. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-50
Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-50
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System without
Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-51
Regulatory Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53
Using the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53
Control buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-55
Connecting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-55
Voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57
Making a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58
Receiving a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59
During a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59
Ending a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59
Text messaging (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59
Bluetooth® settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61
Manual control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-62
REARVIEW MONITOR WITHOUT
NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so
equipped)
WARNING
● Positioning of the heating or air conditioning controls and display controls
should not be done while driving in order that full attention may be given to
the driving operation.
● Do not disassemble or modify this system. If you do, it may result in accidents,
fire, or electrical shock.
● Do not use this system if you notice any
abnormality, such as a frozen screen or
lack of sound. Continued use of the
system may result in accident, fire or
electric shock.
● In case you notice any foreign object in
the system hardware, spill liquid on it,
or notice smoke or smell coming from it,
stop using the system immediately and
contact a NISSAN dealer. Ignoring such
conditions may lead to accidents, fire or
electrical shock.
LHA3521
1. ENTER/SETTING button/TUNE-SCROLL
control knob
When the shift lever is shifted into the R (Reverse) position, the monitor display shows the
view to the rear of the vehicle.
4-2 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
WARNING
● Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use of the RearView Monitor could result in serious
injury or death.
● The RearView Monitor is a convenience
but it is not a substitute for proper backing. Always turn and look out the windows, and check mirrors to be sure that
it is safe to move before operating the
vehicle. Always back up slowly.
● The system is designed as an aid to the
driver in showing large stationary objects directly behind the vehicle, to help
avoid damaging the vehicle.
● The system cannot completely eliminate blind spots and may not show every object.
● Underneath the bumper and the corner
areas of the bumper cannot be viewed
on the RearView Monitor because of its
monitoring range limitation. The system
will not show small objects below the
bumper, and may not show objects
close to the bumper or on the ground.
● Objects viewed in the RearView Monitor differ from actual distance because
a wide-angle lens is used.
● Objects in a RearView Monitor will appear visually opposite than when
viewed in the rearview and outside
mirrors.
● Make sure that the liftgate is securely
close when backing up.
● Do not put anything on the rearview
camera. The rearview camera is installed above the license plate.
● When washing the vehicle with high
pressure water, be sure not to spray it
around the camera. Otherwise, water
may enter the camera unit causing water condensation on the lens, a malfunction, fire or an electric shock.
HOW TO READ THE DISPLAYED
LINES
● Do not strike the camera. It is a precision instrument. Otherwise, it may malfunction or cause damage resulting in a
fire or an electric shock.
Distance guide lines:
CAUTION
Do not scratch the cover when cleaning
dirt or snow from the cover.
LHA2944
Guiding lines which indicate the vehicle width
and distances to objects with reference to the
A are displayed on the monitor.
vehicle body line 䊊
Indicate distances from the vehicle body.
1 : approx. 1.5 ft (0.5 m)
● Red line 䊊
2 : approx. 3 ft (1 m)
● Yellow line 䊊
3 : approx. 7 ft (2 m)
● Green line 䊊
4 : approx. 10 ft (3 m)
● Green line 䊊
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-3
5 :
● Vehicle width guide lines 䊊
Indicate the vehicle width when backing up.
B . Note that any object on
the hill is the place 䊊
the hill is further than it appears on the monitor.
ADJUSTING THE SCREEN
1. Firmly apply the brake and place the shift
lever in R (Reverse).
2. Press the ENTER/SETTING button.
3. The Settings screen will show brightness.
4. Press the ENTER/SETTING button again to
show contrast.
5. Turn the TUNE-SCROLL knob to adjust the
setting up or down.
6. Press the ENTER/SETTING button to complete the adjustment.
● Do not adjust the Brightness or Contrast of
the RearView Monitor while the vehicle is
moving.
DIFFERENCE BETWEEN
PREDICTED AND ACTUAL
DISTANCES
The distance guide line and the vehicle width
guide line should be used as a reference only
when the vehicle is on a level, paved surface. The
distance viewed on the monitor is for reference
only and may be different than the actual distance
between the vehicle and displayed objects.
LHA3523
Backing up on a steep uphill
When backing up the vehicle up a hill, the distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide
lines are shown closer than the actual distance.
For example, the display shows 3 ft (1.0 m) to the
A , but the actual 3 ft (1.0 m) distance on
place 䊊
4-4 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
B . Note that any object on
the hill is the place 䊊
the hill is closer than it appears on the monitor.
LHA3524
LHA2946
Backing up on a steep downhill
Backing up near a projecting object
When backing up the vehicle down a hill, the
distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide
lines are shown farther than the actual distance.
For example, the display shows 3 ft (1.0 m) to the
A , but the actual 3 ft (1.0 m) distance on
place 䊊
The vehicle may seem to nearly clear the object in
the display. However, the vehicle may hit the
object if it projects over the actual backing up
course.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-5
A if the object projects over the
the position 䊊
actual backing up course.
OPERATING TIPS
● When the shift lever is shifted to the R (Reverse) position, the monitor screen automatically changes to the RearView Monitor
mode. However, the radio can be heard.
● Do not use alcohol, benzine or thinner to
clean the camera. This will cause discoloration. To clean the camera, wipe with a cloth
dampened with diluted mild cleaning agent
and then wipe with a dry cloth.
● When the view is switched, the display images on the screen may be displayed with
some delay.
● Do not damage the camera as the monitor
screen may be adversely affected.
● When the temperature is extremely high or
low, the screen may not clearly display objects. This is not a malfunction.
● When strong light is directly coming on the
camera, objects may not be displayed
clearly. This is not a malfunction.
● Vertical lines may be seen in objects on the
screen. This is due to strong reflected light
from the bumper. This is not a malfunction.
LHA3525
Backing up behind a projecting object
C is shown farther than the position
The position 䊊
B in the display. However, the position 䊊
C is
䊊
A.
actually at the same distance as the position 䊊
The vehicle may hit the object when backing up to
● If dirt, rain or snow accumulates on the camera, the RearView Monitor may not display
object clearly. Clean the camera.
● The screen may flicker under fluorescent
light. This is not a malfunction.
● The colors of objects on the RearView Monitor may differ somewhat from the actual
color of objects. This is not a malfunction.
● Objects on the monitor may not be clear in a
dark environment. This is not a malfunction.
4-6 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
● Do not use wax on the camera window.
Wipe off any wax with a clean cloth dampened with mild detergent diluted with water.
REARVIEW MONITOR WITH
NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so
equipped)
WARNING
● Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use of the RearView Monitor could result in serious
injury or death.
● The RearView Monitor is a convenience
but it is not a substitute for proper backing. Always turn and look out the windows, and check mirrors to be sure that
it is safe to move before operating the
vehicle. Always back up slowly.
● The system is designed as an aid to the
driver in showing large stationary objects directly behind the vehicle, to help
avoid damaging the vehicle.
● The system cannot completely eliminate blind spots and may not show every object.
LHA3512
1. CAMERA button
When the shift lever is shifted into the R (Reverse) position, the monitor display shows the
view to the rear of the vehicle.
● Underneath the bumper and the corner
areas of the bumper cannot be viewed
on the RearView Monitor because of its
monitoring range limitation. The system
will not show small objects below the
bumper, and may not show objects
close to the bumper or on the ground.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-7
5 :
● Vehicle width guide lines 䊊
Indicate the vehicle width when backing up.
● Objects viewed in the RearView Monitor differ from actual distance because
a wide-angle lens is used.
● Objects in a RearView Monitor will appear visually opposite than when
viewed in the rearview and outside
mirrors.
● Make sure that the liftgate is securely
close when backing up.
● Do not put anything on the rearview
camera. The rearview camera is installed above the license plate.
● When washing the vehicle with high
pressure water, be sure not to spray it
around the camera. Otherwise, water
may enter the camera unit causing water condensation on the lens, a malfunction, fire or an electric shock.
HOW TO READ THE DISPLAYED
LINES
● Do not strike the camera. It is a precision instrument. Otherwise, it may malfunction or cause damage resulting in a
fire or an electric shock.
Distance guide lines:
CAUTION
Do not scratch the cover when cleaning
dirt or snow from the cover.
LHA2944
Guiding lines which indicate the vehicle width
and distances to objects with reference to the
A are displayed on the monitor.
vehicle body line 䊊
Indicate distances from the vehicle body.
1 : approx. 1.5 ft (0.5 m)
● Red line 䊊
2 : approx. 3 ft (1 m)
● Yellow line 䊊
3 : approx. 7 ft (2 m)
● Green line 䊊
4 : approx. 10 ft (3 m)
● Green line 䊊
4-8 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
HOW TO TURN ON AND OFF
PREDICTIVE COURSE LINES
To toggle ON and OFF the predictive course
lines while in the P (Park), D (Drive) or N (Neutral)
positions:
1. Press the CAMERA button.
2. Touch the Predictive Course Lines key to
turn the feature ON or OFF..
To toggle ON and OFF the predictive course
lines while in the R (Reverse) position:
1. Touch the touch-screen display.
LHA3522
ADJUSTING THE SCREEN
1. While on a RearView Monitor screen, touch
the touch-screen display. The Camera Settings screen will come up.
2. Touch the Display Settings key.
3. Touch the “Brightness,” “Contrast,” “Tint,”
“Color,” or “Black Level” key.
4. Adjust the item by touching the + or — key
on the touch-screen display.
● Do not adjust the display of the RearView
Monitor while the vehicle is moving.
2. Touch the Predictive Course Lines key to
turn the feature ON or OFF.
DIFFERENCE BETWEEN
PREDICTED AND ACTUAL
DISTANCES
The distance guide line and the vehicle width
guide line should be used as a reference only
when the vehicle is on a level, paved surface. The
distance viewed on the monitor is for reference
only and may be different than the actual distance
between the vehicle and displayed objects.
LHA3523
Backing up on a steep uphill
When backing up the vehicle up a hill, the distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide
lines are shown closer than the actual distance.
For example, the display shows 3 ft (1.0 m) to the
A , but the actual 3 ft (1.0 m) distance on
place 䊊
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-9
B . Note that any object on
the hill is the place 䊊
the hill is further than it appears on the monitor.
B . Note that any object on
the hill is the place 䊊
the hill is closer than it appears on the monitor.
LHA3524
Backing up on a steep downhill
When backing up the vehicle down a hill, the
distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide
lines are shown farther than the actual distance.
For example, the display shows 3 ft (1.0 m) to the
A , but the actual 3 ft (1.0 m) distance on
place 䊊
4-10 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
A if the object projects over the
the position 䊊
actual backing up course.
OPERATING TIPS
● When the shift lever is shifted to the R (Reverse) position, the monitor screen automatically changes to the RearView Monitor
mode. However, the radio can be heard.
● When the view is switched, the display images on the screen may be displayed with
some delay.
● When the temperature is extremely high or
low, the screen may not clearly display objects. This is not a malfunction.
● When strong light is directly coming on the
camera, objects may not be displayed
clearly. This is not a malfunction.
● Vertical lines may be seen in objects on the
screen. This is due to strong reflected light
from the bumper. This is not a malfunction.
LHA2946
LHA3525
Backing up near a projecting object
Backing up behind a projecting object
The vehicle may seem to nearly clear the object in
the display. However, the vehicle may hit the
object if it projects over the actual backing up
course.
C is shown farther than the position
The position 䊊
B in the display. However, the position 䊊
C is
䊊
A.
actually at the same distance as the position 䊊
The vehicle may hit the object when backing up to
● The screen may flicker under fluorescent
light. This is not a malfunction.
● The colors of objects on the RearView Monitor may differ somewhat from the actual
color of objects. This is not a malfunction.
● Objects on the monitor may not be clear in a
dark environment. This is not a malfunction.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-11
AROUND VIEW® MONITOR (if so
equipped)
● If dirt, rain or snow accumulates on the camera, the RearView Monitor may not display
object clearly. Clean the camera.
● Do not use alcohol, benzine or thinner to
clean the camera. This will cause discoloration. To clean the camera, wipe with a cloth
dampened with diluted mild cleaning agent
and then wipe with a dry cloth.
● Do not damage the camera as the monitor
screen may be adversely affected.
● Do not use wax on the camera window.
Wipe off any wax with a clean cloth dampened with mild detergent diluted with water.
LHA3512
1. CAMERA button
With the ignition switch in the ON position, press
the CAMERA button or move the shift lever to the R
(Reverse) position to operate the Around View®
Monitor. The monitor displays various views of the
position of the vehicle in a split screen format.
4-12 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
3 of
bird’s-eye view, a tall object near the seam 䊊
the camera viewing areas will not appear in the
2 .
monitor 䊊
Available views:
● Front View
An approximately 150–degree view of the
front of the vehicle.
WARNING
● Rear View
An approximately 150–degree view of the
rear of the vehicle.
● The Around View® Monitor is a convenience but it is not a substitute for
proper vehicle operation because it has
areas where objects cannot be viewed.
The four corners of the vehicle in particular, are blind spots where objects do
not appear in the bird’s-eye, front, or
rear views. Always look out the windows and check with your own eyes to
be sure that it is safe to move before
operating the vehicle. Always operate
the vehicle slowly.
● Bird’s-Eye View
The surrounding view of the vehicle from
above.
● Front-Side View
The view around and ahead of the front
passenger’s side wheel.
● The driver is always responsible for
safety during parking and other
maneuvers.
LHA3513
The system is designed as an aid to the driver in
situations such as slot parking or parallel parking.
There are some areas where the system will not
show objects and the system does not warn of
moving objects. When in the front or rear view
display, an object below the bumper or on the
1 . When in the
ground may not be viewed 䊊
● Do not use the Around View® Monitor
with the outside mirrors in the stored
position, and make sure that the liftgate
is securely closed when operating the
vehicle using the Around View®
Monitor.
● The distance between objects viewed
on the Around View® Monitor differs
from the actual distance.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-13
● The cameras are installed on the front
grille, the outside mirrors and above the
rear license plate. Do not put anything
on the cameras.
AVAILABLE VIEWS
WARNING
● When washing the vehicle with highpressure water, be sure not to spray it
around the cameras. Otherwise, water
may enter the camera unit causing water condensation on the lens, a malfunction, fire or an electric shock.
● The distance guide lines and the vehicle
width lines should be used as a reference only when the vehicle is on a
paved, level surface. The distance
viewed on the monitor may be different
than the actual distance between the
vehicle and displayed objects.
● Do not strike the cameras. They are
precision instruments. Doing so could
cause a malfunction or cause damage
resulting in a fire or an electric shock.
● The distance between objects viewed in
the rearview differs from actual distance because a wide-angle lens is
used.
CAUTION
Do not scratch the camera lens when
cleaning dirt or snow from the front of the
camera.
● Use the displayed lines and the bird’seye view as a reference. The lines and
the bird’s-eye view are greatly affected
by the number of occupants, fuel level,
vehicle position, road condition and
road grade.
● If the tires are replaced with different
sized tires, the predictive course lines
and the bird’s-eye view may be displayed incorrectly.
4-14 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
● When driving the vehicle up a hill, objects viewed in the monitor are further
than they appear. When driving the vehicle down a hill, objects viewed in the
monitor are closer than they appear.
● Use the mirrors or actually look to properly judge distances to other objects.
● Objects in the rear view will appear visually opposite from those viewed in
the inside and outside mirrors.
● On a snow-covered or slippery road,
there may be a difference between the
predictive course lines and the actual
course line.
● The displayed lines on the rear view will
appear slightly off to the right, because
the rear view camera is not installed in
the rear center of the vehicle.
● The vehicle width and predictive course
lines are wider than the actual width
and course.
The front view will not be displayed when the
vehicle speed is above 6 mph (10 km/h).
NOTE:
When the monitor displays the front view
and the steering wheel turns about 90 degrees or less from the straight ahead position, both the right and left predictive
6 are displayed. When the
course lines 䊊
steering wheel turns about 90 degrees or
more, a line is displayed only on the opposite side of the turn.
SAA1840
Front view
Front and rear view
Guiding lines, which indicate the vehicle width
and distance to objects with reference to the
A , are displayed on the monivehicle body line 䊊
tor.
Distance guide lines:
Indicate distances from the vehicle body:
1 : approximately 1.5 ft (0.5 m)
● Red line 䊊
2 : approximately 3 ft (1 m)
● Yellow line 䊊
3 : approximately 7 ft (2 m)
● Green line 䊊
SAA1896
Rear view
5 :
Vehicle width guide lines 䊊
Indicate the vehicle width when backing up.
6 :
Predictive course lines 䊊
Indicate the predictive course when operating
the vehicle. The predictive course lines will be
displayed on the monitor when the steering
wheel is turned. The predictive course lines will
move depending on how much the steering
wheel is turned and will not be displayed while
the steering wheel is in the straight ahead position.
4 : approximately 10 ft (3 m)
● Green line 䊊
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-15
displayed. It will be shown only the first time after
the ignition switch is placed in the ON position.
The driver can check the direction and angle of
3 when
the tire on the display by the tire icon 䊊
driving the vehicle forward or backward.
LHA3526
Bird’s-eye view
The bird’s-eye view shows the overhead view of
the vehicle, which helps confirm the vehicle position and the predicted course to a parking
space.
1 shows the position of the
The vehicle icon 䊊
vehicle. Note that the distance between objects
viewed in the bird’s-eye view may differ somewhat from the actual vehicle.
2 are
The areas that the cameras cannot cover 䊊
indicated in black.
2 is highlighted in yellow
The non-viewable area 䊊
for several seconds after the bird’s-eye view is
4 and 䊊
5 ) indicate the
Predictive course lines (䊊
predictive course when operating the vehicle.
The predictive course lines will be displayed on
the monitor when the steering wheel is turned.
The predictive course lines will move depending
on how much the steering wheel is turned and
will not be displayed while the steering wheel is in
the neutral position.
When the monitor displays the front view and the
steering wheel turns about 90 degrees or less
from the neutral position, the two green predic4 are shown in front of the
tive course lines 䊊
vehicle.
When the steering wheel turns about 90 degrees
or more, one green predictive course line is
shown in front of the vehicle and the other green
5 is shown at the side of
predictive course line 䊊
the vehicle.
When the monitor displays the rear view, the
predictive course lines are shown at the back of
the vehicle.
4-16 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
WARNING
● Objects in the bird’s-eye view will appear further than the actual distance
because the bird’s-eye view is a pseudo
view that is processed by combining the
views from the cameras on the outside
mirrors, the front and the rear of the
vehicle.
● Tall objects, such as a curb or vehicle,
may be misaligned or not displayed at
the seam of the views.
● Objects that are above the camera cannot be displayed.
● The view of the bird’s-eye view may be
misaligned when the camera position
alters.
● A line on the ground may be misaligned
and is not seen as being straight at the
seam of the views. The misalignment
will increase as the line proceeds away
from the vehicle.
● Tire angle display does not indicate the
actual tire angle.
CAUTION
● The turn signal light may look like the
side-of-vehicle line. This is not a
malfunction.
DIFFERENCE BETWEEN
PREDICTIVE AND ACTUAL
DISTANCES
LHA2652
Front-side view
The distance guide line and the vehicle width
guide line should be used as a reference only
when the vehicle is on a level, paved surface. The
distance viewed on the monitor is for reference
only and may be different than the actual distance
between the vehicle and displayed objects.
Guiding lines
Guiding lines that indicate the width and the front
end of the vehicle are displayed on the monitor.
1 shows the front part
The front-of-vehicle line 䊊
of the vehicle.
2 shows the vehicle
The side-of-vehicle line 䊊
width including the outside mirrors.
3 of both the front 䊊
1 and side
The extensions 䊊
2 lines are shown with a green dotted line.
䊊
LHA3523
Backing up on a steep uphill
When backing up the vehicle up a hill, the distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide
lines are shown closer than the actual distance.
For example, the display shows 3 ft (1.0 m) to the
A , but the actual 3 ft (1.0 m) distance on
place 䊊
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-17
B . Note that any object on
the hill is the place 䊊
the hill is further than it appears on the monitor.
B . Note that any object on
the hill is the place 䊊
the hill is closer than it appears on the monitor.
LHA3524
Backing up on a steep downhill
When backing up the vehicle down a hill, the
distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide
lines are shown farther than the actual distance.
For example, the display shows 3 ft (1.0 m) to the
A , but the actual 3 ft (1.0 m) distance on
place 䊊
4-18 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
A if the object projects over the
the position 䊊
actual backing up course.
OPERATING TIPS
● When the shift lever is shifted to the R (Reverse) position, the monitor screen automatically changes to the RearView Monitor
mode. However, the radio can be heard.
● When the view is switched, the display images on the screen may be displayed with
some delay.
● When the temperature is extremely high or
low, the screen may not clearly display objects. This is not a malfunction.
● When strong light is directly coming on the
camera, objects may not be displayed
clearly. This is not a malfunction.
● Vertical lines may be seen in objects on the
screen. This is due to strong reflected light
from the bumper. This is not a malfunction.
LHA1201
LHA3525
Backing up near a projecting object
Backing up behind a projecting object
A do not touch the
The predicted course lines 䊊
object in the display. However, the vehicle may hit
the object if it projects over the actual backing up
course.
C is shown farther than the position
The position 䊊
B in the display. However, the position 䊊
C is
䊊
A.
actually at the same distance as the position 䊊
The vehicle may hit the object when backing up to
● The screen may flicker under fluorescent
light. This is not a malfunction.
● The colors of objects on the RearView Monitor may differ somewhat from the actual
color of objects. This is not a malfunction.
● Objects on the monitor may not be clear in a
dark environment. This is not a malfunction.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-19
● If dirt, rain or snow accumulates on the camera, the RearView Monitor may not display
object clearly. Clean the camera.
● Do not use alcohol, benzine or thinner to
clean the camera. This will cause discoloration. To clean the camera, wipe with a cloth
dampened with diluted mild cleaning agent
and then wipe with a dry cloth.
● Do not damage the camera as the monitor
screen may be adversely affected.
● Do not use wax on the camera window.
Wipe off any wax with a clean cloth dampened with mild detergent diluted with water.
HOW TO SWITCH THE DISPLAY
With the ignition switch in the ON position, press
the CAMERA button or move the shift lever to the
R (Reverse) position to operate the Around
View® Monitor.
The Around View® Monitor can display two split
screen views and a single view of the front view or
rear view. Press the CAMERA button to switch
between the available views.
If the shift lever is not in the R (Reverse) position,
the available views are:
If the shift lever is in the R (Reverse) position, the
available views are:
● Rear view/bird’s-eye view split screen
● Rear view/front-side view split screen
The display will switch from the Around View®
Monitor screen when:
● When the shift lever is in the D (Drive) position and the vehicle speed increases above
approximately 6 mph (10 km/h).
● When a different screen is selected.
MOVING OBJECT DETECTION
(MOD)
The Moving Object Detection (MOD) system can
inform the driver of moving objects behind the
vehicle when backing out of garages, maneuvering in parking lots and in other such instances.
The MOD system detects moving objects by
using image processing technology on the image
shown in the display.
The MOD system operates in the following conditions when the camera view is displayed:
● Front view/bird’s-eye view split screen
● Front view/front-side view split screen
4-20 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
● When the shift lever is in the P (Park) or N
(Neutral) position and the vehicle is stopped,
the moving object detection system detects
the moving objects in the bird’s-eye view.
The MOD system will not operate if the
outside mirrors are moving in or out or if
either door is opened.
● When the shift lever is in the D (Drive) position and the vehicle speed is below approximately 5 mph (8 km/h), the MOD system
detects moving objects in the front view.
● When the shift lever is in the R (Reverse)
position and the vehicle speed is below approximately 5 mph (8 km/h), the MOD system detects moving objects in the rear view.
The MOD system will not operate if the
liftgate is open.
The MOD system does not detect moving objects in the front-side view. The MOD icon is not
displayed on the screen when in this view.
WARNING
● The MOD system is not a substitute for
proper vehicle operation and is not designed to prevent contact with the objects surrounding the vehicle. When
maneuvering, always use the outside
mirrors and rearview mirror and turn
and check the surrounding to ensure it
is safe to maneuver.
● The system is deactivated at speeds
above 6 mph (10 km/h). It is reactivated
at lower speeds.
● The system is not designed to prevent
contact with all objects.
● The MOD system does not have the
function to detect the surrounding stationary objects.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-21
LHA3604
When the MOD system detects moving objects
near the vehicle, the yellow frame will be displayed on the view where the objects are detected and a chime will sound once. While the
MOD system continues to detect moving objects, the yellow frame continues to be displayed.
1 is
In the bird’s eye view, the yellow frame 䊊
displayed on each camera image (front, rear,
right, left) depending on where moving objects
are detected.
The yellow frame is displayed on each view in the
front view and rear view modes.
While the BCI chime (if so equipped) is beeping,
the MOD system does not chime.
2 is displayed in the view
A blue MOD icon 䊊
where the MOD system is operative. A gray MOD
icon is displayed in the view where the MOD
system is not operative.
2
If the MOD system is turned off, the MOD icon 䊊
is not displayed.
The MOD system will turn on automatically under
the following conditions:
● When the shift lever is in the R (Reverse)
position.
● When the CAMERA button is pressed to
switch from a different screen to the camera
view on the display.
4-22 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
● When vehicle speed decreases below approximately 5 mph (8 km/h).
● When the ignition switch is placed in the
OFF position and then back to the ON position.
WARNING
● Do not use the MOD system when towing a trailer. The system may not function properly.
● Excessive noise (for example, audio
system volume or open vehicle window)
will interfere with the chime sound, and
it may not be heard.
● The MOD system performance will be
limited according to environmental conditions and surrounding objects such
as:
– When there is low contrast between
background and the moving objects.
– When there is a blinking source of
light.
– When strong light such as another
vehicle’s headlight or sunlight is
present.
– When camera orientation is not in its
usual position, such as when mirror
is folded.
– When there is dirt, water drops or
snow on the camera lens.
– When the position of the moving objects in the display is not changed.
● The MOD system might detect flowing
water droplets on the camera lens,
white smoke from the muffler, moving
shadows, etc.
● If your vehicle sustains damage to the
parts where the camera is installed,
leaving it misaligned or bent, the sensing zone may be altered and the MOD
system may not detect objects properly.
● When the temperature is extremely
high or low, the screen may not display
objects clearly. This is not a
malfunction.
Camera maintenance
If dirt, rain or snow accumulates on the camera,
the MOD system may not operate properly. Clean
the camera.
AROUND VIEW® MONITOR
SETTINGS
MOD (Moving Object Detection)
To turn the MOD system on or off, press and hold
the CAMERA button for more than 3 seconds.
LHA3607
VIEW MALFUNCTION
When the “!” icon is displayed on the screen,
there are abnormal conditions in the Around
View® Monitor. This will not hinder normal driving
operation but the system should be inspected by
a NISSAN dealer.
● The MOD system may not function
properly depending on the speed, direction, distance or shape of the moving
objects.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-23
3. Adjust the item by touching the + or — key
on the touch-screen display.
Do not adjust any of the display settings of the
Around View® Monitor while the vehicle is moving. Make sure the parking brake is firmly applied.
OPERATING TIPS
CAUTION
LHA3608
When the “[X]” icon is displayed on the screen,
the camera image may be receiving temporary
electronic disturbances from surrounding devices. This will not hinder normal driving operation but the system should be inspected by a
NISSAN dealer if it occurs frequently.
HOW TO ADJUST THE SCREEN
VIEW
1. Touch the touch-screen display with the
Around View® Monitor on.
2. Touch the “Brightness,” “Contrast,” “Tint,”
“Color,” or “Black Level” key.
● Do not use alcohol, benzine or thinner
to clean the camera. This will cause
discoloration. To clean the camera,
wipe with a cloth dampened with a diluted mild cleaning agent and then wipe
with a dry cloth.
● Do not damage the camera as the monitor screen may be adversely affected.
● The screen displayed on the Around View®
Monitor will automatically return to the previous screen 3 minutes after the CAMERA
button has been pressed with the shift lever
in a position other than the R (Reverse)
position.
● When the view is switched, the display images on the screen may be displayed in
some delay.
4-24 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
● When the temperature is extremely high or
low, the screen may not display objects
clearly. This is not a malfunction.
● When strong light directly shines on the
camera, objects may not be displayed
clearly. This is not a malfunction.
● The screen may flicker under fluorescent
light. This is not a malfunction.
● The colors of objects on the Around View®
Monitor may differ somewhat from the actual
color of objects. This is not a malfunction.
● Objects on the Around View® Monitor may
not be clear and the color of the object may
differ in a dark environment. This is not a
malfunction.
● There may be differences in sharpness between each camera view of the bird’s-eye
view.
● If dirt, rain or snow accumulates on the camera, the Around View® Monitor may not
display objects clearly. Clean the camera.
● Do not use wax on the camera lens. Wipe off
any wax with a clean cloth that has been
dampened with a mild detergent diluted with
water.
VENTS
LHA3201
Side
Adjust air flow direction by moving the vent
slides.
LHA3510
Center
LHA1134
Rear
Open or close the vents by using the dial. Move
to open the vents or
the dial toward the
toward the
to close them.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-25
HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER
(automatic)
9.
10.
(fan speed control) buttons
REAR (window and outside mirror
(if so equipped) defroster) button
11.
FRONT (defroster) button
WARNING
● The air conditioner cooling function operates only when the engine is running.
● Do not leave children or adults who
would normally require the assistance
of others alone in your vehicle. Pets
should also not be left alone. They
could accidentally injure themselves or
others through inadvertent operation of
the vehicle. Also, on hot, sunny days,
temperatures in a closed vehicle could
quickly become high enough to cause
severe or possibly fatal injuries to
people or animals.
LHA3200
1.
2.
3.
4.
Temperature control dial (driver’s side)/
AUTO button
ON-OFF button
Display screen
MODE (manual air flow control) button
5.
6.
7.
8.
Temperature control dial (passenger’s
side)/DUAL button
Fresh air intake button
Air recirculation button
A/C (air conditioner) button
4-26 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
● Do not use the recirculation mode for
long periods as it may cause the interior
air to become stale and the windows to
fog up.
NOTE:
● Odors from inside and outside the vehicle can build up in the air conditioner
unit. Odor can enter the passenger
compartment through the vents.
● When parking, set the heater and air
conditioner controls to turn off air recirculation to allow fresh air into the
passenger compartment. This should
help reduce odors inside the vehicle.
AUTOMATIC OPERATION
Cooling and/or dehumidified heating
(AUTO)
This mode may be used all year round as the
system automatically works to keep a constant
temperature. Air flow distribution and fan speed
are also controlled automatically.
1. Press the AUTO button on. The indicator on
the button will illuminate.
2. Turn the temperature control dial to the left
or right to set the desired temperature.
● The temperature of the passenger compartment will be maintained automatically. Air
flow distribution and fan speed are also controlled automatically.
● A visible mist may be seen coming from the
vents in hot, humid conditions as the air is
cooled rapidly. This does not indicate a malfunction.
3. You can individually set driver’s and front
passenger’s side temperature using each
temperature control dial. When the DUAL
button is pressed or passenger’s side temperature dial is turned, the DUAL indicator
will come on. To turn off the passenger’s
side temperature control, press the DUAL
button.
Heating (A/C OFF)
The air conditioner does not activate. When you
need to heat only, use this mode.
● Not recommended if windows fog up.
Dehumidified defrosting or defogging
1. Press the
front defroster button on.
The indicator light on the button will come
on.
2. Turn the temperature control dial to set the
maximum temperature to aid in defrosting or
defogging.
● To quickly remove ice from the outside of the
windows, use the fan speed control buttons
to set the fan speed to maximum.
● As soon as possible after the windshield is
clean, press the AUTO button to return to
the automatic mode.
1. Press the AUTO button. The indicator light
comes on.
2. Turn the temperature control dial to set the
desired temperature.
● The temperature of the passenger compartment will be maintained automatically. Air
flow distribution and fan speed are also controlled automatically.
● Do not set the temperature lower than the
outside air temperature. Otherwise, the system may not work properly.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-27
● When the
front defroster button is
pressed, the air conditioner will automatically be turned on at outside temperatures
above 36°F (2°C). The air recirculate mode
automatically turns off, allowing outside air
to be drawn into the passenger compartment to further improve the defogging performance. When the air recirculate mode
automatically turns off, the air fresh mode will
automatically turn on.
Remote engine start logic (if so
equipped)
Vehicles equipped with automatic climate controls and remote start function may go into automatic heating or cooling mode when remote start
is activated depending on outside and cabin temperatures. Automatic temperature depends on
outside and cabin temperatures. During this period, the climate control display and buttons will
be inoperable until ignition switch is turned on.
MANUAL OPERATION
Fan speed control
Press the fan speed control buttons
to
manually control the fan speed.
Press the AUTO button to return to automatic
control of the fan speed.
Air recirculation
Press the
air recirculation button to recirculate interior air inside the vehicle. The
indicator light on the button will come on.
The air recirculation cannot be activated when
the air conditioner is in the
front defrosting
mode.
Fresh air intake
Press the
fresh air intake button to draw
outside air into the passenger compartment.
Air flow control
Pressing the MODE button manually controls air
flow and selects the air outlet:
— Air flows mainly from center and
side vents.
— Air flows mainly from center and
side vents and foot outlets.
— Air flows mainly from foot outlets
and partly from defroster.
— Air flows mainly from defroster
and foot outlets.
To turn system off
Press the ON-OFF button.
4-28 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
Rear window and outside mirror (if so
equipped) defroster button
For additional information, refer to “Rear window
and outside mirror (if so equipped) defroster
switch” in the “Instruments and controls” section
of this manual.
OPERATING TIPS
● When the engine coolant temperature and
outside air temperature are low, the air flow
from the foot outlets may not operate for a
maximum of 150 seconds. However, this is
not a malfunction. After the coolant temperature warms up, air flow from the foot outlets
will operate normally.
● Keep the moonroof (if so equipped) closed
while the air conditioner is in operation.
● If you feel that the air flow mode you have
selected and the outlets the air is coming out
mode.
do not match, select the
● When you change the air flow mode, you
may feel air flow from the feet vents for just a
moment. This is not a malfunction.
SERVICING AIR CONDITIONER
AUDIO SYSTEM
The air conditioner system in your NISSAN vehicle is charged with a refrigerant designed with
the environment in mind.
RADIO
This refrigerant does not harm the earth’s
ozone layer.
Special charging equipment and lubricant is required when servicing your NISSAN air conditioner. Using improper refrigerants or lubricants
will cause severe damage to your air conditioner
system. For additional information, refer to “Air
conditioner system refrigerant and oil recommendations” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
LHA3554
The sunload sensor, located on the driver’s side
of the instrument panel, helps the system maintain a constant temperature. Do not put anything
on or around this sensor.
A NISSAN dealer is able to service your “environmentally friendly” air conditioning system.
WARNING
The air conditioner system contains refrigerant under high pressure. To avoid personal injury, any air conditioner service
should be done only by an experienced
technician with proper equipment.
With the ignition placed in the ACC or ON posi(power) button/VOL (voltion, press the
ume) control knob to turn the radio on. If you
listen to the radio with the engine not running, the
ignition should be placed in the ACC position.
Radio reception is affected by station signal
strength, distance from radio transmitter, buildings, bridges, mountains and other external influences. Intermittent changes in reception quality
normally are caused by these external influences.
Using a cellular phone in or near the vehicle
may influence radio reception quality.
Radio reception
Your NISSAN radio system is equipped with
state-of-the-art electronic circuits to enhance radio reception. These circuits are designed to
extend reception range, and to enhance the quality of that reception.
However, there are some general characteristics
of both FM and AM radio signals that can affect
radio reception quality in a moving vehicle, even
when the finest equipment is used. These characteristics are completely normal in a given reception area and do not indicate any malfunction
in your NISSAN radio system.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-29
Reception conditions will constantly change because of vehicle movement. Buildings, terrain,
signal distance and interference from other vehicles can work against ideal reception. Described below are some of the factors that can
affect your radio reception.
Static and flutter: During signal interference from
buildings, large hills or due to antenna position
(usually in conjunction with increased distance
from the station transmitter), static or flutter can
be heard. This can be reduced by adjusting the
treble control to reduce treble response.
Some cellular phones or other devices may
cause interference or a buzzing noise to come
from the audio system speakers. Storing the device in a different location may reduce or eliminate the noise.
Multipath reception: Because of the reflective
characteristics of FM signals, direct and reflected
signals reach the receiver at the same time. The
signals may cancel each other, resulting in momentary flutter or loss of sound.
FM RADIO RECEPTION
AM RADIO RECEPTION
Range: FM range is normally limited to 25 – 30 mi
(40 – 48 km), with monaural (single channel) FM
having slightly more range than stereo FM. External influences may sometimes interfere with FM
station reception even if the FM station is within
25 mi (40 km). The strength of the FM signal is
directly related to the distance between the
transmitter and receiver. FM signals follow a lineof-sight path, exhibiting many of the same characteristics as light. For example, they will reflect
off objects.
AM signals, because of their low frequency, can
bend around objects and skip along the ground.
In addition, the signals can be bounced off the
ionosphere and bent back to earth. Because of
these characteristics, AM signals are also subject to interference as they travel from transmitter
to receiver.
Fade and drift: As your vehicle moves away from
a station transmitter, the signals will tend to fade
and/or drift.
Fading: Occurs while the vehicle is passing
through freeway underpasses or in areas with
many tall buildings. It can also occur for several
seconds during ionospheric turbulence even in
areas where no obstacles exist.
Static: Caused by thunderstorms, electrical
power lines, electric signs and even traffic lights.
4-30 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
SATELLITE RADIO RECEPTION
When the satellite radio is used for the first time
or the battery has been replaced, the satellite
radio may not work properly. This is not a malfunction. Wait more than 10 minutes with satellite
radio ON and the vehicle outside of any metal or
large building for satellite radio to receive all of
the necessary data.
No satellite radio reception is available and “NO
SAT” is displayed when the SAT band option is
selected unless optional satellite receiver and
antenna are installed and a SiriusXM® Satellite
Radio service subscription is active. Satellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.
Satellite radio performance may be affected if
cargo carried on the roof blocks the satellite radio
signal.
If possible, do not put cargo over the satellite
antenna.
A build up of ice on the satellite radio antenna can
affect satellite radio performance. Remove the
ice to restore satellite radio reception.
Compact disc (CD) player
CAUTION
● Do not force a compact disc into the CD
insert slot. This could damage the CD
and/or CD player.
● Trying to load a CD with the CD door
closed could damage the CD and/or CD
player.
● Only one CD can be loaded into the CD
player at a time.
● Only use high quality 4.7 in (12 cm)
round discs that have the “COMPACT
disc DIGITAL AUDIO” logo on the disc
or packaging.
● During cold weather or rainy days, the
player may malfunction due to the humidity. If this occurs, remove the CD
and dehumidify or ventilate the player
completely.
LHA0099
AUDIO OPERATION PRECAUTIONS
● The player may skip while driving on
rough roads.
● The CD player sometimes cannot function when the compartment temperature is extremely high or low.
Decrease/increase the temperature
before use.
● Do not expose the CD to direct sunlight.
● CDs that are in poor condition or are
dirty, scratched or covered with fingerprints may not work properly.
● The following CDs may not work properly:
● Copy control compact discs (CCCD)
● Recordable compact discs (CD-R)
● Rewritable compact discs (CD-RW)
● Do not use the following CDs as they
may cause the CD player to malfunction:
● 3.1 in (8 cm) discs with an adapter
● CDs that are not round
● CDs with a paper label
● CDs that are warped, scratched, or
have abnormal edges
● This audio system can only play prerecorded CDs. It has no capability to
record or burn CDs.
● If the CD cannot be played, one of the
following messages will be displayed.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-31
CHECK DISC
Compact disc with MP3 or WMA
● Confirm that the CD is inserted correctly (the label side is facing up,
etc.).
Terms
● Confirm that the CD is not bent or
warped and it is free of scratches.
PRESS EJECT
This is an error due to excessive temperature inside the player. Remove the
CD by pressing the EJECT button. After
a short time, reinsert the CD. The CD
can be played when the temperature of
the player returns to normal.
UNPLAYABLE
The file is unplayable in this audio system (only MP3 or WMA CD).
● MP3 — MP3 is short for Moving Pictures
Experts Group Audio Layer 3. MP3 is the
most well-known compressed digital audio
file format. This format allows for near “CD
quality” sound, but at a fraction of the size of
normal audio files. MP3 conversion of an
audio track from CD-ROM can reduce the
file size by approximately a 10:1 ratio with
virtually no perceptible loss in quality. MP3
compression removes the redundant and
irrelevant parts of a sound signal that the
human ear doesn’t hear.
● WMA — Windows Media Audio (WMA)* is a
compressed audio format created by Microsoft as an alternative to MP3. The WMA
codec offers greater file compression than
the MP3 codec, enabling storage of more
digital audio tracks in the same amount of
space when compared to MP3s at the same
level of quality.
● Bit rate — Bit rate denotes the number of
bits per second used by a digital music file.
The size and quality of a compressed digital
audio file is determined by the bit rate used
when encoding the file.
4-32 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
● Sampling frequency — Sampling frequency
is the rate at which the samples of a signal
are converted from analog to digital (A/D
conversion) per second.
● Multisession — Multisession is one of the
methods for writing data to media. Writing
data once to the media is called a single
session, and writing more than once is called
a multisession.
● ID3/WMA Tag — The ID3/WMA tag is the
part of the encoded MP3 or WMA file that
contains information about the digital music
file such as song title, artist, encoding bit
rate, track time duration, etc. ID3 tag information is displayed on the Artist/song title
line on the display.
* Windows® and Windows Media® are registered trademarks and trademarks in the United
States of America and other countries of Microsoft Corporation of the USA.
● If there is a file in the top level of the disc,
“Root Folder” is displayed.
● The playback order is the order in which the
files were written by the writing software.
Therefore, the files might not play in the
desired order.
WHA1078
Playback order chart
Playback order
Music playback order of a CD with MP3 or WMA
files is as illustrated.
● The names of folders not containing MP3 or
WMA files are not shown in the display.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-33
Specification chart
Supported media
Supported file systems
MP3
Supported
versions*1
WMA
Version
Sampling frequency
Bit rate
Version
Sampling frequency
Bit rate
Tag information
Folder levels
Text character number limitation
Displayable character codes*2
CD, CD-R, CD-RW
ISO9660 LEVEL1, ISO9660 LEVEL2, Apple ISO, Romeo, Joliet * ISO9660 Level 3 (packet writing) is not supported.
MPEG1, MPEG2, MPEG2.5
8 kHz - 48 kHz
8 kbps - 320 kbps, VBR
WMA7, WMA8, WMA9
32 kHz - 48 kHz
48 kbps - 192 kbps, VBR
ID3 tag VER1.0, VER1.1, VER2.2, VER2.3 (MP3 only)
Folder levels: 8, Max folders: 255 (including root folder), Files: 512 (Max. 255 files for one folder)
128 characters
01: ASCII, 02: ISO-8859-1, 03: UNICODE (UTF-16 BOM Big Endian), 04: UNICODE (UTF-16 Non-BOM Big Endian), 05:
UNICODE (UTF-8), 06: UNICODE (Non-UTF-16 BOM Little Endian)
*1 Files created with a combination of 48 kHz sampling frequency and 64 kbps bit rate cannot be played.
*2 Available codes depend on what kind of media, versions and information are going to be displayed.
4-34 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
Troubleshooting guide
Symptom
Cannot play
Poor sound quality
It takes a relatively long time
before the music starts
playing.
Music cuts off or skips
Skipping with high bit rate
files
Moves immediately to the
next song when playing
Songs do not play back in
the desired order
Cause and Countermeasure
Check if the disc was inserted correctly.
Check if the disc is scratched or dirty.
Check if there is condensation inside the player. If there is, wait until the condensation is gone (about 1 hour) before using the player.
If there is a temperature increase error, the CD player will play correctly after it returns to the normal temperature.
If there is a mixture of music CD files (CD-DA data) and MP3/WMA files on a CD, only the music CD files (CD-DA data) will be played.
Files with extensions other than “.MP3”,“.WMA”, “.mp3” or “.wma” cannot be played. In addition, the character codes and number of characters for
folder names and file names should be in compliance with the specifications.
Check if the finalization process, such as session close and disc close, is done for the disc.
Check if the disc is protected by copyright.
Check if the disc is scratched or dirty.
Bit rate may be too low.
If there are many folders or file levels on the MP3/WMA disc, or if it is a multisession disc, some time may be required before the music starts playing.
The writing software and hardware combination might not match, or the writing speed, writing depth, writing width, etc., might not match the
specifications. Try using the slowest writing speed.
Skipping may occur with large quantities of data, such as for high bit rate data.
When a non-MP3/WMA file has been given an extension of “.MP3”, “.WMA”, .“mp3”or “.wma”, or when play is prohibited by copyright protection, there
will be approximately 5 seconds of no sound and then the player will skip to the next song.
The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software. Therefore, the files might not play in the desired order.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-35
USB (Universal Serial Bus)
Connection Port
WARNING
Do not connect, disconnect, or operate the
USB device while driving. Doing so can be
a distraction. If distracted you could lose
control of your vehicle and cause an accident or serious injury.
CAUTION
● Do not force the USB device into the
USB port. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down into the port may
damage the port. Make sure that the
USB device is connected correctly into
the USB port.
● Do not grab the USB port cover (if so
equipped) when pulling the USB device
out of the port. This could damage the
port and the cover.
● Do not leave the USB cable in a place
where it can be pulled unintentionally.
Pulling the cable may damage the port.
The vehicle is not equipped with a USB device.
USB devices should be purchased separately as
necessary.
This system cannot be used to format USB devices. To format a USB device, use a personal
computer.
In some jurisdictions, the USB device for the front
seats plays only sound without images for regulatory reasons, even when the vehicle is parked.
This system supports various USB connection
port devices, USB hard drives and iPod® players. Some USB devices may not be supported by
this system.
● Partitioned USB devices may not play correctly.
● Some characters used in other languages
(Chinese, Japanese, etc.) may not appear
properly in the display. Using English language characters with a USB device is recommended.
● Not all Android devices are supported for
USB audio.
● For Apple products, only Apple or Apple
certified USB cables are supported. Some
aftermarket cables may not be supported.
General notes for USB use
● Refer to your device manufacturer’s owner
information regarding the proper use and
care of the device.
4-36 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
Notes for iPod® use
iPod® is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in
the U.S. and other countries.
● Improperly plugging in the iPod® may cause
a checkmark to be displayed on and off
(flickering). Always make sure that the
iPod® is connected properly.
● An iPod® nano (1st Generation) may remain
in fast forward or rewind mode if it is connected during a seek operation. In this case,
please manually reset the iPod®.
● An iPod® nano (2nd Generation) will continue to fast-forward or rewind if it is disconnected during a seek operation.
● An incorrect song title may appear when the
Play Mode is changed while using an iPod®
nano (2nd Generation).
● Audiobooks may not play in the same order
as they appear on an iPod®.
● Large video files cause slow responses in an
iPod®. The vehicle center display may momentarily black out, but will soon recover.
● If an iPod® automatically selects large video
files while in the shuffle mode, the vehicle
center display may momentarily black out,
but will soon recover.
Bluetooth® streaming audio
● Some Bluetooth® audio devices may not be
recognized by the in-vehicle audio system.
● It is necessary to set up the wireless connection between a compatible Bluetooth®
audio device and the in-vehicle Bluetooth®
module before using the Bluetooth® audio.
● This system supports the Bluetooth® Audio
Distribution Profile (A2DP, AVRCP).
BLUETOOTH® is a
trademark owned by
Bluetooth SIG, Inc.
and licensed to
Visteon.
● Operating procedure of the Bluetooth® audio will vary depending on the devices. Make
sure how to operate your audio device before using it with this system.
● The Bluetooth® audio may be stopped under the following conditions:
● Receiving a call on the Hands-Free
Phone System.
● Checking the connection to the handsfree phone.
● Do not place the Bluetooth® audio device in
an area surrounded by metal or far away from
the in-vehicle Bluetooth® module to prevent
tone quality degradation and wireless connection disruption.
● While an audio device is connected through
the Bluetooth® wireless connection, the
battery power of the device may discharge
quicker than usual.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-37
TRACK button
7.
8. BACK button
9. APPS button
10. ENTER/SETTING button/ TUNE-SCROLL
knob
11. Station select (1 - 6) buttons
12. RDM (random) button
13. RPT (repeat) button
(power) button/ VOL (volume) control
14.
knob
15. DISP (display) button
16. MEDIA button
LHA3527
FM/AM/SAT RADIO WITH
COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (if so
equipped)
1.
CD eject button
3. Display screen
4. CD insert slot
5.
SEEK button
6. SCAN button
2. XM button*
4-38 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
17. FM•AM button
*No satellite radio reception is available when the
XM button is pressed to access satellite radio
stations unless optional satellite receiver and antenna are installed and an SiriusXM® Satellite
Radio service subscription is active. Satellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.
For additional information, refer to “Audio operation precautions” regarding all operation precautions in this section.
Audio main operation
(power) button / VOL (volume) control knob
Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position
and press the
(power) button while the system is off to call up the mode (radio, CD, AUX,
Bluetooth® audio, USB or iPod®) that was playing
immediately before the system was turned off.
To turn the system off, press the
(power)
button.
Turn the VOL (volume) control knob to adjust the
volume.
This vehicle may be equipped with Speed Sensitive Volume. When this feature is active, the
audio volume changes as the driving speed
changes.
ENTER/SETTING button
Press the ENTER/SETTING button to show the
Settings screen on the display. Turn the TUNESCROLL knob to navigate the options and then
press the ENTER button to make a selection.
Settings
Bluetooth
Bass
Treble
Balance
Fade
Brightness
Contrast
Clock adjust
On-Screen Clock
RDS Display
Speed Sens Vol. (Speed Sensitive Volume)
AUX Vol.
Language select
For additional information on Bluetooth settings, refer to “Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System without Navigation System” in this section.
Adjusts the bass to the desired level.
Adjusts the treble to the desired level.
Adjusts the balance to the desired level. Balance adjusts the sound level between the left and right speakers.
Adjusts the fade to the desired level. Fade adjusts the sound level between the front and rear speakers.
Adjust the brightness to adjust the appearance of the display screen.
Adjust the contrast to adjust the appearance of the display screen.
Press the ENTER/SETTING button to highlight the hours or minutes and then use the TUNE/FOLDER knob to
adjust the value. Press the ENTER/SETTING button again to set the value.
Toggles ON or OFF the clock display on the upper right corner of the display screen.
Toggles ON or OFF the RDS information displayed on the screen while the radio is playing.
Adjusts the speed sensitive volume function, which increases the volume of the audio system as the speed of
the vehicle increases. Set to “OFF” to disable the feature. The higher the setting, the more the volume increases in relation to vehicle speed.
Choose a setting from 0 to +3 to control the boost of incoming auxiliary device volume. A setting of 0 provides
no additional boost in volume. A setting of +3 provides the greatest boost in volume.
Select the desired language for the system from the available options.
Bass, treble, balance and fade can also be adjusted by pressing the ENTER/SETTING button and turning the TUNE-SCROLL control knob to select the item
to adjust. When the desired item is shown on the display, turn the tuning to adjust and then press the ENTER/SETTING button until the display returns to
the main audio screen. If the button is not pressed for approximately 10 seconds, the radio or CD display will automatically reappear.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-39
Apps button
Press the Apps button to launch the Smartphone
Integration Mode. For additional information, refer to “NissanConnectSM Mobile Apps” in this
section regarding this feature.
For additional information, refer to “Bluetooth®
Hands-Free Phone system without Navigation” in
this section regarding connecting your phone.
FM/AM/SAT radio operation
FM·AM button
Press the FM·AM button to change the band as
follows:
AM → FM1 → FM2 → AM
If another audio source is playing when the
FM·AM button is pressed, the audio source playing will automatically be turned off and the last
radio station played will begin playing.
The FM stereo indicator (STEREO) is shown on
the screen during FM stereo reception. When the
stereo broadcast signal is weak, the radio automatically changes from stereo to monaural reception.
XM band select
Press the XM button to change the band as
follows:
XM1* → XM2* → XM3* → XM1
When the XM button is pressed while the ignition
switch is in the ACC or ON position, the radio will
come on at the station last played.
SCAN tuning
Press the SCAN button to stop at each broadcasting station for 5 seconds. SCAN will appear
on the screen while the radio is scan tuning.
The last station played will also come on when
(power) control
the VOL (volume)/
knob/button is pressed on.
*When the XM button is pressed, the satellite
radio reception will not be available unless an
optional satellite receiver and antenna are installed and a SiriusXM® Satellite Radio service
subscription is active. Satellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.
Pressing the button again during this 5 second
period will stop SCAN tuning and the radio will
remain tuned to that station. If the SCAN button is
not pressed within 5 seconds, SCAN tuning
moves to the next station.
If a compact disc is playing when the XM button
is pressed, the compact disc will automatically be
turned off and the last radio station played will
come on.
1. Choose the radio band AM, FM1 or FM2
using the FM·AM select button.
TUNE/SCROLL knob (Tuning)
Turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to the left or right
for manual tuning.
SEEK tuning
Press the
or
SEEK buttons to tune
from low to high or high to low frequencies and to
stop at the next broadcasting station.
4-40 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
1 to 6 Station memory operations
Six stations can be set for the AM band. Twelve
stations can be set for the FM band (six for FM1,
six for FM2).
2. Tune to the desired station using the
SEEK button or the
TRACK button.
Press and hold any of the desired station
memory buttons (1 – 6) until the preset
number is updated on the display and a
beep is heard.
3. Programming is now complete.
4. Other buttons can be set in the same manner.
If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the fuse
opens, the radio memory will be canceled. In that
case, reset the desired stations.
SEEK/TRACK button
Compact disc (CD) player operation
If the radio is already operating, it automatically
turns off and the compact disc begins to play.
MEDIA button
With a CD loaded, press the MEDIA button until
the CD mode is displayed on the screen.
CD/MP3 display mode
While listening to an MP3/WMA CD, certain text
may be displayed on the screen if the CD has
been encoded with text information. Depending
on how the MP3/WMA CD is encoded, information such as Artist, Song and Folder will be displayed.
The track number and the total number of tracks
in the current folder or on the current disc are
displayed on the screen as well.
SEEK/TRACK (Reverse or
Fast Forward) button
Press
and
hold
the
or
SEEK/TRACK button for 1.5 seconds while the
compact disc is playing to reverse or fast forward
the track being played. The compact disc plays at
an increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the compact disc returns to normal play speed.
SEEK/TRACK button while a CD
Press the
or MP3/WMA CD is playing to return to the
beginning of the current track. Press
SEEK/TRACK button several times to
the
skip backward several tracks.
SEEK/TRACK button while a CD
Press the
or MP3/WMA CD is playing to advance one
SEEK/TRACK button sevtrack. Press the
eral times to skip forward several tracks. If the last
track on a CD is skipped, the first track on the
disc is played. If the last track in a folder of an
MP3/WMA CD is skipped, the first track of the
next folder is played.
TUNE/SCROLL knob (MP3/WMA CD only)
If an MP3/WMA CD with multiple folders is playing, turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to change
folders. Turn the knob to the left to skip back a
folder. Turn the knob to the right to skip ahead a
folder.
RPT (repeat) button
When the RPT (repeat) button is pressed while a
compact disc is playing, the play pattern can be
changed as follows:
CD:
1 Track Repeat ←→ OFF
CD with MP3 or WMA:
1 Folder Repeat → 1 Track Repeat → OFF
1 Track Repeat: the current track will be repeated.
1 Folder Repeat: the current folder will be repeated.
OFF: No repeat play pattern is applied. The indicator on the display will turn off.
The current play pattern of the CD is displayed on
the screen unless no pattern is applied.
RDM (random) button
When the RDM (random) button is pressed while
a compact disc is playing, the play pattern can be
changed as follows:
CD:
1 Disc Random ←→ OFF
CD with MP3 or WMA:
1 Disc Random → 1 Folder Random → OFF
1 Disc Random: all tracks on the disc will be
played randomly.
1 Folder Random: all tracks in the current folder
will be played randomly.
OFF: No random play pattern is applied. The
indicator on the display will turn off.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-41
The current play pattern of the CD is displayed on
the screen unless no pattern is applied.
CD EJECT button
When the
CD EJECT button is pressed
with a compact disc loaded, the compact disc
will eject and the last source will be played.
CD EJECT button is pressed
When the
twice with a compact disc loaded, the compact
disc will be ejected further for easier CD removal.
If the disc is not removed within 20 seconds, the
disc will reload.
Additional features
For additional information, refer to “iPod® player
operation without Navigation System” regarding
the iPod® player available with this system in this
section.
For additional information, refer to “USB (Universal Serial Bus) Connection Port (models without
Navigation System)” regarding the USB connection port available with this system in this section.
LHA3205
Front
USB (Universal Serial Bus)
CONNECTION PORT (models
without Navigation System) (if so
equipped)
For additional information, refer to “Bluetooth®
streaming audio without Navigation System”
about the Bluetooth® audio interface available
with this system in this section.
4-42 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
LHA3206
Rear (if so equipped)
Connecting a device to the USB
Connection Port
WARNING
Do not connect, disconnect, or operate the
USB device while driving. Doing so can be
a distraction. If distracted you could lose
control of your vehicle and cause an accident or serious injury.
CAUTION
● To avoid damage and loss of function
when using a USB device, note the following precautions.
● Do not force the USB device into the
USB port. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down into the port may
damage the port. Make sure that the
USB device is connected correctly into
the USB port.
● Do not grab the USB port cover (if so
equipped) when pulling the USB device
out of the port. This could damage the
port and the cover.
● Do not leave the USB cable in a place
where it can be pulled unintentionally.
Pulling the cable may damage the port.
Refer to your device manufacturer’s owner information regarding the proper use and care of the
device.
There are two USB connection ports available in
the vehicle. One is located in the media pocket on
the center console near the cupholders, the other
on the back of the rear center console facing the
rear seats. Insert the USB device into the connection port.
When a compatible storage device is plugged
into the connection port, compatible audio files
on the storage device can be played through the
vehicle’s audio system.
Audio file operation
MEDIA button
Place the ignition switch in the ON or ACC
position and press the MEDIA button to switch to
the USB input mode. If a CD is playing or another
audio source is plugged in through the AUX IN
jack located in the center console, the MEDIA
button toggles between the three sources.
Play information
Information about the audio files being played
can be displayed on the display screen of the
vehicle’s audio system. Depending on how the
audio files are encoded, information such as
Folder, Song and Artist will be displayed.
The track number and number of total tracks in
the folder are displayed on the screen as well.
SEEK/TRACK (Reverse or
Fast Forward) button
Press and hold the SEEK/TRACK button
(rewind) or SEEK/TRACK button
(fast forward) for 1.5 seconds while an audio file on the
USB device is playing to reverse or fast forward
the track being played. The track plays at an
increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the audio file
returns to normal play speed.
SEEK and TRACK buttons
while an audio file
Press the SEEK button
on the USB device is playing to return to the
beginning of the current track. Press the SEEK
several times to skip backward sevbutton
eral tracks.
while an audio
Press the TRACK button
file on the USB device is playing to advance one
several
track. Press the TRACK button
times to skip forward several tracks. If the last
track in a folder on the USB device is skipped, the
first track of the next folder is played.
RDM (random) button
When the RDM (random) button is pressed while
an audio file on the USB device is playing, the
play pattern can be changed as follows:
All Random → 1 Folder Random → OFF
All Random: all tracks on the USB device will be
played randomly.
1 Folder Random: all tracks in the current folder
will be played randomly.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-43
OFF: No random play pattern is applied. The
indicator on the display will turn off.
The current play pattern of the USB device is
displayed on the screen unless no pattern is
applied.
RPT (repeat) button
When the RPT (repeat) button is pressed while
an audio file on the USB device is playing, the
play pattern can be changed as follows:
TUNE/SCROLL knob
If there are multiple folders with audio files on the
USB device, turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to
change folders. Turn the knob to the left to skip
back a folder. Turn the knob to the right to skip
ahead a folder. If there is only one folder of audio
files on the USB device, turning the
TUNE/SCROLL knob in either direction will return to the first track on the USB device.
1 Folder Repeat → 1 Track Repeat → OFF
1 Track Repeat: the current track will be repeated.
1 Folder Repeat: the current folder will be repeated.
OFF: No repeat play pattern is applied. The indicator on the display will turn off.
The current play pattern of the USB device is
displayed on the screen unless no pattern is
applied.
LHA3205
iPod®* PLAYER OPERATION
WITHOUT NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if
so equipped)
Connecting iPod®
WARNING
Do not connect, disconnect, or operate the
USB device while driving. Doing so can be
a distraction. If distracted you could lose
control of your vehicle and cause an accident or serious injury.
4-44 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
CAUTION
● Do not force the USB device into the
USB port. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down into the port may
damage the port. Make sure that the
USB device is connected correctly into
the USB port.
● Do not grab the USB port cover (if so
equipped) when pulling the USB device
out of the port. This could damage the
port and the cover.
● Do not leave the USB cable in a place
where it can be pulled unintentionally.
Pulling the cable may damage the port.
Refer to your device manufacturer’s owner information regarding the proper use and care of the
device.
To connect an iPod® to the vehicle so that the
iPod® can be controlled with the audio system
controls and display screen, use the USB connection port located on the center console near
the cupholders, or the other on the back of the
rear center console facing the rear seats. Connect the iPod®-specific end of the cable to the
iPod® and the USB end of the cable to the USB
connection port on the vehicle. If your iPod®
supports charging via a USB connection, its bat-
tery will be charged while connected to the vehicle with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON
position.
While connected to the vehicle, the iPod® can
only be operated by the vehicle audio controls.
To disconnect the iPod® from the vehicle, remove the USB end of the cable from the USB
connection port on the vehicle, then remove the
cable from the iPod®.
* iPod® is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in
the U.S. and other countries.
Compatibility
The following models are compatible:
● iPod® Classic - 5th Generation (firmware
version 1.3.0 or later)
● iPod® Classic - 6th Generation (firmware
version 2.0.1 or later)
● iPod® Classic - 7th Generation (firmware
version 2.0.4 or later)
● iPod® nano - 1st generation (firmware version 1.3.1 or later)
● iPod® nano - 2nd generation (firmware version 1.1.3 or later)
● iPod® nano - 3rd generation (firmware version 1.1.3 or later)
● iPod® nano - 4th generation (firmware version 1.0.4 or later)
● iPod® nano - 5th generation (firmware version 1.0.2 or later)
● iPod® nano - 6th generation (firmware version 1.1 or later)
● iPod® Touch - 2nd generation (firmware
version 4.2.1 or later)
● iPod® Touch - 3rd generation (firmware version 5.1 or later) (minimum iOS 5.0 required
for smartphone integration)
● iPod® Touch - 4th generation (firmware version 5.1 or later) (minimum iOS 5.0 required
for smartphone integration)
● iPhone® 3G (firmware version 4.2.1 or later)
● iPhone® 3GS (firmware version 5.1 or later)
(minimum iOS 5.0 required for smartphone
integration)
● iPhone® 4 (firmware version 5.1 or later)
(minimum iOS 5.0 required for smartphone
integration)
● iPhone® 4S (firmware version 5.1 or later)
(minimum iOS 5.0 required for smartphone
integration)
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-45
● iPhone®5 (firmware version 5.1 or later)
(minimum iOS 5.0 required for smartphone
integration)
Make sure that your iPod® firmware is updated to
the version indicated above.
NOTE:
Apple certified USB cables are supported.
Some aftermarket cables may not be supported.
while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the track returns to normal play
speed.
BACK button
REPEAT (RPT)
BLUETOOTH® STREAMING AUDIO
WITHOUT NAVIGATION SYSTEM
When the RPT button is pressed while a track is
being played, the play pattern can be changed as
follows:
Repeat Off → 1 Track Repeat → All Repeat →
Repeat Off
Audio main operation
1 Track Repeat: the current track will be repeated.
Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON
position. Press the MEDIA button repeatedly to
switch to the iPod® mode.
All Repeat: all songs in the current list are repeated.
If the system has been turned off while the iPod®
control
was playing, pressing the VOL/
knob will start the iPod®.
RANDOM (RDM)
SEEK/TRACK buttons
Press the
SEEK button or
TRACK
button to skip backward or forward one track.
SEEK button or
Press and hold the
TRACK button for 1.5 seconds while a track is
playing to reverse or fast forward the track being
played. The track plays at an increased speed
Repeat Off: no repeat play pattern is applied.
When the RDM button is pressed while a track is
being played, the play pattern can be changed as
follows:
Shuffle Off → Track Shuffle → Album Shuffle →
Shuffle Off
Track Shuffle: the tracks in the current list will be
played randomly.
Album Shuffle: the albums in the current list will
be played randomly.
Shuffle Off: no random play pattern is applied.
4-46 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
When the BACK button is pressed, it returns to
the previous menu.
If you have a compatible Bluetooth® audio device that is capable of playing audio files, the
device can be connected to the vehicle’s audio
system so that the audio files on the device play
through the vehicle’s speakers.
5. The system will display a PIN on the screen
and request confirmation that it matches the
one on the handset.
6. Using the menu control switch on the steering wheel, select “Yes” and then press
button. If the PIN does not match,
the
the wrong device may have been selected
on the handset.
NOTE:
LHA2775
Connecting Bluetooth® audio
To connect your Bluetooth® audio device to the
vehicle, follow the procedure below:
1. Press the ENTER/SETTING button.
2. Select “Bluetooth”.
3. Select “Add Phone or Device”. This same
screen can be accessed to remove, replace
or select a different Bluetooth® device.
4. The system acknowledges the command
and asks you to initiate connecting from the
phone handset.
The connecting procedure of the cellular
phone varies according to each cellular
phone model. For additional information,
refer to the cellular phone Owner’s Manual.
You can also visit www.nissanusa.com/
bluetooth or www.nissan.ca/bluetooth for
instructions on connecting NISSAN recommended cellular phones.
Audio main operation
To switch to the Bluetooth® audio mode, press
the MEDIA button repeatedly until the
Bluetooth® audio mode is displayed on the
screen.
The controls for the Bluetooth® audio are displayed on the screen. Use the Preset 3 button for
play and the Preset 4 button for pause.
LHA0049
CD CARE AND CLEANING
● Handle a CD by its edges. Do not bend the
disc. Never touch the surface of the disc.
● Always place the discs in the storage case
when they are not being used.
● To clean a disc, wipe the surface from the
center to the outer edge using a clean, soft
cloth. Do not wipe the disc using a circular
motion.
● Do not use a conventional record cleaner or
alcohol intended for industrial use.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-47
● A new disc may be rough on the inner and
outer edges. Remove the rough edges by
rubbing the inner and outer edges with the
side of a pen or pencil as illustrated.
* These modes are only available when compatible media storage is inserted into the device or
connected to the system.
Volume control buttons
Push the volume control buttons to increase or
decrease the volume.
Menu control
switch/OK button
LHA3204
1.
menu control switch/OK button
2. SOURCE button
3. Volume control buttons
STEERING WHEEL SWITCH FOR
AUDIO CONTROL
SOURCE select switch
With the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position, push the SOURCE switch to turn the audio
system on.
Push the source select switch to change the
mode in the following sequence:
AM → FM → XM → USB/iPod®*→ Bluetooth®
Audio* → AUX* → AM.
4-48 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
While the display is showing a map or audio
screen, tilt the Menu Control switch upward or
downward to select a station, track, CD or folder.
For most audio sources, tilting the switch
up/down for more than 1.5 seconds provides a
different function than a tilting up/down for less
than 1.5 seconds.
AM and FM
● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the preset station.
● Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to
seek up or down to the next station.
● Press the OK button to show the list of
preset stations.
NISSANCONNECTSM MOBILE APPS
XM
USB
● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the preset station.
● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the track number.
● Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to
go to the next or previous channel.
● Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the folder number.
● Press the OK button to show the XM Menu.
● Press the OK button to show the USB Menu.
This vehicle is equipped with NissanConnectSM
Mobile Apps. This allows many compatible
Smartphone applications to be displayed and
easily controlled through the vehicle’s audio system.
NOTE:
● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the track number.
● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to
skip ahead or back to the next song.
A compatible smartphone and registration
is required to use mobile applications or to
access connected features of certain vehicle applications.
● Press the OK button to show the iPod Menu.
● Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to
reverse or fast forward the current song.
REGISTERING NISSANCONNECTSM
MOBILE APPS
iPod®
CD
● Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the track number.
● Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the folder number (if
playing compressed audio files).
● Press the OK button to show the CD Menu.
Bluetooth® Audio
AUX
● Press the OK button to show the AUX Menu.
To use the NissanConnectSM Mobile Apps feature, it is necessary for the user to register. In
order to register, visit the NissanConnectSM
website,
www.nissanusa.com/connect/
or
https://canada.nissanconnect.com (For Canada).
Once registered, download the NissanConnectSM App from the App Store or Google
Play Store and then log into the application. If you
already have a NISSAN Owner Portal Account,
then you can use this login information to access
the app.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-49
CAR PHONE OR CB RADIO
CONNECT PHONE
To use this feature, a compatible smartphone
must be connected via Bluetooth® or USB to the
vehicle. For additional information, refer to
“Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System without
Navigation System” regarding connecting your
phone in this section.
terface. For additional information on application
availability visit www.nissanusa.com/connect/ or
www.canada.nissanconnect.com
NOTE:
Apple iPhone can be paired via Bluetooth®
for NissanConnectSM Apps to function.
NOTE:
Apple certified cables are supported and
some aftermarket cables may not function
correctly with the USB port.
APPLICATION DOWNLOAD
Once connected, the NissanConnectSM App will
search your phone to determine which compatible applications are currently installed. The user
will then choose which apps they want to bring
into their vehicle from the list of apps within the
“Manage My Apps” section of the NissanConnectSM App on their smartphone. The vehicle
will then download the in-vehicle interface for
each of these compatible applications. Once
downloaded, the user can access their selected
smartphone applications through the vehicle in-
4-50 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
When installing a CB, ham radio or car phone in
your vehicle, be sure to observe the following
precautions; otherwise, the new equipment may
adversely affect the engine control system and
other electronic parts.
WARNING
● A cellular phone should not be used for
any purpose while driving so full attention may be given to vehicle operation.
Some jurisdictions prohibit the use of
cellular phones while driving.
● If you must make a call while your vehicle is in motion, the hands free cellular phone operational mode is highly
recommended. Exercise extreme caution at all times so full attention may be
given to vehicle operation.
● If you are unable to devote full attention
to vehicle operation while talking on
the phone, pull off the road to a safe
location and stop your vehicle.
BLUETOOTH® HANDS-FREE PHONE
SYSTEM WITHOUT NAVIGATION
SYSTEM (if so equipped)
CAUTION
● Keep the antenna as far away as possible from the electronic control
modules.
● Keep the antenna wire more than 8 in
(20 cm) away from the electronic control
system harnesses. Do not route the antenna wire next to any harness.
● Adjust the antenna standing-wave ratio
as recommended by the manufacturer.
● Connect the ground wire from the CB
radio chassis to the body.
● For details, consult a NISSAN dealer.
WARNING
● Use a phone after stopping your vehicle
in a safe location. If you have to use a
phone while driving, exercise extreme
caution at all times so full attention may
be given to vehicle operation.
● If you are unable to devote full attention
to vehicle operation while talking on
the phone, pull off the road to a safe
location and stop your vehicle.
CAUTION
To avoid discharging the vehicle battery,
use a phone after starting the engine.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-51
phone module when the ignition switch is placed
in the ON position with the previously connected
cellular phone turned on and carried in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Some devices require the user to accept
connections to other Bluetooth® devices. If
your phone does not connect automatic
ally to the system, consult the phone’s
Owner’s Manual for details on device operation.
You can connect up to five different Bluetooth®
cellular phones to the in-vehicle phone module.
However, you can talk on only one cellular phone
at a time.
Before using the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone
System, refer to the following notes.
LHA3199
Your NISSAN is equipped with the Bluetooth®
Hands-Free Phone System. If you have a compatible Bluetooth® enabled cellular phone, you
can set up the wireless connection between your
cellular phone and the in-vehicle phone module.
With Bluetooth® wireless technology, you can
make or receive a hands-free telephone call with
your cellular phone in the vehicle.
Once your cellular phone is connected to the
in-vehicle phone module, no other phone connecting procedure is required. Your phone is
automatically connected with the in-vehicle
4-52 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
● Set up the wireless connection between a
compatible cellular phone and the in-vehicle
phone module before using the hands-free
phone system.
● Some Bluetooth® enabled cellular phones
may not be recognized or work properly.
Please visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth
or www.nissan.ca/bluetooth for a recommended phone list and connecting instructions.
● You will not be able to use a hands-free
phone under the following conditions:
– Your vehicle is outside of the cellular service area.
– Your vehicle is in an area where it is
difficult to receive a cellular signal; such
as in a tunnel, in an underground parking
garage, near a tall building or in a mountainous area.
– Your cellular phone is locked to prevent it
from being dialed.
● When the radio wave condition is not ideal
or ambient sound is too loud, it may be
difficult to hear the other person’s voice during a call.
● For additional information, refer to “Troubleshooting guide” in this section if the handsfree phone system seems to be malfunctioning.
● Some cellular phones or other devices may
cause interference or a buzzing noise to
come from the audio system speakers. Storing the device in a different location may
reduce or eliminate the noise.
● For additional information, refer to the cellular phone Owner’s Manual regarding the
telephone charges, cellular phone antenna
and body, etc.
REGULATORY INFORMATION
FCC Regulatory information
● Do not place the cellular phone in an area
surrounded by metal or far away from the
in-vehicle phone module to prevent tone
quality degradation and wireless connection
disruption.
– CAUTION: To maintain compliance with
FCC’s RF exposure guidelines, use only the
supplied antenna. Unauthorized antenna,
modification, or attachments could damage
the transmitter and may violate FCC regulations.
● While a cellular phone is connected through
the Bluetooth® wireless connection, the
battery power of the cellular phone may discharge quicker than usual. The Bluetooth®
Hands-Free Phone System cannot charge
cellular phones.
– Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
IC Regulatory information
– Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference, including interference that may
cause undesired operation of the device.
– This Class B digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian InterferenceCausing Equipment Regulations.
BLUETOOTH® is a
trademark owned by
Bluetooth SIG, Inc.
and licensed to
Visteon.
USING THE SYSTEM
The NISSAN Voice Recognition system allows
hands-free operation of the Bluetooth® HandsFree Phone System.
If the vehicle is in motion, some commands may
not be available so full attention may be given to
vehicle operation.
1. This device may not cause interference and
2. this device must accept any interference,
including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-53
Initialization
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, NISSAN Voice Recognition is initialized,
button is
which takes a few seconds. If the
pressed before the initialization completes, the
system will announce “Hands-free phone system
not ready” and will not react to voice commands.
Operating tips
To get the best performance out of the NISSAN
Voice Recognition system, observe the following:
● Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as
possible. Close the windows to eliminate
surrounding noises (traffic noises, vibration
sounds, etc.), which may prevent the system
from recognizing voice commands correctly.
● Wait until the beep sounds before speaking
a command. Otherwise, the command will
not be received properly.
● Start speaking a command within 5 seconds
after the beep sounds.
● Speak in a natural voice without pausing
between words.
Giving voice commands
To operate NISSAN Voice Recognition (VR),
button located on
press and release the
the steering wheel. After the beep sounds, speak
a command.
The command given is picked up by the microphone, and voice feedback is given when the
command is accepted.
● If you need to hear the available commands
for the current menu again, say “Help” and
the system will repeat them.
● If a command is not recognized, the system
announces, “Command not recognized.
Please try again.” Make sure the command is
said exactly as prompted by the system and
repeat the command in a clear voice.
● If you want to go back to the previous command, you can say “Go back” or “Correction” any time the system is waiting for a
response.
4-54 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
● You can cancel a command when the system is waiting for a response by saying,
“Cancel” or “Quit.” The system announces
“Cancel” and ends the Voice Recognition
session. You can also press and hold
button on the steering wheel for
the
5 seconds at any time to end the VR session.
Whenever the VR session is cancelled, a
double beep is played to indicate you have
exited the system.
● If you want to adjust the volume of the voice
feedback, press the volume control switches
(+ or -) on the steering wheel while being
provided with feedback. You can also use
the radio volume control knob.
Voice Prompt Interrupt
In most cases you can interrupt the voice feedback to speak the next command by pressing
button on the steering wheel. After
the
interrupting the system, wait for a beep before
speaking your command.
One Shot Call
To use the system faster, you may speak the
second level commands with the main menu
command on the main menu. For example, press
button and after the beep say, “Call
the
Redial”.
You can also use the
button
to interrupt the system feedback
and give a command at once. For
additional information, refer to
“Voice commands” and “During a
call” in this section.
LHA3194
CONTROL BUTTONS
The control buttons for the Bluetooth® HandsFree Phone System are located on the steering
wheel.
PHONE/SEND
Press the
button to initiate
a VR session or answer an incoming call.
PHONE/END
While the voice recognition system is active, press and hold
the
button for 5 seconds to
quit the voice recognition system
at any time.
LHA2775
CONNECTING PROCEDURE
Tuning switch
While using the voice recognition
system, tilt the tuning switch up or
down to manually control the
phone system.
NOTE:
The connecting procedure must be performed when the vehicle is stationary. If the
vehicle starts moving during the procedure,
the procedure will be cancelled.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-55
To connect a phone to the Bluetooth® HandsFree Phone System:
1. Press the SETTING button.
2. Use the TUNE/SCROLL knob to select
“Bluetooth” and then press the ENTER button.
Menu Item
Bluetooth ON/OFF
On
Off
Add Phone
Result
Allows user to switch Bluetooth® on and off. Bluetooth® must be turned on in order to connect device.
Turns Bluetooth® functionality on.
Turns Bluetooth® functionality off.
Upon pressing this button, a message with a PIN appears on the screen. Operate the Bluetooth® phone to enter the PIN and complete the
connection process.
Once a phone is connected, additional options will be displayed.
Menu Item
Replace Phone
Select Phone
Phonebook download
Show Incoming Calls
Result
Replace the phone currently connected to the system. This option allows the user to keep any voicetags that were recorded using the previous phone if vehicle is equipped with voice recognition.
Choose a phone a list of previously connected or currently connected phones.
Adds the connected phone’s contacts to the vehicle phonebook.
Displays a list of the connected phone’s incoming calls.
The connecting procedure varies according to each phone. For additional information, refer to the phone’s Owner’s Manual for details. You can also visit
www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth or www.nissan.ca/bluetooth. You can also call the NISSAN Consumer Affairs Department for instructions on connecting
recommended cellular phones.
4-56 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
VOICE COMMANDS
Voice commands can be used to operate the
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System. Press
button and say “Phone” to bring up the
the
phone command menu. The available options
are:
● Call
● Phonebook
● Recent Calls
● Messaging (if available)
● Show Applications (if available)
● Select Phone or Device
“Call”
For additional information on the “Call” command, refer to “Making a call” in this section.
“Phonebook”
The following commands are available under
“Phonebook”:
● (a name)
Say a name in the phonebook to bring up a
list of options for that phonebook entry. The
system will say the name it interpreted based
on the voice command provided. If the name
is incorrect, say “Correction” to hear another
name.
Once the correct phonebook entry is identified, say “Dial” to dial the number or “Send
Text” to send a text message to that number.
Say “Record Name” to record a name for the
phonebook entry. Say “Delete Recording” to
delete a recorded name for the phonebook
entry.
● List Names
Speak this command to have the system list
the names in the phonebook one by one
alphabetically. Say “Dial” to dial the number
of the current name or “Send Text” to send a
text message to that number. Say “Next Entry” or “Previous Entry” to move through the
list alphabetically. Say “Record Name” to
record a name for the current phonebook
entry. Say “Delete Recording” to delete a
recorded name for the current phonebook
entry.
“Recent Calls”
The following commands are available under
“Recent Calls”:
● Incoming Calls
Speak this command to list the last five
incoming calls to the vehicle. If the call is
from an entry in the phonebook, the name
will be displayed. Otherwise, the phone
number of the incoming call will be displayed.
Say “Dial” to call the number or “Send Text”
to send a text message to that number. Say
“Next Entry” or “Previous Entry” to move
through the list of incoming calls.
● Missed Calls
Speak this command to list the last five
missed calls to the vehicle. If the call is from
an entry in the phonebook, the name will be
displayed. Otherwise, the phone number of
the missed call will be displayed.
Say “Dial” to call the number or “Send Text”
to send a text message to that number. Say
“Next Entry” or “Previous Entry” to move
through the list of missed calls.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-57
● Outgoing Calls
Speak this command to list the last five
outgoing calls from the vehicle. If the call
was to an entry in the phonebook, the name
will be displayed. Otherwise, the phone
number of the outgoing call will be displayed.
Say “Dial” to call the number or “Send Text”
to send a text message to that number. Say
“Next Entry” or “Previous Entry” to move
through the list of outgoing calls.
● Redial
Speak this command to call the last number
dialed.
● Call Back
Speak this command to call the number of
the last incoming call to the vehicle.
NOTE:
Compatible smartphone and registration
necessary to access applications. For additional information, refer to “NissanConnectSM Mobile Apps” in this section.
“Select Phone”
Speak this command to select a phone to use
from a list of those phones connected to the
vehicle.
MAKING A CALL
To make a call from a phone connected to the
vehicle’s Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System:
1. Press the
wheel.
button on the steering
“Messaging”
2. The system will prompt you for a command.
Say “Call”.
Speak this command to access text messaging
functions. For additional information on these
commands, refer to “Text messaging” in this section.
3. Select one of the available voice commands
to continue:
“Show Applications”
Speak this command to display list of smartphone apps available.
● “(A Name)” — Speak the name of a phonebook entry to place a call to that entry. The
system will respond with the name it interpreted from your command and will prompt
you to confirm that the name is correct. Say
“Yes” to initiate the call or “No” to hear another name from the phonebook.
4-58 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
● “Phone Number” — Speak this command to
place a call by inputting numbers. For 7– to
10–digit phone number, speak the numbers.
Say “Correction” at any time in the process
to correct a misspoken or misinterpreted
number. For phone numbers with more digits or special characters, say “Special Number”, then speak the digits. Up to 24 digits
can be entered. Available special characters
are “start”, “pound”, “plus”, and “pause”.
When finished, say “Dial” to initiate the call.
Say “Correction” at any time in the process
to correct a misspoken or misinterpreted
number or character.
● “Redial” – Speak this command to dial the
number of the last outgoing call. The system
will display “Re-dialing <name/number>”.
The name of the phonebook entry will be
displayed if it available, otherwise the number being re-dialed will be displayed.
● “Call Back” – Speak this command to dial
the number of the last incoming call. The
system will display “Calling back
<name/number>”. The name of the phonebook entry will be displayed if it available,
otherwise the number being called back will
be displayed.
RECEIVING A CALL
When a call is received by the phone connected
to the vehicle’s Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone
System, the call information is displayed on either
the vehicle information display or both the vehicle
information display and he control panel display.
button to accept the call. Press
Press the
the
button to reject the call.
DURING A CALL
While a call is active, press the
button to
access additional options. Speak one of the following commands:
● “Send” – Speak this command followed by
the digits to enter digits during the phone
call.
● “Mute On” or “Mute Off” – Speak the command to mute or unmute the system.
● “Transfer Call” – Speak this command to
transfer the call to the handset. To transfer
the call back from the handset to the
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System,
button and confirm when
press the
prompted.
If supported by the phone, the Bluetooth®
Hands-Free Phone System allows for call waiting
functionality. If a call is received while another call
is already active, a message will be displayed on
button to hold the
the screen. Press the
active call and switch to the second call. Press
button to reject the second call.
the
While the second call is active, pressing
the
button will allow the same commands
that are available during any call and two additional commands:
● “Switch Call” – Speak this command to hold
the second call and switch back to the original call.
● “End Other Call” – Speak this command to
stay with the second call and end the original
call.
button to accept the call. Press
Press the
button to reject the call.
the
ENDING A CALL
To end an active call, press the
button.
TEXT MESSAGING (if so equipped)
WARNING
● Laws in some jurisdictions may restrict
the use of “Text-to-Speech.” Check local regulations before using the
feature.
● Laws in some jurisdictions may restrict
the use of some of the applications and
features, such as social networking and
texting. Check local regulations for any
requirements.
● Use the text messaging feature after
stopping your vehicle in a safe location.
If you have to use the feature while
driving, exercise extreme caution at all
times so full attention may be given to
vehicle operation.
● If you are unable to devote full attention
to vehicle operation while using the text
messaging feature, pull off the road to a
safe location and stop your vehicle.
NOTE:
This feature is automatically disabled if the
connected device does not support the Message Access Profile (MAP). For additional
information, refer to the phone’s Owner’s
Manual for details and instructions or visit
www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth
or
www.nissan.ca/bluetooth for additional information on phone compatibility.
The system allows for the sending and receiving
of text messages through the vehicle interface.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-59
Sending a text message:
1. Press the
button.
2. Say “Messaging”.
3. Say “Send Text”.
4. The system will provide a list of available
commands in order to determine the recipient of the text message. Choose from the
following:
5. Once a recipient is chosen, the system
prompts for which message to send. Five
predefined messages are available and
three custom messages. To choose one of
the predefined messages, speak one of the
following:
● “Driving, can’t text”
● “Call me”
● “On my way”
● (A name)
● “Running late”
● Number
● “Okay”
● Incoming Calls
● Outgoing Calls
● Missed Calls
If “Incoming Calls”, “Outgoing Calls”, or
“Missed Calls” is selected, the following additional commands will be displayed:
● Send Text
To send one of the custom messages, say
“Custom Message”. If more than one custom message is stored, the system will
prompt for the number of the desired custom message. For additional information on
setting and managing custom text messages, refer to “Bluetooth® settings” in this
section.
Reading a received text message:
● Next Entry
1. Press the
● Previous Entry
2. Say “Messaging”.
For additional information about these options, refer to “Voice commands” in this section.
button.
3. Say “Read Text”.
The text message, sender and delivery time are
shown on the screen. Use the tuning switch on
the steering wheel to scroll through all text mes-
4-60 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
sages if more than one are available. Press
button to exit the text message screen.
the
Press the
button to access the following
options for replying to the text message:
● Call Back
Speak this command to call the sender of
the text message using the Bluetooth®
Hands-Free Phone System.
● Send Text
Speak this command to send a text message
response to the sender of the text message.
● Read Text
Speak this command to read the text message again.
● Previous Text
Speak this command to move to the previous text message (if available).
● Next Text
Speak this command to move to the next text
message (if available).
NOTE:
Text messages are only displayed if the
vehicle speed is less than 5 mph (8 km/h).
● Delete Phone
Select to delete a phone from the displayed
list. The system will ask to confirm before
deleting the phone.
● Replace Phone
Select to replace a phone from the displayed
list. When a selection is made, the system
will ask to confirm before proceeding. The
recorded phonebook for the phone being
deleted will be saved as long as the new
phone’s phonebook is the same as the old
phone’s phonebook.
LHA3540
BLUETOOTH® SETTINGS
To access and adjust the settings for the
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System:
1. Press the SETTING button.
● Select Phone
Select to connect to a previously connected
phone from the displayed list.
● Phonebook Download
Select to turn on or off the automatic download of a connected phone’s phonebook.
● Bluetooth
Select “On” or “Off” to turn the vehicle’s
Bluetooth® system on or off.
● Show Incoming Calls
Select “Driver Only” to have incoming call
information displayed only in the vehicle information display. Select “Both” to have incoming call information displayed in both the
vehicle information display and the center
display screen.
● Add Phone
For additional information, refer to “Connecting procedure” in this section.
● Text Message (if so equipped)
Select to turn on or off the vehicle’s text
messaging feature.
2. Use the TUNE/SCROLL knob to select
“Bluetooth” and then press the ENTER button:
● New Text Sound (if so equipped)
Select to adjust the volume of the sound that
plays when a new text is received by a phone
connected to the Bluetooth® Hands-Free
Phone System. The setting all the way to the
left indicates that the new text sound will be
muted.
● Show Incoming Text (if so equipped)
Select “Driver Only” to have incoming text
messages displayed only in the vehicle information display. Select “Both” to have incoming text messages displayed in both the vehicle information display and the center
display screen. Select “None” to have no
display of incoming text messages.
● Edit Custom Messages (if so equipped)
Select to set a custom message that will be
available with the standard options when
sending a text message. To set a custom
message, send a text message to your own
phone number while the phone is connected
to the system. Three custom messages can
be set. Custom messages can only be set
while the vehicle is stationary.
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-61
● Auto Reply (if so equipped)
Select to turn on or off the Auto Reply function. When enabled, the vehicle will automatically send a predefined text message to
the sender when a text message is received
while driving.
● Auto Reply Message (if so equipped)
Select to choose the message that is sent
when the Auto Reply function is enabled.
Choose from “I’m Driving” or one of the three
custom messages stored in the system.
The manual control mode does not allow dialing a
phone number by digits. The user may select an
entry from the Phonebook or Recent Calls lists.
To reactivate Voice Recognition, exit the manual
control mode by pressing and holding the
) button. At that time, pressPHONE/END (
ing the PHONE/SEND (
) button will start
the Hands Free Phone System.
● Vehicle Signature On/Off (if so equipped)
Select to choose whether or not the vehicle
signature is added to outgoing text messages from the vehicle. This message cannot be changed or customized.
MANUAL CONTROL
While using the Voice Recognition system, it is
possible to select menu options by using the
steering wheel controls instead of speaking voice
commands. To activate manual control mode,
) button on the
press the PHONE/SEND (
steering wheel to access the phone menu and
then press either up or down on the tuning switch
).
(
4-62 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems
MEMO
Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-63
5 Starting and driving
Precautions when starting and driving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Exhaust gas (carbon monoxide) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Three-way catalyst. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). . . . . . . . . . 5-3
On-pavement and off-road driving
precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
Avoiding collision and rollover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
Off-road recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
Rapid air pressure loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
Drinking alcohol/drugs and driving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8
Driving safety precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8
Push-Button Ignition Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
Operating range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
Push-button ignition switch positions . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12
Emergency engine shut off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13
NISSAN Intelligent Key® battery discharge. . . . . . . 5-13
NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14
Before starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14
Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14
Remote start (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15
Driving the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15
Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) . . . . . . . . 5-15
Parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20
Blind Spot Warning (BSW) System
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21
Blind spot warning (BSW) system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21
BSW system operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22
BSW system precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23
BSW driving situations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24
Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA) system
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-27
RCTA system operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-28
RCTA system precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-29
Radar maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-32
Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-33
Precautions on cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-33
Cruise control operations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-33
Intelligent Cruise Control (ICC) system
(full speed range) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-34
ICC system precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-35
ICC operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-37
Predictive Forward Collision Warning system
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-49
System operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-49
Forward Emergency Braking system
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-55
System operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-56
Driver Attention Alert (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-59
Driver Attention Alert operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-60
Turning the Driver Attention Alert system on
and off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-61
Driver Attention Alert limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-61
System malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-62
Break-in schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-62
Fuel efficient driving tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-63
Increasing fuel economy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-64
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-64
Parking/parking on hills. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-67
Power steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-68
Brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-68
Brake precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-68
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-69
Brake assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-70
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-70
Hill Start Assist system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-72
Cold weather driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-73
Freeing a frozen door lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-73
Antifreeze. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-73
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-73
Draining of coolant water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-73
Tire equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-73
Special winter equipment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-73
Driving on snow or ice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-73
Engine block heater (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-74
PRECAUTIONS WHEN STARTING
AND DRIVING
WARNING
● Do not leave children or adults who
would normally require the assistance
of others alone in your vehicle. Pets
should also not be left alone. They
could accidentally injure themselves or
others through inadvertent operation of
the vehicle. Also, on hot, sunny days,
temperatures in a closed vehicle could
quickly become high enough to cause
severe or possibly fatal injuries to
people or animals.
● Properly secure all cargo with ropes or
straps to help prevent it from sliding or
shifting. Do not place cargo higher than
the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause
personal injury.
● Exceeding the roof rack capacity can
change the vehicle’s center of gravity
and adversely affect the handling and
stability of the vehicle resulting in an
accident causing death or serious
injury.
EXHAUST GAS (carbon monoxide)
WARNING
● Do not breathe exhaust gases; they
contain colorless and odorless carbon
monoxide. Carbon monoxide is dangerous. It can cause unconsciousness or
death.
● If you suspect that exhaust fumes are
entering the vehicle, drive with all windows fully open, and have the vehicle
inspected immediately.
● Do not run the engine in closed spaces
such as a garage.
● Do not park the vehicle with the engine
running for any extended length of time.
● Keep the lift gate and rear vent windows
closed while driving, otherwise exhaust
gases could be drawn into the passenger compartment. If you must drive with
the liftgate or rear vent windows open,
follow these precautions:
1. Open all the windows.
air recirculation but2. Set the
ton to off and the fan control dial to
high to circulate the air.
5-2 Starting and driving
● If electrical wiring or other cable connections must pass to a trailer through
the seal on the liftgate or the body,
follow the manufacturer’s recommendation to prevent carbon monoxide entry into the vehicle.
● The exhaust system and body should be
inspected by a qualified mechanic
whenever:
a. The vehicle is raised for service.
b. You suspect that exhaust fumes are
entering
into
the
passenger
compartment.
c. You notice a change in the sound of
the exhaust system.
d. You have had an accident involving
damage to the exhaust system, underbody, or rear of the vehicle.
THREE-WAY CATALYST
The three-way catalyst is an emission control
device installed in the exhaust system. Exhaust
gases in the three-way catalyst are burned at
high temperatures to help reduce pollutants.
WARNING
● The exhaust gas and the exhaust system are very hot. Keep people, animals
or flammable materials away from the
exhaust system components.
● Do not stop or park the vehicle over
flammable materials such as dry grass,
waste paper or rags. They may ignite
and cause a fire.
CAUTION
● Do not use leaded gasoline. Deposits
from leaded gasoline will seriously reduce the three-way catalyst’s ability to
help reduce exhaust pollutants.
● Keep your engine tuned up. Malfunctions in the ignition, fuel injection, or
electrical systems can cause overrich
fuel flow into the three-way catalyst,
causing it to overheat. Do not keep driving if the engine misfires, or if noticeable loss of performance or other unusual
operating
conditions
are
detected. Have the vehicle inspected
promptly by a NISSAN dealer.
● Avoid driving with an extremely low fuel
level. Running out of fuel could cause
the engine to misfire, damaging the
three-way catalyst.
● Do not race the engine while warming it
up.
● Do not push or tow your vehicle to start
the engine.
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING
SYSTEM (TPMS)
Each tire, including the spare (if provided),
should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by
the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard
or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has
tires of a different size than the size indicated on
the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label,
you should determine the proper tire inflation
pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been
equipped with a TPMS that illuminates a low tire
pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is
significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when
the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you
should stop and check all four tires as soon as
possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure.
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire
causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire
failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the
vehicle’s handling and stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for
proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s
responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure,
even if under-inflation has not reached the level to
trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure
telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a
TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the
system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire
pressure telltale. When the system detects a
malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously
illuminated. This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When the malfunction indicator is
illuminated, the system may not be able to detect
or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS
malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons,
including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent
the TPMS from functioning properly. Always
check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to
ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and
wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function
properly.
Starting and driving 5-3
Additional information:
● The TPMS does not monitor the tire
pressure of the spare tire.
● The TPMS will activate only when the vehicle
is driven at speeds above 16 MPH
(25 km/h). Also, this system may not detect a
sudden drop in tire pressure (for example a
flat tire while driving).
● The low tire pressure warning light does not
automatically turn off when the tire pressure
is adjusted. After the tire is inflated to the
recommended pressure, the vehicle must be
driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h)
to activate the TPMS and turn off the low tire
pressure warning light. Use a tire pressure
gauge to check the tire pressure.
● The “Tire Pressure Low Add Air” warning
appears in the vehicle information display
when the low tire pressure warning light is
illuminated and low tire pressure is detected.
The “Tire Pressure Low Add Air” warning
turns off when the low tire pressure warning
light turns off.
● The “Tire Pressure Low Add Air” warning
appears each time the ignition switch is
placed in the ON position as long as the low
tire pressure warning light remains illuminated.
5-4 Starting and driving
● The “Tire Pressure Low Add Air” warning
does not appear if the low tire pressure
warning light illuminates to indicate a TPMS
malfunction.
● Tire pressure rises and falls depending on
the heat caused by the vehicle’s operation
and the outside temperature. Low outside
temperature can lower the temperature of
the air inside the tire which can cause a
lower tire inflation pressure. This may cause
the low tire pressure warning light to illuminate. If the warning light illuminates, check
the tire pressure for all four tires.
● The Tire and Loading Information label (also
referred to as the vehicle placard or tire
inflation pressure label) is located in the
driver’s door opening.
● You can also check the pressure of all tires
(except the spare tire) on the vehicle information display screen. The order of the tire
pressure figures displayed on the screen
corresponds with the actual order of the tire
position.
For additional information, refer to “Low tire pressure warning light” in the “Instruments and controls” section and “Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)” in the “In case of emergency”
section of this manual.
WARNING
● Radio waves could adversely affect
electric medical equipment. Those who
use a pacemaker should contact the
electric medical equipment manufacturer for the possible influences before
use.
● If the low tire pressure warning light
illuminates while driving, avoid sudden
steering maneuvers or abrupt braking,
reduce vehicle speed, pull off the road
to a safe location and stop the vehicle
as soon as possible. Driving with underinflated tires may permanently damage
the tires and increase the likelihood of
tire failure. Serious vehicle damage
could occur and may lead to an accident
and could result in serious personal injury. Check the tire pressure for all four
tires. Adjust the tire pressure to the
recommended COLD tire pressure
shown on the Tire and Loading Information label to turn the low tire pressure
warning light OFF. If you have a flat tire,
replace it with a spare tire as soon as
possible. (For additional information,
refer to “Flat tire” in the “In case of
emergency” section for changing a flat
tire.)
● When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel
is replaced, tire pressure will not be
indicated, the TPMS will not function
and the low tire pressure warning light
will flash for approximately 1 minute.
The light will remain on after 1 minute.
Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as
possible for tire replacement and/or
system resetting.
● Replacing tires with those not originally
specified by NISSAN could affect the
proper operation of the TPMS.
● Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosol
tire sealant into the tires, as this may
cause a malfunction of the tire pressure
sensors.
CAUTION
● The TPMS may not function properly
when the wheels are equipped with tire
chains or the wheels are buried in snow.
● Do not place metalized film or any
metal parts (antenna, etc.) on the windows. This may cause poor reception of
the signals from the tire pressure sensors, and the TPMS will not function
properly.
Some devices and transmitters may temporarily
interfere with the operation of the TPMS and
cause the low tire pressure warning light to illuminate.
Some examples are:
– Facilities or electric devices using similar radio
frequencies are near the vehicle.
NOTE:
Changes or modification not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
For Canada:
FCC Notice:
This device complies with Industry Canada
license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference, including interference that
may cause undesired operation of the device.
For USA:
TPMS with Easy Fill Tire Alert
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may
not cause harmful interference, and (2) this
device must accept any interference received, including interference that may
cause undesired operation.
When adding air to an under-inflated tire, the
TPMS with Easy Fill Tire Alert provides visual and
audible signals outside the vehicle to help you
inflate the tires to the recommended COLD tire
pressure.
– If a transmitter set to similar frequencies is
being used in or near the vehicle.
– If a computer (or similar equipment) or a
DC/AC converter is being used in or near the
vehicle.
Vehicle set-up
1. Park the vehicle in a safe and level place.
2. Apply the parking brake and place the shift
lever to the P (Park) position.
3. Place the ignition switch to the ON position.
Do not start the engine.
Starting and driving 5-5
Operation
1. Add air to the tire.
2. After a few seconds, the hazard indicators
will start flashing.
3. When the designated pressure is reached,
the horn beeps once and the hazard indicators stop flashing.
4. Perform the above steps for each tire.
● If the tire is over-inflated more than approximately 4 psi (30 kPa), the horn
beeps and the hazard indicators flash
three times. To correct the pressure, push
the core of the valve stem on the tire
briefly to release pressure. When the
pressure reaches the designated pressure, the horn beeps once.
● If the hazard indicator does not flash
within approximately 15 seconds after
starting to inflate the tire, it indicates that
the Easy Fill Tire Alert is not operating.
● The TPMS will not activate the Easy Fill
Tire Alert under the following conditions:
– If there is interference from an external
device or transmitter.
– The air pressure from the inflation device
is not sufficient to inflate the tire.
5-6 Starting and driving
– There is a malfunction in the TPMS system.
– There is a malfunction in the horn or hazard indicators.
– The identification code of the tires pressure sensor is not registered to the system.
– The battery of the tire pressure sensor is
low.
● If the Easy Fill Tire Alert does not operate
due to TPMS interference, move the vehicle about 3 ft (1 m) backward or forward
and try again.
If the Easy Fill Tire Alert is not working, use a tire
pressure gauge.
ON-PAVEMENT AND OFF-ROAD
DRIVING PRECAUTIONS
Utility vehicles have a significantly higher
rollover rate than other types of vehicles.
They have higher ground clearance than passenger cars to make them capable of performing in a
variety of on-pavement and off-road applications.
This gives them a higher center of gravity than
ordinary vehicles. An advantage of higher ground
clearance is a better view of the road, allowing
you to anticipate problems. However, they are not
designed for cornering at the same speeds as
conventional 2-wheel drive vehicles any more
than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform satisfactorily under off-road conditions. If at
all possible, avoid sharp turns at high speeds. As
with other vehicles of this type, failure to operate
this vehicle correctly may result in loss of control
or vehicle rollover. In a rollover crash, an unbelted
person is significantly more likely to die than a
person wearing a seat belt.
For additional information, refer to “Driving safety
precautions” in this section.
AVOIDING COLLISION AND
ROLLOVER
WARNING
Failure to operate this vehicle in a safe
and prudent manner may result in loss of
control or an accident.
Be alert and drive defensively at all times. Obey
all traffic regulations. Avoid excessive speed,
high speed cornering, or sudden steering maneuvers, because these driving practices could
cause you to lose control of your vehicle.
As with any vehicle, loss of control could
result in a collision with other vehicles or
objects or cause the vehicle to roll over,
particularly if the loss of control causes the
vehicle to slide sideways.
Be attentive at all times, and avoid driving when
tired. Never drive when under the influence of
alcohol or drugs (including prescription or overthe-counter drugs which may cause drowsiness). Always wear your seat belt as outlined in
the “Safety – Seats, seat belts and supplemental
restraint system” section of this manual, and also
instruct your passengers to do so.
Seat belts help reduce the risk of injury in collisions and rollovers. In a rollover crash, an
unbelted or improperly belted person is
significantly more likely to be injured or
killed than a person properly wearing a
seat belt.
OFF-ROAD RECOVERY
While driving, the right side or left side wheels
may unintentionally leave the road surface. If this
occurs, maintain control of the vehicle by following the procedure below. Please note that this
procedure is only a general guide. The vehicle
must be driven as appropriate based on the conditions of the vehicle, road and traffic.
1. Remain calm and do not overreact.
2. Do not apply the brakes.
3. Maintain a firm grip on the steering wheel
with both hands and try to hold a straight
course.
Rapid air pressure loss can affect the handling
and stability of the vehicle, especially at highway
speeds.
4. When appropriate, slowly release the accelerator pedal to gradually slow the vehicle.
Help prevent rapid air pressure loss by maintaining the correct air pressure and visually inspect
the tires for wear and damage. For additional
information, refer to “Wheels and tires” in the
“Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this
manual. If a tire rapidly loses air pressure or
“blows-out” while driving, maintain control of the
vehicle by following the procedure below. Please
note that this procedure is only a general guide.
The vehicle must be driven as appropriate based
on the conditions of the vehicle, road and traffic.
5. If there is nothing in the way, steer the vehicle to follow the road while vehicle speed
is reduced. Do not attempt to drive the vehicle back onto the road surface until vehicle
speed is reduced.
6. When it is safe to do so, gradually turn the
steering wheel until both tires return to the
road surface. When all tires are on the road
surface, steer the vehicle to stay in the appropriate driving lane.
● If you decide that it is not safe to return the
vehicle to the road surface based on vehicle,
road or traffic conditions, gradually slow the
vehicle to a stop in a safe place off the road.
RAPID AIR PRESSURE LOSS
Rapid air pressure loss or a “blow-out” can occur
if the tire is punctured or is damaged due to
hitting a curb or pothole. Rapid air pressure loss
can also be caused by driving on under-inflated
tires.
WARNING
The following actions can increase the
chance of losing control of the vehicle if
there is a sudden loss of tire air pressure.
Losing control of the vehicle may cause a
collision and result in personal injury.
● The vehicle generally moves or pulls in
the direction of the flat tire.
● Do not rapidly apply the brakes.
● Do not rapidly release the accelerator
pedal.
● Do not rapidly turn the steering wheel.
Starting and driving 5-7
1. Remain calm and do not overreact.
2. Maintain a firm grip on the steering wheel
with both hands and try to hold a straight
course.
3. When appropriate, slowly release the accelerator pedal to gradually slow the vehicle.
4. Gradually steer the vehicle to a safe location
off the road and away from traffic if possible.
5. Lightly apply the brake pedal to gradually
stop the vehicle.
6. Turn on the hazard warning flashers and
contact a roadside emergency service to
change the tire. For additional information,
refer to “Changing a flat tire” in the “In case
of emergency” section of this manual.
DRINKING ALCOHOL/DRUGS AND
DRIVING
WARNING
Never drive under the influence of alcohol
or drugs. Alcohol in the bloodstream reduces coordination, delays reaction time
and impairs judgement. Driving after
drinking alcohol increases the likelihood
of being involved in an accident injuring
yourself and others. Additionally, if you
are injured in an accident, alcohol can
increase the severity of the injury.
NISSAN is committed to safe driving. However,
you must choose not to drive under the influence
of alcohol. Every year thousands of people are
injured or killed in alcohol-related collisions. Although the local laws vary on what is considered
to be legally intoxicated, the fact is that alcohol
affects all people differently and most people
underestimate the effects of alcohol.
Remember, drinking and driving don’t mix! That is
true for drugs (over-the-counter, prescription)
and illegal drugs too. Don’t drive if your ability to
operate your vehicle is impaired by alcohol,
drugs, or some other physical condition.
5-8 Starting and driving
DRIVING SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
Your NISSAN is designed for both normal and
off-road use. However, avoid driving in deep water or mud as your NISSAN is mainly designed for
leisure use, unlike a conventional off-road vehicle.
Remember that 2-wheel drive models are less
capable than all-wheel drive models for rough
road driving and extrication when stuck in deep
snow or mud, or the like.
Please observe the following precautions:
WARNING
● Spinning the front wheels on slippery
surface may cause the AWD warning
message to display and the AWD system to automatically switch from the
AWD to the 2WD mode. This could reduce the traction. Be especially careful
when towing a trailer. (AWD models)
● Drive carefully when off the road and
avoid dangerous areas. Every person
who drives or rides in this vehicle
should be seated with their seat belt
fastened. This will keep you and your
passengers in position when driving
over rough terrain.
● Do not drive across steep slopes. Instead drive either straight up or straight
down the slopes. Off-road vehicles can
tip over sideways much more easily
than they can forward or backward.
● Unsecured cargo can be thrown around
when driving over rough terrain. Properly secure all cargo so it will not be
thrown forward and cause injury to you
or your passengers.
● Lower your speed when encountering
strong crosswinds. With a higher center
of gravity, your NISSAN is more affected
by strong side winds. Slower speeds
ensure better vehicle control.
● Many hills are too steep for any vehicle.
If you drive up them, you may stall. If
you drive down them, you may not be
able to control your speed. If you drive
across them, you may roll over.
● Exceeding the roof rack capacity can
raise the center of gravity excessively
and affect the handling and stability of
the vehicle.
● Do not drive beyond the performance
capability of the tires, even with AWD
engaged.
● Do not shift gears while driving on
downhill grades as this could cause
loss of control of the vehicle.
● Stay alert when driving to the top of a
hill. At the top there could be a drop-off
or other hazard that could cause an
accident.
● If your engine stalls or you cannot make
it to the top of a steep hill, never attempt to turn around. Your vehicle could
tip or roll over. Always back straight
down in R (Reverse) gear and apply
brakes to control your speed.
● Heavy braking going down a hill could
cause your brakes to overheat and fade,
resulting in loss of control and an accident. Apply brakes lightly and use a low
gear to control your speed.
● Secure heavy loads in the cargo area as
far forward and as low as possible. Do
not equip the vehicle with tires larger
than specified in this manual. This could
cause your vehicle to roll over.
● Do not grip the inside or spokes of the
steering wheel when driving off-road.
The steering wheel could move suddenly and injure your hands. Instead
drive with your fingers and thumbs on
the outside of the rim.
● For AWD equipped vehicles, do not attempt to raise two wheels off the
ground and shift the transmission to
any drive or reverse position with the
engine running. Doing so may result in
drivetrain damage or unexpected vehicle movement which could result in
serious vehicle damage or personal
injury.
● Before operating the vehicle, ensure
that the driver and all passengers have
their seat belts fastened.
● Always drive with the floor mats in place
as the floor may become hot.
Starting and driving 5-9
PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
● Do not attempt to test an AWD
equipped vehicle on a 2-wheel dynamometer (such as the dynamometers
used by some states for emissions testing), or similar equipment even if the
other two wheels are raised off the
ground. Make sure you inform test facility personnel that your vehicle is
equipped with AWD before it is placed
on a dynamometer. Using the wrong
test equipment may result in drivetrain
damage or unexpected vehicle movement which could result in serious vehicle damage or personal injury.
● When a wheel is off the ground due to
an unlevel surface, do not spin the
wheel excessively.
● Accelerating quickly, sharp steering
maneuvers or sudden braking may
cause loss of control.
● If at all possible, avoid sharp turning
maneuvers, particularly at high speeds.
Your NISSAN vehicle has a higher center of gravity than a passenger car. The
vehicle is not designed for cornering at
the same speeds as passenger cars.
5-10 Starting and driving
● Failure to operate this vehicle correctly
could result in loss of control and/or a
rollover accident.
● Always use tires of the same type, size,
brand, construction (bias, bias-belted,
or radial), and tread pattern on all four
wheels. Install tire chains on the front
wheels when driving on slippery roads
and drive carefully.
● Be sure to check the brakes immediately after driving in mud or water. For
additional information, refer to “Brake
system” in this section for “Wet
brakes”.
● Avoid parking your vehicle on steep
hills. If you get out of the vehicle and it
rolls forward, backward or sideways,
you could be injured.
● Whenever you drive off-road through
sand, mud or water as deep as the
wheel hub, more frequent maintenance
may be required. For additional information, refer to “Periodic maintenance”
in the “NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide.”
WARNING
Do not operate the push-button ignition
switch while driving the vehicle except in
an emergency. (The engine will stop when
the ignition switch is pushed 3 consecutive times in less than 1.5 seconds or the
ignition switch is pushed and held for
more than 2 seconds.) If the engine stops
while the vehicle is being driven, this
could lead to a crash and serious injury.
If the battery of the vehicle is discharged,
the push-button ignition switch cannot be
moved from the LOCK position.
Some indicators and warnings for operation are
displayed on the vehicle information display. For
additional information, refer to “Vehicle information display” in the “Instruments and controls”
section of this manual.
LSD2014
When the ignition switch is pushed without depressing the brake pedal, the ignition switch will
illuminate.
If the ignition switch is in the LOCK or OFF
position, push the ignition switch center:
● once to change to ACC.
● two times to change to ON.
● three times to change to OFF.
The shift lever can be moved from the P
(Park) position if the ignition switch is in
the ON position and the brake pedal is
depressed.
LSD2020
OPERATING RANGE
The Intelligent Key functions can only be used
when the Intelligent Key is within the specified
operating range.
When the Intelligent Key battery is almost discharged or strong radio waves are present near
the operating location, the Intelligent Key system’s operating range becomes narrower and
may not function properly.
If the Intelligent Key is within the operating range,
it is possible for anyone, even someone who does
not carry the Intelligent Key, to push the ignition
switch to start the engine.
Starting and driving 5-11
The operating range of the engine start function
1 .
is inside of the vehicle 䊊
● The luggage area is not included in the operating range, but the Intelligent Key may
function.
● If the Intelligent Key is placed on the instrument panel, inside the glove box, storage bin
or door pocket, the Intelligent Key may not
function.
● If the Intelligent Key is placed near the door
or window outside the vehicle, the Intelligent
Key may function.
PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
POSITIONS
LOCK (Normal parking position)
The ignition switch can only be locked in this
position.
The ignition switch will be unlocked when it is
pushed to the ACC position while carrying the
Intelligent Key.
The ignition switch will lock when any door is
opened or closed with the ignition switched off.
ACC has a battery saver feature that will turn the
ignition switch to the OFF position after a period
of time under the following conditions:
The battery saver feature will be cancelled if any
of the following occur:
● all doors are closed.
● any door is opened.
● shift lever is in P (Park).
● hazard lamps are off.
● shift lever is moved out of the P (Park) position.
● turn signals are off.
● ignition switch changes position.
The battery saver feature will be cancelled if any
of the following occur:
● hazard lamps are turned on.
● turn signals are turned on.
● any door is opened.
● shift lever is moved out of P (Park).
● ignition switch changes position.
● hazard lamps are turned on.
ON (Normal operating position)
This position turns on the ignition system and
electrical accessories.
ON has a battery saver feature that will turn the
ignition switch to the OFF position, if the vehicle
is not running, after some time under the following conditions:
ACC (Accessories)
● all doors are closed.
This position activates electrical accessories,
such as the radio, when the engine is not running.
● hazard lamps are off.
5-12 Starting and driving
● turn signals are off.
● shift lever is in P (Park).
CAUTION
Do not leave the vehicle with the ignition
switch in ACC or ON positions when the
engine is not running for an extended period. This can discharge the battery.
OFF
The ignition switch is in the OFF position when
the engine is turned off using the ignition switch.
If equipped, the ignition switch heart beat function (pulsed illumination) may activate for a period
of time when any door is unlocked and when the
door opened/closed status changes in the OFF
and ACC positions.
To shut off the engine in an emergency situation
while driving, perform the following procedure:
(After step 3 is performed, when the ignition
switch is pushed without depressing the
brake pedal, the ignition switch position will
change to ON.)
– Rapidly push the push-button ignition switch
three consecutive times in less than 1.5 seconds, or
4. Push the ignition switch while depressing
the brake pedal within ten seconds after the
chime sounds. The engine will start.
EMERGENCY ENGINE SHUT OFF
– Push and hold the push-button ignition switch
for more than 2 seconds.
NOTE:
SSD0860
NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY®
BATTERY DISCHARGE
If the battery of the NISSAN Intelligent Key® is
discharged, or environmental conditions interfere
with the Intelligent Key operation, start the engine
according to the following procedure:
1. Place the shift lever in the P (Park) position.
2. Firmly apply the foot brake.
● When the ignition switch is pushed to the
ON position or the engine is started by the
above procedure, the Intelligent Key battery
discharge indicator appears in the vehicle
information display even when the Intelligent
Key is inside the vehicle. This is not a malfunction. To turn off the Intelligent Key battery discharge indicator, touch the ignition
switch with the Intelligent Key again.
● If the Intelligent Key battery discharge indicator appears, replace the battery as soon
as possible. For additional information, refer
to “Battery Replacement” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this
manual.
3. Touch the ignition switch with the Intelligent
Key as illustrated. (A chime will sound.)
Starting and driving 5-13
BEFORE STARTING THE ENGINE
STARTING THE ENGINE
NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER
SYSTEM
● Make sure the area around the vehicle is
clear.
The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System will not
allow the engine to start without the use of the
registered key.
● Check fluid levels such as engine oil, coolant, brake fluid, and windshield-washer fluid
as frequently as possible, or at least whenever you refuel.
If the engine fails to start using a registered key
(for example, when interference is caused by
another registered key, an automated toll road
device or automatic payment device on the key
ring), restart the engine using the following procedure:
1. Leave the ignition switch in the ON position
for approximately 5 seconds.
2. Place the ignition switch in the OFF or
LOCK position, and wait approximately
10 seconds.
3. Repeat Steps 1 and 2.
4. Restart the engine while holding the device
(which may have caused the interference)
separate from the registered key.
If the no start condition re-occurs, NISSAN recommends placing the registered key on a separate key ring to avoid interference from other
devices.
5-14 Starting and driving
● Check that all windows and lights are clean.
● Visually inspect tires for their appearance
and condition. Also check tires for proper
inflation.
● Check that all doors are closed.
● Position
seat
and
restraints/headrests.
adjust
head
● Adjust inside and outside mirrors.
● Fasten seat belts and ask all passengers to
do likewise.
● Check the operation of warning lights when
the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. For additional information, refer to
“Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders” in the “Instruments and controls”
section of this manual.
1. Apply the parking brake.
2. Move the shift lever to P (Park) or N (Neutral). P (Park) is recommended.
The starter is designed not to operate
unless the shift lever is in either P
(Park) or N (Neutral).
3. Push the ignition switch to the ON position.
Depress the brake pedal and push the ignition switch to start the engine.
To start the engine immediately, push and
release the ignition switch while depressing
the brake pedal with the ignition switch in
any position.
● If the engine is very hard to start in extremely cold weather or when restarting,
depress the accelerator pedal a little (approximately 1/3 to the floor) and while
holding, crank the engine. Release the
accelerator pedal when the engine starts.
● If the engine is very hard to start because
it is flooded, depress the accelerator
pedal all the way to the floor and hold it.
Push the ignition switch to the ON position to start cranking the engine. After five
or six seconds, stop cranking by pushing
the ignition switch to LOCK. After cranking the engine, release the accelerator
pedal. Crank the engine with your foot off
DRIVING THE VEHICLE
the accelerator pedal by depressing the
brake pedal and pushing the push-button
ignition switch to start the engine. If the
engine starts, but fails to run, repeat the
above procedure.
CAUTION
Do not operate the starter for more than
15 seconds at a time. If the engine does
not start, push the ignition switch to the
OFF position and wait 10 seconds before
cranking again, otherwise the starter
could be damaged.
4. Warm-up
NOTE:
Care should be taken to avoid situations
that can lead to potential battery discharge
and potential no-start conditions such as:
1. Installation or extended use of electronic
accessories that consume battery power
when the engine is not running (Phone chargers, GPS, DVD players, etc.)
2. Vehicle is not driven regularly and/or only
driven short distances. In these cases, the
battery may need to be charged to maintain
battery health.
REMOTE START (if so equipped)
Allow the engine to idle for at least 30 seconds after starting. Do not race the engine
while warming it up. Drive at moderate
speed for a short distance first, especially in
cold weather. In cold weather, keep the engine running for a minimum of two to three
minutes before shutting it off. Starting and
stopping the engine over a short period of
time may make the vehicle more difficult to
start.
Vehicles started with the remote start require the
ignition switch to be placed in the ON position
before the shift lever can be moved from the P
(Park) position. To place the ignition switch to the
ON position, follow these steps:
5. To stop the engine, shift the shift lever into
the P (Park) position and push the ignition
switch to the OFF position.
For additional information, refer to “NISSAN Intelligent Key®” in the “Pre-driving checks and
adjustments” section of this manual.
1. Make sure that the Intelligent Key is on you.
2. Apply the brake.
3. Press the ignition switch once to the ON
position.
CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLE
TRANSMISSION (CVT)
The Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) in
your vehicle is electronically controlled to produce maximum power and smooth operation.
The recommended operating procedures for this
transmission are shown on the following pages.
Follow these procedures for maximum vehicle
performance and driving enjoyment.
Engine power may be automatically reduced to protect the CVT if the engine
speed increases quickly when driving on
slippery roads or while being tested on
some dynamometers.
Starting the vehicle
1. After starting the engine, fully depress the
foot brake pedal before moving the shift
lever out of the P (Park) position.
This CVT is designed so that the foot
brake pedal must be depressed before
shifting from P (Park) to any driving
position while the ignition switch is in
the ON position.
The shift lever cannot be moved out of
the P (Park) position and into any of
the other positions if the ignition
switch is placed in the LOCK, OFF or
ACC position.
Starting and driving 5-15
2. Keep the foot brake pedal depressed and
move the shift lever to a driving position.
3. Release the parking brake and foot brake
pedal, and then gradually start the vehicle in
motion.
WARNING
● Do not depress the accelerator pedal
while shifting from P (Park) or N (Neutral) to R (Reverse) or D (Drive) position.
Always depress the brake pedal until
shifting is completed. Failure to do so
could cause you to lose control and
have an accident.
● Cold engine idle speed is high, so use
caution when shifting into a forward or
reverse gear before the engine has
warmed up.
● Never shift to P (Park) or R (Reverse)
while vehicle is moving. Failure to do so
could cause you to lose control and
have an accident.
● Do not downshift abruptly on slippery
roads. This may cause a loss of control.
5-16 Starting and driving
CAUTION
● When stopping the vehicle on an uphill
grade, do not hold the vehicle by depressing the accelerator pedal. The foot
brake should be used for this purpose.
● Except in an emergency, do not shift to
the N (Neutral) position while driving.
Coasting with the transmission in the N
(Neutral) position may cause serious
damage to the transmission.
LSD2222
Shifting
After starting the engine, fully depress the brake
pedal, push and press the shift lever button and
move the shift lever from the P (Park) position to
any of the desired shift positions.
WARNING
Apply the parking brake if the shift lever is
in any position while the engine is not
running. Failure to do so could cause the
vehicle to move unexpectedly or roll away
and result in serious personal injury or
property damage.
CAUTION
Use the P (Park) or R (Reverse) position
only when the vehicle is completely
stopped.
P (Park)
CAUTION
To prevent transmission damage, use the
P (Park) position only when the vehicle is
completely stopped
Use the P (Park) shift lever position when the
vehicle is parked or when starting the engine.
Make sure the vehicle is completely stopped.
The brake pedal must be depressed and
the shift lever button pushed in to move the
shift lever from N (Neutral) or any drive
position to P (Park). Apply the parking brake.
When parking on a hill, apply the parking brake
first, then move the shift lever into the P (Park)
position.
R (Reverse)
CAUTION
To prevent transmission damage, use the
R (Reverse) position only when the vehicle
is completely stopped.
Use the R (Reverse) position to back up. Make
sure the vehicle is completely stopped before
selecting the R (Reverse) position. The brake
pedal must be depressed and the shift lever
button pushed in to move the shift lever
from P (Park), N (Neutral) or any drive position to R (Reverse).
N (Neutral)
Neither forward nor reverse gear is engaged. The
engine can be started in this position. You may
shift to N (Neutral) and restart a stalled engine
while the vehicle is moving.
D (Drive)
Use this position for all normal forward driving.
LSD2342
Manual shift mode
When the shift lever is in the manual shift gate,
the transmission is ready for the manual shift
mode. Shift ranges can be selected manually by
moving the shift lever up or down. To cancel
manual shift mode, return the shift lever to the D
(Drive) position. The transmission returns to automatic driving mode.
When the shift lever is shifted from D (Drive) to
the manual shift gate with the vehicle stopped or
while driving, the transmission enters the manual
shift mode. Shift ranges can be selected manually. In the manual shift mode, the shift range is
displayed on the position indicator in the meter.
Starting and driving 5-17
When shifting the shift lever to the manual shift
gate, the position indicator displays 1 (first) up to
7 (seventh) depending on vehicle speed.
Shift ranges up or down one by one as follows:
1⇔ 2 ⇔ 3 ⇔ 4 ⇔ 5⇔ 6⇔ 7
7 (7th)
Use this position for all normal forward driving at
highway speeds.
5 (5th) and 6 (6th)
Use this position when driving up long slopes, or
for engine braking when driving down long
slopes.
When shifting up
Move the shift lever to the + (up) side. (Shifts to
higher range.)
When shifting down
Move the shift lever to the ⫺ (down) side. (Shifts
to lower range.)
● The transmission will automatically downshift the gears. (For example, if you select the
3rd range, the transmission will shift down
between the 3rd and 1st gears.)
● Moving the shift lever rapidly to the same
side twice will shift the ranges in succession.
4 (4th), 3 (3rd) and 2 (2nd)
When canceling the manual shift mode
Use these positions for hill climbing or engine
braking on downhill grades.
Return the shift lever to the D (Drive) position to
return the transmission to the normal driving
mode.
1 (1st)
Use this position when climbing steep hills slowly
or when driving slowly, or for maximum engine
braking on steep downhill grades.
● Remember not to drive at high speeds for
extended periods of time in lower than 7th
gear. This reduces fuel economy.
5-18 Starting and driving
● In the manual shift mode, the transmission may not shift to the selected gear.
This helps maintain driving performance and reduces the chance of vehicle damage or loss of control.
● When this situation occurs, the CVT
position indicator light will blink and
the chime will sound.
● In the manual shift mode, the transmission may shift up automatically to a
higher range than selected if the engine speed is too high. When the vehicle speed decreases, the transmission automatically shifts down and
shifts to 1st gear before the vehicle
comes to a stop.
● CVT operation is limited to automatic drive
mode when CVT fluid temperature is extremely low even if manual shift mode is
selected. This is not a malfunction. When
CVT fluid warms up, manual mode can be
selected.
● When the CVT fluid temperature is high, the
shift range may upshift in lower rpm than
usual. This is not a malfunction.
5. Press the shift lever button and move the
shift lever to the N (Neutral) position while
holding down the shift lock release. The
vehicle may be moved to the desired location. Replace the removed shift lock release
cover after the operation. If the shift lever
cannot be moved out of the P (Park) position, have a NISSAN dealer check the CVT
system as soon as possible.
WARNING
LSD2274
Shift lock release
If the battery charge is low or discharged, the
shift lever may not be moved from the P (Park)
position even with the brake pedal depressed
and the shift lever button pushed. To move the
shift lever, perform the following procedure:
1. Place the ignition switch in the OFF or
LOCK position.
2. Apply the parking brake.
If the shift lever cannot be moved from the
P (Park) position while the engine is running and the brake pedal is depressed, the
stop lights may not work. Malfunctioning
stop lights could cause an accident injuring yourself and others.
Accelerator downshift
— in D (Drive) position —
For passing or hill climbing, depress the accelerator pedal to the floor. This shifts the transmission down into a lower gear, depending on the
vehicle speed.
3. Remove the shift lock release cover using a
suitable tool.
High fluid temperature protection
mode
4. Push down the shift lock release using a
suitable tool.
This transmission has a high fluid temperature
protection mode. If the fluid temperature be-
comes too high (for example, when climbing
steep grades in high temperatures with heavy
loads, such as when towing a trailer), engine
power and, under some conditions, vehicle
speed will be decreased automatically to reduce
the chance of transmission damage. Vehicle
speed can be controlled with the accelerator
pedal, but the engine and vehicle speed may be
limited.
Fail-safe
If the vehicle is driven under extreme conditions, such as excessive wheel spinning
and subsequent hard braking, the fail-safe
system may be activated. The MIL may
come on to indicate the fail-safe mode is
activated. For additional information, refer
to “Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)” in the
“Instrument and controls” section of this
manual. This will occur even if all electrical
circuits are functioning properly. In this
case, place the ignition switch in the OFF
position and wait for 10 seconds. Then
push the switch back to the ON position.
The vehicle should return to its normal operating condition. If it does not return to its
normal operating condition, have a
NISSAN dealer check the transmission and
repair if necessary.
Starting and driving 5-19
PARKING BRAKE
WARNING
When the high fluid temperature protection mode or fail-safe operation occurs,
vehicle speed may be gradually reduced.
The reduced speed may be lower than
other traffic, which could increase the
chance of a collision. Be especially careful
when driving. If necessary, pull to the side
of the road at a safe place and allow the
transmission to return to normal operation, or have it repaired if necessary.
WARNING
● Be sure the parking brake is fully released before driving. Failure to do so
can cause brake failure and lead to an
accident.
● Do not release the parking brake from
outside the vehicle.
● Do not use the shift lever in place of the
parking brake. When parking, be sure
the parking brake is fully engaged.
● Do not leave children unattended in a
vehicle. They could release the parking
brake and cause an accident.
LSD0158
To engage:
Firmly depress the parking brake.
To release:
1. Firmly apply the foot brake.
2. Move the shift lever to the P (Park) position.
3. Firmly depress the parking brake pedal and it
will release.
4. Before driving, be sure the brake warning
light goes out.
5-20 Starting and driving
BLIND SPOT WARNING (BSW)
SYSTEM (if so equipped)
● Blind Spot Warning (BSW) system
WARNING
● The BSW system is not a replacement
for proper driving procedure and is not
designed to prevent contact with vehicles or objects. When changing lanes,
always use the side and rear mirrors
and turn and look in the direction you
will move to ensure it is safe to change
lanes. Never rely solely on the BSW
system.
● The BSW system operates above approximately 20 mph (32 km/h).
BLIND SPOT WARNING (BSW)
SYSTEM
The Blind Spot Warning (BSW) system helps
alert the driver of other vehicles in adjacent lanes
when changing lanes.
LSD2223
The BSW system uses radar sensors 䊊 installed near the rear bumper to detect other vehicles in an adjacent lane.
1
SSD1030
Detection zone
The radar sensors can detect vehicles on either
side of your vehicle within the detection zone
shown as illustrated. This detection zone starts
from the outside mirror of your vehicle and extends approximately 10 ft (3.0 m) behind the rear
bumper, and approximately 10 ft (3.0 m) sideways.
The BSW system operates above approximately
20 MPH (32 km/h). If the radar sensors detect
vehicles in the detection zone, the Blind Spot
Warning indicator light illuminates. If the driver
then activates the turn signal, a chime will sound
twice and the Blind Spot Warning indicator light
will flash.
Starting and driving 5-21
The brightness of the BSW indicator light is
adjusted automatically depending on the brightness of the ambient light.
A chime sounds if the radar sensors have already
detected vehicles when the driver activates the
turn signal. If a vehicle comes into the detection
zone after the driver activates the turn signal, then
only the BSW indicator light flashes and no
chime sounds. For additional information, refer to
“BSW driving situations” in this section.
LSD2228
BSW indicator light
BSW SYSTEM OPERATION
If the radar sensors detect a vehicle in the detection zone, the Blind Spot Warning (BSW) indicator light located by the outside mirrors illuminates. If the turn signal is then activated, the
system chimes (twice) and the BSW indicator
light flashes. The BSW indicator light continues
to flash until the detected vehicles leave the
detection zone.
The BSW indicator light illuminates for a few
seconds when the ignition switch is placed in the
ON position.
5-22 Starting and driving
The BSW system automatically turns on every
time the engine is started, as long as it is activated using the settings menu on the vehicle
information display.
How to enable/disable the BSW
system
Perform the following steps to enable or disable
the BSW system.
button until “Settings” dis1. Press the
plays in the vehicle information display and
button to
then press OK. Use the
select “Driver Assistance”. Then press the
OK button.
2. Select “Blind Spot” and press the OK button.
NOTE:
The RCTA system is integrated into the
BSW system. There is not a separate selection in the vehicle information display for
the RCTA system. When the BSW is disabled, the RCTA system is also disabled.
Action to take:
When the above conditions no longer exist, the
system will resume automatically.
Malfunction
When the system malfunctions, it will turn off
automatically. The system malfunction warning
message with the blind spot indicator (orange)
will appear in the vehicle information display. If
the BSW system fails, the RCTA system will also
fail.
LSD2290
Temporarily not available
Action to take:
Stop the vehicle in a safe location, place the
vehicle in the P (Park) position, turn the engine off
and restart the engine. If the message continues
to appear, have the system checked by a
NISSAN dealer.
When radar blockage is detected, the system will
be deactivated automatically. The “Side Radar
Obstruction” warning message will appear and
A in the
the blind spot indicator (white) will blink 䊊
vehicle information display.
BSW SYSTEM PRECAUTIONS
The systems are not available until the conditions
no longer exist.
● The radar sensors may not be able to
detect and activate BSW when certain
objects are present such as:
The radar sensors may be blocked by temporary
ambient conditions such as splashing water, mist
or fog. The blocked condition may also be caused
by objects such as ice, frost or dirt obstructing
the radar sensors.
WARNING
– Oncoming vehicles.
– Vehicles remaining in the detection
zone when you accelerate from a
stop. For additional information, refer to “BSW driving situations” in this
section.
– A vehicle merging into an adjacent
lane at a speed approximately the
same as your vehicle. For additional
information, refer to “BSW driving
situations” in this section.
– A vehicle approaching rapidly from
behind. For additional information,
refer to “BSW driving situations” in
this section.
– A vehicle which your vehicle overtakes rapidly. For additional information, refer to “BSW driving situations” in this section.
– A vehicle that passes through the detection zone quickly.
– Pedestrians, bicycles, or animals.
– Vehicles such as motorcycles, low
height vehicles, or high ground clearance vehicles.
Starting and driving 5-23
mirrors and turn and look in the direction your
vehicle will move to ensure it is safe to change
lanes.
● The radar sensors detection zone is designed based on a standard lane width.
When driving in a wider lane, the radar
sensors may not detect vehicles in an
adjacent lane. When driving in a narrow
lane, the radar sensors may detect vehicles driving two lanes away.
● The radar sensors are designed to ignore most stationary objects, however
objects such as guardrails, walls, foliage and parked vehicles may occasionally be detected. The system malfunction warning message with the blind
spot indicator (orange) will appear in
the vehicle information display. This is a
normal driving condition.
● Severe weather or road spray conditions may reduce the ability of the radar
to detect other vehicles.
● Excessive noise (e.g. audio system volume, open vehicle window) will interfere with the chime sound, and it may
not be heard.
SSD1026
Illustration 1 – Approaching from behind
BSW DRIVING SITUATIONS
Another vehicle approaching from
behind
Illustration 1: The Blind Spot Warning indicator
light illuminates if a vehicle enters the detection
zone from behind in an adjacent lane.
However, if the overtaking vehicle is traveling
much faster than your vehicle, the indicator light
may not illuminate before the detected vehicle is
beside your vehicle. Always use the side and rear
5-24 Starting and driving
SSD1031
Illustration 2 – Approaching from behind
Illustration 2: If the driver activates the turn
signal then the system chimes a sound (twice)
and the Blind Spot Warning indicator light
flashes.
NOTE:
If the driver activates the turn signal before
a vehicle enters the detection zone, the
Blind Spot Warning indicator light will flash
but no chime will sound when the other
vehicle is detected.
SSD1032
Illustration 3 – Accelerate from a stop
NOTE:
Illustration 3: If you accelerate from a stop
with a vehicle in the detection zone, the
other vehicle may not be detected.
SSD1033
Illustration 4 – Overtaking another vehicle
Overtaking another vehicle
Illustration 4: The Blind Spot Warning indicator
light illuminates if you overtake a vehicle and that
vehicle stays in the detection zone for approximately 2 seconds.
The radar sensors may not detect slower moving
vehicles if they are passed quickly.
Starting and driving 5-25
SSD1034
Illustration 5 – Overtaking another vehicle
Illustration 5: If the driver activates the turn
signal while another vehicle is in the detection
zone, then the system chimes a sound (twice)
and the Blind Spot Warning indicator light
flashes.
5-26 Starting and driving
SSD1036
Illustration 6 – Overtaking several vehicles
NOTE:
Illustration 6: When overtaking several vehicles in a row, the vehicles after the first
vehicle may not be detected if they are
traveling close together.
REAR CROSS TRAFFIC ALERT (RCTA)
SYSTEM (if so equipped)
LSD2050
Illustration 7– Entering from the side
Entering from the side
Illustration 7: The Blind Spot Warning indicator
light illuminates if a vehicle enters the detection
zone from either side.
NOTE:
The radar sensors may not detect a vehicle
which is traveling at about the same speed
as your vehicle when it enters the detection
zone.
SSD1038
Illustration 8– Entering from the side
Illustration 8: Illustration 8: If the driver activates the turn signal while another vehicle is in the
detection zone the Blind Spot Warning indicator
light flashes and a chime will sound twice.
NOTE:
If the driver activates the turn signal before
a vehicle enters the detection zone, the
Blind Spot Warning indicator light will flash
but no chime will sound when another vehicle is detected.
LSD2223
WARNING
● The RCTA system is not a replacement
for proper driving procedures and is not
designed to prevent contact with vehicles or objects. When backing out of
parking space, always use the side and
rear mirrors and turn and look in the
direction you will move. Never rely
solely on the RCTA system.
Starting and driving 5-27
RCTA SYSTEM OPERATION
button until “Settings” dis1. Press the
plays in the vehicle information display. Use
button to select “Driver Assisthe
tance”. Then press the OK button.
The RCTA system can help alert the driver of an
approaching vehicle when the driver is backing
out of a parking space.
2. Select “Blind Spot” and press the OK button.
When the shift position is in R (Reverse) and the
vehicle speed is less than approximately 5 MPH
(8 km/h), the RCTA system is operational.
NOTE:
The RCTA system is integrated into the
BSW system. There is not a separate selection in the vehicle information display for
the RCTA system. When the BSW is disabled, the RCTA system is also disabled.
LSD2216
1 inThe RCTA system uses radar sensors 䊊
stalled on both sides near the rear bumper to
detect an approaching vehicle.
1 detect an approaching
The radar sensors 䊊
vehicle from up to approximately 66 ft. (20 m)
away.
If the radar detects a vehicle approaching from
the side, the system gives visual and audible
warnings.
How to enable/disable the RCTA
system
Perform the following steps to enable or disable
the RCTA system.
5-28 Starting and driving
WARNING
● Always check surroundings and turn to
check what is behind you before backing up. The radar sensors detect approaching (moving) vehicles. The radar
sensors cannot detect every object such
as:
– Pedestrians, bicycles, motorcycles,
animals or child operated toy
vehicles
– A vehicle that is passing at speeds
greater than approximately 19 MPH
(30 km/h)
– A vehicle that is passing at speeds
lower than approximately 5 MPH
(8 km/h)
● The radar sensors may not detect approaching vehicles in certain situations:
LSD2173
RCTA SYSTEM PRECAUTIONS
– Illustration a: When a vehicle parked
next to you obstructs the beam of the
radar sensor.
– Illustration b: When the vehicle is
parked in an angled parking space.
– Illustration c: When the vehicle is
parked on inclined ground.
Starting and driving 5-29
– Illustration d: When an approaching
vehicle turns into your vehicle’s parking lot aisle.
– Illustration e: When the angle formed
by your vehicle and approaching vehicle is small
● The following conditions may reduce
the ability of the radar to detect other
vehicles:
● Excessive noise (e.g. audio system volume, open vehicle window) will interfere with the chime sound, and it may
not be heard.
If the radar detects an approaching vehicle from
the side, the system chimes a sound (single
beep) and the BSW indicator light on the side the
vehicle is approaching from flashes.
– Severe weather
– Road spray
– Ice build up on the vehicle
LSD2043
– Frost build up on the vehicle
– Dirt build up on the vehicle
● Do not attach stickers (including transparent material), install accessories or
apply additional paint near the radar
sensors. These conditions may reduce
the ability of the radar to detect other
vehicles
● Do not use the RCTA systems when
towing a trailer.
5-30 Starting and driving
Illustration 1
NOTE:
● In the case of several vehicles approaching
in a row (Illustration 1) or in the opposite
direction (Illustration 2), a chime may not be
sounded by the RCTA system after the first
vehicle passes the sensors.
RCTA temporarily not available
When radar blockage is detected, the system will
be deactivated automatically. The “Side Radar
Obstruction” warning message will appear and
the blind spot indicator (white) will blink in the
vehicle information display.
off and restart the engine. If the message continues to appear, have the system checked by a
NISSAN dealer.
The systems are not available until the conditions
no longer exist.
LSD2044
Illustration 2
The radar sensors may be blocked by temporary
ambient conditions such as splashing water, mist
or fog. The blocked condition may also be caused
by objects such as ice, frost or dirt obstructing
the radar sensors.
Action to take:
When the above conditions no longer exist, the
system will resume automatically.
RCTA malfunction
If the RCTA system malfunctions, the system will
turn off automatically. The system malfunction
warning message with the blind spot indicator
(orange) will appear in the vehicle information
display. If the BSW system fails, the RCTA system will also fail.
Action to take:
Stop the vehicle in a safe location, turn the engine
Starting and driving 5-31
Do not attach stickers (including transparent material), install accessories or apply additional
paint near the radar sensors.
Do not strike or damage the area around the
radar sensors. Consult a NISSAN dealer if the
area around the radar sensors is damaged due to
a collision.
Radio frequency statement
This device complies with part 15 of the
FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
LSD2223
RADAR MAINTENANCE
1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and
1 for the BSW and
The two radar sensors 䊊
RCTA systems are located near the rear bumper.
Always keep the area near the radar sensors
clean.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
The radar sensors may be blocked by temporary
ambient conditions such as splashing water, mist
or fog.
The blocked condition may also be caused by
objects such as ice, frost or dirt obstructing the
radar sensors.
Check for and remove objects obstructing the
area around the radar sensors.
5-32 Starting and driving
FCC Warning
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
Applicable law: Canada 310
This device complies with Industry Canada
license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause inter-
ference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference, including interference that
may cause undesired operation of the device.
Frequency
24.25GHz
of
operation:
24.05GHz
Output power: less than 20 milliwatts
—
CRUISE CONTROL
● If the CRUISE indicator light blinks, turn the
cruise control switch off and have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.
● The CRUISE indicator light may blink when
the cruise control switch is turned ON while
pushing the RES/+ switch, SET/- switch, or
CANCEL switch. To properly set the cruise
control system, use the following procedures.
WARNING
Do not use the cruise control when driving
under the following conditions:
LSD2237
PRECAUTIONS ON CRUISE
CONTROL
1. RES/+ switch
2. SET/- switch
3. ON/OFF switch
4. CANCEL switch
● If the cruise control system malfunctions, it
cancels automatically. The CRUISE indicator light in the vehicle information display
then blinks to warn the driver.
● When it is not possible to keep the
vehicle at a set speed.
● In heavy traffic or in traffic that varies in
speed.
● On winding or hilly roads.
● On slippery roads (rain, snow, ice, etc.).
● In very windy areas.
Doing so could cause a loss of vehicle
control and result in an accident.
CRUISE CONTROL OPERATIONS
The cruise control allows driving at a speed between 25 - 89 MPH (40 - 144 km/h) without
keeping your foot on the accelerator pedal.
To turn on the cruise control, push the
ON·OFF switch ON. The CRUISE indicator light
in the vehicle information display will illuminate.
To set cruising speed, accelerate the vehicle to
the desired speed, push the SET/– switch and
release it. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.
Your vehicle maintains the set speed.
● To pass another vehicle, depress the accelerator pedal. When you release the
pedal, the vehicle returns to the previously
set speed.
● The vehicle may not maintain the set speed
when going up or down steep hills. If this
happens, drive without the cruise control.
To cancel the preset speed, use one of the
following three methods.
● Push the CANCEL button.
● Tap the brake pedal.
● Push the ON·OFF switch off. The CRUISE
indicator light in the vehicle information display goes out.
Starting and driving 5-33
INTELLIGENT CRUISE CONTROL (ICC)
SYSTEM (full speed range) (if so
equipped)
The cruise control is automatically canceled if:
● you depress the brake pedal while pushing
the RES/+ or SET/– switch. The preset
speed is deleted from memory.
● the vehicle slows down more than 8 MPH
(13 km/h) below the set speed.
● you move the shift lever to N (Neutral).
To reset at a faster cruising speed, use one of
the following three methods.
● Depress the accelerator pedal. When the
vehicle attains the desired speed, push and
release the SET/– switch.
● Push and hold the RES/+ switch. When the
vehicle attains the speed you desire, release
the switch.
● Push and release the RES/+ switch. Each
time you do this, the set speed increases by
about 1 MPH (1.6 km/h).
To reset at a slower cruising speed, use one
of the following three methods.
● Lightly tap the brake pedal. When the vehicle attains the desired speed, push the
SET/– switch and release it.
● Push and hold the SET/– switch. Release
the switch when the vehicle slows to the
desired speed.
5-34 Starting and driving
● Push and release the SET/– switch. Each
time you do this, the set speed decreases by
about 1 MPH (1.6 km/h).
To resume the preset speed, push and release the RES/+ switch. The vehicle returns to
the last set cruising speed when the vehicle
speed is over 25 MPH (40 km/h).
To turn off the cruise control, use one of the
following three methods.
● Push the CANCEL button.
● Tap the brake pedal.
● Push the ON·OFF switch off. The CRUISE
indicator light in the vehicle information display goes out.
The ICC system maintains a selected distance
from the vehicle in front of you within the speed
range 0 to 90 MPH (0 to 144 km/h) up to the set
speed. The set speed can be selected by the
driver between 20 to 90 MPH (32 to 144 km/h).
The vehicle travels at a set speed when the road
ahead is clear.
For maintaining a selected distance between
your vehicle and the vehicle in front of you up to
the preset speed.
WARNING
● ICC is not a collision avoidance or warning device. For highway use only and
not intended for congested areas or city
driving. Will not brake automatically to
a stop. Failure to apply the brakes could
result in an accident.
● Always observe posted speed limits
and do not set the speed over them.
● Always drive carefully and attentively
when using ICC system. Read and understand the Owner’s Manual thoroughly before using the ICC system. To
avoid serious injury or death, do not rely
on the system to prevent accidents or to
control the vehicle’s speed in emergency situations. Do not use ICC system
except in appropriate road and traffic
conditions.
The ICC system automatically maintains a selected distance from the vehicle traveling in front
of you according to that vehicle’s speed (up to
the set speed), or at the set speed when the road
ahead is clear.
WARNING
● This system is only an aid to assist the
driver and is not a collision warning or
avoidance device. It is the driver’s responsibility to stay alert, drive safely
and be in control of the vehicle at all
times.
● The system is primarily intended for use
on straight, dry, open roads with light
traffic. It is not advisable to use the
system in city traffic or congested areas.
LSD2249
ICC SYSTEM PRECAUTIONS
The system is intended to enhance the operation
of the vehicle when following a vehicle traveling in
the same lane and direction.
A detects a slower movIf the distance sensor 䊊
ing vehicle ahead, the system will reduce the
vehicle speed so that your vehicle follows the
vehicle in front at the selected distance.
The system automatically controls the throttle
and applies the brakes (up to 40% of vehicle
braking power) if necessary.
● This system will not adapt automatically
to road conditions. This system should
be used in evenly flowing traffic. Do not
use the system on roads with sharp
curves, or on icy roads, in heavy rain or
in fog.
The distance sensor will not detect the following
objects:
● Stationary and slow moving vehicles
● Pedestrians or objects in the roadway
● Oncoming vehicles in the same lane
● Motorcycles traveling offset in the travel lane
The detection range of the sensor is approximately 390 ft (120 m) ahead.
Starting and driving 5-35
WARNING
● As there is a performance limit to the
distance control function, never rely
solely on the Intelligent Cruise Control
system. This system does not correct
careless, inattentive or absent-minded
driving, or overcome poor visibility in
rain, fog, or other bad weather. Decelerate the vehicle speed by depressing the
brake pedal, depending on the distance
to the vehicle ahead and the surrounding circumstances in order to maintain a
safe distance between vehicles.
● If the vehicle ahead comes to a stop, the
vehicle decelerates to a standstill
within the limitations of the system. The
system will cancel once it judges that
the vehicle has come to a standstill and
sound a warning chime. To prevent the
vehicle from moving, the driver must
depress the brake pedal.
● The system may not detect the vehicle
in front of you in certain road or weather
conditions. To avoid accidents, never
use the Intelligent Cruise Control system under the following conditions:
– On roads where the traffic is heavy or
there are sharp curves
5-36 Starting and driving
– On slippery road surfaces such as on
ice or snow, etc.
– During bad weather (rain, fog, snow,
etc.)
– When rain, snow or dirt adhere to the
bumper around the distance sensor
– On steep downhill roads (the vehicle
may go beyond the set vehicle speed
and frequent braking may result in
overheating the brakes)
– On repeated uphill and downhill
roads
– When traffic conditions make it difficult to keep a proper distance between vehicles because of frequent
acceleration or deceleration
– Interference by other radar sources.
● Do not use the Intelligent Cruise Control system if you are towing a trailer.
The system may not detect a vehicle
ahead.
● In some road or traffic conditions, a
vehicle or object can unexpectedly
come into the sensor detection zone
and cause automatic braking. You may
need to control the distance from other
vehicles using the accelerator pedal. Always stay alert and avoid using the ICC
system where not recommended in this
warning section.
The following are some conditions in which the
sensor cannot detect the signals:
● When snow or road spray from traveling
vehicles reduces the sensor’s detection.
● When excessively heavy baggage is loaded
in the rear seat or the trunk of your vehicle.
LSD2249
ICC OPERATION
Always pay attention to the operation of the vehicle and be ready to manually control the proper
following distance. The ICC system may not be
able to maintain the selected distance between
vehicles (following distance) or selected vehicle
speed under some circumstances.
A
The Intelligent Cruise Control uses a sensor 䊊
located on the front of the vehicle to detect
vehicles traveling ahead. The sensor generally
detects the signals returned from the vehicle
ahead. Therefore, if the sensor cannot detect the
reflection from the vehicle ahead, the ICC system
may not maintain the selected distance.
The ICC system is designed to automatically
check the sensor’s operation within the limitation
of the system. When the sensor area is covered
with dirt or is obstructed, the system will automatically be canceled. If the sensor area is covered with ice, a transparent or translucent vinyl
bag, etc., the ICC system may not detect them. In
these instances, the ICC system may not cancel
and may not be able to maintain the selected
following distance from the vehicle ahead. Be
sure to check and clean the sensor area around
the distance sensor regularly.
The ICC system is designed to maintain a selected distance and reduce the speed to match
the slower vehicle ahead. The system will decelerate the vehicle as necessary and if the vehicle
ahead comes to a stop, the vehicle decelerates to
a standstill. However, the ICC system can only
apply up to 40% of the vehicle’s total braking
power.
This system should only be used when traffic
conditions allow vehicle speeds to remain fairly
constant or when vehicle speeds change gradually. If a vehicle moves into the traveling lane
ahead or if a vehicle traveling ahead rapidly decelerates, the distance between vehicles may
become closer because the ICC system cannot
decelerate the vehicle quickly enough. If this occurs, the ICC system will sound a warning chime
and blink the system display to notify the driver to
take necessary action.
The system will cancel and a warning chime will
sound if the speed is below approximately
15 MPH (24 km/h) and a vehicle is not detected
ahead. The system will also disengage when the
vehicle goes above the maximum set speed.
For additional information, refer to “Approach
warning” in this section.
The following items are controlled in the ICC
system:
● When there are no vehicles traveling ahead,
the ICC system maintains the speed set by
the driver. The set speed range is between
approximately 20 and 90 MPH (32 and
144 km/h).
Starting and driving 5-37
● When there is a vehicle traveling ahead, the
ICC system adjusts the speed to maintain
the distance, selected by driver, from the
vehicle ahead. The adjusting speed range is
up to the set speed. If the vehicle ahead
comes to a stop, the vehicle decelerates to a
standstill within the limitations of the system.
The system will cancel once it judges a
standstill with a warning chime.
● When the vehicle traveling ahead has moved
out from its lane of travel, the ICC system
accelerates and maintains vehicle speed up
to the set speed.
The ICC system does not control vehicle speed
or warn you when you approach stationary and
slow moving vehicles. You must pay attention to
vehicle operation to maintain proper distance
from vehicles ahead when approaching toll gates
or traffic congestion.
SSD0252
The detection zone of the ICC sensor is limited. A
vehicle ahead must be in the detection zone for
the vehicle-to-vehicle distance detection mode
to maintain the selected distance from the vehicle
ahead.
A vehicle ahead may move outside of the detection zone due to its position within the same lane
of travel. Motorcycles may not be detected in the
same lane ahead if they are traveling offset from
the centerline of the lane. A vehicle that is entering the lane ahead may not be detected until the
vehicle has completely moved into the lane. If
this occurs, the ICC system may warn you
by blinking the system indicator and
sounding the chime. The driver may have to
5-38 Starting and driving
manually control the proper distance away
from vehicle traveling ahead.
When driving on some roads, such as winding,
hilly, curved, narrow roads, or roads which are
under construction, the ICC sensor may detect
vehicles in a different lane, or may temporarily not
detect a vehicle traveling ahead. This may cause
the ICC system to decelerate or accelerate the
vehicle.
The detection of vehicles may also be affected by
vehicle operation (steering maneuver or traveling
position in the lane, etc.) or vehicle condition. If
this occurs, the ICC system may warn you
by blinking the system indicator and
sounding the chime unexpectedly. You will
SSD0253
SSD0254
have to manually control the proper distance away from the vehicle traveling
ahead.
When driving on the freeway at a set speed and
approaching a slower traveling vehicle ahead, the
ICC will adjust the speed to maintain the distance, selected by the driver, from the vehicle
ahead. If the vehicle ahead changes lanes or exits
the freeway, the ICC system will accelerate and
maintain the speed up to the set speed. Pay
attention to the driving operation to maintain control of the vehicle as it accelerates to the set
speed.
The vehicle may not maintain the set speed on
winding or hilly roads. If this occurs, you will have
to manually control the vehicle speed.
Starting and driving 5-39
4. DISTANCE switch:
Changes the vehicle’s following distance:
● Long
● Middle
● Short
5. CANCEL switch:
Deactivates the system without erasing the
set speed.
LSD2250
LSD2285
ICC switch
ICC system display and indicators
The system is operated by the CRUISE ON/OFF
switch and four control switches, all mounted on
the steering wheel.
The display is located between the speedometer
and tachometer.
1. RES/ACCELERATE (+) switch:
Resumes set speed or increases speed incrementally.
2. SET/COAST (–) switch:
Sets desired cruise speed or reduces speed
incrementally.
3. CRUISE ON/OFF switch:
Master switch to activate the system.
5-40 Starting and driving
1. CRUISE ON/OFF switch indicator:
● ICC system ON indicator (white): Indicates that the CRUISE ON/OFF switch is
ON.
● ICC system SET indicator (green): Indicates that the cruising speed is set.
● ICC system warning (orange): Indicates
that if there is a malfunction in the ICC
system.
2. Set vehicle speed indicator:
Indicates the set vehicle speed.
For Canadian models, the speed is displayed in km/h.
3. Set distance indicator:
Displays the selected distance between vehicles set with the distance switch.
4. Vehicle ahead detection indicator:
Indicates whether it detects a vehicle in front
of you.
LSD2286
LSD2287
To turn on the cruise control, quickly push
A on.
and release the CRUISE ON/OFF switch 䊊
The ICC system ON indicator (white), set distance indicator and set vehicle speed indicator
come on in a standby state for setting.
To set cruising speed, accelerate your vehicle
to the desired speed, push the SET/COAST (–)
switch and release it. The ICC system set indicator (green), vehicle ahead detection indicator, set
distance indicator and set vehicle speed indicaB will come on.) Take your foot off the acceltor 䊊
erator pedal. Your vehicle will maintain the set
speed.
Operating ICC
When the SET/COAST (–) switch is pushed
under the following conditions, the system cannot be set and the ICC indicators will blink for
approximately 2 seconds:
● When traveling below 20 MPH (32 km/h)
and the vehicle ahead is not detected
Starting and driving 5-41
● When the shift lever is not in the D (Drive) or
Manual mode
System operation
WARNING
● When the parking brake is applied
● When the brakes are operated by the driver
When the SET/COAST (–) switch is pushed
under the following conditions, the system cannot be set.
A warning chime will sound and a message will
pop up.
● When the VDC system is off (To use the ICC
system, turn on the VDC system. Push the
CRUISE ON/OFF switch to turn off the ICC
system and reset the ICC switch by pushing
the CRUISE ON/OFF switch again.)
For additional information about the VDC
system, refer to “Vehicle Dynamic Control
(VDC) system” in this section.
● When ABS or VDC (including the TCS) is
operating
● When a wheel is slipping (To use the ICC
system, make sure the wheels are no longer
slipping. Push the CRUISE ON/OFF switch
to turn off the ICC, and reset the ICC system
by pushing the CRUISE ON/OFF switch
again.)
5-42 Starting and driving
LSD2288
1
䊊
2
䊊
System set display with vehicle ahead
System set display without vehicle ahead
Normally when controlling the distance to
a vehicle ahead, this system automatically
accelerates or decelerates your vehicle
according to the speed of the vehicle
ahead. Depress the accelerator to properly accelerate your vehicle when acceleration is required for a lane change. Depress the brake pedal when deceleration
is required to maintain a safe distance to
the vehicle ahead due to its sudden braking or if a vehicle cuts in. Always stay alert
when using the ICC system.
The driver sets the desired vehicle speed based
on the road conditions.
The ICC system displays the set speed.
Vehicle detected ahead:
When a vehicle is detected in the lane ahead, the
ICC system decelerates the vehicle by controlling the throttle and applying the brakes to match
the speed of a slower vehicle ahead. The system
then controls the vehicle speed based on the
speed of the vehicle ahead to maintain the driver
selected distance.
The stoplights of the vehicle come on when
braking is performed by the ICC system.
How to change the set vehicle speed
To cancel the preset speed, use any of these
methods:
When the brake operates, a noise may be
heard. This is not a malfunction.
● Push the CANCEL switch. The set vehicle
speed indicator will go out.
When a vehicle ahead is detected, the vehicle
ahead detection indicator comes on. The ICC
system will also display the set speed and selected distance.
● Tap the brake pedal. The set vehicle speed
indicator will go out.
● Turn the CRUISE ON/OFF switch off. The
ICC indicators will go out.
Vehicle ahead not detected:
When a vehicle is no longer detected ahead, the
ICC system gradually accelerates your vehicle to
resume the previously set vehicle speed. The ICC
system then maintains the set speed.
When a vehicle is no longer detected the vehicle
ahead detection indicator turns off.
If a vehicle ahead appears during acceleration to
the set vehicle speed or any time the ICC system
is in operation, the system controls the distance
to that vehicle.
When a vehicle is no longer detected under
approximately 15 MPH (24 km/h), the system will
be canceled.
To reset at a faster cruising speed, use one of
the following methods:
LSD2289
When passing another vehicle, the set speed
B will flash when the vehicle speed
indicator 䊊
exceeds the set speed. The vehicle detect indicator will turn off when the area ahead of the
vehicle is open. When the pedal is released, the
vehicle will return to the previously set speed.
Even though your vehicle speed is set in the ICC
system, you can depress the accelerator pedal
when it is necessary to accelerate your vehicle
rapidly.
● Depress the accelerator pedal. When the
vehicle attains the desired speed, push and
release the SET/COAST (–) switch.
● Push and hold the RES/ACCELERATE (+)
switch. The set vehicle speed will increase
by approximately 5 MPH (5 km/h for
Canada).
● Push,
then
quickly
release
the
RES/ACCELERATE (+) switch. Each time
you do this, the set speed will increase by
approximately 1 MPH (1 km/h for Canada).
Starting and driving 5-43
To reset at a slower cruising speed, use one
of the following methods:
● Lightly tap the brake pedal. When the vehicle attains the desired speed, push the
SET/COAST (–) switch and release it.
● Push and hold the SET/COAST (–) switch.
The set vehicle speed will decrease by approximately 5 MPH (5 km/h for Canada).
● Push, then quickly release the SET/COAST
(–) switch. Each time you do this, the set
speed will decrease by approximately
1 MPH (1 km/h for Canada).
To resume the preset speed, push and release the RES/ACCELERATE (+) switch. The
vehicle will resume the last set cruising speed
when the vehicle speed is over 20 MPH
(32 km/h).
LSD2242
LSD2429
How to change the set distance to the
vehicle ahead
The distance to the vehicle ahead can be selected at any time depending on the traffic conditions.
A is pushed, the
Each time the distance switch 䊊
set distance will change to long, average, short
and back to long again, in that sequence.
Distance
Approximate distance at
60 MPH (100 km/h) [ft (m)]
1.
Long
200 (60)
2.
Average
150 (45)
3.
Short
90 (30)
● The distance to the vehicle ahead will
change according to the vehicle speed. The
higher the vehicle speed, the longer the distance.
● If the engine is stopped, the set distance
becomes “long”. (Each time the engine is
started, the initial setting becomes “long”.)
5-44 Starting and driving
Approach warning
NOTE:
If your vehicle comes closer to the vehicle ahead
due to rapid deceleration of that vehicle or if
another vehicle cuts in, the system warns the
driver with the chime and ICC system display.
Decelerate by depressing the brake pedal to
maintain a safe vehicle distance if:
The approach warning chime may sound
and the system display may blink when the
ICC sensor detects objects on the side of
the vehicle or on the side of the road. This
may cause the ICC system to decelerate or
accelerate the vehicle. The ICC sensor may
detect these objects when the vehicle is
driven on winding roads, narrow roads, hilly
roads, or when entering or exiting a curve.
In these cases you will have to manually
control the proper distance ahead of your
vehicle.
● The chime sounds.
● The vehicle ahead detection indicator blinks.
The warning chime may not sound in some cases
when there is a short distance between vehicles.
Some examples are:
● When the vehicles are traveling at the same
speed and the distance between vehicles is
not changing
● When the vehicle ahead is traveling faster
and the distance between vehicles is increasing
● When a vehicle cuts in near your vehicle
The warning chime will not sound when:
● When the shift lever is not in the D (Drive) or
Manual mode
● When the parking brake is applied
● When the VDC system is turned off
● When ABS or VDC (including the traction
control system) operates
● When a wheel slips
Also, the sensor sensitivity can be affected by
vehicle operation (steering maneuver or driving
position in the lane) or traffic or vehicle condition
(for example, if a vehicle is being driven with some
damage).
Automatic cancellation
A chime sounds under the following conditions
and the control is automatically canceled.
● The vehicle approaches other vehicles that
are parked or moving slowly.
● When the vehicle ahead is not detected and
your vehicle is traveling below the speed of
15 MPH (24 km/h)
● The accelerator pedal is depressed, overriding the system.
● When the system judges the vehicle is at
standstill
Starting and driving 5-45
Action to take:
When the conditions listed above are no longer
present, turn the system off using the ICC
CRUISE ON/OFF switch. Turn the ICC system
back on to use the system.
Condition B:
When the sensor area of the front bumper is dirty
making it impossible to detect a vehicle ahead,
the ICC system is automatically canceled.
LSD2256
The system warning light (orange) will illuminate
and the “front radar obstruction” warning message will appear in the vehicle information display.
LSD2257
Warning light and display
Action to take:
Condition A:
If the warning light (orange) comes on, park the
vehicle in a safe location and turn the engine off.
Check to see if the sensor window is blocked. If
the sensor window is blocked, remove the blocking material. Restart the engine. If the warning
light continues to illuminate, have the ICC system
checked by a NISSAN dealer.
Under the following conditions, the ICC system is
automatically canceled. The chime will sound and
the system will not be able to be set.
● When the VDC system is turned off
● When the VDC or ABS (including the TCS)
operates
Condition C:
When the ICC system is not operating properly,
the chime sounds and the system warning light
(orange) will come on.
5-46 Starting and driving
● Do not attach a sticker (including transparent material) or install an accessory near the
sensor. This could cause failure or malfunction.
● Do not attach metallic objects near the sensor area (brush guard, etc.) This could cause
failure or malfunction.
● Do not alter, remove, or paint the front bumper. Before customizing or restoring the
front bumper, please contact an NISSAN
dealer.
Radar certificate
LSD2258
LSD2249
FCC Notice:
Action to take:
Sensor maintenance
For USA:
If the warning light comes on, park the vehicle in a
safe place. Turn the engine off, restart the engine,
resume driving and set the ICC system again.
A is located on
The sensor for the ICC system 䊊
the front of the vehicle.
User Manual statement according to §15.19:
If it is not possible to set the system or the
indicator stays on, it may indicate that the
system is malfunctioning. Although the vehicle is still driveable under normal conditions, have the vehicle checked at an
NISSAN dealer.
To keep the ICC system operating properly, be
sure to observe the following:
● Always keep the sensor area clean.
● Do not strike or damage the areas around
the sensor. Do not touch or remove the
screw located on the sensor. Doing so could
failure or malfunction . If the sensor is damaged due to an accident, contact an
NISSAN dealer.
This device complies with part 15 of the
FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
Starting and driving 5-47
User Manual statement according to §15.21:
Changes or modifications made to this equipment not expressly approved by Robert BOSCH
GmbH may void the FCC authorization to operate this equipment.
User Manual statement according to §15.105:
This equipment has been tested and found to
comply with the limits for a Class A digital device,
pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These
limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial environment.
This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate
radio frequency energy and, if not installed and
used in accordance with the instruction manual,
may cause harmful interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference
in which case the user will be required to correct
the interference at his own expense.
RF Exposure Information according 2.1091 /
2.1093 / OET bulletin 65:
Radio frequency radiation exposure Information:
This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.
5-48 Starting and driving
This equipment should be installed and operated
with minimum distance of 20 cm between the
radiator and your body.
This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or
transmitter.
For Canada:
This device complies with Industry Canada
license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is
subject to the following two conditions:
1. This device must not cause interference, and
2. This device must accept any interference, including interference that may
cause undesired operation of the device.
Le présent appareil est conforme aux CNR
d’Industrie Canada applicables aux appareils radio exempts de licence. L’exploitation est autorisée aux deux conditions suivantes:
1. L’appareil ne doit pas produire de
brouillage, et
2. L’utilisateur de l’appareil doit accepter
tout brouillage radioélectrique subi,
même si le brouillage est susceptible
d’en compromettre le fonctionnement.
PREDICTIVE FORWARD COLLISION
WARNING SYSTEM (if so equipped)
LSD2263
The Predictive Forward Collision Warning system can help alert the driver when there is a
sudden braking of a second vehicle traveling in
front of the vehicle ahead in the traveling same
lane.
LSD2249
SYSTEM OPERATION
The Predictive Forward Collision Warning sysA located on the front
tem uses a radar sensor 䊊
of the vehicle to measure the distance to a second vehicle ahead in the traveling lane.
The Predictive Forward Collision Warning system operates at speeds above approximately
3 MPH (5 km/h).
If there is a potential risk of a forward collision, the
Predictive Forward Collision Warning system will
warn the driver by blinking the vehicle ahead
detection indicator, and sounding a warning
tone.
Starting and driving 5-49
LSD2264
Precautions on the Predictive Forward
Collision Warning system
WARNING
● The Predictive Forward Collision Warning system helps warn the driver before
a collision but will not avoid a collision.
It is the driver’s responsibility to stay
alert, drive safely and be in control of
the vehicle at all times.
● The radar sensor does not detect the
following objects:
5-50 Starting and driving
– Pedestrians, animals or obstacles in
the roadway
– Oncoming vehicles
– Crossing vehicles
LSD2265
WARNING
● The Predictive Forward Collision Warning system does not function when a
vehicle ahead is a narrow vehicle, such
as a motorcycle. The radar sensor may
not detect a second vehicle ahead in the
following conditions:
– Snow or road spray from travelling
vehicles.
– Driving in a tunnel.
– Snow or heavy rain.
– Dirt, ice, snow or other material covering the radar sensor.
– Interference by other radar sources.
Starting and driving 5-51
LSD2266
5-52 Starting and driving
LSD2262
LSD2267
WARNING
● The radar sensor may not detect a second vehicle when the vehicle ahead is
being towed.
● When the distance to the vehicle ahead
is too close, the beam of the radar sensor is obstructed.
● The radar sensor may not detect a second vehicle when driving on a steep
downhill slope or on roads with sharp
curves.
● Excessive noise will interfere with the
warning tone sound, and it may not be
heard.
Forward Emergency Braking system warning light (orange)
System temporarily unavailable
Condition A:
When the radar sensor picks up interference
from another radar source, making it impossible
to detect a vehicle ahead, the Predictive Forward
Collision Warning system is automatically turned
off.
The Forward Emergency Braking system warning
light (orange) and the driver assist system forward indicator (orange) will illuminate.
Starting and driving 5-53
Action to take:
System malfunction
When the above conditions no longer exist, the
Predictive Forward Collision Warning system will
resume automatically.
System malfunction
Condition B:
When the sensor area of the front bumper is
covered with dirt or is obstructed, making it impossible to detect a vehicle ahead, the Predictive
Forward Collision Warning system is automatically turned off.
The Forward Emergency Braking system warning
light (orange) will illuminate and the “FRONT
RADAR OBSTRUCTION” warning message will
appear in the vehicle information display.
Action to take:
If the warning light (orange) comes on, stop the
vehicle in a safe place, place the shift lever in the
P (Park) position and turn the engine off. Clean
the radar cover on lower grille with a soft cloth,
and restart the engine. If the warning light continues to illuminate, have the Predictive Forward
Collision Warning system checked by an
NISSAN dealer.
If the Predictive Forward Collision Warning system malfunctions, it will be turned off automatically, a chime will sound, the Forward Emergency
Braking system warning light (orange) will illuminate.
1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
Action to take:
User Manual statement according to §15.21:
If the warning light (orange) illuminates, stop the
vehicle in a safe location and place the shift lever
in the P (Park) position. Turn the engine off and
restart the engine. If the warning light continues
to illuminate, have the predictive forward collision
warning system checked by an NISSAN dealer.
For additional information, refer to “Sensor Maintenance” in the “Intelligent Cruise Control (ICC)
System (full speed range) (if so equipped)” section of this manual.
Changes or modifications made to this equipment not expressly approved by Robert BOSCH
GmbH may void the FCC authorization to operate this equipment.
Radar certificate
FCC Notice:
For USA:
User Manual statement according to §15.19:
This device complies with part 15 of the
FCC Rules.
5-54 Starting and driving
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
User Manual statement according to §15.105:
This equipment has been tested and found to
comply with the limits for a Class A digital device,
pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These
limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial environment.
This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate
radio frequency energy and, if not installed and
used in accordance with the instruction manual,
may cause harmful interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference
in which case the user will be required to correct
the interference at his own expense.
FORWARD EMERGENCY BRAKING
SYSTEM (if so equipped)
RF Exposure Information according 2.1091 /
2.1093 / OET bulletin 65:
Radio frequency radiation exposure Information:
Le présent appareil est conforme aux CNR
d’Industrie Canada applicables aux appareils radio exempts de licence. L’exploitation est autorisée aux deux conditions suivantes:
This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.
1. L’appareil ne doit pas produire de
brouillage, et
This equipment should be installed and operated
with minimum distance of 20 cm between the
radiator and your body.
2. L’utilisateur de l’appareil doit accepter
tout brouillage radioélectrique subi,
même si le brouillage est susceptible
d’en compromettre le fonctionnement.
This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or
transmitter.
For Canada:
This device complies with Industry Canada
license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is
subject to the following two conditions:
1. This device must not cause interference, and
2. This device must accept any interference, including interference that may
cause undesired operation of the device.
LSD2249
The Forward Emergency Braking system can assist the driver when there is a risk of a forward
collision with the vehicle ahead in the travelling
lane. The Forward Emergency Braking system
A located at the front of the
uses a radar sensor 䊊
vehicle to measure the distance to the vehicle
ahead in the travelling lane. The Forward Emergency Braking system operates at speeds above
approximately 3 MPH (5 km/h).
Starting and driving 5-55
WARNING
● The Forward Emergency Braking system is a supplemental aid to the driver.
It is not a replacement for the driver’s
attention to traffic conditions or responsibility to drive safely. It cannot
prevent accidents due to carelessness
or dangerous driving techniques.
● The Forward Emergency Braking system does not function in all driving,
traffic, weather and road conditions.
LSD2284
SYSTEM OPERATION
The Forward Emergency Braking system will
function when your vehicle is driven at speeds
above approximately 3 MPH (5 km/h).
If a risk of a forward collision is detected, the
Forward Emergency Braking system will provide
the first warning to the driver by an audible warning.
If the driver applies the brakes quickly and forcefully after the warning, and the Forward Emergency Braking system detects that there is still
the possibility of a forward collision, the system
will automatically increase the braking force. If the
driver does not take action, the Forward Emer-
5-56 Starting and driving
gency Braking system issues the second visual
warning (red) and audible warning and also applies partial braking. If the risk of a collision becomes imminent, the Forward Emergency Braking system applies harder braking automatically.
NOTE:
The vehicle’s brake lights come on when
braking is performed by the Forward Emergency Braking system.
Depending on vehicle speed and distance to the
vehicle ahead, as well as driving and roadway
conditions, the system may help the driver avoid a
forward collision or may help mitigate the consequences if a collision should one be unavoidable.
If the driver is handling the steering wheel, accelerating or braking, the Forward Emergency Braking system will function later or will not function.
The automatic braking will cease under the following conditions:
● When the steering wheel is turned as far as
necessary to avoid a collision.
● When the accelerator pedal is depressed.
● When there is no longer a vehicle detected
ahead. If the Forward Emergency Braking
system has stopped the vehicle, the vehicle
will remain at a standstill for approximately
2 seconds before the brakes are released.
WARNING
● The radar sensor does not detect the
following objects:
– Pedestrians, animals or obstacles in
the roadway
– Oncoming vehicles
– Crossing vehicles
● The radar sensor has some performance limitations. If a stationary vehicle is in the vehicle’s path, the Forward Emergency Braking system will
not function when the vehicle is driven
at speeds over approximately 50 MPH
(80 km/h).
● The radar sensor may not detect a vehicle ahead in the following conditions:
– Dirt, ice, snow or other material covering the radar sensor.
– Interference by other radar sources.
– Snow or road spray from travelling
vehicles.
● Braking distances increase on slippery
surfaces.
● Excessive noise will interfere with the
warning chime sound, and the chime
may not be heard.
● The system is designed to automatically
check the sensor’s functionality, within
certain limitations. The system may not
detect some forms of obstruction of the
sensor area such as ice, snow, stickers,
for example. In these cases, the system
may not be able to warn the driver properly. Be sure that you check, clean and
clear the sensor area regularly.
– If the vehicle ahead is narrow (e.g.
motorcycle).
Turning the Forward Emergency
Braking system ON/OFF
– When driving on a steep downhill
slope or roads with sharp curves.
Perform the following steps to turn the Forward
Emergency Braking system ON or OFF.
– When towing a trailer.
● In some road or traffic conditions, the
Forward Emergency Braking system
may unexpectedly apply partial braking.
When acceleration is necessary, continue to depress the accelerator pedal
to override the system.
button until “Settings” dis1. Press the
plays in the vehicle information display and
button
then press OK button. Use the
to select “Driver Assistance”. Then press the
OK button.
2. Select “Emergency Brake” and press the
OK button.
3. Select “System” and press the OK button.
Starting and driving 5-57
The Forward Emergency Braking system will be
automatically turned on when the engine is restarted.
Condition B:
When the sensor window is dirty, making it impossible to detect a vehicle ahead, the Forward
Emergency Braking system is automatically
turned off. The system warning light (orange) will
illuminate and the “front radar obstruction” warning message will appear in the vehicle information
display.
NOTE:
When the Forward Emergency Braking system setting is turned on or off, the Predictive Forward Collision Warning system is
also turned on or off simultaneously.
Action to take:
LSD2262
System temporarily unavailable
Condition A:
When the radar sensor picks up interference
from another radar source, making it impossible
to detect a vehicle ahead, the Forward Emergency Braking system is automatically turned off.
The Forward Emergency Braking system warning
light (orange) will illuminate.
Action to take:
When the above conditions no longer exist, the
Forward Emergency Braking system will resume
automatically.
5-58 Starting and driving
If the warning light (orange) comes on, park the
vehicle in a safe location and turn the engine off.
Check to see if the sensor window is blocked. If
the sensor window is blocked, remove the blocking material. Restart the engine. If the warning
light continues to illuminate, have the ICC system
checked by a NISSAN dealer.
System malfunction
If the Forward Emergency Braking system malfunctions, it will be turned off automatically, a
chime will sound, the Forward Emergency Braking system warning light (orange) will illuminate
and the warning message [Malfunction] will appear in the vehicle information display.
DRIVER ATTENTION ALERT (if so
equipped)
Action to take:
For Canada:
If the warning light (orange) comes on, park the
vehicle in a safe location, turn the engine off and
restart the engine. If the warning light continues
to illuminate, have the Forward Emergency Braking system checked by a NISSAN dealer.
This device complies with Industry Canada
license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is
subject to the following two conditions:
Radar certificate
FCC Notice:
For USA:
User Manual statement according to §15.19:
This device complies with part 15 of the
FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
WARNING
1. This device must not cause interference, and
● The Driver Attention Alert system is only
a warning to inform the driver of a potential lack of driver attention or
drowsiness. It will not steer the vehicle
or prevent loss of control.
2. This device must accept any interference, including interference that may
cause undesired operation of the device.
● The Driver Attention Alert system does
not detect and provide an alert of the
driver’s lack of attention or fatigue in
every situation.
Le présent appareil est conforme aux CNR
d’Industrie Canada applicables aux appareils radio exempts de licence. L’exploitation est autorisée aux deux conditions suivantes:
1. L’appareil ne doit pas produire de
brouillage, et
2. L’utilisateur de l’appareil doit accepter
tout brouillage radioélectrique subi,
même si le brouillage est susceptible
d’en compromettre le fonctionnement.
● It is the driver’s responsibility to:
● stay alert,
● drive safely,
● keep the vehicle in the traveling lane,
● be in control of the vehicle at all
times,
● avoid driving when tired,
● avoid distractions (texting, etc).
Failure to do so could cause you to lose
control of the vehicle, resulting in a serious accident, personal injury or death.
Driver Attention Alert system helps alert the driver
if the system detects a lack of attention or driving
fatigue.
Starting and driving 5-59
The system monitors driving style and steering
behavior over a period of time, and it detects
changes from the normal pattern. If the system
detects that driver attention is decreasing over a
period of time, the system uses an audible and
visual warning to suggest that the driver take a
break.
DRIVER ATTENTION ALERT
OPERATION
If the system detects that driver fatigue or that
driver attention is decreasing, the message “Take
a break?” appears in the vehicle information display and a chime sounds when the vehicle is
driven at speeds above 37 MPH (60 km/h).
The system continuously monitors driver attention and can provide multiple warnings per trip.
The system resets and starts reassessing driving
style and steering behavior when the ignition
switch is cycled from on to off and back on.
LSD2335
5-60 Starting and driving
TURNING THE DRIVER ATTENTION
ALERT SYSTEM ON AND OFF
Perform the following steps to enable or disable
the Driver Attention Alert system.
button until “Settings” dis1. Press the
plays in the vehicle information display and
button
press the OK button. Use the
to select “Driver Assistance”. Then press the
OK button.
2. Select “Driver Attention Alert” and press the
OK button.
NOTE:
The setting will be retained even if the
engine is restarted.
DRIVER ATTENTION ALERT
LIMITATIONS
WARNING
● The Driver Attention Alert system may
not operate properly and may not provide an alert in the following conditions:
● Poor road conditions such as an uneven road surface or pot holes.
LSD2330
● Strong side wind.
Starting and driving 5-61
BREAK-IN SCHEDULE
● If you have adopted a sporty driving
style with higher cornering speeds or
higher rates of acceleration.
CAUTION
During the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km),
follow these recommendations to obtain
maximum engine performance and ensure
the future reliability and economy of your
new vehicle. Failure to follow these recommendations may result in shortened
engine
life
and
reduced
engine
performance.
● Frequent lane changes or changes to
vehicle speed.
● The Driver Attention Alert system may
not provide an alert in the following
conditions:
● Vehicle speeds lower than 37 mph
(60 km/h).
● Avoid driving for long periods at constant
speed, either fast or slow, and do not run the
engine over 4,000 RPM.
● Short lapses of attention.
● Instantaneous distractions such as
dropping an object.
LIC3125
SYSTEM MALFUNCTION
● Avoid quick starts.
If the Driver Attention Alert system malfunctions,
the system warning message will appear in the
vehicle information display and the function will
be stopped automatically.
● Avoid hard braking as much as possible.
Action to take
Stop the vehicle in a safe location, and then turn
off and restart the engine. If the system warning
message continues to appear, have the system
checked by a NISSAN dealer.
5-62 Starting and driving
● Do not accelerate at full throttle in any gear.
● Do not tow a trailer for the first 500 mi
(805 km). Your engine, axle or other parts
could be damaged.
FUEL EFFICIENT DRIVING TIPS
Follow these easy-to-use Fuel Efficient Driving
Tips to help you achieve the most fuel economy
from your vehicle.
● Above 40 MPH (64 km/h), it is more
efficient to use A/C to cool the vehicle
due to increased aerodynamic drag.
1. Use Smooth Accelerator and Brake
Pedal Application
● Recirculating the cool air in the cabin
when the A/C is on reduces cooling load.
● Avoid rapid starts and stops.
● Use smooth, gentle accelerator and
brake application whenever possible.
● Maintain constant speed while commuting and coast whenever possible.
2. Maintain Constant Speed
● Look ahead to try and anticipate and minimize stops.
● Synchronizing your speed with traffic
lights allows you to reduce your number
of stops.
● Maintaining a steady speed can minimize
red light stops and improve fuel efficiency.
3. Use Air Conditioning (A/C) at Higher
Vehicle Speeds
● Below 40 MPH (64 km/h), it is more
efficient to open windows to cool the
vehicle due to reduced engine load.
4. Drive at Economical Speeds and Distances
● Observing the speed limit and not exceeding 60 MPH (97 km/h) (where legally allowed) can improve fuel efficiency
due to reduced aerodynamic drag.
● Maintaining a safe following distance behind other vehicles reduces unnecessary
braking.
● Safely monitoring traffic to anticipate
changes in speed permits reduced braking and smooth acceleration changes.
● Select a gear range suitable to road conditions.
5. Use Cruise Control
● Using cruise control during highway driving helps maintain a steady speed.
● Cruise control is particularly effective in
providing fuel savings when driving on flat
terrains.
6. Plan for the Shortest Route
● Utilize a map or navigation system to determine the best route to save time.
7. Avoid Idling
● Shutting off your engine when safe for
stops exceeding 30–60 seconds saves
fuel and reduces emissions.
8. Buy an Automated Pass for Toll Roads
● Automated passes permit drivers to use
special lanes to maintain cruising speed
through the toll and avoid stopping and
starting.
9. Winter Warm Up
● Limit idling time to minimize impact to fuel
economy.
● Vehicles typically need no more than
30 seconds of idling at start-up to effectively circulate the engine oil before driving.
● Your vehicle will reach its ideal operating
temperature more quickly while driving
versus idling.
Starting and driving 5-63
INCREASING FUEL ECONOMY
10. Keeping your Vehicle Cool
● Keep your engine tuned up.
● Park your vehicle in a covered parking
area or in the shade whenever possible.
● Follow the recommended scheduled maintenance.
● When entering a hot vehicle, opening the
windows will help to reduce the inside
temperature faster, resulting in reduced
demand on your A/C system.
● Keep the tires inflated to the correct pressure. Low tire pressure increases tire wear
and lowers fuel economy.
● Keep all the wheels in correct alignment.
Improper alignment increases tire wear and
lowers fuel economy.
● Use the recommended viscosity engine oil.
For additional information, refer to “Engine
oil and oil filter recommendations” in the
“Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
5-64 Starting and driving
ALL-WHEEL DRIVE (AWD) (if so
equipped)
If any malfunction occurs in the All-Wheel Drive
(AWD) system while the engine is running, messages are displayed in the meter.
LSD2275
LSD2276
LSD2277
If the AWD error warning message is displayed,
there may be a malfunction in the All-Wheel Drive
(AWD) system. Reduce vehicle speed and have
your vehicle checked by an NISSAN dealer as
soon as possible.
The AWD high temperature message may be
displayed while trying to free a stuck vehicle due
to increased oil temperature. The driving mode
may change to 2-wheel drive. If this message is
displayed, stop the vehicle with the engine idling,
as soon as it is safe to do so. Then if the message
turns off, you can continue driving.
The tire size message may be displayed if there is
a large difference between the diameters of front
and rear wheels. Pull off the road in a safe area,
with the engine idling. Check that all tire sizes are
the same, that the tire pressure is correct and that
the tires are not excessively worn.
If any warning messages continue to be displayed, have your vehicle checked by an NISSAN
dealer as soon as possible.
Starting and driving 5-65
WARNING
● Do not drive beyond the performance
capability of the tires. Accelerating
quickly, sharp steering maneuvers or
sudden braking may cause loss of control, even with All-Wheel Drive (AWD)
engaged.
● For AWD equipped vehicles, do not attempt to raise two wheels off the
ground and shift the transmission to
any drive or reverse position with the
engine running. Doing so may result in
drivetrain damage or unexpected vehicle movement which could result in
serious personal injury or vehicle
damage.
● Do not attempt to test an AWD
equipped vehicle on a 2-wheel dynamometer (such as the dynamometers
used by some states for emissions testing) or similar equipment even if the
other two wheels are raised off the
ground. Make sure that you inform the
test facility personnel that your vehicle
is equipped with AWD before it is
placed on a dynamometer. Using the
wrong test equipment may result in
drivetrain damage or unexpected vehicle movement which could result in
serious personal injury or vehicle
damage.
CAUTION
● Do not operate the engine on a free
roller when any of the wheels are
raised.
● If you use the free roller, rotate four
wheels with the same speed without
raising any wheels.
● If an AWD warning message is displayed while driving there may be a
malfunction in the AWD system. Reduce
the vehicle speed immediately and have
your vehicle checked by a NISSAN
dealer as soon as possible.
5-66 Starting and driving
● The powertrain may be damaged if you
continue driving when the AWD temperature or tire size incorrect messages
are displayed
● If the AWD high temperature message
is displayed while you are driving, pull
off the road in a safe area, and idle the
engine. The driving mode will change to
2WD to prevent the AWD system from
malfunctioning. If the warning message
turns off, you can drive again.
● If the tire size incorrect message is displayed while you are driving, pull off the
road in a safe area with the engine
idling. Check that all tire sizes are the
same, that the tire pressure is correct
and that the tires are not excessively
worn.
● If a warning message continues to be
displayed after the above operations,
have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN
dealer as soon as possible.
PARKING/PARKING ON HILLS
A
● HEADED DOWNHILL WITH CURB: 䊊
Turn the wheels into the curb and move the
vehicle forward until the curb side wheel
gently touches the curb.
B
● HEADED UPHILL WITH CURB: 䊊
Turn the wheels away from the curb and
move the vehicle back until the curb side
wheel gently touches the curb.
● HEADED UPHILL OR DOWNHILL, NO
C
CURB: 䊊
WSD0050
WARNING
● Do not stop or park the vehicle over
flammable materials such as dry grass,
waste paper or rags. They may ignite
and cause a fire.
● Safe parking procedures require that
both the parking brake be set and the
transmission placed into P (Park). Failure to do so could cause the vehicle to
move unexpectedly or roll away and result in an accident. Make sure the shift
lever has been pushed as far forward as
it can go and cannot be moved without
depressing the foot brake pedal.
● Never leave the engine running while
the vehicle is unattended.
Turn the wheels toward the side of the road
so the vehicle will move away from the center of the road if it moves.
4. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK position.
● Do not leave children unattended inside
the vehicle. They could unknowingly activate switches or controls. Unattended
children could become involved in serious accidents.
1. Firmly apply the parking brake.
2. Move the shift lever to the P (Park) position.
3. To help prevent the vehicle from rolling into
traffic when parked on an incline, it is a good
practice to turn the wheels as illustrated.
Starting and driving 5-67
POWER STEERING
WARNING
● If the engine is not running or is turned
off while driving, the power assist for
the steering will not work. Steering will
be harder to operate.
● When the power steering warning light
illuminates with the engine running,
there will be no power assist for the
steering. You will still have control of
the vehicle, but the steering will be
much harder to operate. Have the power
steering system checked by a NISSAN
dealer.
The power steering system is designed to provide power assistance while driving to operate
the steering wheel with light force.
When the steering wheel is operated repeatedly
or continuously while parking or driving at a very
low speed, the power assist for the steering
wheel will be reduced. This is to prevent overheating of the power steering system and protect
it from getting damaged. While the power assist
is reduced, steering wheel operation will become
heavy. If the steering wheel operation is still performed, the power steering may stop and the
power steering warning light will illuminate. In a
safe location, stop the engine and push the ignition switch to the OFF position. The temperature
5-68 Starting and driving
BRAKE SYSTEM
of the power steering system will go down after a
period of time and the power assist level will
return to normal after starting the engine. The
power steering warning light will go off. Avoid
repeating such steering wheel operations that
could cause the power steering system to overheat.
You may hear a noise from the front of the vehicle
when the steering wheel is operated. This is a
normal operational noise and is not a malfunction.
If the power steering warning light illuminates
while the engine is running, it may indicate the
power steering system is not functioning properly
and may need servicing. Have the power steering
system checked by a NISSAN dealer.
When the power steering warning light illuminates with the engine running, the power assist
for the steering will cease operation but you will
still have control of the vehicle. At this time,
greater steering efforts are required to operate
the steering wheel, especially in sharp turns and
at low speeds.
The brake system has two separate hydraulic
circuits. If one circuit malfunctions, you will still
have braking at two wheels.
BRAKE PRECAUTIONS
Vacuum assisted brakes
The brake booster aids braking by using engine
vacuum. If the engine stops, you can stop the
vehicle by depressing the brake pedal. However,
greater foot pressure on the brake pedal will be
required to stop the vehicle and stopping distance will be longer.
Using the brakes
Avoid resting your foot on the brake pedal while
driving. This will overheat the brakes, wear out the
brake pads faster, and reduce gas mileage.
To help reduce brake wear and to prevent the
brakes from overheating, reduce speed and
downshift to a lower gear before going down a
slope or long grade. Overheated brakes may
reduce braking performance and could result in
loss of vehicle control.
WARNING
● While driving on a slippery surface, be
careful when braking, accelerating or
downshifting. Abrupt braking or accelerating could cause the wheels to skid
and result in an accident.
● If the engine is not running or is turned
off while driving, the power assist for
the brakes will not work. Braking will be
harder.
Wet brakes
When the vehicle is washed or driven through
water, the brakes may get wet. As a result, your
braking distance will be longer and the vehicle
may pull to one side during braking.
To dry the brakes, drive the vehicle at a safe
speed while lightly pressing the brake pedal to
heat up the brakes. Do this until the brakes return
to normal. Avoid driving the vehicle at high
speeds until the brakes function correctly.
Parking brake break-in
Break-in the parking brake shoes whenever the
effect of the parking brake is weakened or whenever the parking brake shoes and/or drum/rotors
are replaced, in order to assure the best brake
performance.
This procedure is described in the vehicle service
manual and can be performed by a NISSAN
dealer.
ANTI-LOCK BRAKING SYSTEM
(ABS)
WARNING
– When installing a spare tire, make
sure that it is the proper size and type
as specified on the Tire and Loading
Information label. For additional information, refer to “Tire and loading
information label” in the “Technical
and consumer information” section
of this manual.
● The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) is a
sophisticated device, but it cannot prevent accidents resulting from careless
or dangerous driving techniques. It can
help maintain vehicle control during
braking on slippery surfaces. Remember that stopping distances on slippery
surfaces will be longer than on normal
surfaces even with ABS. Stopping distances may also be longer on rough,
gravel or snow covered roads, or if you
are using tire chains. Always maintain a
safe distance from the vehicle in front of
you. Ultimately, the driver is responsible for safety.
The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) controls the
brakes so the wheels do not lock during hard
braking or when braking on slippery surfaces.
The system detects the rotation speed at each
wheel and varies the brake fluid pressure to prevent each wheel from locking and sliding. By
preventing each wheel from locking, the system
helps the driver maintain steering control and
helps to minimize swerving and spinning on slippery surfaces.
● Tire type and condition may also affect
braking effectiveness.
Using the system
– When replacing tires, install the
specified size of tires on all four
wheels.
– For additional information, refer to
“Wheels and tires” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of
this manual.
Depress the brake pedal and hold it down. Depress the brake pedal with firm steady pressure,
but do not pump the brakes. The ABS will operate to prevent the wheels from locking up. Steer
the vehicle to avoid obstacles.
Starting and driving 5-69
VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC)
SYSTEM
WARNING
Do not pump the brake pedal. Doing so
may result in increased stopping
distances.
Self-test feature
The ABS includes electronic sensors, electric
pumps, hydraulic solenoids and a computer. The
computer has a built-in diagnostic feature that
tests the system each time you start the engine
and move the vehicle at a low speed in forward or
reverse. When the self-test occurs, you may hear
a “clunk” noise and/or feel a pulsation in the brake
pedal. This is normal and does not indicate a
malfunction. If the computer senses a malfunction, it switches the ABS off and illuminates the
ABS warning light on the instrument panel. The
brake system then operates normally but without
anti-lock assistance.
If the ABS warning light illuminates during the
self-test or while driving, have the vehicle
checked by a NISSAN dealer.
Normal operation
The ABS operates at speeds above 3 - 6 MPH (5
- 10 km/h). The speed varies according to road
conditions.
5-70 Starting and driving
When the ABS senses that one or more wheels
are close to locking up, the actuator rapidly applies and releases hydraulic pressure. This action
is similar to pumping the brakes very quickly. You
may feel a pulsation in the brake pedal and hear a
noise from under the hood or feel a vibration from
the actuator when it is operating. This is normal
and indicates that the ABS is operating properly.
However, the pulsation may indicate that road
conditions are hazardous and extra care is required while driving.
The Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system uses
various sensors to monitor driver inputs and vehicle motion. Under certain driving conditions,
the VDC System helps to perform the following
functions:
● Controls brake pressure to reduce wheel
slip on one slipping drive wheel so power is
transferred to a non slipping drive wheel on
the same axle.
BRAKE ASSIST
● Controls brake pressure and engine output
to reduce drive wheel slip based on vehicle
speed (traction control function).
When the force applied to the brake pedal exceeds a certain level, the brake assist is activated
generating greater braking force than a conventional brake booster even with light pedal force.
● Controls brake pressure at individual wheels
and engine output to help the driver maintain
control of the vehicle in the following conditions:
WARNING
The brake assist is only an aid to assist
braking operation and is not a collision
warning or avoidance device. it is the drivers responsibility to stay alert, drive safely
and be in control of the vehicle at all times.
– understeer (vehicle tends to not follow
the steered path despite increased steering input)
– oversteer (vehicle tends to spin due to
certain road or driving conditions)
The VDC system can help the driver to maintain
control of the vehicle, but it cannot prevent loss of
vehicle control in all driving situations.
When the VDC system operates, the
indicator in the instrument panel flashes so note the
following:
● The road may be slippery or the system may
determine some action is required to help
keep the vehicle on the steered path.
● You may feel a pulsation in the brake pedal
and hear a noise or vibration from under the
hood. This is normal and indicates that the
VDC system is working properly.
● Adjust your speed and driving to the road
conditions.
For additional information, refer to “Slip indicator
light” and ”Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF
indicator light” in the ”Instruments and controls”
section of this manual.
If a malfunction occurs in the system, the
and
indicator lights come on in the instrument panel. The VDC system automatically turns
off when these indicator lights are on.
The VDC OFF switch is used to turn off the VDC
indicator illuminates to indisystem. The
cate the VDC system is off.
When the VDC switch is used to turn off the
system, the VDC system still operates to prevent
one drive wheel from slipping by transferring
power to a non slipping drive wheel. The
indicator flashes if this occurs. All other VDC
indicator will not
functions are off and the
flash.
The VDC system is automatically reset to on
when the ignition switch is placed in the OFF
position then back to the ON position.
The computer has a built in diagnostic feature
that tests the system each time you start the
engine and move the vehicle forward or in reverse
at a slow speed. When the self-test occurs, you
may hear a clunk noise and/or feel a pulsation in
the brake pedal. This is normal and is not an
indication of a malfunction.
WARNING
● The VDC system is designed to help the
driver maintain stability but does not
prevent accidents due to abrupt steering operation at high speeds or by careless or dangerous driving techniques.
Reduce vehicle speed and be especially
careful when driving and cornering on
slippery surfaces and always drive
carefully.
● Do not modify the vehicle’s suspension.
If suspension parts such as shock absorbers, struts, springs, stabilizer bars,
bushings and wheels are not NISSAN
recommended for your vehicle or are
extremely deteriorated, the VDC system
may not operate properly. This could
adversely affect vehicle handling perindicator may
formance, and the
and
indicaflash or both the
tor lights may illuminate.
● If brake related parts such as brake
pads, rotors and calipers are not
NISSAN recommended or are extremely
deteriorated, the VDC system may not
operate properly and both the
and the
indicator lights may
illuminate.
● If engine control related parts are not
NISSAN recommended or are extremely
and
deteriorated, both the
indicator lights may illuminate.
Starting and driving 5-71
HILL START ASSIST SYSTEM
● When driving on extremely inclined surfaces such as higher banked corners,
the VDC system may not operate propindicator may flash or
erly and the
and
indicator
both the
lights may illuminate. Do not drive on
these types of roads.
● When driving on an unstable surface
such as a turntable, ferry, elevator or
indicator may flash or
ramp, the
and
indicator
both the
lights may illuminate. This is not a malfunction. Restart the engine after driving onto a stable surface.
● If wheels or tires other than the NISSAN
recommended ones are used, the VDC
system may not operate properly and
indicator may flash or both
the
and
indicator lights may
the
illuminate.
● The VDC system is not a substitute for
winter tires or tire chains on a snow
covered road.
5-72 Starting and driving
WARNING
● Never rely solely on the Hill Start Assist
system to prevent the vehicle from moving backward on a hill. Always drive
carefully and attentively. Depress the
brake pedal when the vehicle is stopped
on a steep hill. Be especially careful
when stopped on a hill on frozen or
muddy roads. Failure to prevent the vehicle from rolling backwards may result
in a loss of control of the vehicle and
possible serious injury or death.
● The Hill Start Assist system is not designed to hold the vehicle at a standstill
on a hill. Depress the brake pedal when
the vehicle is stopped on a steep hill.
Failure to do so may cause the vehicle
to roll backwards and may result in a
collision or serious personal injury.
● The Hill Start Assist may not prevent the
vehicle from rolling backwards on a hill
under all load or road conditions. Always be prepared to depress the brake
pedal to prevent the vehicle from rolling
backwards. Failure to do so may result
in a collision or serious personal injury.
When the vehicle is stopped on a hill, the Hill
Start Assist system automatically keeps the
brakes applied. This helps prevent the vehicle
from rolling backward in the time it takes the
driver to release the brake pedal and apply the
accelerator.
Hill Start Assist will operate automatically under
the following conditions:
● The shift lever is shifted to a forward or
reverse gear.
● The vehicle is stopped completely on a hill
by applying the brake.
● The hill grade is above 10%.
The maximum holding time is two seconds. After
two seconds the vehicle will begin to roll back
and Hill Start Assist will stop operating completely.
Hill Start Assist will not operate when the shift
lever is shifted into N (Neutral) or P (Park) or on a
flat and level road.
COLD WEATHER DRIVING
FREEING A FROZEN DOOR LOCK
To prevent a door lock from freezing, apply deicer through the key hole. If the lock becomes
frozen, heat the key before inserting it into the key
hole, or use the NISSAN Intelligent Key®.
ANTIFREEZE
In the winter when it is anticipated that the temperature will drop below 32°F (0°C), check the
antifreeze to assure proper winter protection. For
additional information, refer to “Engine cooling
system” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself”
section of this manual.
BATTERY
If the battery is not fully charged during extremely
cold weather conditions, the battery fluid may
freeze and damage the battery. To maintain maximum efficiency, the battery should be checked
regularly. For additional information, refer to “Battery” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual.
DRAINING OF COOLANT WATER
If the vehicle is to be left outside without antifreeze, drain the cooling system, including the
engine block. Refill before operating the vehicle.
For additional information, refer to “Changing
engine coolant” in the “Maintenance and do-ityourself” section of this manual.
TIRE EQUIPMENT
1. SUMMER tires have a tread designed to
provide superior performance on dry pavement. However, the performance of these
tires will be substantially reduced in snowy
and icy conditions. If you operate your vehicle on snowy or icy roads, NISSAN recommends the use of MUD & SNOW or ALL
SEASON TIRES on all four wheels. Please
consult a NISSAN dealer for the tire type,
size, speed rating and availability information.
2. For additional traction on icy roads, studded
tires may be used. However, some U.S.
states and Canadian provinces prohibit their
use. Check local, state and provincial laws
before installing studded tires.
Skid and traction capabilities of studded
snow tires on wet or dry surfaces may be
poorer than that of non-studded snow tires.
3. Tire chains may be used. For additional information, refer to “Tire chains” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this
manual.
SPECIAL WINTER EQUIPMENT
It is recommended that the following items be
carried in the vehicle during winter:
● A scraper and stiff-bristled brush to remove
ice and snow from the windows and wiper
blades.
● A sturdy, flat board to be placed under the
jack to give it firm support.
● A shovel to dig the vehicle out of snowdrifts.
● Extra washer fluid to refill the windshieldwasher fluid reservoir.
DRIVING ON SNOW OR ICE
WARNING
● Wet ice (32°F, 0°C and freezing rain),
very cold snow or ice can be slick and
very hard to drive on. The vehicle will
have much less traction or “grip” under
these conditions. Try to avoid driving on
wet ice until the road is salted or
sanded.
● Whatever the condition, drive with caution. Accelerate and slow down with
care. If accelerating or downshifting too
fast, the drive wheels will lose even
more traction.
Starting and driving 5-73
● Allow more stopping distance under
these conditions. Braking should be
started sooner than on dry pavement.
● Allow greater following distances on
slippery roads.
● Watch for slippery spots (glare ice).
These may appear on an otherwise
clear road in shaded areas. If a patch of
ice is seen ahead, brake before reaching it. Try not to brake while on the ice,
and avoid any sudden steering
maneuvers.
● Do not use the cruise control on slippery roads.
● Snow can trap dangerous exhaust
gases under your vehicle. Keep snow
clear of the exhaust pipe and from
around your vehicle.
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER (if so
equipped)
Engine block heaters are used to assist with cold
temperature starting.
The engine block heater should be used when
the outside temperature is 20°F (-7°C) or lower.
5-74 Starting and driving
WARNING
● Do not use your engine block heater
with an ungrounded electrical system or
a 2-pronged adapter. You can be seriously injured by an electrical shock if
you use an ungrounded connection.
● Disconnect and properly store the engine block heater cord before starting
the engine. Damage to the cord could
result in an electrical shock and can
cause serious injury.
● Use a heavy-duty 3-wire, 3-pronged extension cord rated for at least 10 A. Plug
the extension cord into a Ground Fault
Interrupt (GFI) protected, grounded
110-VAC outlet. Failure to use the
proper extension cord or a grounded
outlet can result in a fire or electrical
shock and cause serious personal
injury.
To use the engine block heater:
1. Turn the engine off.
2. Open the hood and unwrap the engine block
heater cord.
3. Plug the engine block heater cord into a
grounded 3-wire, 3-pronged extension
cord.
4. Plug the extension cord into a Ground Fault
Interrupt (GFI) protected, grounded 110volt AC (VAC) outlet.
5. The engine block heater must be plugged in
for at least two to four hours, depending on
outside temperatures, to properly warm the
engine coolant. Use an appropriate timer to
turn the engine block heater on.
6. Before starting the engine, unplug and properly store the cord to keep it away from
moving parts.
6 In case of emergency
Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
Emergency engine shut off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Changing a flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10
Push starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
If your vehicle overheats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
Towing your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
Towing recommended by NISSAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14
Vehicle recovery (freeing a stuck vehicle) . . . . . . . . . 6-15
HAZARD WARNING FLASHER
SWITCH
EMERGENCY ENGINE SHUT OFF
LIC0394
Push the switch on to warn other drivers when
you must stop or park under emergency conditions. All turn signal lights flash.
WARNING
● If stopping for an emergency, be sure to
move the vehicle well off the road.
● Do not use the hazard warning flashers
while moving on the highway unless
unusual circumstances force you to
drive so slowly that your vehicle might
become a hazard to other traffic.
● Turn signals do not work when the hazard warning flasher lights are on.
6-2 In case of emergency
The flashers will operate with the ignition switch
placed in any position.
To shut off the engine in an emergency situation
while driving, perform the following procedure:
Some jurisdictions may prohibit the use of
the hazard warning flasher switch while
driving.
– Rapidly push the push-button ignition switch 3
consecutive times in less than 1.5 seconds, or
– Push and hold the push-button ignition switch
for more than 2 seconds.
FLAT TIRE
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING
SYSTEM (TPMS)
This vehicle is equipped with TPMS. It monitors
tire pressure of all tires except the spare. When
the low tire pressure warning light is lit, and the
Tire Pressure Low - Add Air warning appears in
the vehicle information display, one or more of
your tires is significantly under-inflated. If
equipped, the system also displays pressure of
all tires (except the spare tire) on the display
screen by sending a signal from a sensor that is
installed in each wheel. If the vehicle is being
driven with low tire pressure, the TPMS will activate and warn you of it by the low tire pressure
warning light. This system will activate only when
the vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 mph
(25 km/h). For additional information, refer to
“Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders”
in the “Instruments and controls” section and
“Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)” in the
“Starting and driving” section of this manual.
WARNING
● Radio waves could adversely affect
electric medical equipment. Those who
use a pacemaker should contact the
electric medical equipment manufacturer for the possible influences before
use.
● If the low tire pressure warning light
illuminates while driving, avoid sudden
steering maneuvers or abrupt braking,
reduce vehicle speed, pull off the road
to a safe location and stop the vehicle
as soon as possible. Driving with underinflated tires may permanently damage
the tires and increase the likelihood of
tire failure. Serious vehicle damage
could occur and may lead to an accident
and could result in serious personal injury. Check the tire pressure for all four
tires. Adjust the tire pressure to the
recommended COLD tire pressure
shown on the Tire and Loading Information label to turn the low tire pressure
warning light OFF. If you have a flat tire,
replace it with a spare tire as soon as
possible. If the light still comes on while
driving after adjusting the tire pressure,
a tire may be flat or the TPMS may be
malfunctioning. If you have a flat tire,
replace it with a spare tire as soon as
possible. If no tire is flat and all tires are
properly inflated, have the vehicle
checked by a NISSAN dealer.
● When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel
is replaced, tire pressure will not be
indicated, the TPMS will not function
and the low tire pressure warning light
will flash for approximately 1 minute.
The light will remain on after 1 minute.
Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as
possible for tire replacement and/or
system resetting.
● Replacing tires with those not originally
specified by NISSAN could affect the
proper operation of the TPMS.
● Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosol
tire sealant into the tires, as this may
cause a malfunction of the tire pressure
sensors.
● If the light still comes on while driving
after adjusting the tire pressure, a tire
may be flat or the TPMS may be malfunctioning. If you have a flat tire, replace it with a spare tire as soon as
possible. If no tire is flat and all tires are
properly inflated, have the vehicle
checked by a NISSAN dealer.
In case of emergency 6-3
CHANGING A FLAT TIRE
If you have a flat tire, follow the instructions below:
Stopping the vehicle
1. Safely move the vehicle off the road and
away from traffic.
2. Turn on the hazard warning flashers.
3. Park on a level surface and apply the parking
brake. Move the shift lever to P (Park).
WARNING
● Make sure the parking brake is securely
applied and the shift lever is shifted into
P (Park).
● Never change tires when the vehicle is
on a slope, ice or slippery areas. This is
hazardous.
● Never change tires if oncoming traffic is
close to your vehicle. Wait for professional road assistance.
4. Turn off the engine.
5. Raise the hood to warn other traffic and to
signal professional road assistance personnel that you need assistance.
6. Have all passengers get out of the vehicle
and stand in a safe place, away from traffic
and clear of the vehicle.
LCE2142
A.
Blocks
B.
Flat tire
Blocking wheels
Place suitable blocks at both the front and back
of the wheel diagonally opposite the flat tire to
prevent the vehicle from moving when it is jacked
up.
WARNING
Be sure to block the wheel as the vehicle
may move and result in personal injury.
6-4 In case of emergency
LCE2222
Getting the spare tire and tools
1. Open the rear liftgate.
2. Pull up on the handle to lift the carpeted
floorboard and attach the hook as shown.
LCE2186
LCE2200
3. The jack and tools are located in the storage
compartment beneath the carpeted lid on
the passenger side of the cargo area.
4. Remove the storage door by pulling the
strap on the storage compartment lid.
In case of emergency 6-5
5. Remove the jack and tools from the storage
area.
WCE0188
6. To remove the spare tire, loosen the bolt by
turning counterclockwise.
7. Once free, remove the bolt.
1. To loosen the bolt, turn counterclockwise.
8. Remove the spare tire.
2. Once free, remove the bolt.
9. Once the flat tire is exchanged with the
spare tire, store the flat tire where the spare
tire was located.
10. Turn the bolt clockwise to tighten and place
the carpeted floorboard back over the tire.
6-6 In case of emergency
LCE2109
Changing the spare tire with BOSE®
sub-woofer (if so equipped)
LCE2216
3. Place the sub-woofer in the lower left corner
of the cargo area, leaning against the driver
side wall.
4. Remove the spare tire.
5. Once the flat tire is exchanged with the
spare tire, store the flat tire where the spare
was located.
LCE2106
6. Place the sub-woofer inside the flat tire.
7. Turn the bolt clockwise to tighten and place
the carpeted lid back over the tire.
In case of emergency 6-7
Jacking up vehicle and removing the
damaged tire
WARNING
● Never get under the vehicle while it is
supported only by the jack. If it is necessary to work under the vehicle, support it with safety stands.
● Use only the jack provided with your
vehicle to lift the vehicle. Do not use the
jack provided with your vehicle on other
vehicles. The jack is designed for lifting
only your vehicle during a tire change.
● Use the correct jack-up points. Never
use any other part of the vehicle for jack
support.
● Never jack up the vehicle more than
necessary.
● Never use blocks on or under the jack.
● Do not start or run the engine while
vehicle is on the jack. It may cause the
vehicle to move. This is especially true
for
vehicles
with
limited
slip
differentials.
● Do not allow passengers to stay in the
vehicle while it is on the jack.
6-8 In case of emergency
● Never run the engine with a wheel(s) off
the ground. It may cause the vehicle to
move.
SCE0002
Always refer to the proper illustrations for the
correct placement and jack-up points for your
specific vehicle model and jack type.
the front or the rear as shown. Also fit the
groove of the jack head between the
notches as shown.
Carefully read the caution label attached to
the jack body and the following instructions.
The jack should be used on firm and
level ground.
1. Loosen each wheel nut 1 or 2 turns by
turning counterclockwise with the wheel nut
wrench. Do not remove the wheel nuts
until the tire is off the ground.
2. Place the jack directly under the jack-up
point as illustrated so the top of the jack
contacts the vehicle at the jack-up point.
Align the jack head between the 2 notches in
3. To lift the vehicle, securely hold the jack lever
and rod with both hands. Carefully raise the
vehicle until the tire clears the ground. Remove the wheel nuts, and then remove the
tire.
WCE0056
Installing the spare tire
The spare tire is designed for emergency
use. For additional information, refer to
“Wheels and tires” in the “Maintenance
and do-it-yourself” section of this manual.
1. Clean any mud or dirt from the surface between the wheel and hub.
2. Carefully put the spare tire on and tighten
the wheel nuts finger tight.
3. With the wheel nut wrench, tighten wheel
nuts alternately and evenly as illustrated until
A,䊊
B,䊊
C,䊊
D,䊊
E ).
they are tight (䊊
In case of emergency 6-9
JUMP STARTING
4. Lower the vehicle slowly until the tire
touches the ground. Then, with the wheel
nut wrench, tighten the wheel nuts securely
A,䊊
B,䊊
C,䊊
D,
in the sequence illustrated (䊊
E ). Lower the vehicle completely.
䊊
5. Securely store the jack and tools back in
their storage compartment. Ensure the jack
is expanded and tools snapped into place to
prevent rattle noise from happening while
driving.
WARNING
● Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly
tightened wheel nuts can cause the
wheel to become loose or come off.
This could cause an accident.
● Do not use oil or grease on the wheel
studs or nuts. This could cause the nuts
to become loose.
● Retighten the wheel nuts when the vehicle has been driven for 600 miles
(1,000 km) (also in cases of a flat tire,
etc.).
As soon as possible, tighten the wheel nuts
to the specified torque with a torque
wrench.
6-10 In case of emergency
Wheel nut tightening torque:
83 ft-lb (113 N·m)
The wheel nuts must be kept tightened to
specification at all times. It is recommended that wheel nuts be tightened to
specifications at each lubrication interval.
Adjust tire pressure to the COLD pressure.
COLD pressure: After vehicle has been
parked for 3 hours or more or driven less
than 1 mile (1.6 km).
COLD tire pressures are shown on the tire
and loading information label affixed to the
driver side center pillar.
To start your engine with a booster battery, the
instructions and precautions below must be followed.
WARNING
● If done incorrectly, jump starting can
lead to a battery explosion, resulting in
severe injury or death. It could also
damage your vehicle.
● Explosive hydrogen gas is always present in the vicinity of the battery. Keep all
sparks and flames away from the
battery.
● Do not allow battery fluid to come into
contact with eyes, skin, clothing or
painted surfaces. Battery fluid is a corrosive sulfuric acid solution which can
cause severe burns. If the fluid should
come into contact with anything, immediately flush the contacted area with
water.
● Keep battery out of the reach of
children.
● The booster battery must be rated at
12 volts. Use of an improperly rated
battery can damage your vehicle.
● Whenever working on or near a battery,
always wear suitable eye protectors (for
example, goggles or industrial safety
spectacles) and remove rings, metal
bands, or any other jewelry. Do not lean
over the battery when jump starting.
● Do not attempt to jump start a frozen
battery. It could explode and cause serious injury.
● Your vehicle has an automatic engine
cooling fan. It could come on at any
time. Keep hands and other objects
away from it.
LCE2187
WARNING
Always follow the instructions below. Failure to do so could result in damage to the
charging system and cause personal
injury.
1. If the booster battery is in another vehicle,
position the two vehicles to bring their batteries near each other.
Do not allow the two vehicles to touch.
2. Apply the parking brake. Move the shift lever
to P (Park). Switch off all unnecessary electrical systems (lights, heater, air conditioner,
etc.).
3. Ensure the vent caps are level and tight.
4. Connect the jumper cables in the sequence
A,䊊
B,䊊
C,䊊
D ).
illustrated (䊊
CAUTION
● Always connect positive (⫹) to positive
(⫹) and negative (⫺) to body ground (for
example, strut mounting bolt, engine
lift bracket, etc.) — not to the battery.
● Make sure the jumper cables do not
touch moving parts in the engine compartment and that the cable clamps do
not contact any other metal.
In case of emergency 6-11
PUSH STARTING
5. Start the engine of the booster vehicle and
let it run for a few minutes.
6. Keep the engine speed of the booster vehicle at about 2,000 rpm and start the engine of the vehicle being jump started.
CAUTION
Do not keep the starter motor engaged for
more than 10 seconds. If the engine does
not start right away, place the ignition
switch in the OFF position and wait 3 to
4 seconds before trying again.
7. After starting the engine, carefully disconnect the negative cable and then the positive
cable.
CAUTION
IF YOUR VEHICLE OVERHEATS
WARNING
● CVT models cannot be push-started or
tow-started. Attempting to do so may
cause transmission damage.
● Do not continue to drive if your vehicle
overheats. Doing so could cause engine
damage or a vehicle fire.
● Do not push start this vehicle. The 3-way
catalyst may be damaged.
● To avoid the danger of being scalded,
never remove the radiator or coolant
reservoir cap while the engine is still
hot. When the radiator or coolant reservoir cap is removed, pressurized hot
water will spurt out, possibly causing
serious injury.
● Do not open the hood if steam is coming out.
If your vehicle is overheating (indicated by an
extremely high temperature gauge reading and
the illumination of the engine oil pressure/engine
coolant temperature high indicator light), or if you
feel a lack of engine power, detect abnormal
noise, etc. take the following steps:
1. Move the vehicle safely off the road, apply
the parking brake and move the shift lever to
P (Park).
Do not stop the engine.
2. Turn off the air conditioner. Open all the
windows, move the heater or air conditioner
temperature control to maximum hot and fan
control to high speed.
6-12 In case of emergency
TOWING YOUR VEHICLE
3. Get out of the vehicle. Look and listen for
steam or coolant escaping from the radiator
before opening the hood. If steam or coolant
is escaping, turn off the engine. Do not open
the hood further until no steam or coolant
can be seen.
4. Open the engine hood.
WARNING
If steam or water is coming from the engine, stand clear to prevent getting
burned.
5. Visually check drive belts for damage or
looseness. Also check if the cooling fan is
running. The radiator hoses and radiator
should not leak water. If coolant is leaking,
the water pump belt is missing or loose, or
the cooling fan does not run, stop the engine.
6. After the engine cools down, check the coolant level in the engine coolant reservoir tank
with the engine running. Add coolant to the
engine coolant reservoir tank if necessary.
Have your vehicle repaired at a NISSAN
dealer.
When towing your vehicle, all jurisdictional and
local regulations for towing must be followed.
Incorrect towing equipment could damage your
vehicle. Towing instructions are available from a
NISSAN dealer. Local service operators are generally familiar with the applicable laws and procedures for towing. To assure proper towing and to
prevent accidental damage to your vehicle,
NISSAN recommends having a service operator
tow your vehicle. It is advisable to have the service operator carefully read the following precautions:
WARNING
● Never ride in a vehicle that is being
towed.
● Never get under your vehicle after it has
been lifted by a tow truck.
CAUTION
WARNING
Be careful not to allow your hands, hair,
jewelry or clothing to come into contact
with, or get caught in, engine belts or the
engine cooling fan. The engine cooling fan
can start at any time.
● When towing, make sure that the transmission, axles, steering system and
powertrain are in working condition. If
any of these conditions apply, dollies or
a flatbed tow truck must be used.
● Always attach safety chains before
towing.
In case of emergency 6-13
For additional information about towing your front
wheel drive vehicle behind a recreational vehicle
(RV), refer to “Flat towing for front wheel drive
vehicle” in the “Technical and Consumer Information” section of this manual.
For additional information about towing your allwheel drive vehicle behind a recreational vehicle
(RV), refer to “Flat towing for all-wheel drive
vehicle” in the “Technical and Consumer Information” section of this manual.
TOWING RECOMMENDED BY
NISSAN
NISSAN recommends towing your vehicle based
upon the type of drivetrain. Please refer to the
diagrams in this section to ensure that your vehicle is properly towed.
LCE2220
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) models
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) models
NISSAN recommends that towing dollies be
used when towing your vehicle or the vehicle be
placed on a flatbed truck as illustrated.
CAUTION
DO NOT tow AWD models with any of the
wheels on the ground as this may cause
serious and expensive damage to the
powertrain.
6-14 In case of emergency
● When towing with the rear wheels on
the ground or on towing dollies, place
the ignition switch in the ON position,
and secure the steering wheel in the
straight-ahead position with a rope or
similar device.
VEHICLE RECOVERY (freeing a stuck
vehicle)
There are two options to recover a stuck vehicle:
pulling and rocking. For additional information,
regarding these options, please refer to the following sections.
LCE2221
Pulling a stuck vehicle
Front-Wheel Drive (FWD) models
Front-Wheel Drive (FWD) models
NISSAN recommends that your vehicle be towed
with the driving wheels (front) off the ground or
place the vehicle on a flatbed truck as illustrated.
WARNING
● Never tow your vehicle with the front
wheels on the ground or 4 wheels on
the ground (forward or backward), as
this may cause serious and expensive
damage to the transmission. If it is necessary to tow the vehicle with the rear
wheels raised always use towing dollies
under the front wheels.
WARNING
To avoid vehicle damage, serious personal
injury or death when recovering a stuck
vehicle:
● Contact a professional towing service
to recover the vehicle if you have any
questions regarding the recovery
procedure.
● Attach recovery devices only to main
structural members of the vehicle or the
recovery hooks.
In case of emergency 6-15
● Do not use the vehicle tie-downs to tow
or free a stuck vehicle.
● Only use devices specifically designed
for vehicle recovery and follow the
manufacturer’s instructions.
● Always pull the recovery device straight
out from the front of the vehicle. Never
pull at an angle.
● Route recovery devices so they do not
touch any part of the vehicle except the
attachment point.
If your vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc.,
use a tow strap or other device designed specifically for vehicle recovery. Always follow the
manufacturer’s instructions for the recovery device.
Do not use the tie-down hooks for towing or
vehicle recovery.
Rocking a stuck vehicle
WARNING
● Stand clear of a stuck vehicle.
● Do not spin your tires at high speed.
This could cause them to explode and
result in serious injury. Parts of your
vehicle could also overheat and be
damaged.
If your vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc.,
use the following procedure:
1. Turn off the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC)
system.
2. Make sure the area in front and behind the
vehicle is clear of obstructions.
3. Turn the steering wheel right and left to clear
an area around the front tires.
4. Slowly rock the vehicle forward and backward.
● Shift back and forth between R (Reverse)
and D (Drive).
6-16 In case of emergency
● Apply the accelerator as little as possible
to maintain the rocking motion.
● Release the accelerator pedal before
shifting between R and D.
● Do not spin the tires above 35 mph
(55 km/h).
5. If the vehicle cannot be freed after a few
tries, contact a professional towing service
to remove the vehicle.
7 Appearance and care
Cleaning exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2
Washing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2
Waxing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2
Removing spots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Underbody . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Glass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Aluminum alloy wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Chrome parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Tire dressings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Cleaning interior. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Air fresheners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Floor mats (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
Cleaning the seat tracks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
Corrosion protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
Most common factors contributing to vehicle
corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
Environmental factors influence the rate of
corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
Protect your vehicle from corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
CLEANING EXTERIOR
In order to maintain the appearance of your vehicle, it is important to take proper care of it.
To protect the paint surfaces, please wash your
vehicle as soon as you can:
● after a rainfall to prevent possible damage
from acid rain
● after driving on coastal roads
● when contaminants such as soot, bird droppings, tree sap, metal particles or bugs get
on the paint surface
● when dust or mud builds up on the surface
Whenever possible, store or park your vehicle
inside a garage or in a covered area.
When it is necessary to park outside, park in a
shady area or protect the vehicle with a body
cover.
Be careful not to scratch the paint surface
when putting on or removing the body
cover.
WASHING
Wash dirt off with a wet sponge and plenty of
water. Clean the vehicle thoroughly using a mild
soap, a special vehicle soap or general purpose
dishwashing liquid mixed with clean, lukewarm
(never hot) water.
7-2 Appearance and care
CAUTION
● Do not use car washes that use acid in
the detergent. Some car washes, especially brushless ones, use some acid for
cleaning. The acid may react with some
plastic vehicle components, causing
them to crack. This could affect their
appearance, and also could cause them
not to function properly. Always check
with your car wash to confirm that acid
is not used.
● Do not wash the vehicle with strong
household soap, strong chemical detergents, gasoline or solvents.
● Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight or while the vehicle body is hot, as
the surface may become water-spotted.
● Avoid using tight-napped or rough
cloths, such as washing mitts. Care
must be taken when removing
caked-on dirt or other foreign substances so the paint surface is not
scratched or damaged.
Rinse the vehicle thoroughly with plenty of clean
water.
Inside edges, seams and folds on the doors,
hatches and hood are particularly vulnerable to
the effects of road salt. Therefore, these areas
must be cleaned regularly. Take care that the
drain holes in the lower edge of the door are
open. Spray water under the body and in the
wheel wells to loosen the dirt and wash away
road salt.
A damp chamois can be used to dry the vehicle to
avoid water spots.
WAXING
Regular waxing protects the paint surface and
helps retain new vehicle appearance. Polishing is
recommended to remove built-up wax residue
and to avoid a weathered appearance before
re-applying wax.
A NISSAN dealer can assist you in choosing the
proper product.
● Wax your vehicle only after a thorough washing. Follow the instructions supplied with the
wax.
● Do not use a wax containing any abrasives,
cutting compounds or cleaners that may
damage the vehicle finish.
Machine compounding or aggressive polishing
on a base coat/clear coat paint finish may dull the
finish or leave swirl marks.
REMOVING SPOTS
CAUTION
Remove tar and oil spots, industrial dust, insects,
and tree sap as quickly as possible from the
surface of the paint to avoid lasting damage or
staining. Special cleaning products are available
at a NISSAN dealer or any automotive accessory
store.
When cleaning the inside of the windows,
do not use sharp-edged tools, abrasive
cleaners or chlorine-based disinfectant
cleaners. They could damage the electrical
conductors, radio antenna elements or
rear window defroster elements.
UNDERBODY
ALUMINUM ALLOY WHEELS
In areas where road salt is used in winter, it is
necessary to clean the underbody regularly in
order to prevent dirt and salt from building up and
causing the acceleration of corrosion on the underbody and suspension. Before the winter period and again in the spring, the underseal must
be checked and, if necessary, re-treated.
Wash the wheels regularly with a sponge dampened in a mild soap solution, especially during
winter months in areas where road salt is used. If
not removed, road salt can discolor the wheels.
GLASS
Use glass cleaner to remove smoke and dust film
from the glass surfaces. It is normal for glass to
become coated with a film after the vehicle is
parked in the hot sun. Glass cleaner and a soft
cloth will easily remove this film.
CAUTION
Follow the directions below to avoid
staining or discoloring the wheels:
● Do not use a cleaner that uses strong
acid or alkali contents to clean the
wheels.
● Do not apply wheel cleaners to the
wheels when they are hot. The wheel
temperature should be the same as ambient temperature.
● Rinse the wheel to completely remove
the cleaner within 15 minutes after the
cleaner is applied.
CHROME PARTS
Clean all chrome parts regularly with a nonabrasive chrome polish to maintain the finish.
TIRE DRESSINGS
NISSAN does not recommend the use of tire
dressings. Tire manufacturers apply a coating to
the tires to help reduce discoloration of the rubber. If a tire dressing is applied to the tires, it may
react with the coating and form a compound. This
compound may come off the tire while driving and
stain the vehicle paint.
If you choose to use a tire dressing, take the
following precautions:
● Use a water-based tire dressing. The coating on the tire dissolves more easily than
with an oil-based tire dressing.
● Apply a light coat of tire dressing to help
prevent it from entering the tire
tread/grooves (where it would be difficult to
remove).
● Wipe off excess tire dressing using a dry
towel. Make sure the tire dressing is completely removed from the tire tread/grooves.
● Allow the tire dressing to dry as recommended by the tire dressing manufacturer.
Appearance and care 7-3
CLEANING INTERIOR
Occasionally remove loose dust from the interior
trim, plastic parts and seats using a vacuum
cleaner or soft bristled brush. Wipe the vinyl and
leather (if so equipped) surfaces with a clean,
soft cloth dampened in mild soap solution, then
wipe clean with a dry, soft cloth.
Regular care and cleaning is required in order to
maintain the appearance of the leather (if so
equipped).
Before using any fabric protector, read the manufacturer’s recommendations. Some fabric protectors contain chemicals that may stain or
bleach the seat material.
Use a cloth dampened only with water to clean
the meter and gauge lens.
WARNING
Do not use water or acidic cleaners (hot
steam cleaners) on the seat. This can damage the seat or occupant classification
sensor. This can also affect the operation
of the air bag system and result in serious
personal injury.
7-4 Appearance and care
CAUTION
● Never use benzine, thinner or any similar material.
● Liquid-type air fresheners typically clip on
the vents. These products can cause immediate damage and discoloration when
spilled on interior surfaces.
● Small dirt particles can be abrasive and
damaging to leather surfaces and
should be removed promptly. Do not
use saddle soap, car waxes, polishes,
oils, cleaning fluids, solvents, detergents or ammonia-based cleaners as
they may damage the leather’s natural
finish.
Carefully read and follow the manufacturer’s instructions before using the air fresheners.
● Never use fabric protectors unless recommended by the manufacturer.
● NEVER place a floor mat on top of another floor mat in the driver front
position.
● Do not use glass or plastic cleaner on
meter or gauge lens covers. It may damage the lens cover.
AIR FRESHENERS
Most air fresheners use a solvent that could affect
the vehicle interior. If you use an air freshener,
take the following precautions:
● Hanging-type air fresheners can cause permanent discoloration when they contact vehicle interior surfaces. Place the air freshener in a location that allows it to hang free
and not contact an interior surface.
FLOOR MATS (if so equipped)
WARNING
To avoid potential pedal interference that
may result in a collision, injury or death:
● Use only Genuine NISSAN floor mats
specifically designed for use in your vehicle model. For additional information,
refer to a NISSAN dealer.
● Properly position the mats in the floorwell using the floor mat positioning aid.
Refer to ⴖFloor mat positioning aidⴖ in
this section.
The use of Genuine NISSAN floor mats can
extend the life of your vehicle carpet and make it
easier to clean the interior. Mats should be maintained with regular cleaning and replaced if they
become excessively worn.
CORROSION PROTECTION
SEAT BELTS
The seat belts can be cleaned by wiping them
with a sponge dampened in a mild soap solution.
Allow the belts to dry completely in the shade
before using them. For additional information,
refer to “Seat belt maintenance” in the “Safety –
Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section of this manual.
WARNING
LAI2016
Floor mat positioning aid
This vehicle includes two driver’s side front floor
mat bracket hooks, two passenger’s side front
floor mat bracket hooks and two rear floor mat
bracket hooks to help keep your floor mats in
place. Genuine NISSAN floor mats have been
specially designed for your vehicle model. The
floor mats have grommet holes incorporated in
them. Position each mat by placing the floor mat
bracket hook through the floor mat grommet
holes while centering the mat in the floorwell.
Periodically check to make certain the mats are
properly positioned.
Do not allow wet seat belts to roll up in the
retractor. NEVER use bleach, dye or
chemical solvents to clean the seat belts,
since these materials may severely
weaken the seat belt webbing.
CLEANING THE SEAT TRACKS
CAUTION
Periodically clean the seat tracks to prevent reduction of ability to move the seats.
Clean periodically with a high-powered vacuum
cleaner. Dirt and debris may reduce the ability to
adjust the seat. A wet cleansing agent may be
used if necessary.
MOST COMMON FACTORS
CONTRIBUTING TO VEHICLE
CORROSION
Most vehicle corrosion is caused by:
● the accumulation of moisture-retaining dirt
and debris in body panel sections, cavities,
and other areas
● damage to paint and other protective coatings caused by gravel and stone chips or
minor traffic collisions
ENVIRONMENTAL FACTORS
INFLUENCE THE RATE OF
CORROSION
Moisture
Accumulation of sand, dirt and water on the vehicle body underside can accelerate corrosion.
Wet floor coverings will not dry completely inside
the vehicle and should be removed for drying to
avoid floor panel corrosion.
Relative humidity
Corrosion will be accelerated in areas of high
relative humidity, especially those areas where
the temperatures stay above freezing and where
atmospheric pollution exists and road salt is
used.
Appearance and care 7-5
Temperature
CAUTION
Air pollution
● NEVER remove dirt, sand or other debris from the passenger compartment
by washing it out with a hose. Remove
dirt with a vacuum cleaner or broom.
Industrial pollution, the presence of salt in the air
in coastal areas, or heavy road salt use accelerates the corrosion process. Road salt also accelerates the disintegration of paint surfaces.
● Never allow water or other liquids to
come in contact with electronic components inside the vehicle as this may
damage them.
High temperatures accelerate the rate of corrosion to those parts which are not well ventilated.
PROTECT YOUR VEHICLE FROM
CORROSION
● Wash and wax your vehicle often to keep the
vehicle clean.
● Always check for minor damage to the paint
and repair it as soon as possible.
● Keep drain holes at the bottom of the doors
open to avoid water accumulation.
● Check the underbody for accumulation of
sand, dirt or salt. If present, wash with water
as soon as possible.
7-6 Appearance and care
Chemicals used for road surface de-icing are
extremely corrosive. They accelerate corrosion
and deterioration of underbody components
such as the exhaust system, fuel and brake lines,
brake cables, floor pan and fenders.
In winter, the underbody must be cleaned
periodically.
For additional protection against rust and corrosion, which may be required in some areas, consult a NISSAN dealer.
8 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
Maintenance requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2
General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2
Explanation of general maintenance items . . . . . . . . . 8-2
Maintenance precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
Engine compartment check locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6
Engine cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
Checking engine coolant level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
Changing engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
Engine oil. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9
Checking engine oil level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9
Changing engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10
Changing engine oil filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12
Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) fluid . . . . . . 8-13
Power steering fluid. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14
Windshield-washer fluid. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14
Windshield-washer fluid reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15
Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17
Drive belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17
Spark plugs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18
Replacing spark plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18
Air cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18
In-cabin microfilter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19
Windshield wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19
Replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-21
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-22
Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-22
Passenger compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-23
Battery replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-25
NISSAN Intelligent Key® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-26
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-27
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-27
Fog lights (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-27
Exterior and interior lights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-28
Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-29
Tire pressure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-29
Tire labeling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-32
Types of tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-35
Tire chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-36
Changing wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-37
MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS
Your NISSAN is designed to have minimum maintenance requirements with long service intervals
to save you both time and money. However, some
day-to-day and regular maintenance is essential
to maintain your NISSAN’s good mechanical
condition, as well as its emissions and engine
performance.
It is the owner’s responsibility to make sure that
the scheduled maintenance, as well as general
maintenance, is performed.
As the vehicle owner, you are the only one who
can ensure that your vehicle receives proper
maintenance. You are a vital link in the maintenance chain.
Scheduled maintenance
For your convenience, both required and optional
scheduled maintenance items are described and
listed in your “NISSAN Service and Maintenance
Guide”. You must refer to that guide to ensure
that necessary maintenance is performed on your
NISSAN at regular intervals.
General maintenance
General maintenance includes those items which
should be checked during normal day-to-day operation. They are essential for proper vehicle operation. It is your responsibility to perform these
maintenance procedures regularly as prescribed.
8-2 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
Performing general maintenance checks requires
minimal mechanical skill and only a few general
automotive tools.
These checks or inspections can be done by you,
a qualified technician, or, if you prefer, a NISSAN
dealer.
Where to go for service
If maintenance service is required or your vehicle
appears to malfunction, have the systems
checked and corrected by a NISSAN dealer.
NISSAN technicians are well-trained specialists
who are kept up-to-date with the latest service
information through technical bulletins, service
tips and in-dealership training programs. They
are completely qualified to work on NISSAN vehicles before they work on your vehicle rather
than after they have worked on it.
You can be confident that a NISSAN dealer’s
service department performs the best job to meet
the maintenance requirements on your vehicle —
in a reliable and economical way.
During the normal day-to-day operation of the
vehicle, general maintenance should be performed regularly as prescribed in this section. If
you detect any unusual sounds, vibrations or
smells, be sure to check for the cause or have a
NISSAN dealer do it promptly. In addition, you
should notify a NISSAN dealer if you think that
repairs are required.
When performing any checks or maintenance
work, closely observe the “Maintenance precautions” in this section.
EXPLANATION OF GENERAL
MAINTENANCE ITEMS
Additional information on the following
items with “ * ” is found in this section.
Outside the vehicle
The maintenance items listed here should be
performed from time to time, unless otherwise
specified.
Doors and engine hood Check that the doors
and engine hood operate properly. Also ensure
that all latches lock securely. Lubricate hinges,
latches, latch pins, rollers and links as necessary.
Make sure that the secondary latch keeps the
hood from opening when the primary latch is
released.
When driving in areas using road salt or other
corrosive materials, check lubrication frequently.
Lights* Clean the headlights on a regular basis.
Make sure that the headlights, stop lights, tail
lights, turn signal lights, and other lights are all
operating properly and installed securely. Also
check headlight aim.
alignment. If the steering wheel or seat vibrates at
normal highway speeds, wheel balancing may be
needed.
● For additional information regarding tires,
refer to “Important Tire Safety Information”
(US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in
the Warranty Information Booklet.
Road wheel nuts (lug nuts)* When checking
the tires, make sure no wheel nuts are missing,
and check for any loose wheel nuts. Tighten if
necessary.
Windshield Clean the windshield on a regular
basis. Check the windshield at least every six
months for cracks or other damage. Have a damaged windshield repaired by a qualified repair
facility.
Tire rotation* Tires should be rotated every
5,000 miles (8,000 km).
Windshield wiper blades* Check for cracks or
wear if they do not wipe properly.
Tires* Check the pressure with a gauge often
and always prior to long distance trips. If necessary, adjust the pressure in all tires, including the
spare, to the pressure specified. Check carefully
for damage, cuts or excessive wear.
Inside the vehicle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
transmitter components Replace the TPMS
transmitter grommet seal, valve core and cap
when the tires are replaced due to wear or age.
Wheel alignment and balance If the vehicle
should pull to either side while driving on a
straight and level road, or if you detect uneven or
abnormal tire wear, there may be a need for wheel
The maintenance items listed here should be
checked on a regular basis, such as when performing periodic maintenance, cleaning the vehicle, etc.
Additional information on the following
items with an “*” is found in this section.
Accelerator pedal Check the pedal for smooth
operation and make sure the pedal does not bind
or require uneven effort. Keep the floor mat away
from the pedal.
Brake pedal Check the pedal for smooth operation. If the brake pedal suddenly goes down fur-
ther than normal, the pedal feels spongy or the
vehicle seems to take longer to stop, see a
NISSAN dealer immediately. Keep the floor mat
away from the pedal.
Brakes Check that the brakes do not pull the
vehicle to one side when applied.
Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT)
P (Park) position mechanism On a fairly
steep hill check that your vehicle is held securely
with the shift lever in the P (Park) position without
applying any brakes.
Parking brake Check the parking brake operation regularly. The vehicle should be securely held
on a fairly steep hill with only the parking brake
applied. If the parking brake needs adjustment,
see a NISSAN dealer.
Seats Check seat position controls such as seat
adjusters, seatback recliner, etc. to ensure they
operate smoothly and all latches lock securely in
every position. Check that the head
restraints/headrests move up and down
smoothly and the locks (if so equipped) hold
securely in all latched positions.
Seat belts Check that all parts of the seat belt
system (for example, buckles, anchors, adjusters
and retractors) operate properly and smoothly,
and are installed securely. Check the belt webbing for cuts, fraying, wear or damage.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-3
Steering wheel Check for changes in the steering system, such as excessive freeplay, hard
steering or strange noises.
Warning lights and chimes Make sure all
warning lights and chimes are operating properly.
Windshield wiper and washer* Check that
the wipers and washer operate properly and that
the wipers do not streak.
Windshield defroster Check that the air
comes out of the defroster outlets properly and in
sufficient quantity when operating the heater or
air conditioner.
Under the hood and vehicle
The maintenance items listed here should be
checked periodically (for example, each time you
check the engine oil or refuel).
Battery* Check the fluid level in each cell. It
should be between the MAX and MIN lines. Vehicles operated in high temperatures or under
severe conditions require frequent checks of the
battery fluid level.
8-4 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
NOTE:
Care should be taken to avoid situations
that can lead to potential battery discharge
and potential no-start conditions such as:
1. Installation or extended use of electronic
accessories that consume battery power
when the engine is not running (Phone chargers, GPS, DVD players, etc.)
2. Vehicle is not driven regularly and/or only
driven short distances. In these cases, the
battery may need to be charged to maintain
battery health.
Brake fluid level* Make sure that the brake fluid
level is between the MIN and MAX lines on the
reservoir.
Engine coolant level* Check the coolant level
when the engine is cold.
Engine drive belts* Make sure the drive belts
are not frayed, worn, cracked or oily.
Engine oil level* Check the level after parking
the vehicle on a level surface with the engine off.
Wait more than 10 minutes for the oil to drain
back into the oil pan.
Exhaust system Make sure there are no loose
supports, cracks or holes. If the sound of the
exhaust seems unusual or there is a smell of
exhaust fumes, immediately have the exhaust
system inspected by a NISSAN dealer. For additional information, refer to “Exhaust gas (carbon
monoxide)” in the “Starting and driving” section of
this manual.
Fluid leaks Check under the vehicle for fuel, oil,
water or other fluid leaks after the vehicle has
been parked for a while. Water dripping from the
air conditioner after use is normal. If you should
notice any leaks or if gasoline fumes are evident,
check for the cause and have it corrected immediately.
Power steering fluid level* and lines Check
the level when the fluid is cold, with the engine
off. Check the lines for proper attachment, leaks,
cracks, etc.
Radiator and hoses Check the front of the
radiator and clean off any dirt, insects, leaves,
etc., that may have accumulated. Make sure the
hoses have no cracks, deformation, rot or loose
connections.
MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS
Underbody The underbody is frequently exposed to corrosive substances such as those
used on icy roads or to control dust. It is very
important to remove these substances from the
underbody, otherwise rust may form on the floor
pan, frame, fuel lines and exhaust system. At the
end of winter, the underbody should be thoroughly flushed with plain water, in those areas
where mud and dirt may have accumulated. For
additional information, refer to the “Appearance
and care” section of this manual.
Windshield-washer fluid* Check that there is
adequate fluid in the reservoir.
When performing any inspection or maintenance
work on your vehicle, always take care to prevent
serious accidental injury to yourself or damage to
the vehicle. The following are general precautions which should be closely observed.
WARNING
● Park the vehicle on a level surface, apply the parking brake securely and
block the wheels to prevent the vehicle
from moving. Move the shift lever to P
(Park).
● Be sure the ignition switch is in the OFF
or LOCK position when performing any
parts replacement or repairs.
● If you must work with the engine running, keep your hands, clothing, hair
and tools away from moving fans, belts
and any other moving parts.
● It is advisable to secure or remove any
loose clothing and remove any jewelry,
such as rings, watches, etc. before
working on your vehicle.
● Your vehicle is equipped with an automatic engine cooling fan. It may come
on at any time without warning, even if
the ignition switch is in the OFF position and the engine is not running. To
avoid injury, always disconnect the
negative battery cable before working
near the fan.
● If you must run the engine in an enclosed space such as a garage, be sure
there is proper ventilation for exhaust
gases to escape.
● Never get under the vehicle while it is
supported only by a jack. If it is necessary to work under the vehicle, support
it with safety stands.
● Keep smoking materials, flame and
sparks away from the fuel tank and
battery.
● The fuel filter or fuel lines should be
serviced by a NISSAN dealer because
the fuel lines are under high pressure
even when the engine is off.
● Always wear eye protection whenever
you work on your vehicle.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-5
ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECK
LOCATIONS
CAUTION
● Do not work under the hood while the
engine is hot. Turn the engine off and
wait until it cools down.
● Avoid contact with used engine oil and
coolant. Improperly disposed engine
oil, engine coolant and/or other vehicle
fluids can damage the environment. Always conform to local regulations for
disposal of vehicle fluid.
● Never leave the engine or continuously
variable transmission related component harnesses disconnected while the
ignition switch is in the ON position.
● Never connect or disconnect the battery
or any transistorized component while
the ignition switch is in the ON position.
This “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section
gives instructions regarding only those items
which are relatively easy for an owner to perform.
You should be aware that incomplete or improper
servicing may result in operating difficulties or
excessive emissions, and could affect warranty
coverage. If in doubt about any servicing,
have it done by a NISSAN dealer.
LDI2633
8-6 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM
VQ35DE engine
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10
11.
12.
Engine coolant reservoir
Drive belt location
Engine oil dipstick
Engine oil filler cap
Brake fluid reservoir
Air cleaner
Fuse box
Fuse box/Fusible links
Battery
Radiator cap
Power steering fluid reservoir
Windshield-washer fluid reservoir
The engine cooling system is filled at the factory
with a pre-diluted mixture of 50% Genuine
NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) and
50% water to provide year-round antifreeze and
coolant protection. The antifreeze solution contains rust and corrosion inhibitors. Additional engine cooling system additives are not necessary.
WARNING
● Never remove the radiator or coolant
reservoir cap when the engine is hot.
Wait until the engine and radiator cool
down. Serious burns could be caused
by high pressure fluid escaping from
the radiator. For additional information,
refer to precautions in “If your vehicle
overheats” found in the “In case of
emergency” section of this manual.
● The radiator is equipped with a pressure type radiator cap. To prevent engine damage, use only a Genuine
NISSAN radiator cap.
CAUTION
● Never use any cooling system additives
such as radiator sealer. Additives may
clog the cooling system and cause damage to the engine, transmission and/or
cooling system.
● When adding or replacing coolant, be
sure to use only Genuine NISSAN Long
Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) or
equivalent. Genuine NISSAN Long Life
Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) is pre-diluted
to provide antifreeze protection to -34°
F (-37° C). If additional freeze protection
is needed due to weather where you
operate your vehicle, add Genuine
NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant
(blue) concentrate following the directions on the container. If an equivalent
coolant other than Genuine NISSAN
Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) is
used, follow the coolant manufacturer’s
instructions to maintain minimum antifreeze protection to -34° F (-37° C). The
use of other types of coolant solutions
other than Genuine NISSAN Long Life
Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) or equivalent
may damage the engine cooling
system.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-7
coolant or the use of non-distilled water will reduce the life expectancy of the factory-fill coolant.
For additional information, refer to the NISSAN
Service and Maintenance Guide.
● The life expectancy of the factory-fill
coolant is 105,000 miles (168,000 km) or
7 years. Mixing any other type of coolant other than Genuine NISSAN Long
Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue), including Genuine NISSAN Long Life
Antifreeze/Coolant (green), or the use
of non-distilled water will reduce the
life expectancy of the factory-fill coolant. For additional information, refer to
the NISSAN Service and Maintenance
Guide.
If the cooling system frequently requires
coolant, have it checked by a NISSAN
dealer.
For additional information on the location of the
engine coolant reservoir, refer to “Engine compartment check locations” in this section.
CHANGING ENGINE COOLANT
LDI2590
CHECKING ENGINE COOLANT
LEVEL
Check the coolant level in the reservoir when
the engine is cold. If the coolant level is below
the MIN level, add coolant to the MAX level. If the
reservoir is empty, check the coolant level in the
radiator when the engine is cold. If there is
insufficient coolant in the radiator, fill the radiator
with coolant up to the filler opening and also add
it to the reservoir up to the MAX level.
This vehicle contains Genuine NISSAN Long Life
Antifreeze/Coolant (blue). The life expectancy of
the factory-fill coolant is 105,000 miles
(168,000 km) or 7 years. Mixing any other type of
8-8 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
A NISSAN dealer can change the engine coolant.
The service procedure can be found in the
NISSAN Service Manual.
Improper servicing can result in reduced
heater performance and engine overheating.
WARNING
● To avoid the danger of being scalded,
never change the coolant when the engine is hot.
● Never remove the radiator or engine
coolant reservoir cap when the engine
is hot. Serious burns could be caused by
high pressure fluid escaping from the
radiator.
ENGINE OIL
● Avoid direct skin contact with used
coolant. If skin contact is made, wash
thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner as
soon as possible.
● Keep coolant out of the reach of children and pets.
Engine coolant must be disposed of properly.
Check your local regulations.
LDI2556
CHECKING ENGINE OIL LEVEL
1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply
the parking brake.
2. Start the engine and let it idle until it reaches
operating temperature.
3. Turn off the engine. Wait more than
10 minutes for the oil to drain back into
the oil pan.
4. Remove the dipstick and wipe it clean. Reinstall dipstick.
WDI0214
5. Remove the dipstick again and check the oil
level. It should be between the H (High) and
B . This is the normal operL (Low) marks 䊊
ating oil level range. If the oil level is below
A , remove the oil filler cap
the L (Low) mark 䊊
and pour recommended oil through the
C.
opening. Do not overfill 䊊
6. Recheck oil level with the dipstick.
It is normal to add some oil between oil
maintenance intervals or during the
break-in period, depending on the severity
of operating conditions.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-9
CAUTION
Oil level should be checked regularly. Operating the engine with an insufficient
amount of oil can damage the engine, and
such damage is not covered by warranty.
LDI2554
CHANGING ENGINE OIL
1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply
the parking brake.
2. Start the engine and let it idle until it reaches
operating temperature, then turn it off.
A by turning it
3. Remove the oil filler cap 䊊
counterclockwise.
B from the under-engine pro4. Remove pins 䊊
tector.
5. Place a large drain pan under the drain plug
C.
䊊
8-10 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
LDI2558
C with a wrench by
6. Remove the drain plug 䊊
turning it counterclockwise and completely
drain the oil.
If the engine oil filter is to be changed, remove and replace it at this time. For additional information, refer to “Changing engine
oil filter” in this section.
● Waste oil must be disposed of properly.
● Check your local regulations.
CAUTION
Be careful not to burn yourself. The engine
oil may be hot.
10. Turn the engine off and wait more than
10 minutes. Check the oil level with the
dipstick. Add engine oil if necessary.
7. Clean and reinstall the drain plug and a new
washer. Securely tighten the drain plug with
a wrench. Do not use excessive force.
Drain plug tightening torque:
26 ft-lb (34 N·m)
8. Refill engine with recommended oil through
the oil filler opening, then install the oil filler
cap securely.
LDI2634
WARNING
● Prolonged and repeated contact with
used engine oil may cause skin cancer.
● Try to avoid direct skin contact with
used oil. If skin contact is made, wash
thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner as
soon as possible.
● Keep used engine oil out of reach of
children.
For additional information, refer to “Recommended fluids/lubricants and capacities” in
the “Technical and consumer information”
section of this manual for drain and refill
capacity.
The drain and refill capacity depends on the
oil temperature and drain time. Use these
specifications for reference only. Always use
the dipstick to determine when the proper
amount of oil is in the engine.
9. Start the engine. Check for leakage around
the drain plug and oil filter. Correct as required.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-11
A from the right engine pro4. Remove pins 䊊
tector located inside the right wheel well and
B
then remove protector. Remove oil filter 䊊
with an oil filter wrench by turning it counterclockwise. Then remove the oil filter by turning it by hand.
CAUTION
Be careful not to burn yourself. The engine
oil may be hot.
5. Wipe the engine oil filter sealing surface with
a clean rag.
CAUTION
● Be sure to remove any old gasket
material remaining on the sealing
surface of the engine. Failure to do
so could lead to an oil leak and engine damage.
LDI2562
CHANGING ENGINE OIL FILTER
● The dipstick must be inserted in
place to prevent oil spillage from the
dipstick hole when filling the engine
with oil.
1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply
the parking brake.
6. Coat the gasket on the new filter with clean
engine oil.
2. Turn the engine off.
7. Screw on the oil filter until a slight resistance
is felt, then tighten an additional 2/3 turn.
B.
3. Place a large drain pan under the oil filter 䊊
8-12 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8. Start the engine and check for leakage
around the oil filter. Correct as required.
9. Turn the engine off and wait more than
10 minutes. Check the oil level. Add engine
oil if necessary.
CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLE
TRANSMISSION (CVT) FLUID
POWER STEERING FLUID
CAUTION
CAUTION
● NISSAN recommends using Genuine
NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3 ONLY in
NISSAN CVTs. Do not mix with other
fluids.
● DO NOT OVERFILL.
● Use of a power steering fluid other than
Genuine NISSAN E-PSF or equivalent
will prevent the power steering system
from operating properly.
● Do not use Automatic transmission
fluid (ATF) or Manual transmission fluid
in a NISSAN CVT, as it may damage the
CVT. Damage caused by the use of fluids other than as recommended is not
covered under NISSAN’s New Vehicle
Limited Warranty.
● Using fluids that are not equivalent to
Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3 may
also damage the CVT. Damage caused
by the use of fluids other than as recommended is not covered under NISSAN’s
New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
When checking or replacement of CVT fluid is
required, we recommend your NISSAN dealer for
servicing.
● Power steering fluid is poisonous and
should be stored carefully in marked
containers out of the reach of children.
LDI2635
Check the fluid level in the reservoir.
The fluid level should be checked when the fluid
is cold at fluid temperatures of 32 to 86ºF (0 to
30ºC). The fluid level can be checked with the
level gauge which is attached to the cap. To
check the fluid level, remove the cap. The fluid
1 and MIN 䊊
2
level should be between the MAX 䊊
lines.
2 line, add Genuine
If the fluid is below the MIN 䊊
NISSAN E-PSF or equivalent. Remove the cap
and fill through the opening.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-13
BRAKE FLUID
WINDSHIELD-WASHER FLUID
CAUTION
Do not spill the fluid on any painted surfaces. This will damage the paint. If fluid is
spilled, immediately wash the surface with
water.
Check the fluid level in the reservoir. If the brake
fluid is below the MIN line, the brake warning light
will illuminate. Add brake fluid up to the MAX line.
For additional information on brake fluid type,
refer to “Recommended fluids/lubricants and capacities” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
LDI2592
WARNING
● Use only new fluid from a sealed container. Old, inferior or contaminated
fluid may damage the brake system.
The use of improper fluids can damage
the brake system and affect the vehicle’s stopping ability.
● Clean the filler cap before removing.
● Brake fluid is poisonous and should be
stored carefully in marked containers
out of reach of children.
8-14 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
If the brake fluid must be added frequently, the
brake system should be thoroughly checked by a
NISSAN dealer.
LDI2573
WINDSHIELD-WASHER FLUID
RESERVOIR
Fill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir periodically. Add windshield-washer fluid when the low
windshield-washer fluid warning light comes on.
To fill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir, lift
the cap off the reservoir and pour the windshieldwasher fluid into the reservoir opening.
Add a washer solvent to the washer for better
cleaning. In the winter season, add a windshieldwasher antifreeze. Follow the manufacturer’s instructions for the mixture ratio.
BATTERY
Refill the reservoir more frequently when driving
conditions require an increased amount of
windshield-washer fluid.
● Keep the battery surface clean and dry.
Clean the battery with a solution of baking
soda and water.
Recommended fluid is Genuine NISSAN Windshield Washer Concentrate Cleaner & Antifreeze
or equivalent.
● Make certain the terminal connections are
clean and securely tightened.
CAUTION
● If the vehicle is not to be used for 30 days or
longer, disconnect the negative (-) battery
terminal cable to prevent discharge.
● Do not substitute engine antifreeze
coolant for windshield-washer fluid.
This may result in damage to the paint.
NOTE:
● Do not fill the windshield-washer fluid
reservoir with washer fluid concentrates at full strength. Some methyl alcohol based washer fluid concentrates
may permanently stain the grille if
spilled while filling the windshieldwasher fluid reservoir.
Care should be taken to avoid situations
that can lead to potential battery discharge
and potential no-start conditions such as:
1. Installation or extended use of electronic
accessories that consume battery power
when the engine is not running (Phone chargers, GPS, DVD players, etc.)
● Pre-mix washer fluid concentrates with
water to the manufacturer’s recommended levels before pouring the fluid
into the windshield-washer fluid reservoir. Do not use the windshield-washer
fluid reservoir to mix the washer fluid
concentrate and water.
2. Vehicle is not driven regularly and/or only
driven short distances. In these cases, the
battery may need to be charged to maintain
battery health.
WARNING
● Do not expose the battery to flames, an
electrical spark or a cigarette. Hydrogen
gas generated by the battery is explosive. Explosive gases can cause blindness or injury. Do not allow battery fluid
to contact your skin, eyes, fabrics or
painted surfaces. Sulfuric acid can
cause blindness or injury. After touching a battery or battery cap, do not
touch or rub your eyes. Thoroughly
wash your hands. If the acid contacts
your eyes, skin or clothing, immediately
flush with water for at least 15 minutes
and seek medical attention.
● Do not operate the vehicle if the fluid in
the battery is low. Low battery fluid can
cause a higher load on the battery
which can generate heat, reduce battery
life, and in some cases lead to an
explosion.
● When working on or near a battery, always wear suitable eye protection and
remove all jewelry.
● Battery posts, terminals and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands after handling.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-15
● Keep battery out of the reach of
children.
● Do not tip the battery. Keep the vent
caps tight and the battery level.
WDI0224
1. Remove the vent caps with a screwdriver as
shown. Use a cloth to protect the battery
case.
LDI0302
2. Check the fluid level in each cell. If it is
necessary to add fluid, add only distilled
water to bring the level up to the bottom of
the filler opening. Do not overfill. Reinstall
the vent caps.
8-16 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
DRIVE BELT
Vehicles operated in high temperatures or under
severe conditions require frequent checks of the
battery fluid level.
1. Visually inspect the belt for signs of unusual
wear, cuts, fraying or looseness. If the belt is
in poor condition or is loose, have it replaced
or adjusted by a NISSAN dealer.
JUMP STARTING
2. Have the belt checked regularly for condition and tension in accordance with the
maintenance schedule found in the
“NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide”.
If jump starting is necessary, refer to “Jump starting” in the “In case of emergency” section of this
manual. If the engine does not start by jump
starting, the battery may have to be replaced.
Contact a NISSAN dealer.
LDI2131
VQ35DE engine
1.
2.
3.
4.
Crankshaft pulley
Drive belt automatic tensioner pulley
Generator pulley
Air conditioner compressor pulley
WARNING
Be sure the ignition switch is placed in the
OFF or LOCK position before servicing
drive belt. The engine could rotate
unexpectedly.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-17
SPARK PLUGS
AIR CLEANER
WARNING
Be sure the engine and ignition switch are
off and that the parking brake is engaged
securely.
CAUTION
Be sure to use the correct socket to remove the spark plugs. An incorrect socket
can damage the spark plugs.
If replacement is required, see a NISSAN dealer
for assistance.
SDI1895
REPLACING SPARK PLUGS
Iridium-tipped spark plugs
A
It is not necessary to replace iridium-tipped 䊊
spark plugs as frequently as conventional type
spark plugs because they last much longer. Follow the maintenance log shown in the “NISSAN
Service and Maintenance Guide”. Do not service
iridium-tipped spark plugs by cleaning or regapping.
● Always replace spark plugs with recommended or equivalent ones.
8-18 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
LDI2553
The air cleaner filter should not be cleaned and
reused. Replace it according to the maintenance
log shown in the “NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide.”
To remove the air cleaner filter:
A.
1. Unlatch the retaining clips 䊊
2. Move the air cleaner cover upwards.
3. Remove the air cleaner filter. Wipe the inside
of the air cleaner filter housing and the cover
with a damp cloth, then replace air cleaner
filter.
WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES
NOTE:
IN-CABIN MICROFILTER
CLEANING
After installing a new air cleaner filter,
make sure the air cleaner cover is seated in
the housing and latch the clips.
The in-cabin microfilter restricts the entry of airborne dust and pollen particles and reduces
some objectionable outside odors. The filter is
located behind the glove box. For additional information, refer to the “NISSAN Service and
Maintenance Guide” for change intervals.
If your windshield is not clear after using the
windshield-washer or if a wiper blade chatters
when running, wax or other material may be on
the blade or windshield.
WARNING
● Operating the engine with the air
cleaner removed can cause you or others to be burned. The air cleaner not
only cleans the air, it stops the flame if
the engine backfires. If it isn’t there, and
the engine backfires, you could be
burned. Do not drive with the air cleaner
removed, and be careful when working
on the engine with the air cleaner
removed.
● Never pour fuel into the throttle body or
attempt to start the engine with the air
cleaner removed. Doing so could result
in serious injury.
If replacement is required, see your NISSAN
dealer.
Clean the outside of the windshield with a washer
solution or a mild detergent. Your windshield is
clean if beads do not form when rinsing with clear
water.
Clean each blade by wiping it with a cloth soaked
in a washer solution or a mild detergent. Then
rinse the blades with clear water. If your windshield is still not clear after cleaning the blades
and using the wiper, replace the blades.
WARNING
Worn windshield wiper blades can damage the windshield and impair driver
vision.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-19
CAUTION
● After wiper blade replacement, return
the wiper arm to its original position;
otherwise it may be damaged when the
hood is opened.
● Make sure the wiper blades contact the
glass; otherwise the arms may be damaged from wind pressure.
LDI2584
REPLACING
Replace the wiper blades if they are worn.
To replace the windshield wiper blades, follow
the procedure below:
1. Lift the wiper arm away from the windshield.
A.
2. Lift the release tab 䊊
B down and remove.
3. Move the wiper blade 䊊
4. Insert the new wiper blade onto the wiper
arm.
5. Push the release tab down until it clicks.
6. Push wiper on to windshield.
8-20 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
LDI2182
If you wax the surface of the hood, be careful not
A . This may
to let wax get into the washer nozzle 䊊
cause clogging or improper windshield-washer
operation. If wax gets into the nozzle, remove it
B.
with a needle or small pin 䊊
BRAKES
Rear window wiper blade
Contact a NISSAN dealer if checking or replacement is required.
If the brakes do not operate properly, have the
brakes checked by a NISSAN dealer.
Self-adjusting brakes
Your vehicle is equipped with self-adjusting
brakes.
Proper brake inspection intervals should
be followed. For additional information regarding brake inspections, refer to the appropriate
maintenance schedule information in the
“NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide”.
The front and rear disc-type brakes self-adjust
every time the brake pedal is applied.
WARNING
See a NISSAN dealer for a brake system
check if the brake pedal height does not
return to normal.
Brake pad wear indicators
The disc brake pads on your vehicle have audible
wear indicators. When a brake pad requires replacement, a high pitched scraping or screeching sound will be heard when the vehicle is in
motion. The noise will be heard whether or not the
brake pedal is depressed. Have the brakes
checked as soon as possible if the wear indicator
sound is heard.
Under some driving or climate conditions, occasional brake squeak, squeal or other noise may
be heard. Occasional brake noise during light to
moderate stops is normal and does not affect the
function or performance of the brake system.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-21
FUSES
3. Remove the fuse box cover by pushing the
tab and lifting the cover up.
4. Remove the fuse with the fuse puller. The
fuse puller is located in the center of the fuse
block in the passenger compartment.
LDI2385
If any electrical equipment does not operate,
check for an open fuse.
Fuses are used in the passenger and engine
compartment. Spare fuses are provided and can
be found in the passenger compartment fuse
box.
When installing a fuse make sure the fuse is
installed in the fuse box securely.
LDI2636
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
CAUTION
Never use a fuse of a higher or lower
amperage rating than specified on the
fuse box cover. This could damage the
electrical system or cause a fire.
If any electrical equipment does not come on,
check for an open fuse.
1. Be sure the ignition switch and the headlight
switch are OFF.
2. Open the engine hood.
8-22 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
LDI0456
A , replace it with a new
5. If the fuse is open 䊊
B.
fuse 䊊
6. If a new fuse also opens, have the electrical
system checked and repaired by a NISSAN
dealer.
LDI2560
Fusible links
If the electrical equipment does not operate and
fuses are in good condition, check the fusible
links. If any of these fusible links are melted,
replace with only Genuine NISSAN parts.
LDI2569
PASSENGER COMPARTMENT
CAUTION
Never use a fuse of a higher or lower
amperage rating than specified on the
fuse box cover. This could damage the
electrical system or cause a fire.
If any electrical equipment does not operate,
check for an open fuse.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-23
LDI2570
NOTE:
The fuse box is located on the driver’s side
of the instrument panel.
1. Be sure the ignition switch and the headlight
switch are OFF.
1 to remove.
2. Pull down on fuse box cover 䊊
3. Locate the fuse that needs to be replaced.
2 .
4. Remove the fuse with the fuse puller 䊊
8-24 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
LDI0456
A , replace it with an
5. If the fuse is open 䊊
B.
equivalent good fuse 䊊
6. Push the fuse box cover to install.
If a new fuse also opens, have the electrical
system checked and repaired by a NISSAN
dealer.
LDI2035
Extended storage switch
If any electrical equipment does not operate,
remove the extended storage switch and check
for an open fuse.
NOTE:
The extended storage switch is used for
long term vehicle storage. Even if the extended storage switch is broken it is not
necessary to replace it. Replace only the
open fuse in the switch with a new fuse.
BATTERY REPLACEMENT
How to replace the extended storage switch:
1. To remove the extended storage switch, be
sure the ignition switch is in the OFF or
LOCK position.
CAUTION
Be careful not to allow children to swallow
the battery or removed parts.
2. Be sure the headlight switch is in the OFF
position.
3. Remove the fuse box cover.
1 found on each
4. Pinch the locking tabs 䊊
side of the storage switch.
5. Pull the storage switch straight out from the
2 .
fuse box 䊊
LDI2001
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-25
3. Replace the battery with a new one.
NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY®
Replace the battery in the Intelligent Key as follows:
Recommended battery: CR2032 or equivalent.
1. Remove the mechanical key from the Intelligent Key.
● Do not touch the internal circuit and electric terminals as doing so could cause a
malfunction.
A into
2. Insert a small flathead screwdriver 䊊
B of the corner and twist it to sepathe slit 䊊
rate the upper part from the lower part. Place
a cloth over the screwdriver to protect the
casing.
● Hold the battery by the edges. Holding
the battery across the contact points will
seriously deplete the storage capacity.
● Make sure that the + side faces the bottom of the lower part.
C
4. Close the lid securely as illustrated with 䊊
D.
and 䊊
5. Operate the buttons to check the operation.
See a NISSAN dealer if you need assistance for
replacement.
FCC Notice:
For USA:
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may
not cause harmful interference, and (2) this
device must accept any interference received, including interference that may
cause undesired operation.
LDI2637
8-26 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
LIGHTS
Note:
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
For Canada:
This device complies with Industry Canada
licence-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference, including interference that
may cause undesired operation of the device.
HEADLIGHTS
Replacing the halogen headlight bulb
(if so equipped)
The headlight is a semi-sealed beam type which
uses a replaceable headlight (halogen) bulb. Because the headlight assembly must be removed
from the vehicle for bulb replacement, see your
NISSAN dealer.
CAUTION
● Aiming is not necessary after replacing
the bulb. When aiming adjustment is
necessary, contact a NISSAN dealer.
● Do not leave the headlight assembly
open without a bulb installed for a long
period of time. Dust, moisture, smoke,
etc. entering the headlight body may
affect bulb performance. Remove the
bulb from the headlight assembly just
before a replacement bulb is installed.
● High pressure halogen gas is sealed
inside the halogen bulb. The bulb may
break if the glass envelope is scratched
or the bulb is dropped.
Fog may temporarily form inside the lens of the
exterior lights in the rain or in a car wash. A
temperature difference between the inside and
the outside of the lens causes the fog. This is not
a malfunction. If large drops of water collect
inside the lens, contact a NISSAN dealer.
Replacing the LED headlight bulb (if
so equipped)
If LED headlight bulb replacement is required,
see your NISSAN dealer.
FOG LIGHTS (if so equipped)
Replacing the fog light bulb
If replacement is required, see your NISSAN
dealer.
● Only touch the base when handling the
bulb. Never touch the glass envelope.
Touching the glass could significantly
affect bulb life and/or headlight
performance.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-27
CAUTION
● High pressure halogen gas is sealed
inside the halogen bulb. The bulb may
break if the glass envelope is scratched
or the bulb is dropped.
● When handling the bulb, do not touch
the glass envelope.
● Use the same number and wattage as
originally installed as shown in the
chart.
● Do not leave the bulb out of the fog light
for a long period of time as dust, moisture and smoke may enter the fog light
body and affect the performance of the
fog light.
EXTERIOR AND INTERIOR LIGHTS
Item
Headlight assembly (Type A) (if so equipped)*
High (Halogen)
Low (Halogen)
Turn
Side marker
Park
Headlight assembly (Type B) (if so equipped)*
High
Low
Turn
Side marker
Park
Front fog lights (if so equipped)*
Daytime running lights*
Door mirror turn signal light
Map light*
Personal light*
Vanity mirror light*
Glove box light*
Cargo light*
High-mounted stop light*
Rear combination light*
Tail/Stop
Turn
Rear side marker
Backup (reversing)
License plate light*
Wattage (W)
Bulb No.
65
55
28/8
5
—
H9
H11
7444NA
W5W
—
—
—
28/8
5
—
35
—
—
—
—
1.3
—
5
—
—
—
7444NA
W5W
—
H8
—
—
—
—
37LL
—
—
—
—
21
5
16
5
—
WY21W
W5W
921
W5W
* See a NISSAN dealer for replacement.
Always check with the Parts Department at a NISSAN dealer for the latest parts information.
8-28 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
WHEELS AND TIRES
1.
2
3
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
Map light
Headlight assembly
Personal light
Door mirror turn signal light
Fog light (if so equipped)
High mounted stoplight
License plate light
Rear combination light
Cargo light
Daytime running light
If you have a flat tire, refer to the “In case of
emergency” section of this manual.
TIRE PRESSURE
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)
WARNING
Radio waves could adversely affect electric medical equipment. Those who use a
pacemaker should contact the electric
medical equipment manufacturer for the
possible influences before use.
This vehicle is equipped with the Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS). It monitors tire pressure of all tires except the spare. When the low
tire pressure warning light is lit and the Tire
Pressure Low - Add Air warning appears in the
vehicle information display, one or more of your
tires is significantly under-inflated. If equipped,
the system also displays pressure of all tires
(except the spare tire) on the display screen by
sending a signal from a sensor that is installed in
each wheel.
LDI2638
The TPMS will activate only when the vehicle is
driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h). Also,
this system may not detect a sudden drop in tire
pressure (for example a flat tire while driving).
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-29
For additional information, refer to “Low tire pressure warning light” in the “Instruments and controls” section and “Flat tire” in the “In case of
emergency” section of this manual.
Tire inflation pressure
Check the tire pressures (including the
spare) often and always prior to long distance trips. The recommended tire pressure specifications are shown on the
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label
or the Tire and Loading Information label
under the “Cold Tire Pressure” heading.
The Tire and Loading Information label is
affixed to the driver side center pillar. Tire
pressures should be checked regularly
because:
● Most tires naturally lose air over time.
● Tires can lose air suddenly when
driven over potholes or other objects
or if the vehicle strikes a curb while
parking.
The tire pressures should be checked
when the tires are cold. The tires are
considered COLD after the vehicle has
8-30 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
been parked for 3 or more hours, or driven
less than 1 mile (1.6 km) at moderate
speeds.
The TPMS with Easy Fill Tire Alert provides visual and audible signals outside
the vehicle for inflating the tires to the
recommended COLD tire pressure. For
additional information, refer to “TPMS
with Easy Fill Tire Alert” in the “Starting
and driving” section of this manual.
Incorrect tire pressure, including under inflation, may adversely affect
tire life and vehicle handling.
WARNING
● Improperly inflated tires can fail
suddenly and cause an accident.
● The Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR) is located on the
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label. The vehicle weight capacity is indicated on the Tire and
Loading Information label. Do
not load your vehicle beyond this
capacity. Overloading your vehicle may result in reduced tire
life, unsafe operating conditions
due to premature tire failure, or
unfavorable handling characteristics and could also lead to a
serious accident. Loading beyond
the specified capacity may also
result in failure of other vehicle
components.
● Before taking a long trip, or
whenever you heavily load your
vehicle, use a tire pressure gauge
to ensure that the tire pressures
are at the specified level.
● For additional information regarding tires, refer to “Important
Tire Safety Information” (US) or
“Tire
Safety
Information”
(Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet.
4
䊊
5
䊊
6
䊊
Original tire size: The size of the tires
originally installed on the vehicle at
the factory.
Spare tire size.
Vehicle load limit: Refer to “Vehicle
loading information” in the “Technical
and consumer information” section of
this manual.
LDI2083
Tire and loading information label
1
䊊
2
䊊
Seating capacity: The maximum number of occupants that can be seated
in the vehicle.
Tire size - refer to “Tire labeling” in
this section.
3
䊊
Cold tire pressure: Inflate the tires to
this pressure when the tires are cold.
Tires are considered COLD after the
vehicle has been parked for 3 or more
hours, or driven less than 1 mile
(1.6 km) at moderate speeds. The
recommended cold tire inflation is set
by the manufacturer to provide the
best balance of tire wear, vehicle
handling, driveability, tire noise, etc.,
up to the vehicle’s GVWR.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-31
4. Read the tire pressure on the gauge
stem and compare to the specification shown on the Tire and Loading
Information label.
5. Add air to the tire as needed. If too
much air is added, press the core of
the valve stem briefly with the tip of
the gauge stem to release pressure.
Recheck the pressure and add or
release air as needed.
6. Install the valve stem cap.
LDI0393
Checking tire pressure
7. Check the pressure of all other tires,
including the spare.
1. Remove the valve stem cap from the
tire.
Size
2. Press the pressure gauge squarely
onto the valve stem. Do not press too
hard or force the valve stem sideways, or air will escape. If the hissing
sound of air escaping from the tire is
heard while checking the pressure,
reposition the gauge to eliminate this
leakage.
Front and Rear
Original Tire:
235/65R18
Front and Rear
Original Tire:
235/55R20
Spare Tire:
T165/90D18
3. Remove the gauge.
8-32 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
Cold Tire Inflation
Pressure
33 PSI, 230 kPa
35 PSI, 240 kPa
60 PSI, 420 kPa
WDI0394
Example
TIRE LABELING
Federal law requires tire manufacturers to
place standardized information on the
sidewall of all tires. This information identifies and describes the fundamental
characteristics of the tire and also provides the tire identification number (TIN)
for safety standard certification. The TIN
can be used to identify the tire in case of a
recall.
7. H: Tire speed rating. You should not
drive the vehicle faster than the tire
speed rating.
WDI0395
Example
1 Tire size (example: P215/65R15 95H)
䊊
1. P: The “P” indicates the tire is designed for passenger vehicles (not all
tires have this information).
2. Three-digit number (215): This number gives the width in millimeters of
the tire from sidewall edge to sidewall edge.
3. Two-digit number (65): This number,
known as the aspect ratio, gives the
tire’s ratio of height to width.
4. R: The “R” stands for radial.
5. Two-digit number (15): This number
is the wheel or rim diameter in inches.
6. Two- or three-digit number (95): This
number is the tire’s load index. It is a
measurement of how much weight
each tire can support. You may not
find this information on all tires because it is not required by law.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-33
ers also must indicate the materials in the
tire, which include steel, nylon, polyester
and others.
4 Maximum permissible inflation pres䊊
sure
This number is the greatest amount of air
pressure that should be put in the tire. Do
not exceed the maximum permissible inflation pressure.
5 Maximum load rating
䊊
LDI2786
Example
2 TIN (Tire Identification Number) for a
䊊
new tire (example: DOT XX XX XXX
XXXX)
1. DOT: Abbreviation for the “Department Of Transportation”. The symbol
can be placed above, below or to the
left or right of the Tire Identification
Number.
2. Two-digit code:
identification mark.
Manufacturer’s
3. Two-digit code: Tire size.
8-34 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
4. Three-digit code: Tire type code
(Optional).
5. Four numbers represent the week
and year the tire was built. For example, the numbers 3103 means the
31st week of 2003. If these numbers
are missing then look on the other
sidewall of the tire.
3 Tire ply composition and material
䊊
The number of layers or plies of rubbercoated fabric in the tire. Tire manufactur-
This number indicates the maximum load
in kilograms and pounds that can be carried by the tire. When replacing the tires
on the vehicle, always use a tire that has
the same load rating as the factory installed tire.
6 Term of “tubeless” or “tube type”
䊊
Indicates whether the tire requires an inner tube (“tube type”) or not (“tubeless”).
7 The word “radial”
䊊
The word “radial” is shown if the tire has
radial structure.
8 Manufacturer or brand name
䊊
Manufacturer or brand name is shown.
Other Tire-related Terminology
In addition to the many terms that are
defined throughout this section, Intended
Outboard Sidewall is (1) the sidewall that
contains a whitewall, bears white lettering
or bears manufacturer, brand, and/or
model name molding that is higher or
deeper than the same molding on the
other sidewall of the tire, or (2) the outward facing sidewall of an asymmetrical
tire that has a particular side that must
always face outward when mounted on a
vehicle.
TYPES OF TIRES
WARNING
● When changing or replacing tires, be
sure all four tires are of the same type
(i.e., Summer, All Season or Snow) and
construction. A NISSAN dealer may be
able to help you with information about
tire type, size, speed rating and
availability.
● Replacement tires may have a lower
speed rating than the factory equipped
tires, and may not match the potential
maximum vehicle speed. Never exceed
the maximum speed rating of the tire.
● Replacing tires with those not originally
specified by NISSAN could affect the
proper operation of the low tire pressure warning system.
● For additional information regarding
tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet.
● Always use tires of the same type, size,
brand, construction and tread pattern
on all four wheels. Failure to do so may
result in a circumference difference between tires on the front and rear axles
which can cause the VDC system to malfunction resulting in personal injury or
death, excessive tire wear and may
damage the transmission, transfer case
and differential gears.
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) models
CAUTION
● ONLY use spare tires specified for the
AWD model.
If excessive tire wear is found, it is recommended
that all four tires be replaced with tires of the
same size, brand, construction and tread pattern.
The tire pressure and wheel alignment should
also be checked and corrected as necessary.
Contact a NISSAN dealer.
All season tires
NISSAN specifies All Season tires on some models to provide good performance all year, including snowy and icy road conditions. All Season
tires are identified by ALL SEASON and/or M&S
on the tire sidewall. Snow tires have better snow
traction than All Season tires and may be more
appropriate in some areas.
Summer tires
NISSAN specifies summer tires on some models
to provide superior performance on dry roads.
Summer tire performance is substantially reduced in snow and ice. Summer tires do not have
the tire traction rating “M&S” on the tire sidewall.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-35
If you plan to operate your vehicle in snowy or icy
conditions, NISSAN recommends the use of
SNOW tires or ALL SEASON tires on all four
wheels.
Snow tires
If snow tires are needed, it is necessary to select
tires equivalent in size and load rating to the
original equipment tires. If you do not, it can
adversely affect the safety and handling of your
vehicle.
Generally, snow tires have lower speed ratings
than factory equipped tires and may not match
the potential maximum vehicle speed. Never exceed the maximum speed rating of the tire.
If you install snow tires, they must be the same
size, brand, construction and tread pattern on all
four wheels.
For additional traction on icy roads, studded tires
may be used. However, some U.S. states and
Canadian provinces prohibit their use. Check
local, state and provincial laws before installing
studded tires. Skid and traction capabilities of
studded snow tires on wet or dry surfaces may be
poorer than that of non-studded snow tires.
8-36 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
TIRE CHAINS
CAUTION
Tire chains/cables should not be installed
on 235/55R20 size tires. Installation of the
tire chains/cables on 235/55R20 size tires
will cause damage to the vehicle. If you
plan to use tire chains/cables, you should
install 235/65R18 size tires on your
vehicle.
Use of tire chains may be prohibited according to
location. Check the local laws before installing
tire chains. When installing tire chains, make sure
they are the proper size for the tires on your
vehicle and are installed according to the chain
manufacturer’s suggestions. Use only SAE
class “S” chains. Class “S” chains are used on
vehicles with restricted tire to vehicle clearance.
Vehicles that can use Class “S” chains are designed to meet the minimum clearances between
the tire and the closest vehicle suspension or
body component required to accommodate the
use of a winter traction device (tire chains or
cables). The minimum clearances are determined
using the factory equipped tire size. Other types
may damage your vehicle. Use chain tensioners
when recommended by the tire chain manufacturer to ensure a tight fit. Loose end links of the
tire chain must be secured or removed to prevent
the possibility of whipping action damage to the
fenders or underbody. If possible, avoid fully loading your vehicle when using tire chains. In addition, drive at a reduced speed. Otherwise, your
vehicle may be damaged and/or vehicle handling
and performance may be adversely affected.
Do not use tire chains on dry roads. Driving with
chains in such conditions can cause damage to
the various mechanisms of the vehicle due to
some overstress.
Wheel nut tightening torque:
83 ft-lb (113 N·m)
The wheel nuts must be kept tightened to
specifications at all times. It is recommended that wheel nuts be tightened to
specification at each tire rotation interval.
WARNING
● After rotating the tires, check and adjust
the tire pressure.
WDI0258
CHANGING WHEELS AND TIRES
Tire rotation
NISSAN recommends rotating the tires every
5,000 miles (8,000 km).
For additional information, refer to “Flat tire” in the
“In case of emergency” section of this manual for
tire replacing procedures.
As soon as possible, tighten the wheel nuts
to the specified torque with a torque
wrench.
● Retighten the wheel nuts when the vehicle has been driven for 600 miles
(1,000 km) (also in cases of a flat tire,
etc.).
● Do not include the spare tire in the tire
rotation.
● For additional information regarding
tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet.
WDI0259
Tire wear and damage
1. Wear indicator
2. Location mark
WARNING
● Tires should be periodically inspected for wear, cracking, bulging or objects caught in the tread.
If excessive wear, cracks, bulging
or deep cuts are found, the tire(s)
should be replaced.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-37
● The original tires have built-in
tread wear indicators. When the
wear indicators are visible, the
tire(s) should be replaced.
● Tires degrade with age and use.
Have tires, including the spare,
over 6 years old checked by a
qualified technician because
some tire damage may not be obvious. Replace the tires as necessary to prevent tire failure and
possible personal injury.
● Improper service of the spare tire
may result in serious personal injury. If it is necessary to repair the
spare tire, contact a NISSAN
dealer.
● For additional information regarding tires, refer to “Important
Tire Safety Information” (US) or
“Tire
Safety
Information”
(Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet.
Replacing wheels and tires
When replacing a tire, use the same size, tread
design, speed rating and load carrying capacity
8-38 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
as originally equipped. Recommended types and
sizes are shown in “Wheels and tires” in the
“Technical and consumer information” section of
this manual.
WARNING
● The use of tires other than those recommended or the mixed use of tires of
different brands, construction (bias,
bias-belted or radial), or tread patterns
can adversely affect the ride, braking,
handling, VDC system, ground clearance, body-to-tire clearance, tire chain
clearance, speedometer calibration,
headlight aim and bumper height.
Some of these effects may lead to accidents and could result in serious personal injury.
● For 2WD models, if your vehicle was
originally equipped with 4 tires that
were the same size and you are only
replacing 2 of the 4 tires, install the new
tires on the rear axle. Placing new tires
on the front axle may cause loss of
vehicle control in some driving conditions and cause an accident and personal injury
● If the wheels are changed for any reason, always replace with wheels which
have the same off-set dimension.
Wheels of a different off-set could
cause premature tire wear, degrade vehicle handling characteristics, affect the
VDC system and/or interference with
the brake disc/drum. Such interference
can lead to decreased braking efficiency and/or early brake pad/shoe
wear. For additional information, refer
to “Wheels and tires” in the “Technical
and consumer information” section of
this
manual
for
wheel
off-set
dimensions.
● When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel
is replaced, tire pressure will not be
indicated, the TPMS will not function
and the low tire pressure warning light
will flash for approximately 1 minute.
The light will remain on after 1 minute.
Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as
possible for tire replacement and/or
system resetting.
● Replacing tires with those not originally
specified by NISSAN could affect the
proper operation of the TPMS.
● Do not install a damaged or deformed
wheel or tire even if it has been repaired. Such wheels or tires could have
structural damage and could fail without warning.
● The use of retread
recommended.
tires
is
not
● For additional information regarding
tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet.
● Always use tires of the same type, size,
brand, construction and tread pattern
on all four wheels. Failure to do so may
result in a circumference difference between tires on the front and rear axles
which can cause the VDC system to malfunction resulting in personal injury or
death, excessive tire wear and may
damage the transmission, transfer case
and differential gears (AWD models).
Wheel balance
Unbalanced wheels may affect vehicle handling
and tire life. Even with regular use, wheels can get
out of balance. Therefore, they should be balanced as required.
Wheel balance service should be performed with the wheels off the vehicle.
Spin balancing the wheels on the vehicle
could lead to mechanical damage.
● For additional information regarding
tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety
Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet.
Care of wheels
● Wash the wheels when washing the vehicle
to maintain their appearance.
● Clean the inner side of the wheels when the
wheel is changed or the underside of the
vehicle is washed.
● Do not use abrasive cleaners when washing
the wheels.
● Inspect wheel rims regularly for dents or
corrosion. Such damage may cause loss of
pressure or poor seal at the tire bead.
● NISSAN recommends waxing the road
wheels to protect against road salt in areas
where it is used during winter.
Spare tire (TEMPORARY USE ONLY
spare tire)
Observe the following precautions if the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire must be used.
Otherwise, your vehicle could be damaged or
involved in an accident:
WARNING
● The spare tire should be used for emergency use only. It should be replaced
with the standard tire at the first opportunity to avoid possible tire or differential damage.
● Drive carefully while the TEMPORARY
USE ONLY spare tire is installed. Avoid
sharp turns and abrupt braking while
driving.
● Periodically check spare tire inflation
pressure. Always keep the pressure of
the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire
at 60 psi (420 kPa, 4.2 bar).
● With the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare
tire installed do not drive the vehicle at
speeds faster than 50 MPH (80 km/h).
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-39
● When driving on roads covered with
snow or ice, the TEMPORARY USE
ONLY spare tire should be used on the
rear wheels and the original tire used
on the front wheels (drive wheels). Use
tire chains only on the front (original)
tires.
● Tire tread of the TEMPORARY USE
ONLY spare tire will wear at a faster rate
than the standard tire. Replace the
spare tire as soon as the tread wear
indicators appear.
● Do not use the spare tire on other
vehicles.
● Do not use more than one spare tire at
the same time.
● Do not tow a trailer when the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire is installed.
8-40 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
CAUTION
● Do not use tire chains on a TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire. Tire chains
will not fit properly and may cause damage to the vehicle.
● Because the TEMPORARY USE ONLY
spare tire is smaller than the original
tire, ground clearance is reduced. To
avoid damage to the vehicle, do not
drive over obstacles. Also, do not drive
the vehicle through an automatic car
wash since it may get caught.
9 Technical and consumer information
Recommended fluids/lubricants and capacities . . . . . . . 9-2
Recommended fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4
Engine oil and oil filter recommendations . . . . . . . . . . 9-6
Air conditioner system refrigerant and oil
recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7
Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8
Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9
Dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9
When traveling or registering your vehicle in
another country . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10
Vehicle identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10
Vehicle identification number (VIN) plate . . . . . . . . . 9-10
Vehicle identification number
(chassis number) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10
Engine serial number. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . . . . 9-11
Emission control information label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11
Tire and loading information label. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12
Air conditioner specification label. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12
Installing front license plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12
Vehicle loading information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13
Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13
Vehicle load capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14
Securing the load. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-15
Loading tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-16
Measurement of weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-16
Towing a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-17
Maximum load limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-17
Towing load/specification. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20
Towing safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20
Flat towing for All–Wheel drive vehicle
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25
Flat towing for front wheel drive vehicle
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25
Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-26
Emission control system warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-27
Reporting safety defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-27
Readiness for inspection/maintenance (I/M) test . . . . . 9-28
Event Data Recorders (EDR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-29
Owner’s Manual/Service Manual order information . . . 9-29
RECOMMENDED FLUIDS/
LUBRICANTS AND CAPACITIES
The following are approximate capacities. The actual refill capacities may be slightly different. When refilling, follow the procedure
described in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section to determine the proper refill capacity.
Capacity (Approximate)
US measure
Imp measure
Fuel
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants
Liter
19 gal
15 7/8 gal
71.9 L
With oil filter
change
5-1/8 qt
4-1/4 qt
4.8 L
Without oil
filter change
4-3/4 qt
4.0 qt
4.5 L
With reservoir
2-1/4 gal
1-7/8 gal
Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT)
fluid
—
—
—
Differential gear oil
—
—
—
Engine oil
Drain and refill
Cooling system
9-2 Technical and consumer information
8.7 L
• Unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of at least 87 AKI (RON 91).
• For additional information, refer to “Recommended fuel” in this section.
• Genuine NISSAN engine oil or equivalent.
• Engine oil with API Certification Mark.
• Viscosity SAE 0W-20.
• As an alternative to this recommended oil, SAE 5W-30 conventional petroleum based oil may be used and meet all specifications and requirements
necessary to maintain the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
• For additional information, refer to “Engine oil and oil filter recommendations” in this section.
• For additional information, refer to “Changing engine oil” and “Changing
engine oil filter” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this
manual.
• Pre-diluted Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) or
equivalent.
• Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3.
• NISSAN recommends using Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3
ONLY in NISSAN CVTs. Do not mix with other fluids. Using fluids
that are not equivalent to Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-3 may
damage the CVT. Damage caused by the use of fluids other than as
recommended is not covered under NISSAN’s New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
• Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super GL-5 80W-90 or equivalent conventional (non-synthetic) oil.
• See a NISSAN dealer for service for synthetic oil.
Capacity (Approximate)
US measure
Imp measure
Transfer oil
Power steering fluid
Brake fluid
—
—
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants
Liter
—
Refill to the proper level according to the instructions in
the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section.
See your NISSAN dealer for service.
Multi-purpose grease
—
—
—
Air conditioning system refrigerant
—
—
—
Air conditioning system oil
—
—
—
1-3/8 gal
1-1/8 gal
4.6 L
Windshield-washer fluid
• Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super GL-5 80W-90 or equivalent conventional (non-synthetic) oil.
• See a NISSAN dealer for service for synthetic oil.
• Genuine NISSAN E-PSF or equivalent.
•Use of power steering fluid other than Genuine NISSAN E-PSF will prevent the power steering system from operating properly.
• Genuine NISSAN Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT 3.
• Available in mainland USA through a NISSAN dealer.
• NLGI No. 2 (Lithium Soap base).
• See your NISSAN dealer for service.
• HFC-134a (R-134a).
• For additional information, refer to “Air conditioner system refrigerant and
oil recommendations” in this section.
•See your NISSAN dealer for service.
• NISSAN A/C System Oil Type ND-OIL8 or equivalent.
• For additional information, refer to “Air conditioner system refrigerant and
oil recommendations” in this section.
•See your NISSAN dealer for service.
• Refill to the proper level according to the instructions in the “Maintenance
and do-it-yourself” section.
• Genuine NISSAN Windshield Washer Concentrate Cleaner & Antifreeze
or equivalent.
Technical and consumer information 9-3
RECOMMENDED FUEL
Use unleaded regular gasoline with an octane
rating of at least 87 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) number (Research octane number 91).
CAUTION
● Only vehicles with the E-85 filler door
label can operate on E-85. Fuel system
or other damage can occur if E-85 is
used in vehicles that are not designed
to run on E-85.
● Using a fuel other than that specified
could adversely affect the emission
control system, and may also affect the
warranty coverage.
● Under no circumstances should a
leaded gasoline be used, because this
will damage the three-way catalyst.
● Do not use E-15 or E-85 fuel in your
vehicle. Your vehicle is not designed to
run on E-15 or E-85 fuel. Using E-15 or
E-85 fuel in a vehicle not specifically
designed for E-15 or E-85 fuel can adversely affect the emission control devices and systems of the vehicle. Damage caused by such fuel is not covered
by the NISSAN new vehicle limited
warranty.
9-4 Technical and consumer information
● U.S. government regulations require
ethanol dispensing pumps to be identified by a small, square, orange and
black label with the common abbreviation or the appropriate percentage for
that region.
Gasoline specifications
NISSAN recommends using gasoline that meets
the World-Wide Fuel Charter (WWFC) specifications where it is available. Many of the automobile manufacturers developed this specification
to improve emission control system and vehicle
performance. Ask your service station manager if
the gasoline meets the WWFC specifications.
Reformulated gasoline
Some fuel suppliers are now producing reformulated gasolines. These gasolines are specially
designed to reduce vehicle emissions. NISSAN
supports efforts towards cleaner air and suggests that you use reformulated gasoline when
available.
Gasoline containing oxygenates
Some fuel suppliers sell gasoline containing oxygenates such as ethanol, MTBE and methanol
with or without advertising their presence.
NISSAN does not recommend the use of fuels of
which the oxygenate content and the fuel com-
patibility for your NISSAN cannot be readily determined. If in doubt, ask your service station
manager.
If you use oxygenate-blend gasoline, please take
the following precautions as the usage of such
fuels may cause vehicle performance problems
and/or fuel system damage.
● The fuel should be unleaded and have
an octane rating no lower than that
recommended for unleaded gasoline.
● If an oxygenate-blend other than
methanol blend is used, it should contain no more than 10% oxygenate.
(MTBE may, however, be added up to
15%.)
● E-15 fuel contains more than 10% oxygenate. E-15 fuel will adversely affect
the emission control devices and systems of the vehicle and should not be
used. Damage caused by such fuel is
not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle
limited warranty.
● If a methanol blend is used, it should
contain no more than 5% methanol
(methyl alcohol, wood alcohol). It
should also contain a suitable amount
of appropriate cosolvents and corrosion inhibitors. If not properly formulated with appropriate cosolvents and
corrosion inhibitors, such methanol
blends may cause fuel system damage
and/or vehicle performance problems.
At this time, sufficient data is not available to ensure that all methanol blends
are suitable for use in NISSAN vehicles.
If any driveability problems such as engine stalling and difficult hot-starting are experienced after
using oxygenate-blend fuels, immediately
change to a non-oxygenate fuel or a fuel with a
low blend of MTBE.
Take care not to spill gasoline during refueling. Gasoline containing oxygenates can
cause paint damage.
E–15 fuel
E-15 fuel is a mixture of approximately 15% fuel
ethanol and 85% unleaded gasoline. E-15 can
only be used in vehicles designed to run on E-15
fuel. Do not use E-15 in your vehicle. U.S. government regulations require fuel ethanol dispensing pumps to be identified with small, square,
orange and black label with the common abbreviation or the appropriate percentage for that
region.
E–85 fuel
E-85 fuel is a mixture of approximately 85% fuel
ethanol and 15% unleaded gasoline. E-85 can
only be used in a Flexible Fuel Vehicle (FFV). Do
not use E-85 in your vehicle. U.S. government
regulations require fuel ethanol dispensing
pumps to be identified by a small, square, orange
and black label with the common abbreviation or
the appropriate percentage for that region.
Aftermarket fuel additives
NISSAN does not recommend the use of any
aftermarket fuel additives (for example, fuel injector cleaner, octane booster, intake valve deposit
removers, etc.) which are sold commercially.
Many of these additives intended for gum, varnish
or deposit removal may contain active solvents or
similar ingredients that can be harmful to the fuel
system and engine.
detect a persistent heavy spark knock even
when using gasoline of the stated octane
rating, or if you hear steady spark knock
while holding a steady speed on level
roads, have a NISSAN dealer correct the
condition. Failure to correct the condition
is misuse of the vehicle, for which NISSAN
is not responsible.
Incorrect ignition timing may result in spark
knock, after-run and/or overheating, which may
cause excessive fuel consumption or engine
damage. If any of the above symptoms are encountered, have your vehicle checked at a
NISSAN dealer.
However, now and then you may notice
light spark knock for a short time while
accelerating or driving up hills. This is not a
cause for concern, because you get the
greatest fuel benefit when there is light
spark knock for a short time under heavy
engine load.
Octane rating tips
Using unleaded gasoline with an octane
rating lower than recommended can cause
persistent, heavy “spark knock.” (“Spark
knock” is a metallic rapping noise.) If severe, this can lead to engine damage. If you
Technical and consumer information 9-5
Oil viscosity
The engine oil viscosity or thickness changes
with temperature. Because of this, it is important
to select the engine oil viscosity based on the
temperatures at which the vehicle will be operated before the next oil change. Choosing an oil
viscosity other than that recommended could
cause serious engine damage.
Selecting the correct oil filter
LTI2051
ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER
RECOMMENDATIONS
Selecting the correct oil
It is essential to choose the correct grade, quality
and viscosity engine oil to ensure satisfactory
engine life and performance. For additional information, refer to “Recommended fluids/lubricants
and capacities” in this section. NISSAN recommends the use of an energy conserving oil in
order to improve fuel economy.
Select only engine oils that meet the American
Petroleum Institute (API) certification or International Lubricant Standardization and Approval
9-6 Technical and consumer information
Committee (ILSAC) certification and SAE viscosity standard. These oils have the API certification mark on the front of the container. Oils which
do not have the specified quality label should not
be used as they could cause engine damage.
Oil additives
NISSAN does not recommend the use of oil
additives. The use of an oil additive is not necessary when the proper oil type is used and maintenance intervals are followed.
Oil which may contain foreign matter or has been
previously used should not be used.
Your new NISSAN vehicle is equipped with a
high-quality Genuine NISSAN oil filter. When
replacing, use a Genuine NISSAN oil filter or its
equivalent for the reason described in “Change
intervals.”
Change intervals
The oil and oil filter change intervals for your
engine are based on the use of the specified
quality oils and filters. Using engine oil and filters
that are not of the specified quality, or exceeding
recommended oil and filter change intervals
could reduce engine life. Damage to the engine
caused by improper maintenance or use of incorrect oil and filter quality and/or viscosity is not
covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty.
Your engine was filled with a high-quality engine
oil when it was built. You do not have to change
the oil before the first recommended change
interval. Oil and filter change intervals depend
upon how you use your vehicle.
Operation under the following conditions may
require more frequent oil and filter changes:
● repeated short distance driving at cold outside temperatures
● driving in dusty conditions
● extensive idling
● towing a trailer
● stop and go commuting
For additional information, refer to the “NISSAN
Service and Maintenance Guide” for the maintenance schedule.
CAUTION
The use of any other refrigerant or oil will
cause severe damage to the air conditioning system and will require the replacement of all air conditioner system
components.
The refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) in your
NISSAN vehicle does not harm the earth’s ozone
layer. Although this refrigerant does not affect the
earth’s atmosphere, certain government regulations require the recovery and recycling of any
refrigerant during automotive air conditioner system service. A NISSAN dealer has the trained
technicians and equipment needed to recover
and recycle your air conditioner system refrigerant.
Contact a NISSAN dealer when servicing your air
conditioner system.
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM
REFRIGERANT AND OIL
RECOMMENDATIONS
The air conditioner system in your NISSAN
vehicle must be charged with the refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) and NISSAN A/C
system oil Type ND-OIL8 or the exact
equivalents.
Technical and consumer information 9-7
SPECIFICATIONS
ENGINE
Model
Type
Cylinder arrangement
Bore x Stroke
Displacement
Firing order
VQ35DE
Gasoline, 4-cycle, DOHC
6-cylinder, V-block, Slanted at 60°
in (mm) 3.760 x 3.205 (95.5 x 81.4)
cu in (cm3) 213.45 (3,498)
1–2–3–4–5–6
Idle speed
CVT (in N (Neutral) position)
Ignition timing (degree B.T.D.C. at idle speed)
CO % at idle
Spark plug
Spark plug gap (Nominal)
Camshaft operation
This spark ignition system complies with the Canadian standard ICES-002.
9-8 Technical and consumer information
No adjustment is necessary.
FXE22HR-11
in (mm) 0.043 (1.1)
Timing chain
WHEELS AND TIRES
DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS
Wheel type
Offset: in (mm)
Size
Aluminum
1.97 (50)
18 x 7.5J
1.97 (50)
20 x 7.5J
Spare wheel-steel
0.99 (25)
18 x 4T
Tire size
235/65R18
Tire size
235/55R20
Spare tire
T165/90D18
Overall length
without front license plate bracket
with front license plate bracket
Overall width
Overall height
Front and rear tread width
Wheelbase
Gross vehicle weight rating
Gross axle weight rating
Front
Rear
in (mm)
in (mm)
in (mm)
in (mm)
in (mm)
lb (kg)
lb (kg)
lb (kg)
192.4 (4,888)
192.8 (4,898)
75.4 (1,916)
66.6 (1,691)
64.6 (1,640)
111.2 (2,825)
Refer to the “F.M.V.S.S./C.M.
V.S.S. certification label” on
the center pillar between the
driver’s side front and rear
doors.
Technical and consumer information 9-9
WHEN TRAVELING OR REGISTERING
YOUR VEHICLE IN ANOTHER
COUNTRY
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION
When planning to drive your NISSAN vehicle in another country, you should first find
out if the fuel available is suitable for your vehicle’s engine.
Using fuel with an octane rating that is too low
may cause engine damage. All gasoline vehicles
must be operated with unleaded gasoline. Therefore, avoid taking your vehicle to areas where
appropriate fuel is not available.
When transferring the registration of your
vehicle to another country, state, province
or district, it may be necessary to modify the
vehicle to meet local laws and regulations.
The laws and regulations for motor vehicle emission control and safety standards vary according
to the country, state, province or district; therefore, vehicle specifications may differ.
When any vehicle is to be taken into another country, state, province or district and
registered, its modifications, transportation and registration are the responsibility
of the user. NISSAN is not responsible for
any inconvenience that may result.
9-10 Technical and consumer information
LTI2107
LTI2108
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
(VIN) PLATE
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
(chassis number)
The vehicle identification number (VIN) plate is
attached as shown. This number is the identification for your vehicle and is used in the vehicle
registration.
The vehicle identification number is located as
shown.
LTI2034
ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER
The number is stamped on the engine as shown.
WTI0172
LTI2072
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.
CERTIFICATION LABEL
EMISSION CONTROL
INFORMATION LABEL
The Federal/Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety
Standard (F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.) certification label is affixed as shown. This label contains valuable vehicle information, such as: (GVWR),
(GAWR), month and year of manufacture, (VIN),
etc. Review it carefully.
The emission control information label is attached to the underside of the hood as shown.
Technical and consumer information 9-11
INSTALLING FRONT LICENSE PLATE
WTI0174
WTI0167
TIRE AND LOADING INFORMATION
LABEL
AIR CONDITIONER SPECIFICATION
LABEL
The cold tire pressure is shown on the Tire and
Loading Information Label. The label is located as
shown.
The air conditioner specification label is affixed to
the underside of the hood as shown.
9-12 Technical and consumer information
LTI2100
To mount the front license plate, attach the li1 to the plastic finisher at
cense plate bracket 䊊
the location marks (small dimples) using the two
6 mm screws provided.
VEHICLE LOADING INFORMATION
WARNING
● It is extremely dangerous to ride
in a cargo area inside a vehicle. In
a collision, people riding in these
areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed.
● Do not allow people to ride in any
area of your vehicle that is not
equipped with seats and seat
belts.
● Be sure everyone in your vehicle
is in a seat and using a seat belt
properly.
TERMS
It is important to familiarize yourself with
the following terms before loading your
vehicle:
● Curb Weight (actual weight of your
vehicle) - vehicle weight including:
standard and optional equipment, fluids, emergency tools, and spare tire
assembly. This weight does not include passengers and cargo.
● GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) - curb
weight plus the combined weight of
passengers and cargo.
● GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) - maximum total combined
weight of the unloaded vehicle, passengers, luggage, hitch, trailer
tongue load and any other optional
equipment. This information is located on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.
certification label.
● GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) maximum weight (load) limit specified
for the front or rear axle. This information
is
located
on
the
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification
label.
● Vehicle Capacity Weight, Load limit,
Total load capacity - maximum total
weight limit specified of the load
(passengers and cargo) for the vehicle. This is the maximum combined
weight of occupants and cargo that
can be loaded into the vehicle. If the
vehicle is used to tow a trailer, the
trailer tongue weight must be included as part of the cargo load. This
information is located on the Tire and
Loading Information label.
● Cargo capacity - permissible weight
of cargo, the subtracted weight of
occupants from the load limit.
● GCWR (Gross Combined Weight
rating) - The maximum total weight
rating of the vehicle, passengers,
cargo, and trailer.
Technical and consumer information 9-13
VEHICLE LOAD CAPACITY
Do not exceed the load limit of your vehicle shown as “The combined weight of
occupants and cargo” on the Tire and
Loading Information label. Do not exceed
the number of occupants shown as
“Seating Capacity” on the Tire and Loading Information label.
To get “the combined weight of occupants and cargo”, add the weight of all
occupants, then add the total luggage
weight. Examples are shown in the following illustration.
LTI0152
Example
9-14 Technical and consumer information
Steps for determining correct load
limit
1. Locate the statement “The combined
weight of occupants and cargo
should never exceed XXX lbs or XXX
kg” on your vehicle’s placard.
2. Determine the combined weight of
the driver and passengers that will be
riding in your vehicle.
3. Subtract the combined weight of the
driver and passengers from XXX lbs
or XXX kg.
4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage
load capacity. For example, if the
XXX amount equals 1,400 lbs. and
there will be five 150 lb. passengers
in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs. (1,400-750 (5 X 150)
= 650 lbs) or (640-340 (5 X 70) =
300 kg.)
5. Determine the combined weight of
luggage and cargo being loaded on
the vehicle. That weight may not
safely exceed the available cargo and
luggage load capacity calculated in
step 4.
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer,
load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this
manual to determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.
Before driving a loaded vehicle, confirm
that you do not exceed the Gross Vehicle
Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle
Weight Rating (GAWR) for your vehicle.
For additional information, refer to “Measurement of weights” in this section.
Also check tires for proper inflation pressures. For additional information, refer to
the “Tire and loading information label” in
this section.
LTI2113
Cargo area luggage hooks
SECURING THE LOAD
There are luggage hooks located in the cargo
area as shown. The hooks can be used to secure
cargo with ropes or other types of straps.
Do not apply a total load of more than
6.5 lbs. (29 N) to a single metal floor hook
when securing cargo.
Technical and consumer information 9-15
WARNING
● Properly secure all cargo with ropes or
straps to help prevent it from sliding or
shifting. Do not place cargo higher than
the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause
personal injury.
● The child restraint top tether strap may
be damaged by contact with items in
the cargo area. Secure any items in the
cargo area. Your child could be seriously injured or killed in a collision if
the top tether strap is damaged.
● Do not load your vehicle any heavier
than the GVWR or the maximum front
and rear GAWRs. If you do, parts of your
vehicle can break, tire damage could
occur, or it can change the way your
vehicle handles. This could result in loss
of control and cause personal injury.
LOADING TIPS
● The GVW must not exceed GVWR
or GAWR as specified on the
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification
label.
9-16 Technical and consumer information
● Do not load the front and rear axle to
the GAWR. Doing so will exceed the
GVWR.
WARNING
● Properly secure all cargo with
ropes or straps to help prevent it
from sliding or shifting. Do not
place cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could
cause personal injury.
● Do not load your vehicle any
heavier than the GVWR or the
maximum front and rear GAWRs.
If you do, parts of your vehicle can
break, tire damage could occur,
or it can change the way your
vehicle handles. This could result
in loss of control and cause personal injury.
● Overloading not only can shorten
the life of your vehicle and the
tire, but can also cause unsafe
vehicle handling and longer braking distances. This may cause a
premature tire failure which
could result in a serious accident
and personal injury. Failures
caused by overloading are not
covered by the vehicle’s warranty.
MEASUREMENT OF WEIGHTS
Secure loose items to prevent weight
shifts that could affect the balance of your
vehicle. When the vehicle is loaded, drive
to a scale and weigh the front and the rear
wheels separately to determine axle
loads. Individual axle loads should not exceed either of the gross axle weight ratings (GAWR). The total of the axle loads
should not exceed the gross vehicle
weight rating (GVWR). These ratings are
given on the vehicle certification label. If
weight ratings are exceeded, move or remove items to bring all weights below the
ratings.
TOWING A TRAILER
WARNING
Overloading or improper loading of a
trailer and its cargo can adversely affect
vehicle handling, braking and performance and may lead to accidents.
CAUTION
● Do not tow a trailer or haul a heavy load
for the first 500 miles (805 km). Your
engine, axle or other parts could be
damaged.
● For the first 500 miles (805 km) that you
tow a trailer, do not drive over 50 mph
(80 km/h) and do not make starts at full
throttle. This helps the engine and other
parts of your vehicle wear in at the
heavier loads.
Your new vehicle was designed to be used primarily to carry passengers and cargo. Remember
that towing a trailer places additional loads on
your vehicle’s engine, drive train, steering, braking and other systems.
A NISSAN Towing Guide (U.S. only) is available
on the website at www.nissanusa.com. This
guide includes information on trailer towing capability and the special equipment required for
proper towing.
MAXIMUM LOAD LIMITS
Maximum trailer loads
Never allow the total trailer load to exceed the
value
specified
in
the
“Towing
Load/Specification” chart found in this section.
The total trailer load equals trailer weight plus its
cargo weight.
The maximum Gross Combined Weight Rating
(GCWR) should not exceed the value specified
in the following Towing Load/Specification Chart.
LTI2105
The Gross Combined Weight Rating (GCWR)
equals the combined weight of the towing vehicle
(including passengers and cargo) plus the total
trailer load. Towing loads greater than these or
using improper towing equipment could adversely affect vehicle handling, braking and performance.
The ability of your vehicle to tow a trailer is not
only related to the maximum trailer loads, but also
the places you plan to tow. Tow weights appropriate for level highway driving may have to be
reduced for low traction situations (for example,
on slippery boat ramps).
Technical and consumer information 9-17
Temperature conditions can also affect towing.
For example, towing a heavy trailer in high outside
temperatures on graded roads can affect engine
performance and cause overheating. The engine
protection mode, which helps reduce the chance
of engine damage, could activate and automatically decrease engine power. Vehicle speed may
decrease under high load. Plan your trip carefully
to account for trailer and vehicle load, weather
and road conditions.
WARNING
Overheating can result in reduced engine
power and vehicle speed. The reduced
speed may be lower than other traffic,
which could increase the chance of a collision. Be especially careful when driving.
If the vehicle cannot maintain a safe driving speed, pull to the side of the road in a
safe area. Allow the engine to cool and
return to normal operation. For additional
information, refer to “If your vehicle overheats” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual.
CAUTION
Vehicle damage resulting from improper
towing procedures is not covered by
NISSAN warranties.
9-18 Technical and consumer information
WTI0160
Tongue load
When using a weight carrying or a weight distributing hitch, keep the tongue load between 10 15% of the total trailer load or use the trailer
tongue load specified by the trailer manufacturer.
The tongue load must be within the maximum
tongue load limits shown in the following “Towing
Load/Specification” chart. If the tongue load becomes excessive, rearrange cargo to allow for
proper tongue load.
LTI2106
Maximum Gross Vehicle Weight
(GVW)/maximum Gross Axle Weight
(GAW)
The GVW of the towing vehicle must not exceed
the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification
label. The GVW equals the combined weight of
the unloaded vehicle, passengers, luggage,
hitch, trailer tongue load and any other optional
equipment. In addition, front or rear GAW must
not exceed the Gross Axle Weight Rating
(GAWR) shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.
certification label.
Towing capacities are calculated assuming a
base vehicle with driver and any options required
to achieve the rating. Additional passengers,
cargo and/or optional equipment, such as the
trailer hitch, will add weight to the vehicle and
reduce your vehicle’s maximum towing capacity
and trailer tongue load.
The vehicle and trailer need to be weighed to
confirm the vehicle is within the GVWR, Front
GAWR, Rear GAWR, Gross Combined Weight
Rating (GCWR) and Towing capacity.
All vehicle and trailer weights can be measured
using platform type scales commonly found at
truck stops, highway weigh stations, building
supply centers or salvage yards.
To determine the available payload capacity for
tongue/king pin load, use the following procedure.
1. Locate
the
GVWR
on
the
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label.
2. Weigh your vehicle on the scale with all of
the passengers and cargo that are normally
in the vehicle when towing a trailer.
3. Subtract the actual vehicle weight from the
GVWR. The remaining amount is the available maximum tongue/king pin load.
To determine the available towing capacity, use
the following procedure.
1. Find the GCWR for your vehicle on the
⬙Towing Load/Specification⬙ chart found in
this section.
2. Subtract the actual vehicle weight from the
GCWR. The remaining amount is the available maximum towing capacity.
To determine the Gross Trailer Weight, weigh
your trailer on a scale with all equipment and
cargo, that are normally in the trailer when it is
towed. Make sure the Gross trailer weight is not
more than the Gross Trailer Weight Rating shown
on the trailer and is not more than the calculated
available maximum towing capacity.
Also weigh the front and rear axles on the scale to
make sure the Front Gross Axle Weight and Rear
Gross Axle Weight are not more than Front
Gross Axle Weight and Rear Gross Axle Weight
on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label.
The cargo in the trailer and vehicle may need to
be moved or removed to meet the specified ratings.
Example:
● Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) as weighed
on a scale - including passengers, cargo and
hitch - 6,350 lb. (2,880 kg).
● Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) from
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label 7,250 lb. (3,289 kg).
● Gross Combined Weight Rating (GCWR)
from “Towing Load/Specification⬙ chart 15,100 lb. (6,849 kg).
● Maximum Trailer towing capacity from “Towing Load/Specification⬙ chart - 9,100 lb.
(4,128 kg).
7,250 lb. (3,289 kg)
– 6,350 lb. (2,880 kg)
= 900 lb. (409 kg)
GVWR
GVW
Available for tongue
weight
15,100 lb. (6,849 kg)
GCWR
– 6,350 lb. (2,880 kg)
GVW
= 9,123 lb. (4,138 kg)
Capacity available for
towing
900 lb. (409 kg) Available tongue weight
/ 8,750 lb. (3,969 kg)
=
Available capacity
10 % tongue weight
Technical and consumer information 9-19
The available towing capacity may be less than
the maximum towing capacity due to the passenger and cargo load in the vehicle.
Remember to keep trailer tongue weight between 10 - 15% of the trailer weight or within the
trailer tongue load specification recommended
by the trailer manufacturer. If the tongue load
becomes excessive, rearrange the cargo to obtain the proper tongue load. Do not exceed the
maximum tongue weight specification shown in
the “Towing load/specification” chart even if the
calculated available tongue weight is greater
than 15%. If the calculated tongue weight is less
than 10%, reduce the total trailer weight to match
the available tongue weight.
Always verify that available capacities are within
the required ratings.
Trailer frontal area
CAUTION
Exceeding the maximum trailer frontal
area specification may exceed the towing
capacity of the vehicle. This may affect the
towing performance and lead to vehicle
damage.
9-20 Technical and consumer information
The trailer frontal area affects the towing load of a
trailer. The frontal area is the total area of the
vehicle and trailer that is affected by air resistance while towing. Do not exceed the maximum
trailer frontal area specification shown in the
⬙Towing Load/Specification” chart. The frontal
area can be determined by multiplying the width
of the trailer by the height of the trailer. For
example, a trailer that is 8 feet wide by 6 feet tall
has a trailer frontal area of 48 square feet.
TOWING LOAD/SPECIFICATION
TOWING LOAD/SPECIFICATION CHART
U.S. and Canada
Maximum Towing Capacity*1
1,500 lb.
(680 kg)
Maximum Tongue Load
150 lb.
(68 kg)
Maximum Gross Combined
6,393 lb.
Weight Rating
(2,900 kg)
*1: The towing capacity values are calculated assuming
a base vehicle with driver and any options required to
achieve the rating. Additional passengers, cargo and/or
optional equipment will add weight to the vehicle and
reduce your vehicle’s maximum towing capacity.
TOWING SAFETY
Trailer hitch
Your vehicle may be equipped with an optional
trailer tow package. The trailer tow package includes a receiver-type frame mounted hitch. This
hitch is rated for the maximum towing capacity of
this vehicle when the proper towing equipment is
used. Choose a proper ball mount and hitch ball
that is rated for the trailer to be towed. Genuine
NISSAN ball mounts and hitch balls are available
from a NISSAN dealer.
If your vehicle is not equipped with the optional
trailer tow package, check the towing capacity of
your bumper hitch or receiver-type frame
mounted hitch. Choose a proper hitch for your
vehicle and trailer. A Genuine NISSAN trailer
hitch is available from a NISSAN dealer. Make
sure the trailer hitch is securely attached to the
vehicle to help avoid personal injury or property
damage due to sway caused by crosswinds,
rough road surfaces or passing trucks.
WARNING
Trailer hitch components have specific
weight ratings. Your vehicle may be capable of towing a trailer heavier than the
weight rating of the hitch components.
Never exceed the weight rating of the
hitch components. Doing so can cause
serious personal injury or property
damage.
Hitch ball
Choose a hitch ball of the proper size and weight
rating for your trailer:
● The required hitch ball size is stamped on
most trailer couplers. Most hitch balls also
have the size printed on the top of the ball.
● Choose the proper class hitch ball based on
the trailer weight.
● The diameter of the threaded shank of the
hitch ball must be matched to the ball mount
hole diameter. The hitch ball shank should
be no more than 1/16” smaller than the hole
in the ball mount.
● The threaded shank of the hitch ball must be
long enough to be properly secured to the
ball mount. There should be at least 2
threads showing beyond the lock washer
and nut.
Ball mount
The hitch ball is attached to the ball mount and
the ball mount is inserted into the hitch receiver.
Choose a proper class ball mount based on the
trailer weight. Additionally, the ball mount should
be chosen to keep the trailer tongue level with the
ground.
Weight carrying hitches
A weight carrying or “dead weight” ball mount is
one that is designed to carry the whole amount of
tongue weight and gross weight directly on the
ball mount and on the receiver.
Weight distribution hitch
This type of hitch is also called a “load-leveling” or
“equalizing” hitch. A set of bars attach to the ball
mount and to the trailer to distribute the tongue
weight (hitch weight) of your trailer. Many vehicles can’t carry the full tongue weight of a given
trailer, and need some of the tongue weight
transferred through the frame and pushing down
on the front wheels. This gives stability to the tow
vehicle.
A weight-distributing hitch system (Class IV) is
recommended if you plan to tow trailers with a
maximum weight over 5,000 lbs (2,268 kg).
Check with the trailer and towing equipment
manufacturers to determine if they recommend
the use of a weight-distributing hitch system.
NOTE:
A weight-distributing hitch system may affect the operation of trailer surge brakes. If
you are considering use of a weightdistributing hitch system with a surge
brake-equipped trailer, check with the
surge brake, hitch or trailer manufacturer
to determine if and how this can be done.
Follow the instructions provided by the manufacturer for installing and using the weightdistributing hitch system.
General set-up instructions are as follows:
1. Park unloaded vehicle on a level surface.
With the ignition on and the doors closed,
allow the vehicle to stand for several minutes
so that it can level.
2. Measure the height of a reference point on
the front and rear bumpers at the center of
the vehicle.
Technical and consumer information 9-21
3. Attach the trailer to the vehicle and adjust
the hitch equalizers so that the front bumper
height is within 0 - .5 inches (0 – 13 mm) of
the reference height measured in step 2. The
rear bumper should be no higher than the
reference height measured in step 2.
WARNING
Properly adjust the weight distributing
hitch so the rear of the bumper is no
higher than the measured reference
height when the trailer is attached. If the
rear bumper is higher than the measured
reference height when loaded, the vehicle
may handle unpredictably which could
cause a loss of vehicle control and cause
serious personal injury or property
damage.
Sway control device
Sudden maneuvers, wind gusts, and buffeting
caused by other vehicles can affect trailer handling. Sway control devices may be used to help
control these affects. If you choose to use one,
contact a reputable trailer hitch supplier to make
sure the sway control device will work with the
vehicle, hitch, trailer and the trailer’s brake system. Follow the instructions provided by the
manufacturer for installing and using the sway
control device.
9-22 Technical and consumer information
Class I hitch
Class I trailer hitch equipment (receiver, ball
mount and hitch ball) can be used to tow trailers
of a maximum weight of 2,000 lb (907 kg).
Tire pressures
● When towing a trailer, inflate the vehicle tires to the recommended cold
tire pressure indicated on the Tire
and Loading Information label.
● Trailer tire condition, size, load rating
and proper inflation pressure should
be in accordance with the trailer and
tire manufacturer’s specifications.
Safety chains
Always use suitable safety chains between your
vehicle and the trailer. The safety chains should
be crossed and should be attached to the hitch,
not to the vehicle bumper or axle. The safety
chains can be attached to the bumper if the hitch
ball is mounted to the bumper. Be sure to leave
enough slack in the chains to permit turning
corners.
Trailer lights
CAUTION
When splicing into the vehicle electrical
system, a commercially available powertype module/converter must be used to
provide power for all trailer lighting. This
unit uses the vehicle battery as a direct
power source for all trailer lights while
using the vehicle tail light, stoplight and
turn signal circuits as a signal source. The
module/converter must draw no more that
15 milliamps from the stop and tail lamp
circuits. Using a module/converter that
exceeds these power requirements may
damage the vehicle’s electrical system.
See a reputable trailer retailer to obtain
the proper equipment and to have it
installed.
Trailer lights should comply with federal and/or
local regulations. For assistance in hooking up
trailer lights, contact a NISSAN dealer or reputable
trailer retailer. Vehicles equipped with the optional
trailer tow package are equipped with a flat 4-pin
connector, an adapter will be needed to connect
the trailer lights to the vehicle. Adapters are available at auto parts stores and hitch retailers.
Pre-towing tips
● Be certain your vehicle maintains a level
position when a loaded and/or unloaded
trailer is hitched. Do not drive the vehicle if it
has an abnormal nose-up or nose-down
condition; check for improper tongue load,
overload, worn suspension or other possible
causes of either condition.
● Always secure items in the trailer to prevent
load shift while driving.
● Keep the cargo load as low as possible in
the trailer to keep the trailer center of gravity
low.
● Load the trailer so approximately 60% of the
trailer load is in the front half and 40% is in
the back half. Also make sure the load is
balanced side to side.
● Check your hitch, trailer tire pressure, vehicle tire pressure, trailer light operation, and
trailer wheel lug nuts every time you attach a
trailer to the vehicle.
● Be certain your rearview mirrors conform to
all federal, state or local regulations. If not,
install any mirrors required for towing before
driving the vehicle.
● Determine the overall height of the vehicle
and trailer so the required clearance is
known.
Always block the wheels on both vehicle and
trailer when parking. Parking on a slope is not
recommended; however, if you must do so:
Trailer towing tips
CAUTION
In order to gain skill and an understanding of the
vehicle’s behavior, you should practice turning,
stopping and backing up in an area which is free
from traffic. Steering stability and braking performance will be somewhat different than under
normal driving conditions.
If you move the shift lever to the P (Park)
position before blocking the wheels and
applying the parking brake, transmission
damage could occur.
● Always secure items in the trailer to prevent
load shift while driving.
2. Have someone place blocks on the downhill
side of the vehicle and trailer wheels.
● Lock the trailer hitch coupler with a pin or
lock to prevent the coupler from inadvertently becoming unlatched.
3. After the wheel blocks are in place, slowly
release the brake pedal until the blocks absorb the vehicle load.
● Avoid abrupt starts, acceleration or stops.
4. Apply the parking brake.
● Avoid sharp turns or lane changes.
5. Shift the transmission into P (Park).
● Always drive your vehicle at a moderate
speed.
6. Turn off the engine.
● When backing up, hold the bottom of the
steering wheel with one hand. Move your
hand in the direction in which you want the
trailer to go. Make small corrections and
back up slowly. If possible, have someone
guide you when you are backing up.
1. Apply and hold the brake pedal.
To drive away:
1. Start the vehicle.
2. Apply and hold the brake pedal.
3. Shift the transmission into gear.
4. Release the parking brake.
Technical and consumer information 9-23
5. Drive slowly until the vehicle and trailer are
clear from the blocks.
6. Apply and hold the brake pedal.
7. Have someone retrieve and store the blocks.
● While going downhill, the weight of the
trailer pushing on the tow vehicle may decrease overall stability. Therefore, to maintain adequate control, reduce your speed
and shift to a lower gear. Avoid long or
repeated use of the brakes when descending a hill, as this reduces their effectiveness
and could cause overheating. Shifting to a
lower gear instead provides “engine braking” and reduces the need to brake as frequently.
● If the engine coolant temperature rises to a
high temperature, refer to “If your vehicle
overheats” in the “In case of emergency”
section of this owner’s manual.
● Have your vehicle serviced more often than
at intervals specified in the recommended
Maintenance Schedule in the “NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide”.
● When making a turn, your trailer wheels will
be closer to the inside of the turn than your
vehicle wheels. To compensate for this,
make a larger than normal turning radius
during the turn.
● Crosswinds and rough roads will adversely
affect vehicle/trailer handling, possibly causing vehicle sway. When being passed by
larger vehicles, be prepared for possible
changes in crosswinds that could affect vehicle handling.
Do the following if the trailer begins to sway:
3. Try to rearrange the trailer load so it is balanced as described in this section.
● Be careful when passing other vehicles.
Passing while towing a trailer requires considerably more distance than normal passing. Remember, the length of the trailer must
also pass the other vehicle before you can
safely change lanes.
● Downshift the transmission to a lower gear
for engine braking when driving down steep
or long hills. This will help slow the vehicle
without applying the brakes.
● Avoid holding the brake pedal down too long
or too frequently. This could cause the
brakes to overheat, resulting in reduced
braking efficiency.
1. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal to
allow the vehicle to coast and steer as
straight ahead as the road conditions allow.
This combination will help stabilize the vehicle
● Increase your following distance to allow for
greater stopping distances while towing a
trailer. Anticipate stops and brake gradually.
● Avoid towing a trailer for your vehicle’s first
500 miles (805 km).
– Do not correct trailer sway by steering or
applying the brakes.
● For the first 500 miles (805 km) that you do
tow, do not drive over 50 MPH (80 km/h).
2. When the trailer sway stops, gently apply the
brakes and pull to the side of the road in a
safe area.
● Some states or provinces have specific
regulations and speed limits for vehicles that
are towing trailers. Obey the local speed
limits.
● Trailer towing requires more fuel than normal
circumstances.
9-24 Technical and consumer information
● NISSAN recommends that the cruise control not be used while towing a trailer.
● Check your hitch, trailer wiring harness connections, and trailer wheel lug nuts after
50 miles (80 km) of travel and at every break.
● When launching a boat, don’t allow the water level to go over the exhaust tail pipe or
rear bumper.
● Make sure you disconnect the trailer lights
before backing the trailer into the water or
the trailer lights may burn out.
When towing a trailer, final drive gear oil
should be replaced and transmission
oil/fluid should be changed more frequently. For additional information, refer to
the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual.
FLAT TOWING FOR ALL–WHEEL
DRIVE VEHICLE (if so equipped)
Towing your vehicle with all four wheels on the
ground is sometimes called flat towing. This
method is sometimes used when towing a vehicle
behind a recreational vehicle, such as a motor
home.
CAUTION
CAUTION
● Failure to follow these guidelines can
result in severe transmission damage.
● Failure to follow these guidelines can
result in severe transmission damage.
● Never flat tow your All-wheel drive
(AWD) vehicle.
● Whenever flat towing your vehicle, always tow forward, never backward.
● DO NOT tow your All-wheel drive (AWD)
vehicle with any wheels on the ground.
Doing so may cause serious and expensive damage to the powertrain.
● Never tow your front wheel drive vehicle
with the front tires on the ground. Doing
so may cause serious and expensive
damage to the powertrain.
● For emergency towing procedures refer
to “Towing recommended by NISSAN”
in the “In case of emergency” section of
this manual.
● DO NOT tow your front wheel drive continuously variable transmission vehicle
with all four wheels on the ground (flat
towing). Doing so WILL DAMAGE internal transmission parts due to lack of
transmission lubrication.
FLAT TOWING FOR FRONT WHEEL
DRIVE VEHICLE (if so equipped)
Towing your vehicle with all four wheels on the
ground is sometimes called flat towing. This
method is sometimes used when towing a vehicle
behind a recreational vehicle, such as a motor
home.
● For emergency towing procedures refer
to “Towing recommended by NISSAN”
in the “In case of emergency” section of
this manual.
Continuously Variable Transmission
To tow a vehicle equipped with a continuously
variable transmission, an appropriate vehicle dolly
MUST be placed under the towed vehicle’s drive
wheels. Always follow the dolly manufacturer’s
recommendations when using their product.
Technical and consumer information 9-25
UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADING
DOT (Department of Transportation) Quality
Grades: All passenger car tires must conform to
federal safety requirements in addition to these
grades.
Quality grades can be found where applicable on
the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and
maximum section width. For example:
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A
Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating
based on the wear rate of the tire when tested
under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire graded
150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times
as well on the government course as a tire graded
100. The relative performance of tires depends
upon the actual conditions of their use, however,
and may depart significantly from the norm due to
variations in driving habits, service practices and
differences in road characteristics and climate.
Traction AA, A, B and C
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are
AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent the
tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified
government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction
performance.
9-26 Technical and consumer information
WARNING
The traction grade assigned to this tire is
based on straight-ahead braking traction
tests, and does not include acceleration,
cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction
characteristics.
Temperature A, B and C
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B,
and C, representing the tire’s resistance to the
generation of heat, and its ability to dissipate heat
when tested under controlled conditions on a
specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained
high temperature can cause the material of the
tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure.
The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet
under the Federal Motor Safety Standard No.
109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of
performance on the laboratory test wheel than
the minimum required by law.
WARNING
The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated
and not overloaded. Excessive speed,
under-inflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can
cause heat build-up and possible tire
failure.
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
WARRANTY
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
Your NISSAN vehicle is covered by the following
emission warranties:
For USA
For USA
1. Emission Defects Warranty
2. Emissions Performance Warranty
Details of this warranty may be found with other
vehicle warranties in your Warranty Information
Booklet which comes with your NISSAN vehicle.
If you did not receive a Warranty Information
Booklet, or it is lost, you may obtain a replacement by writing to:
● Nissan North America, Inc.
Consumer Affairs Department
P.O. Box 685003
Franklin, TN 37068-5003
For Canada
Emission Control System Warranty
Details of this warranty may be found with other
vehicle warranties in your Warranty Information
Booklet which comes with your NISSAN vehicle.
If you did not receive a Warranty Information
Booklet, or it is lost, you may obtain a replacement by writing to:
● Nissan Canada Inc.
5290 Orbitor Drive
Mississauga, Ontario, L4W 4Z5
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could
cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic
Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying NISSAN.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it
may open an investigation, and if it finds
that a safety defect exists in a group of
vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy
campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or NISSAN.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go
to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:
Administrator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh
Street, SW., Washington, D.C. 20590.
You can also obtain other information
about motor vehicle safety from
http://www.safercar.gov.
You may notify NISSAN by contacting our
Consumer Affairs Department, toll-free, at
1-800-NISSAN-1.
For Canada
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could
cause injury or death, you should immediately inform Transport Canada in addition
to notifying NISSAN.
If Transport Canada receives complaints,
it may open an investigation, and if it finds
that a safety defect exists in a group of
vehicles, it may request that NISSAN conduct a recall campaign. However, Transport Canada cannot become involved in
individual problems between you, your
dealer, or NISSAN.
You may contact Transport Canada’s Defect Investigations and Recalls Division
toll free at 1-800-333-0510. You may
also report safety defects online at:
https://wwwapps.tc.gc.ca/Saf-Sec-Sur/
7/PCDB-BDPP/fc-cp.aspx?lang=eng
(English speakers) or
Technical and consumer information 9-27
READINESS FOR INSPECTION/
MAINTENANCE (I/M) TEST
https://wwwapps.tc.gc.ca/Saf-Sec-Sur/
7/PCDB-BDPP/fc-cp.aspx?lang=fra
(French speakers)
Additional information concerning motor
vehicle safety may be obtained from Transport Canada’s Road Safety Information
Centre at 1-800-333-0371 or online at
www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety (English speakers) or www.tc.gc.ca/securiteroutiere
(French speakers).
To notify NISSAN of any safety concerns
please contact our Consumer Information
Centre toll free at 1-800-387-0122.
WARNING
A vehicle equipped with All -Wheel Drive
(AWD) should never be tested using a two
wheel dynamometer (such as the dynamometers used by some states for emissions testing), or similar equipment. Make
sure you inform the test facility personnel
that your vehicle is equipped with AWD
before it is placed on a dynamometer.
Using the wrong test equipment may result in drivetrain damage or unexpected
vehicle movement which could result in
serious vehicle damage or personal injury.
Due to legal requirements in some states and
Canadian Provinces, your vehicle may be required to be in what is called the “ready condition” for an Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) test of
the emission control system.
The vehicle is set to the “ready condition” when it
is driven through certain driving patterns. Usually,
the ready condition can be obtained by ordinary
usage of the vehicle.
9-28 Technical and consumer information
If a powertrain system component is repaired or
the battery is disconnected, the vehicle may be
reset to a “not ready” condition. Before taking the
I/M
test,
check
the
vehicle’s
inspection/maintenance test readiness condition. Place the ignition switch in the ON position
without starting the engine. If the Malfunction
Indicator Light (MIL) comes on steady for 20 seconds and then blinks for 10 seconds , the I/M test
condition is “not ready”. If the MIL does not blink
after 20 seconds, the I/M test condition is
“ready”. Contact a NISSAN dealer to set the
“ready condition” or to prepare the vehicle for
testing.
EVENT DATA RECORDERS (EDR)
This vehicle is equipped with an Event Data Recorder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to
record, in certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a
road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicle’s systems performed. The EDR
is designed to record data related to vehicle
dynamics and safety systems for a short period of
time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this
vehicle is designed to record such data as:
● How various systems in your vehicle were
operating;
● Whether or not the driver and passenger
safety belts were buckled/fastened;
● How far (if at all) the driver was depressing
the accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,
● How fast the vehicle was traveling.
● Sounds are not recorded.
These data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which crashes and
injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data are recorded by
your vehicle only if a nontrivial crash situation
occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under
normal driving conditions and no personal data
(e.g. name, gender, age and crash location) are
recorded. However, other parties, such as law
enforcement, could combine the EDR data with
OWNER’S MANUAL/SERVICE
MANUAL ORDER INFORMATION
the type of personally identifying data routinely
acquired during a crash investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required and access to the vehicle or the
EDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer and NISSAN dealer, other parties, such
as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, can read the information if they have access to the vehicle or the EDR. EDR data will only
be accessed with the consent of the vehicle
owner or lessee or as otherwise required or permitted by law.
Genuine NISSAN Service Manuals for this model
year and prior can be purchased. A Genuine
NISSAN Service Manual is the best source of
service and repair information for your vehicle.
This manual is the same one used by the factorytrained technicians working at NISSAN dealerships. Genuine NISSAN Owner’s Manuals can
also be purchased.
For USA
For current pricing and availability of Genuine
NISSAN Service Manuals, contact:
www.nissan-techinfo.com
For current pricing and availability of Genuine
NISSAN Owner’s Manuals, contact:
1-800-247-5321
For Canada
To purchase a copy of a Genuine NISSAN Service Manual or Owner’s Manual, for this model
year and prior, please contact your nearest
NISSAN dealer. For the phone number and location of a NISSAN dealer in your area, call the
NISSAN Information Center at 1-800-387-0122
and a bilingual NISSAN representative will assist
you.
Technical and consumer information 9-29
MEMO
9-30 Technical and consumer information
10 Index
A
Air bag (See supplemental restraint
system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-46
Air bag system
Front (See supplemental front impact air bag
system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-54
Air bag warning labels . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-65
Air bag warning light. . . . . . . . . . .1-66, 2-11
Air bag warning light, supplemental . .1-66, 2-11
Air cleaner housing filter . . . . . . . . . . . .8-18
Air conditioner
Air conditioner service . . . . . . . . . . .4-29
Air conditioner specification label . . . . .9-12
Air conditioner system refrigerant and
oil recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-7
Heater and air conditioner (automatic)
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-26
Heater and air conditioner controls . . . .4-27
Servicing air conditioner . . . . . . . . . .4-29
Alarm system
(See vehicle security system) . . . . . . . . .2-25
Anchor point locations . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-30
Anti-lock brake warning light . . . . . . . .2-7, 2-8
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS). . . . . . . .5-69
Armrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-7
Around View® Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-12
Audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-14
Audio system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-29
AM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-30
Bluetooth® audio. . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-46
Bluetooth® streaming audio . . . . . . . .4-46
Compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . . .4-41
FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD)
player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-38
FM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-30
iPod® Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-44
iPod® player operation. . . . . . . . . . .4-44
Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-29
USB interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-42
USB (Universal Serial Bus) Connection
Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-42
Autolight switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-31
Automatic
Automatic drive positioner . .3-35, 3-36, 3-37
Automatic power window switch . . . . .2-47
Automatic door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6
Automatic drive positioner . . . .3-35, 3-36, 3-37
B
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-73, 8-15
Charge warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8
Battery replacement
Key fob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-25
NISSAN Intelligent Key®. . . . . . . . . .8-26
Before starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . .5-14
Belt (See drive belt) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-17
Blind Spot Warning (BSW) warning
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-21
Block heater
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-74
Bluetooth® audio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-46
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System without
Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-51
Booster seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-43
Brake
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS). . . . . .5-69
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-14
Brake light (See stop light). . . . . . . . .8-28
Brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-68
Brake warning light. . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8
Brake wear indicators . . . . . . . .2-14, 8-21
Parking brake operation . . . . . . . . . .5-20
Self-adjusting brakes . . . . . . . . . . . .8-21
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-14
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-21
Brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-68
Break-in schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-62
Brightness control
Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33
Bulb check/instrument panel . . . . . . . . . .2-7
Bulb replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-28
C
Capacities and recommended
fuel/lubricants. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cargo (See vehicle loading information)
Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . .
CD care and cleaning . . . . . . . . . .
CD player (See audio system) . . . . . .
Check tire pressure. . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .9-2
.9-13
.4-50
.4-47
.4-41
.2-23
Child restraints . . . . . . .1-23, 1-24, 1-25, 1-27
LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for
CHildren) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-27
Precautions on child
restraints. . . . . . . . .1-25, 1-32, 1-39, 1-43
Top tether strap anchor point locations . .1-30
Child restraint with top tether strap. . . . . . .1-29
Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . . . .3-7
Chimes, audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . .2-14
Cleaning exterior and interior . . . . . . . .7-2, 7-4
Clock setting
(models without Navigation System) . . . . . .4-39
C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . . . .9-11
Cold weather driving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-73
Compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . . . . .4-41
Connect phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-50
Console box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-43
Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT). . .5-15
Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT)
fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-13
Driving with Continuously Variable
Transmission (CVT) . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-15
Controls
Heater and air conditioner controls. . . . .4-27
Coolant
Capacities and recommended
fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2
Changing engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . .8-8
Checking engine coolant level . . . . . . . .8-8
Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-5
Corrosion protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-5
Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-33
Cup holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-41
10-2
D
Daytime running light system (Canada only) . .2-32
Defroster switch
Rear window and outside mirror defroster
switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-30
Dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-9
Dimmer switch for instrument panel . . . . . .2-33
Door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4
Drive belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-17
Drive positioner, Automatic . . . .3-35, 3-36, 3-37
Driving
Cold weather driving. . . . . . . . . . . . .5-73
Driving with Continuously Variable
Transmission (CVT) . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-15
Precautions when starting and
driving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2, 5-8
Driving the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-15
E
Economy - fuel . . . . . . . . . . .
Emission control information label
Emission control system warranty
Engine
Before starting the engine. . .
Block heater . . . . . . . . . .
Capacities and recommended
fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . .
Changing engine coolant . . .
Changing engine oil . . . . . .
Changing engine oil filter . . .
Checking engine coolant level
Checking engine oil level . . .
. . . . . . .5-64
. . . . . . .9-11
. . . . . . .9-27
. . . . . . .5-14
. . . . . . .5-74
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .9-2
. .8-8
.8-10
.8-12
. .8-8
. .8-9
Engine compartment check locations . . . .8-6
Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-5
Engine cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7
Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-9
Engine oil and oil filter recommendation . . .9-6
Engine oil pressure warning light . . . .2-8, 2-9
Engine oil viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-6
Engine serial number . . . . . . . . . . . .9-11
Engine specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-8
Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14
Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . . . .2-5
Event data recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-29
Exhaust gas (Carbon monoxide) . . . . . . . . .5-2
Explanation of maintenance items . . . . . . . .8-2
Extended storage switch . . . . . . . . . . . .8-24
Eyeglass case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-41
F
Flashers (See hazard warning flasher switch) . .6-2
Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3
Floor mat positioning aid . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-5
Fluid
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-14
Capacities and recommended
fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2
Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT)
fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-13
Engine coolant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7
Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-9
Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-13
Windshield-washer fluid. . . . . . . . . . .8-14
F.M.V.S.S. certification label. . . . . . . . . . .9-11
Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-34
Front air bag system
(See supplemental restraint system) . . . . . .1-54
Front power seat adjustment . . . . . . . . . . .1-4
Front seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2
Fuel
Capacities and recommended
fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2
Fuel economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-64
Fuel-filler door and cap . . . . . . . . . . .3-27
Fuel-filler door lock opener lever . . . . . .3-27
Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6
Fuel octane rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-5
Fuel recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-4
Loose fuel cap warning. . . . . . . .2-23, 3-27
Fuel Cell Vehicle (FCV) System
Tire pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-29
Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-22
Fusible links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-23
G
Garage door opener, HomeLink® Universal
Transceiver . . . . . .2-51, 2-53, 2-54, 2-54, 2-55
Gas cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-27
Gauge
Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-5
Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5
Trip odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-2
Glove box. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-43
H
Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . . . . .6-2
Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . . . . .2-30
Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . . . . .2-30
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-27
Head restraints. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-10
Heated seats . . . . . . . . . . . .2-35, 2-36, 2-37
Heated steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-34
Heater
Heater and air conditioner (automatic)
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-26
Heater and air conditioner controls. . . . .4-27
Heater operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-28
Heater and air conditioner (automatic) . . . . .4-26
Hill start assist system . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-72
HomeLink® Universal
Transceiver . . . . . .2-51, 2-53, 2-54, 2-54, 2-55
Hood release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-22
Hook
Luggage hook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-44
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-34
I
Ignition Switch
Push-Button Ignition Switch . . . . . . . .5-10
Immobilizer system . . . . . . . . . . . .2-26, 5-14
Important vehicle information label . . . . . . .9-11
In-cabin microfilter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-19
Increasing fuel economy. . . . . . . . . . . . .5-64
Indicator
NISSAN Intelligent Key® battery discharge
indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-13
Indicator lights and audible reminders
(See warning/indicator lights and audible
reminders). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7, 2-12
Inside mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-32
Instrument brightness control . . . . . . . . . .2-33
Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .0-6, 2-2
Instrument panel dimmer switch . . . . . . . .2-33
Intelligent cruise control (ICC) system
Brake assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-34
Intelligent Key system
Key operating range . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-8
Key operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-9
Mechanical key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3
Remote keyless entry operation. . . . . . .3-12
Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . .3-17
Warning signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-17
Interior light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-50
iPod® Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-44
ISOFIX child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-27
J
Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-10, 8-17
K
Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Key fob battery replacement . .
Keyless entry
With Intelligent Key system
(See Intelligent Key system).
Keys
NISSAN Intelligent Key® . .
. . . . . . . . .3-2
. . . . . . . .8-25
. . . . . . . .3-12
. . . . . .3-2, 3-7
10-3
L
Labels
Air conditioner specification label . . . . .9-12
C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . .9-11
Emission control information label . . . . .9-11
Engine serial number . . . . . . . . . . . .9-11
F.M.V.S.S. certification label. . . . . . . . .9-11
Tire and Loading Information label . . . . .9-12
Vehicle identification number (VIN) . . . . .9-10
Vehicle identification number (VIN) plate. .9-10
Warning labels (for SRS) . . . . . . . . . .1-65
LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren)
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-27
License plate
Installing the license plate . . . . . . . . . .9-12
Lift gate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-22
Lift gate release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-26
Light
Air bag warning light . . . . . . . . .1-66, 2-11
Brake light (See stop light) . . . . . . . . .8-28
Bulb check/instrument panel . . . . . . . . .2-7
Bulb replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-28
Charge warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8
Exterior and Interior lights . . . . . . . . . .8-28
Fog lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-27
Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-34
Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . . .2-30
Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . . .2-30
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-27
Interior light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-50
Light bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-27
Low tire pressure warning light. . . . . . . .2-9
Low windshield-washer fluid warning
light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11, 2-23
10-4
Passenger air bag and status light . . . . .1-56
Personal lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-51
Security indicator light. . . . . . . . . . . .2-13
Spotlights (See map light) . . . . . . . . .2-51
Warning/indicator lights and audible
reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7, 2-12
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-27
Map lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-51
Lock
Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . .3-7
Door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4
Fuel-filler door lock opener lever . . . . . .3-27
Lift gate release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-26
Power door locks . . . . . . . . . . . .3-5, 3-6
Loose fuel cap warning. . . . . . . . . .2-23, 3-27
Low fuel warning light . . . . . . . . . .2-11, 2-23
Low tire pressure warning light. . . . . . . . . .2-9
Low windshield-washer fluid warning
light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11, 2-23
Luggage hook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-44
Luggage rack (see roof rack) . . . . . . . . . .2-44
Luggage (See vehicle loading information) . .9-13
M
Maintenance
General maintenance . . . .
Inside the vehicle . . . . . .
Maintenance precautions . .
Outside the vehicle . . . . .
Seat belt maintenance. . . .
Under the hood and vehicle
Maintenance requirements . . .
Malfunction indicator light . . . .
Manual front seat adjustment . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. .8-2
. .8-3
. .8-5
. .8-2
.1-23
. .8-4
. .8-2
.2-12
. .1-3
Map lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-51
Memory Seat . . . . . . . . . . . .3-35, 3-36, 3-37
Meters and gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-3
Instrument brightness control . . . . . . . .2-33
Mirror
Inside mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-32
Outside mirror control . . . . . . . .3-33, 3-34
Outside mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-34
Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-32
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-32
Moonroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-48
N
NISSAN Intelligent Key® . . . . . . . . . .3-2, 3-7
NISSAN Intelligent Key® battery discharge
indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-13
NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system . . .2-26, 5-14
O
Octane rating (See fuel octane rating). . . . . .9-5
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
Oil
Capacities and recommended
fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2
Changing engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-10
Changing engine oil filter . . . . . . . . . .8-12
Checking engine oil level . . . . . . . . . . .8-9
Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-9
Engine oil and oil filter recommendation . . .9-6
Engine oil viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-6
One shot call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-54, 4-54
Outside mirror control . . . . . . . . . .3-33, 3-34
Outside mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Overheat
If your vehicle overheats . . . . . . .
Owner’s manual order form . . . . . . .
Owner’s manual/service manual order
information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . .3-34
. . . .6-12
. . . .9-29
Precautions when starting and
driving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2, 5-8
Pre-tensioner seat belt system . . . . . . . . .1-64
Push starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-12
. . . .9-29
R
P
Parking
Parking brake operation . . . . . . . . . . .5-20
Parking/parking on hills . . . . . . . . . . .5-67
Personal lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-51
Power
Front seat adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-4
Power door locks . . . . . . . . . . . .3-5, 3-6
Power outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-39
Power rear windows . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-47
Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-13
Power steering system . . . . . . . . . . .5-68
Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . . .2-47
Power outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-39
Power steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-68
Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-13
Precautions
Maintenance precautions . . . . . . . . . . .8-5
On-pavement and off-road driving
precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6
Precautions on booster
seats . . . . . . . . . . .1-25, 1-32, 1-39, 1-43
Precautions on child
restraints. . . . . . . . .1-25, 1-32, 1-39, 1-43
Precautions on seat belt usage . . . . . . .1-13
Precautions on supplemental restraint
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-46
Radio
Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . . .4-50
FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD)
player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-38
Readiness for inspection maintenance (I/M)
test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-28
Rear center seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-19
Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-47
Rear seat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-6
RearView Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-2, 4-7
Rear window and outside mirror defroster
switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-30
Rear window wiper and washer switches . . .2-29
Recorders
Event data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-29
Refrigerant recommendation . . . . . . . . . . .9-7
Registering your vehicle in another country . .9-10
Remote Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-19, 5-15
Reporting safety defects (US only) . . . . . . .9-27
Roof rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-44
S
Safety
Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . .3-7
Child seat belts . . . . .1-25, 1-32, 1-39, 1-43
Reporting safety defects (US only) . . . . .9-27
Seat adjustment
Front manual seat adjustment . . . . . . . .1-3
Front power seat adjustment . . . . . . . . .1-4
Seatback pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-40
Seat belt
Child safety. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-23
Infants and small children . . . . . . . . . .1-24
Injured Person . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-16
Larger children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-24
Precautions on seat belt usage . . . . . . .1-13
Pregnant women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-16
Pre-tensioner seat belt system . . . . . . .1-64
Rear center seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . .1-19
Seat belt extenders . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-22
Seat belt maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . .1-23
Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-13, 7-5
Shoulder belt height adjustment . . . . . .1-22
Three-point type with retractor . . . . . . .1-16
Seat belt extenders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-22
Seat belt warning light . . . . . . . . . .1-16, 2-11
Seats
Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2
Armrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-7
Automatic drive positioner. . .3-35, 3-36, 3-37
Front seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2
Heated seats . . . . . . . . . .2-35, 2-36, 2-37
Manual front seat adjustment . . . . . . . . .1-3
Rear seat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-6
Security indicator light. . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-13
Security system (NISSAN vehicle immobilizer
system), engine start . . . . . . . . . . .2-26, 5-14
Security systems
Vehicle security system . . . . . . . . . . .2-25
Self-adjusting brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-21
Service manual order form . . . . . . . . . . .9-29
Servicing air conditioner. . . . . . . . . . . . .4-29
10-5
Shoulder belt height adjustment . . . . . . . .1-22
Spark plug replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-18
Spark plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-18
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-8
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
Spotlights (See map light) . . . . . . . . . . .2-51
SRS warning label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-65
Stability control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-70
Starting
Before starting the engine. . . . . . . . . .5-14
Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-10, 8-17
Precautions when starting and
driving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2, 5-8
Push starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-12
Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14
Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14
Steering
Heated steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . .2-34
Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-13
Power steering system . . . . . . . . . . .5-68
Stop light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-28
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-40
Sunglasses case. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-41
Sunglasses holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-41
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-48
Sunroof (see Moonroof) . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-48
Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-31
Supplemental air bag warning labels . . . . . .1-65
Supplemental air bag warning light . . .1-66, 2-11
Supplemental front impact air bag system . . .1-54
Supplemental restraint system
Information and warning labels . . . . . . .1-65
Precautions on supplemental restraint
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-46
Supplemental restraint system
(Supplemental air bag system) . . . . . . . . .1-46
10-6
Switch
Autolight switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-31
Automatic power window switch . . . . . .2-47
Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-34
Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . . .6-2
Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . . .2-30
Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . . .2-30
Instrument brightness control . . . . . . . .2-33
Power door lock switch . . . . . . . . .3-5, 3-6
Rear window and outside mirror defroster
switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-30
Rear window wiper and washer
switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29
Steering wheel switch for audio
control/Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-48
Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33
Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) off
switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-38
Wiper and washer switch . . . . . . . . . .2-27
T
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5
Temperature gauge
Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-5
Theft (NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system),
engine start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-26, 5-14
Three-way catalyst . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2
Tire
Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3
Spare tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-5, 8-39
Tire and Loading Information label . . . . .9-12
Tire chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-36
Tire pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-29
Tire rotation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-37
Types of tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-35
Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . . .9-26
Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-29
Wheel/tire size. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-9
Tire pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-29
Low tire pressure warning light. . . . . . . .2-9
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) . . . .5-3
Top tether strap child restraint . . . . . . . . .1-29
Towing
Flat towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-25
Towing load/specification . . . . . . . . . .9-20
Tow truck towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-13
Trailer towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-17
Towing a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-17
Transceiver
HomeLink® Universal
Transceiver . . . .2-51, 2-53, 2-54, 2-54, 2-55
Transmission
Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT)
fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-13
Driving with Continuously Variable
Transmission (CVT) . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-15
Travel (See registering your vehicle in another
country). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10
Trip odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33
U
Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . . . . .9-26
USB interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-42
Audio file operation . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-43
V
Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-32
Vehicle dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . .9-9
Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) off switch . . .2-38
Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) system. . . . .5-70
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system . . . .5-70
Vehicle identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10
Vehicle identification number (VIN) . . . . . . .9-10
Vehicle identification number (VIN)
(Chassis number) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10
Vehicle identification number (VIN) plate. . . .9-10
Vehicle immobilizer system . . . . . . . .2-26, 5-14
Vehicle loading information . . . . . . . . . . .9-13
Vehicle recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-15, 6-16
Vehicle security system . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-25
Vehicle security system (NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system), engine start . . . . . . . .2-26, 5-14
Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-25
Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-31
Voice Prompt Interrupt. . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-54
W
Warning
Air bag warning light . . . . . . . . .1-66, 2-11
Anti-lock brake warning light . . . . . .2-7, 2-8
Battery charge warning light . . . . . . . . .2-8
Blind Spot Warning (BSW) warning
light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-21
Brake warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8
Engine oil pressure warning light . . . .2-8, 2-9
Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . . .6-2
Loose fuel cap warning. . . . . . . .2-23, 3-27
Low fuel warning light . . . . . . . .2-11, 2-23
Low tire pressure warning light. . . . . . . .2-9
Low windshield-washer fluid warning
light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11, 2-23
Passenger air bag and status light . . . . .1-56
Seat belt warning light . . . . . . . .1-16, 2-11
Supplemental air bag warning light .1-66, 2-11
Vehicle security system . . . . . . . . . . .2-25
Warning/indicator lights and audible
reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7, 2-12
Warning labels (for SRS) . . . . . . . . . .1-65
Warning/indicator lights and audible
reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7, 2-12
Audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . .2-7, 2-12
Indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7, 2-12
Warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7, 2-12
Warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7, 2-12
Washer switch
Rear window wiper and washer
switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29
Wiper and washer switch . . . . . . . . . .2-27
Weights (See dimensions and weights) . . . . .9-9
Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-29
Wheel/tire size. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-9
When traveling or registering your vehicle
in another country . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-45
Locking passengers’ windows . . . . . . .2-46
Power rear windows . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-47
Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . . .2-47
Windshield-washer fluid. . . . . . . . . . . . .8-14
Windshield wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . .8-19
Wiper
Rear window wiper and washer
switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29
Wiper and washer switch . . . . . . . . . .2-27
Wiper blades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-19
Wiper and washer switch . . . . . . . . . . . .2-27
10-7
GAS STATION INFORMATION
RECOMMENDED FUEL
Use unleaded regular gasoline with an octane
rating of at least 87 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) number (Research octane number 91).
CAUTION
● Only vehicles with the E-85 filler door
label can operate on E-85. Fuel system
or other damage can occur if E-85 is
used in vehicles that are not designed
to run on E-85.
● Using a fuel other than that specified
could adversely affect the emission
control system, and may also affect the
warranty coverage.
● Under no circumstances should a
leaded gasoline be used, because this
will damage the three-way catalyst.
● Do not use E-15 or E-85 fuel in your
vehicle. Your vehicle is not designed to
run on E-15 or E-85 fuel. Using E-15 or
E-85 fuel in a vehicle not specifically
designed for E-15 or E-85 fuel can adversely affect the emission control devices and systems of the vehicle. Damage caused by such fuel is not covered
by the NISSAN new vehicle limited
warranty.
● U.S. government regulations require
ethanol dispensing pumps to be identified by a small, square, orange and
black label with the common abbreviation or the appropriate percentage for
that region.
ENGINE OIL RECOMMENDATION
• Genuine NISSAN engine oil or equivalent
• Engine oil with API Certification Mark
• Viscosity SAE 0W-20
For additional information, refer to “Engine oil and
oil filter recommendations” in the “Technical and
consumer information” section of this manual.
COLD TIRE PRESSURE:
Refer to the Tire and loading information label.
The label is typically located on the driver side
center pillar or on the driver’s door. For additional
information, refer to “Wheels and tires” in the
“Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this
manual.
RECOMMENDED NEW VEHICLE
BREAK-IN PROCEDURE:
During the first 1,200 mi (2,000 km) of vehicle
use, follow the break-in procedure recommendations for the future reliability and economy of your
new vehicle. For additional information, refer to
“Break-in schedule” in the “Starting and driving”
section of this manual. Follow these recommendations for the future reliability and economy of
your new vehicle. Failure to follow these recommendations may result in vehicle damage or
shortened engine life.
Printing : July 2015 (04)
Publication No.: OM0E
0L32U2
OM15EA
0Z52U3
Printed in U.S.A.
TOOUM-1SX6D
Z52-D